-------
_3
The annual mean concentration of phosphorus decreased from 62 mg m
_3
in 1969 to 47 mg m in 1973, which is almost 50% of the decrease
required to attain the new steady state concentration predicted with
a balance equation for phosphorus in a perfectly-mixed basin. Virtually
all the phosphorus lost from the lake since the influx decreased has
been deposited in the lake sediments, because the quantity lost through
the outflowing stream is very small.
The trophic state before and after the influx of phosphorus decreased
is described objectively by changes in the relative integral photosynthetic
rate, which indicates the fraction of photosynthetically active radiation
attenuated by phytoplankton populations on a scale from 0 to 1. The
relative integral photosynthetic rate is the integral photosynthetic
rate relative to the rate attained by a population dense enough to
attenuate all subsurface light. The maximal relative integral photo-
synthetic rates, attained by the densest populations in Lower Lake
Minnetonka, were 0.58 in 1968 and 0.43 in 1974, The latter is somewhat
higher than the maxima at highest population densities in Windermere,
England, (0.38) and Lake Victoria, Africa (0.32). The mean relative
integral photosynthetic rate during the ice-free season decreased
26% from 0.35 in 1969 to 0.26 in 1973, as mean concentrations of
—3 —3'
chlorophyll decreased from 22 ± 5 mg m to 14 ± 4 mg m
114
-------
REFERENCES
1. Report on bacteriological and chemical sampling of Lake Minnetonka,
1966-1967. Schoell and Madson, Inc., Engineers and Surveyors.
Hopkins, Minn. 1967. 52 p.
2. Overall plan for water management, Minnehaha Creek Watershed
District. E. A. Hickok Associates, Consulting Hydrologists,
Wayzata, Minn. 1969. 79 p.
3. A program for preserving the quality of Lake Minnetonka. Harza
Engineering Co. State of Minnesota Pollution Control Agency.
Minneapolis, Minn. 1971.
4. Zumberge, J. H. The lakes of Minnesota, their origin and classifica-
tion. Minn. Geol. Surv. Bull. 35. 1952. 99 p.
5. Wright, H. E. and R. V. Ruhe. Glaciation of Minnesota and Iowa.
In: H. E. Wright and D. G. Frey (ed.). Princeton Univ. Press.
1965. p. 29-41.
6. Waddington, J. C. B. A stratigraphic record of pollen influx to
a lake in the Big Woods of Minnesota. Geol. Soc. Amer. Spec. Paper
123:263-281. 1969.
7. Florin, M. and H. E. Wright, Jr. Diatom evidence for the persistence
of stagnant glacial ice in Minnesota. Geol. Soc. Amer. Bull.
80:695-704. 1969.
8. Megard, R. 0., P. D. Smith, A. S. Knoll, and W. S. Combs, Jr.
Attenuation of light and photosynthetic rates of phytoplankton.
Submitted for publication to Limnol. Oceanogr. 1975.
9. Tailing, J. F. Photosynthetic characteristics of some freshwater
plankton diatoms in relation to underwater radiation. New Phytol.
56:29-50. 1957.
10. Vollenweider, R. A. Models for calculating integral photosynthesis
and some implications regarding structural properties of the community
metabolism of aquatic systems. In: Prediction and measurement
of photosynthetic productivity. Proc. IBP/PP Tech. Meeting, Trebon,
Czechoslovakia. Wageningen. Centre Agr. Publ. Doc. 1970.
p. 455-472.
11. Tailing, J. F. Self-shading effects in natural populations of a
planktonic diatom. Wett. Leben. 12:235-242. 1960.
115
-------
12. Ganf, G. G. Incident solar irradlance and underwater light penetra-
tion as factors controlling the chlorophyll a^ content of a shallow
equatorial lake (Lake George, Uganda). J. Ecol. 62:593-629. 1974.
13. Wood, E. An ecological study of Lower Lake Minnetonka. M. S.
Thesis. Univ. Minn. Minneapolis. 1938. 39 p.
14. Megard, R. 0. Phytoplankton, photosynthesis, and phosphorus in
Lake Minnetonka, Minnesota. Limnol. Oceanogr. 17:68-87. 1972.
15. Bannister, T. T. Production equations in terms of chlorophyll
concentration, quantum yield, and upper limit to production.
Limnol. Oceanogr. 19:1-12. 1974.
16. Vollenweider, R, A. Calculation models of photosynthesis-depth
curves and some implications regarding day rate estimates in
primary production measurements. Mem. 1st. Ital. Idrobiol. 18(Suppl.)
425-257. 1965.
it
17. Vollenweider, R. A. Moglichkeiten und Grenzen elementarer Modelle
der Stoffbilang von Seen. Arch. Hydrobiol. 66:1-36. 1968.
18. Tailing, J. F. The underwater light climate as a controlling
factor in the production ecology of freshwater phytoplankton.
Mitt. Internat. Verein. Limnol. 19:214-243. 1971.
19. Bindloss, M. Primary productivity of phytoplankton in Loch Leven,
Kinross. Proc. Roy. Soc. Edinburgh (B) 10:157-181. 1974.
20. Tailing, J. F. The photosynthetic activity of phytoplankton in
East African Lakes. Int. Rev. ges. Hydrobiol. 50:1-32. 1965.
21. Bright, R. C. Surface water chemistry of some Minnesota lakes,
with some preliminary notes on diatoms. Univ. Minn. Limnol.
Res. Center Interim Report No. 3. 59 p. 1968.
116
-------
REPORT ON THE MINNEAPOLIS CITY LAKES
Joseph Shapiro
Limnological Research Center
University of Minnesota
Minneapolis, Minnesota
I. INTRODUCTION
A. Past History
The five lakes discussed in this report make up the so-called
Minneapolis Chain of Lakes. They are all within the Minneapolis city
limits (see Figure 1). Four of them, from north to south, Brownie,
Cedar, Isles, and Calhoun, are connected by channels made between 1910
and the early 1920's, but Lake Harriet, the southernmost, is isolated.
Lake of the Isles was dredged extensively about 1920. The four upper
lakes have had chronic low water problems for several decades because of
their connection with the groundwater table, the level of which has not
been high enough to sustain them. In order to resolve this low water
problem, storm drainage from the surrounding city was directed into the
lakes beginning in 1912 and continuing to the present. In addition,
groundwater used by nearby companies for cooling purposes has been added
to the four upper lakes. In recent dry years, water from the Mississippi
River and city drinking water has been pumped in. As a consequence,
particularly of the storm drain inputs, the lakes have become increasingly
eutrophic in recent years.
117
-------
©Birch Pond
Broirnie Lode \Loriag Pond
Cedar Lake
Lake of the Isles
/Diamond Lake
w
\jSrass Lake *>
Fig. 1. Location map of study area.
118
-------
Transparencies in Minneapolis Lakes in 1927 and 1971, m
Lake July 29, 1927 July-August, 1971
Brownie
Cedar
Isles
Calhoun
Harriet
4.1
3
2.6
3.4
4.1
1.9
1.2
.5
1.7
3
II. Geography
A. Latitude and Longitude - 45°N 93°W
B. Altitude
The surface of the upper lakes is at an altitude of
260 m above mean sea level. Lake Harriet's surface is at an
altitude of 258 m.
C. Catchment Area
Lake Are a, ha (inc. lake)
Brownie 47
Cedar 163
Isles 285
Calhoun 761
Harriet 480
D. Climatic data
Mean monthly air temperatures (°F) are approximately
as follows:
JFMAMJJASOND
High 22 25 35 55 65 75 84 82 70 58 43 27
Low 4 7 20 36 45 58 64 62 52 43 25 14
119
-------
The lakes begin to freeze over in November and breakup generally
occurs in mid-April. Ice thickness may reach 75 cm. Snow may
be present from October to May but the peak snowfall is from
November to March. Total snowfall may reach 150 cm. Approximate
average monthly precipitation as follows (in cm) :
JFMAMJJASOND
2.0 2.0 3.6 6.1 8.4 10.7 8.6 8.6 7.6 4.6 3.6 2.3
Summer winds average 190° (SSE) with a mean velocity from April
to October of 14.6 kph. Evaporation exceeds precipitation by
12.7 cm annually and by 17.8 cm between April and October.
Total evaporation averages about 99 cm per year.
E. Geology
All of the lakes are ice block lakes formed about
11,000 years ago. They are embedded in sand and gravel with
some clay. The bottom sediments are typical deep-water sediments
of productive lakes, total thickness unknown. Sfediments in Lake
of the Isles are only about .5 m deep and are underlaid by
undecomposed plant remains as this lake was essentially a swamp
until its dredging in the 1920s. Land erosion in the catchment
area is probably negligible as the whole area is urban and has
long been settled. Pollen analysis of the deep waters of Lake
Calhoun and Harriet shows a sedimentation rate of about 3 mm
per year.
F. Vegetation
Virtually all of the area not covered by impervious
120
-------
surfaces such as houses, roads, walks, and alleys is planted
in lawn grasses. A large number of trees, especially elms and
oaks, is present in the catchment area.
G. Population
2
Population density is high—about 1550/km .
H. Land use
Excluding water areas, 83% of the area surrounding
the lakes is urban, and includes residential use, commercial
and service use, institutional use, and transportation. The
remaining 17% is open land, and includes parks, a golf course,
a cemetery, islands in Lake of the Isles, and grassy areas
immediately surrounding the lakes.
I. Water use
The lakes are used primarily for fishing, swimming,
sailing, and canoeing. No water is taken for drinking purposes
J. Sewage and effluent discharge
No sanitary sewage or industrial effluents reach the
lakes.
III. Morphometric and hydrologic characteristics
A., B., C., D., and E. See Table below.
Est. % area
121
Epilimnion
Lake
Brownie
Cedar
Isles
Calhoun
Harriet
Area
(ha)
7.3
69
42
170
143
Max. depth
(m)
15
15
11
27
26
Mean depth
(m)
6.8
6.1
2.7
10.6
8.8
Volume
10 V3
0.5
4.22
1.12
18.0
12.5
less than
3 m deep
15
80
5
15
thickness ,
July - Aug
3
4
4
6
6
-------
F. Duration of stratification
The lakes are stratified for approximately six months
from late April to late October.
G. Sediments
The sediments are highly organic. Lake Calhoun has
2000 micrograms P/gram dry weight in the surface sediments and
800 micrograms P/gram dry weight below 10 cm. Lake Harriet has
3000 micrograms P/gram dry weight at the surface, falling to
800 at 25 cm/ then rising again to high and variable concentra-
tions of between 2000 and 6000 grams P/gram dry weight.
H. Variation of precipitation
See IID above.
I. Inflow and outflow of water
Lake
Brownie
Cedar
Isles
Calhoun
Harriet
Total inflow 103m3
252
1281
1812
5012
5157
% lost to groundwater
79
61
82
75
81
% lost to evaporation
21
39
18
25
19
There are no functional surface outlets. The percentage
of groundwater loss was determined by resolving the hydrologic
budget, i.e. by accounting for all inputs and outputs except
groundwater. Because the upper lakes are connected, this
procedure may not be entirely correct. If, for example, Lake
of the Isles has a completely impervious basin, its excess water
will run to Lake Calhoun which would then have a higher loss to
groundwater than was calculated. This would not change the water
122
-------
residence time for Isles but Lake Calhoun would appear to have
a longer residence time than it really has.
J. Currents
No currents are known.
K. Water retention time
With the possible error noted in I above, retention
times are as follows:
Water retention
Lake times (yrs)
Brownie 1.98 (probably less for the
mixolimnion because of
meromixis)
Cedar 3.30
Isles .62
Calhoun 3.59
Harriet 2.43
IV. Limnological characterization
A. Physical
1. Temperature
All of the lakes fetratify thermally. Surface
temperatures range up to 26°C in summer but typically are
20-22°C. Bottom temperatures are 5-7°C except in Brownie Lake
which is meromictic from road salt. Its bottom temperatures
are higher than those at 6-8 m which are at 4°C. The mixolimnion
extends down to 4 m in Brownie Lake.
2. Conductivity
1974 range in surface specific
Lake conductance (micromhos/cm).
Brownie 400-475
Cedar 400
Isles 380-470
Calhoun 400-500
Harriet 360-425
123
-------
3. Light
No light measurements were made other than
Secchi disk transparencies.
4. Color
The lakes have no apparent color.
5. Solar radiation
No measurements were made.
B. Chemical
1. pjl
Epilimnetic pH values are high throughout the
growing season.
Lake
Brownie
Cedar
Isles
Calhoun
Harriet
1971-72 pH maximum in
surface waters
8.91
9.30
9.49
9.10
8.81
2. Dissolved oxygen
All of the lakes have anoxic hypolimnia from late
May until turnover in October-November. Anoxia in Isles begins
somewhat earlier. Brownie Lake has an anoxic hypolimnion year
round because of its meromixis.
3. Phosphorus
a. Orthophosphorus-P
Calhoun, Harriet, and Cedar surface waters contain
5 ppb or less PO.-P during the summer. Isles and Brownie surface-
waters contain 10 ppb or less during the summer. Bottom water
concentrations are as follows:
124
-------
Lake
PO .-P, miprograms/I
Brownie
Cedar
Isles
Calhoun
Harriet
>1600
738
601
379
255
b. Total P
Lake Surface range, ppb P
Brownie 30-40
Cedar 30-40
Isles 70-100
Calhoun 40-50
Harriet 40
Mean concentration
whole lake
55
110
106
62
4 . Nitrogen
No total nitrogen figures are available. Surface
NO,-N is less than 5 ppb in the summer. Surface NH^-N is less
than 50 ppb in the summer.
5. Alkalinity
Lake
Brownie
Cedar
Isles
Calhoun
Harriet
surface ranges
1971-1972 meg/1
2.47-2.72
1.41-2.18
1.36-2.62
1.59-2.27
1.84-2.47
6. Major ions
Lake
Brownie
Cedar
Isles
Calhoun
Harriet
Na
3.11
1.
1.
1.
38
64
64
1.21
K
.06
.08
.09
.10
.10
Surface values 11/16/71
Ca
1.
1.
1,
1.
99
63
63
55
Mg
1
1
1
1
,04
,03
,01
22
1.63
1.02
.28
.42
.33
.31
.21
Cl
3.64
1.61
1.91
1.93
1.54
HC03
2.65
2.26
2.31
2.36
2.41
125
-------
Total iron concentrations in all the lakes averaged about 20 ppb.
7. Trace metals
No determinations were made.
C. Biological characteristics
1. Phy top 1 ankton
a. chlorophyll a
Lake
Brownie
Cedar
Isles
Calhoun
Harriet
1971 surface values ppb
4.3-24
2.4-27
15-72
3.4-37
1.2-27
mean surface concentration
July-August 1971
5.6
20
53
6.0
3.5
b. Primary production
No measurements.
c. Algal assays
No algal assays as such. Determinations of
alkaline phosphatase activity show low values until late July
and high values through September.
d. Identification and count
The five dominant algae in 1971-72 are listed
be low
Lake
Brownie
Cedar
Algae
Fragilaria crotonensis
Mougeotia sp.
Asterionella formosa
Cryptomonad sp. 3
Oocystis spp.
Scourfeldia cordiformis
Anabaena planctonica
Cryptomonad sp. 3
Oscillatoria agardhii
Aphanizomenon elenkinii
126
-------
Lake Algae
Isles Scourfeldia cordiformis
Aphanizomenon flos-aquae
Anabaenopsis raciborskii
Oscillatoria agardhii
Asterionella formosa
Calhoun Aphanizomenon flos-aquae
Anabaena planctonica
Stephanodiscus niagarae
Stephanodiscus-Cyclotella spp,
Cryptomonad sp. 3
Harriet Aphanizomenon flos-aquae
Ceratium hirundinella
Oocystis spp.
Cryptomonad sp. 3
Stephanodiscus niagarae
Volume % of blue-greens during
Lake July and August 1971
Brownie /. 5
Cedar 99
Isles 99
Calhoun 95
Harriet 78
2 . Zo op lank ton
a. Identification and count
Numbers of species in each lake
Lake Cyclops Piaptomus Daphnia Chydorus sphaericus
Cedar 111 present
Isles 1 .1 4 present
Calhoun 325 present
Harriet 113 present
The numbers are very variable.
3. Bottom fauna
Bottom fauna was very sparse in all the lakes.
4. Fish
Fish in the lakes are mostly yellow perch, blue-gill
sunfish, and black crappies. Some northern pike are present and
127
-------
bass are abundant in Cedar and Isles. Isles has many carp.
5. Bacteria
Unknown.
6. Bottom flora
Unknown.
7. Macrophytes
Brownie A ring of Nuphar variegatum to a depth of 1.8 m.
Cedar Nuphar and Nymphaea with Potamogeton and Ceratophyllum
in significant quantities.
Isles Ceratophyllum and Potamogeton in water of less than
1. 8 m.
Calhoun Potamogeton and Ceratophyllum in less than 1.8 m.
Harriet Ceratophy1lum and Elodea in less than 2.5 m.
Cedar Lake is the only lake in which the weeds are very abundant.
V. Nutrient budget summary
A. Phosphorus
kg/year/lake in 1971
Sources Brownie Cedar Isles Calhoun Harriet
Waste discharges
(includes city
water and air
conditioning
water) 24.6 0.2 0 13.3 0
Land runoff
(via storm drain
and direct)
Estimated
precipitation
Estimated ground-
water input
Total 85.9 241 851 1461 101
57.5
3.8
0
205
36
0
828
23
0
1357
91
0
890
72
54
-------
B. Nitrogen
No data are available.
C. Other budgets
None.
VI. Discussion
A. Limnological characteristics
B. Trophic state
By most criteria all of these lakes would be classed
as eutrophic. Data from 1933 show considerably lower concen-
trations of algae, lower pH, higher dissolved oxygen, and higher
transparency. There is no question that the addition of storm
runoff has been responsible for the changes.
C. Trophic state vs. nutrient budgets
Lake
Brownie
Cedar
Isles
Calhoun
Harriet
grams P/itr/yr
1.18
0.35
2.06
0.88
0.71
Mean depth/detention time
3.43 (2.02 mixolimnion)
1.85
4.35
2.95
3.62
Plotting the results from the above table would suggest
that the lakes should form a series with Isles being most
eutrophic and Cedar least so. While some indicators of trophic
state would corroborate this, e.g. total P, others, such as
chlorophyll, epilimnetic pH, and transparency would not, i.e.
Isles is most eutrophic on any basis but Cedar is least so with
some, and not least eutrophic with others. Furthermore, the
situation changes from year to year. Thus, if summer chlorophyll
129
-------
concentrations are used as the index, Lake of the Isles appears
to be becoming less eutrophic in recent years while Calhoun and
Harriet, after several years of lessened eutrophy, appear to be
becoming more eutrophic (Figure 2), These chlorophyll data are
substantiated by transparency measurements and measurements of
algal abundance as shown in the table. So far as is known, the
nutrient budgets of the lakes have not changed in recent years.
Therefore, the question arises, why have the lakes undergone
these changes? A variety of hypotheses have been tested and
discarded. For example, neither Lake Harriet nor Lake Calhoun
appear to have more nitrogen fixing algae in 1974 than in
1971-72, as judged by heterocyst frequencies. Neither has
there been a related change in either total rainfall or the
seasonal pattern of rainfall that brings the nutrients into
the lake. It appears rather that changes within the lakes
themselves are responsible for the changes in the manifestation
of eutrophy, i.e. changes have occurred despite the fact that
the total phosphorus has remained constant (see table for Lake
Harriet data) .
One explanation that appears likely is that the algal
abundance is being affected by the grazing of zooplankton and
that the higher chlorophyll concentrations occur as a result
of less grazing. Substantiation for this is shown in Figure 3
where the transparency in Lake Calhoun during 1973 appears to
correlate very well with the abundance of Daphnia. If this is
a correct explanation then it implies that zooplankton grazing
pressure in the lakes has been changing. This in turn could be
130
-------
70
60
rO
50
ISLES
—J 40
V
X
CL
O
30
O
20
O
\
\
\
\
•CALHOUN
V
\
HARRIET
\
\
\
68
69
70 7\
YEAR
72
73
74
Fig. 2. Mean surface chlorophyll concentrations for the period July-September.
131
-------
Lake Harriet
Date
1968
1969
1971
1972
1973
1974
7/23
7/29
7/19
8/2
8/24
9/13
7/6
7/24
8/9
8/22
9/13
7/11
7/25
8/23
9/19
7/22
8/20
9/16
Secchi
Disk
(feet)
-
5.0
11.3
5.2
5.6
5.9
14.0
11.0
9.3
8.4
10.0
10.0
7.0
9.0
8.8
5.5
3.5
6.6
Surface
Chlorophyll
(ppb)
16.0
10.0
1.7
4.5
2.8
3.2
2.4
2.8
4.2
3.4
4.0
(3.9)
3.9
24.0
47.4
14.8
Surface
Algae
(mg/1)
Surface
Total P
(ppb)
4.4
1.1
0.61
0.61
0.33
1.1
1.5
0.70
10.2
12.0
10.2
41
43
41
42
37
37
39
38
38
35
40
35
22
64
45
42
( ) = values from 2.5 m, not used in average.
132
-------
0
2
-' 4
6
8
LJ
°-12
< 14
o:
16
18
20
TRANSPARENCY
DAPHNIA
2000
O
>
T)
JOOO J"
o
OJ
MAY JUNE JULY AUG. SEPT.
0
Fig. 3. Relationship between Secchi Disk Transparency and Daphnia abundance
in Lake Calhoun during 1973.
133
-------
a result of changes in the populations of such fish as yellow
perch which are zooplanktivorous. In fact, we have recently
begun a program to test the possibility of using carnivorous
fish to control zooplanktivorous fish, so that zooplankton
grazing could increase and so help control algae.
Because of such biological effects as suggested above on
the manifestations of eutrophication, it appears extremely
unlikely that the loading concept will ever be linked in a
precise fashion with trophic state.
134
-------
SECTION III - NEW YORK
A DESCRIPTION OF THE TROPHIC STATUS AND
NUTRIENT LOADING FOR LAKE GEORGE, NEW YORK
«•
James J. Ferris and Nicholas L. Clesceri
Rensselaer Fresh Water Institute at Lake George
Rensselaer Polytechnic Institute
Troy, New York
I. INTRODUCTION
Lake George is located in the eastern Adirondack Mountains of New York
State (Fig. 1), and has been under investigation by scientists and engineers
of the Rensselaer Fresh Water Institute as well as by other educational and
governmental bodies within the region. The lake has served as an aquatic site
for the Eastern Deciduous Forest Biome of the International Biological Program.
Much of the data presented was collected as part of that multidisciplinary,
ecosystem-wide study.
Lake George lies in a glacial-scoured basin of Precambrian metamorphic,
plutonic and igneous rock, with small patches of Cambrian deposits mainly at
the southern end of the basin. Most of the drainage basin is covered with
shallow soil from glacial debris with numerous outcroppings present.
Prior to the colonization of the New World, Lake George was part of a
natural trail, and the site of numerous Indian conflicts. Its strategic
location between the Hudson River and Lake Champlain made it an area of battle
in both the French and Indian Wars and the Revolutionary War.
During the latter part of the nineteenth century, mining operations in
the region produced a representative supply of the nation's high-grade graphite
as well as some iron ore. An active logging industry was also present at this
time which supported several mills in the Village of Ticonderoga, located on
the extreme north end of Lake George. Virtually all this industry, however,
ceased within the first three decades of the twentieth century.
It has been replaced by a flourishing tourist trade, drawn by the beauty
of the lake and its scenery. The resort aspects of the area were enhanced
by the construction of the Adirondack Northway in 1967, which made the lake
far more accessible to the large urban areas to the south and north.
135
-------
a
.3
4-1
n)
o
o
136
-------
TICONDEROGA B MILL
LAKE GEORGE
HAGUE BROOK BASIN
NORTHWEST BAY BROOK BASIN
RENSSELAER
FRESH WATER
INSTITUTE
AT LAKE
GEORGE
INDIAN BROOK BASIN
ENGLISH BROOK
BASIN
WEST BROOK
BASIN
SHELVING ROCK
BROOK BASIN
0 12345
SCALE IN MILES
Figure 2.
QLAKE SAMPLING STATIONS
Location of Lake George Sampling Stations.
Not located on the map are the following stations:
1. Smith Bay and Burnt Point are located immediately east of Station 6.
2. Lake George Village is located in the extreme southwestern corner of Lake
George (in the West Brook drainage basin).
3. Tea Island is located immediately to the west of Station 1.
4. Diamond Island is located immediately to the south of Station 2.
137
-------
II. BRIEF GEOGRAPHIC DESCRIPTION OF WATER BODY
Lake George is a relatively large lake located in the south-
eastern Adirondack Mountain region of New York State. It lies within
the basin boundaries of latitude 43°22' and 43°51' North and longitudes
73°24' and 73°47' West. The lake surface stands at 97 meters above
o
sea level, and encompasses 114 km . The drainage basin surface
area is 492 km^, giving a total catchment area of 606 km^. Thus,
the tributary watershed to lake surface ratio is only 4. 3.
In general, the climatology of Lake George is typical for the
humid continental climatic region of the Northeastern United States
(Stewart, 1971, 1972). 1970-71 monthly air temperatures are presented
in Table 1 for the Lake George basin. Long term averages at Glens
Falls, located approximately seven miles south of Lake George are
-7.2°C in January and 21°C in July.
Wind pattern analysis by Stewart (1972) shpw that for the
period of September 1971 through August 1972, wind speed averaged
5.65 jh 0.65 knots (based on monthly averages). Wind direction is
from the south or southwest during the warmer months, but shifts to
the north or northwest in November, December, February, March and
April.
Lake evaporation and evapotranspiration figures for the Lake
George catchment area are presented in Table 2. Evaporation has
been calculated using the Penman Method and the evapotranspiration
from a water balance of the active soil zone.
General Geologic Characteristics
Lake George occupies a graben in Precambrian bedrock. This
bedrock consists of plutonic, metamorphic and igneous rock, for example,
gneisses and schists, syenite, granite and gabbro. At a few places
along the shore of the southern Lake George basin are exposures of
Cambrian sandstones (Potsdam sandstone) and dolostones (Little Falls
dolomite).
The linear straight shorelines and sheer slopes are the combined
effect of erosion following prominent faults and a deepening of the fault-
controlled valleys by the sweep of the Pleistocene glaciers which deepened
the rock channels. Prior to glaciation, two rivers drained the Lake
George basin. One stream originated in the narrow trench now occupied
by Northwest Bay Brook and flowed into the southern Lake George basin;
the second river flowed from the Narrows northward. A preglacial
divide existed where the Narrows are now located. When the glaciers
plowed their way through the deep narrow Lake George Valley they
138
-------
W
§
tH
55
„
W
S
O
w
o
1
od
o
fa
^™\
o
o
1
3
w
w
£-1
tA
>-•
. T
c
g
§
w
o
<
r-l
,_(
4J
.s s
*n |^^
O ON
4J
c
«
ON
vO
^0 S
M
X!
u
M
O
r-4
r-l
0)
bO
td
r-l O
•r4 O>
^ r-l
0)
50
O
8 s
OJ ON
ky t
r-M r™*
3
•H
CO
^ 4J
2 §
w S
r-l VO r-l ON
ON s^- CM CM
I 1 1
r-4 00
* *
\r\ o
i i
!**• ^C ON CO r-l
r-i m CM -4- cn
r-< r-l
1 1 1
m rx cn m
-TlJ
F^l
I I
CM
O
1
>•>
J-i «
§3 A r-<
M CJ *H
§ "S ffl 0. rt"
•-) fa 32
-------
Table 2. EVAPORATION AND EVAPOTRANSPIRATION
(1971 WATER YEAR) FOR LAKE GEORGE, N.Y.*
Date
Lake Evaporation
Evapotraq
Month
October
November
December
January
February
March
April
May
Inches/day^
0.06
0,04
0.03
0.02
0.03
0.05
0.07
0.11
Jnches/ month
1.91
1.18
0.80
0.67
0.81
1.42
2.19
3.51
Inches /day
0.06
0.04
0.03
0.02
0.03
0.04
0.06
0.10
Inches /month
1.74
1.11
0.78
0.63
0.74
1.26
1.91
3.06
spiration
*(Colon, 1972)
deepened the Narrows by ice erosion. The waters of Lake George are
now held in place by Pleistocene glacial sediments which block the river
outlets at the north and south end of the lake. At the south end of the
lake glacial sand and gravel deposits rise 500 feet above lake level.
After the retreat of the glaciers Lake George was a glacial lake as
evidenced by the presence of varved clay flooring the bottom of the lake
in the Narrows; this varved clay also occurs above the present lake
level at elevations up to 750 to 800 feet.
Surficial sediments of the Champlain basin of which Lake George
forms a part have been mapped. Sand and gravel are abundant in the
delta and ice-contact gravels southwest of Lake George Village (Schoettle
and Friedman, 1971).
Vegetation
Hemlock (72% of stands), sugar maple (69%), white pine (64%),
red maple and northern oak (57%) are the most frequently encountered
of 35 tree species occurring in 75 randomly selected stands in the Lake
George drainage basin. Hemlock leads in density (32% stands), white
pine (13%), beech (12%), northern red oak (9%), and red/sugar maple
140
-------
(8%). Distribution patterns of hemlock and pine shows the former is
most abundant in sloping stands at the lowest elevation (100 m) and gener-
ally prevail on the east side of the basin, while white pine is best
represented in level stands about 200 m, but uncommon on the east side.
Forest composition of our random sample for the drainage basin differs
slightly from 1970 estimates by Northeast Forest Experiment Station
in that pine-hemlock stands are more common (42%-18%) and elm-ash-
red maple and spruce-fir less common (3%-17% and 0%-7%) (Nicholson
and Scott, 1972).
Population - See Tables 3 and 4.
Land Usage - Data are not available.
Use of Water
Primarily drinking, aesthetics, sport (i. e. , boating, fishing,
SCUBA diving, swimming, etc. ), and all other recreational purposes.
Sewage and Effluent Discharges
The types of wastewater discharges in the Lake George drainage
Table 3. POPULATION DISTRIBUTION IN THE
LAKE GEORGE, N. Y. BASIN*
South Lake Basin
North Lake Basin
Population
Type
Permanent,
Year -Round
Summer Camp
Resort Hotel
and Motel
Total Avg.
Summer
Number Total
Sev/ered Number
2,930
1,750
9,111
13,791
4,445
8,775
12, 558
25,778
Number Total
Sewered Number
0
0
0
0
1,130
3,205
47
4,382
* Compiled from 1970 Census data.
141
-------
g
on
•
to
H
B
H
3
P
p3
0
w
0
H
8
rvi
•3
•
lH
5
CQ
ffi
W
S
&
w
S
H™
^^
ff
pt
CO
p!
<
g
C
fc-
«3
S
2
1-^
<
£•
c
p
Jr
a
X
g
0) «H
tt) -p
a 0
(H H
>!
*5 9
H*
0 JH
-P Si
O §
EH S
03
T)
S
I)
3
4>
CQ
HOOOOOO OOO
<7\ O
CM IfN
CVJ H
tVJ r^
•H
0
•P
S
mop CViif\OOO OOO
-d-OHCO H OO lf\j*
CO ON H N- CU QO CVJ
.? IA CVI CVI CVJ H
F"H
a
o
•H
•P
H 0
CO H
•P P
O PH
S3 o
08 w
-p
H Vi
0) O
•P CO
O V
S crt
"d
0)
IH
CD
>
a>
CQ
HOOOOOO OOO
VO LTN
vo_a-
00
H
5
P
EH
ITvOOO-OOOO OOO
cvj on
O CV)
S
,
I
1
|
i f).CM
1 WC
0 O
0 -H
-p
M 0
0) rH
g Q
CQ PH
-a
0)
h
a>
»
a>
CQ
OOOOOOO OOO
O m
IfN CVI
H
H
5
8
QOl/MT\OOO OQO
O O CVJ t-- O O C?S
p-*-* on o c>- O
CM CM r-t CVI CVJ H
H
4.|§
C 3 «rt
« O -P
c c« 0
1*3
M 0 P.
9> Q) O
ft N ft
•d
S
1
a>
CQ
t^Q OOOOO OOO
rH CO
CVJ
ti
4>
g
^^5S°°S ^^R
VO Hv2)^- CVJ H H
CVJ H
cj
|. = = E r C £
!>»CU fl«) 06""
•P bfl >s G M u H
c ^ & o a
a o s N JQ o c
Of .0 3 eo G O C S
UOC CO n3 E O -P < d »
1 r-l -P
1 ON «H
1 H
•
> .
a H
O VA WO
\D V *>
CVJ ^J C
r-H -P O
o
>»
P H
0
to -p
a> a
Ol Q C QJ
I lf\ -H S
1C— H B
I H O
C fH
•H -rl
CQ >
0 C
O rO W
0! CO
15 &%
( p g t
•H'-P
0 P<
h S^
•o o
o a>
0 8 -"^
OX S -P
CVJ C CQ
o
!§
G «O
3= 0 -P
6 C
t-i a> a>
CC Q) EL
>, M > C)
-P O H
C 5n 0 0>
9 0) -P >
O t3 0 CU
o c p p
o
X O H
Q) -r-t 0 •
« EH -P H
CQ O
W EH
•
T3
a>
gj
3
CO
CO
0
?
o
fH
&
CQ
a
0
w
p
&
lf\
«H
O
«
>> CM
O C^-
c u\
0 H
S1 ^
0 fH
0 0)
O 0
CO
fl CU
CD r— 1
I B
R
CQ
H •§
OS fl5
B yQ
O 0)
C H
< <,
• •
cvi rn
142
-------
basin are: 1) secondary treated (trickling filter plant) from the Village
of Lake George Sewage Treatment Plant onto natural sand beds, 2) pri-
mary treated (Imhoff tank) discharged onto natural sand beds from the
Town of Bolton facility, 3) septic tank-leach field effluent, and 4) pit
privy discharge. There is no industrial discharge. Population data
relative to this are seen in Table 4.
III. MORPHOMETRIC AND HYDROLOGIC DESCRIPTION OF WATER
BODY (at 97.25 m or 319 ft. amsl)
Surface Area of Water - 114 sq. km (44 sq. mi.)
1. Length - 51 km (32 mi.)
2. Width - Maximum = 4.0 km (2.4 mi.)
Average = 2.3 km (1.4 mi.)
3. Shoreline Length - 209.6 km (131 mi.)
Volume of Water - 2.1 km3 (0.5 mi.3)
Regulation - Lake George Water Levels (as described in Section 38 of
the New York State Navigation Law)
Any dam or other similar structure so located in the outlet
of Lake George as to affect the water levels of the lake shall, with due
allowance for fluctuations due to natural causes or to emergencies and
for a reasonable use of water for power and for sanitary purposes, be
operated in such a manner as to maintain the waters of the lake from
the first day of June to the thirtieth day of September in each year as
nearly as may be at an average level of three and five-tenths feet on
the gage of the United States Geological Survey at Rogers Rock on Lake
George, known as Rogers Rock gage, and in such a manner as to main-
tain the waters of the lake from the first day of October to the first
day of December at a level which shall not fall below two and five-
tenths feet on said gage; and, consistent with the above mentioned fluc-
tuations and reasonable use, the waste gates of any such dam or other
structure shall be operated so that, to the extent possible, the waters
of the lake will not be permitted to rise above a level of four feet on
such gage at any time during the year or to fall below a level of two
and five-tenths feet on said gage at any time after the first day of June
and prior to the first day of December in any year. If at any time
during the year the waters of the lake shall rise above such level of
four feet any person owning or operating such dam or other structure
shall immediately open the waste gates thereof and take such other
appropriate action as in the judgment of the superintendent of public
works may be necessary to lower the waters of the lake with the least
practicable delay to a level not higher than four feet on said gage. If
at any time after the first day of June and prior to the first day of
December in any year the waters of the lake shall fall below such level
143
-------
of two and five-tenths feet such person shall immediately close the
waste gates of such dam or other structure; and no person shall with-
draw water from the lake for the purpose of generating power during any
period of time between the first day of June and the first day of October
in any year when the level of the waters of the lake is below two and
five-tenths feet on said gage. The superintendent of public works or his
duly authorized representative shall at all times have access to such dam
or other structure and is hereby authorized and directed to operate the
waste gates thereof whenever necessary for the purpose of carrying out
the provisions of this section. The superintendent of public works shall
establish such rules and regulations as in his judgment may be neces-
sary for the enforcement of the provisions of this section, and he is
hereby authorized to enter into such agreement or agreements with any
person or persons owning or operating any such dam or other structure
as in his judgment may be necessary in order to carry into effect the
provisions of this section and of such rules and regulations. In addition,
the superintendent of public works shall, once in each year during the
first week in July, cause to be published in at least three daily news-
papers serving the area the reading on the Rogers Rock gage on the
first day of July in that year. Any person violating any provision of
this section or of any rule or regulation established or of any agreement
entered into pursuant thereto shall for every such violation forfeit to
the people of the state the sum of not to exceed two hundred and fifty
dollars to be recovered in a civil action.
Maximum and Average Depths - See Table 5 (Colon, 1972; Langmuir,
et al., 1966).
Table 5. MAXIMUM AND AVERAGE DEPTHS
FOR LAKE GEORGE, N. Y.
Basin
Maximum Depth
Aver a &e Depth
North
South
Total Lake
53.3 m (175 ft.)
58 m (191 ft.)
58 m (191 ft.)
20.5 m (67.3 ft.)
15.5 m (50.9 ft.)
18 m (59 ft.)
Location of Exceptional Depths and the Surface Area Ratio of Deep to
Shallow Waters - These data are not available.
Ratio of Epilimnion over Hypolimnion - These calculations are not
available.
Duration of Stratification - This phenomenon occurs in Lake George for
approximately 150 to 180 days (i.e., from May 1 through
October 31).
144
-------
Nature of Lake Sediments
Most of the sediments of Lake George consist of silty clay;
pure sand lies mostly near the shore, yet most sand also contains silt
and clay in nearly equal amounts. In the south basin sediments con-
taining more than 50 percent clay occur near the east shore and under-
lie the large central expanse of the lake. Sediments with less than 25
percent clay (hence mostly sandy) are restricted to the west shore of
the south basin, although in two places a tongue of sandy sediment is
present in the central area of the south basin. Sediments underlying
the eastern Narrows are rich in clay, whereas those beneath the western
Narrows are generally rich in sand. The southern part of the north
basin is underlain by clay-rich sediments. In the central part of this
basin clay floors the middle of the lake and sand is found closer to
shore. In the northernmost part of the north basin, near Ticonderoga,
the sediment consists mostly of sand (See Figure 3).
In the south basin most of the bottom sediments contain be-
tween 5 and 10 percent organic carbon. However, close to and in bays
of the east shore the organic carbon content exceeds 10 percent. By
contrast, near the west shore and in two tongues in the central part
of the south basin the organic carbon content is < 5 percent. The
sediments of the Narrows are mostly depleted in organic carbon, where-
as the sediments of the north basin contain between 5 and 10 percent
organic carbon in the center, but < 5 percent near the shore. Near
Ticonderoga the sediments of the northernmost part of Lake George
contain < 5 percent organic carbon. The muddy bottom sediments of
Lake Champlain, contiguous to Lake George, contain 5 to 20 percent
organic carbon; organic mud covers about three-quarters of its bottom
(See Figure 4).
Many values of organic carbon exceed 10 percent and most
sediments contain between 5 and 10 percent organic carbon. These
high values indicate that a large part of the clay-size fraction consists
of organic matter. To compute organic matter from organic carbon a
factor of 1.72 is used, so that in most sediments between 8.6 and 17.2
percent organic matter is present. Examination under the binocular
microscope shows that the organic matter in the nearshore sediments
consists largely of leaves, needles, tree bark, and spore capsules. In
deeper water sediments, however, the fabric of organic matter usually
cannot be identified because of advanced decomposition. In the clay-
size fraction quartz and clay minerals including illite and chlorite with
traces of kaolinite are found. In the cores studied the same clay-
mineral suite occurs unchanged throughout the cores. The clay is
derived from the local metamorphic and igneous bedrock and the glacial
sediments.
145
-------
-to Loke Chomptoin
Tt'conderogo Creek
NORTH
LAKE
GEORGE
CLAY %
FIGURE 3. Clay
Content Of Lake George
Surface Sediments.
CZ3 25-50
>50
X SAMPLING STATIONS
LAKE
GEORGE
VILLAGE
-------
1o Loft* Chomplgin
Ticondarogo Creak
NORTH
LAKE
GEORGE
FIGURE 4. Organic
Carbon Content of Lake
George Surface Sediments
ORGANIC CARBON %
<5
5-10
A, X SAMPLING STATIONS
Lake
Georg*
Villogt
147
-------
In the sand the light minerals are quartz and feldspars
(plagioclase, orthoclase), some microcline, muscovite and biotite. The
heavy mineral fraction is dominated by garnet; less abundant heavy
minerals include hornblende, sillimanite, epidote, hypersthene, augite,
staurolite, kyanite, zoisite, zircon, tourmaline, rutile, titanite and
iron-rich biotite.
Except at water-sediment interface all sediment color is black.
There the color is either black or brown; the brown color of fine-
grained sediment passing downward into black. Black color at the
interface dominates near the east shore in the south basin, especially-
near the bays, whereas brown color is present near the west shore.
The sediments in the Narrows and contiguous areas consist of
varved clay in which iron-manganese nodules occur (Schoettle and
Friedman, 1973).
Seasonal Variation of Monthly Precipitation Together With Maximum and
Minimum Conditions on Drainage Basin - See Tables 6a and 6b (Colon,
1972).
Table 6a. AVERAGE MONTHLY PRECIPITATION FOR THE SOUTH BASIN
(STATION 1), LAKE GEORGE, N.Y.+
Month
Precipitation (Inches)
1969 1970
1971
January
February
March
April
May
June
July
August
September
October
November
December
0.083 (0.820)
0.041* (0.360)
0.050 (0.870)
0.136 (1.490)
0.137 (1.020)
0.104 (1.060)
0.112 (0.920)
0.078 (0.380)
0.052 (0.600)
0.042 (0.490)
0.175** (1.070)
0.081 (0.890)
0.021* (0.210)
0.082 (0.830)
0.078 (0.650)
0.058 (1.090)
0.074 (0.950)
0.065 (0.810)
0.095 (0.800)
0.067 (0.930)
0.138** (1.130)
0.092 (0.800)
0.106 (0.940)
0.115 (0.840)
0.052* (0.480)
0.158** (1.170)
0.127 (1.260)
0.087 (1.200)
0.070 (0,620)
0.053 (0.940)
-1.0
-1.0
-1.0
-UO
-1.0
-1.0
The maximum precipitation value (inches) for each month is seen
in parenthesis. Missing data are shown, as -1.0. Annual mini-
mum and maximum precipitation values are designated by an
asterisk (*) and double asterisk (**) respectively.
148
-------
Table 6b. AVERAGE MONTHLY PRECIPITATION FOR THE
NORTH BASIN (STATION 6), LAKE GEORGE, N. Y. +
Precipitation (Inches)
Month r 1969 1970 1971
January
February
March
April
May
June
July
August
September
October
November
December
-1.0
-1.0
-1.0
-1.0
-1.0
-1.0
-1.0
-1.0
-1.0
0.030* (0.400)
0.145 (0.860)
0.155** (0.860)
0.013* (0.120)
0.089 (0.930)
0.070 (0.600)
0.117 (1.770)
0.089 (1.090)
0.069 (0.680)
0.089 (1.090)
0.074 (1.240)
0.128** (0.980)
0.085 (0.650)
0.039 (0.270)
0.076 (0.710)
0.050* (0.500)
0.161** (1.180)
0.098 (0.710)
0.055 (0.710)
0.065 (0.560)
-1.0
-1.0
-1.0
-1.0
-1.0
-1.0
-1.0
+ The maximum precipitation value (inches) for each month is seen
in parenthesis. Missing data are shown as -1.0. Annual mini-
mum and maximum precipitation values are designated by an
asterisk (*) and double asterisk (**) respectively.
Inflow and Outflow of Water
For the period of October, 1971 through May, 1972, total
water input to the lake was 94.6 in-., losses were 86.5 in. and a
storage of 8. 1 in. Groundwater for the 1971 water year is seen in
Figure 5 (Colon, 1972). Average outflow from, the lake at the north
(Ticonderoga) is 8.34 m^/sec., based on 22 years of record.
Water Currents - These data have not been determined.
Water Renewal Time - Based on the volume and average outflow from
the lake, the water retention time in Lake George, NY is
7. 98 years.
149
-------
o
o
i
E
V
in
H
S
O
UJ
UJ
o m
o
o
o
o.
GC
UJ
i
o
Ul
o
I
s
id - "I3A31 B31VM
15Q
-------
IV. LIMNOLOGICAL CHARACTERIZATION (Preliminary)
Physical
1. Temperature - See Figures 6, 7, 8, and 9 (Williams and Clesceri,
1972; Colon, 1972).
2. Conductivity - These data available at this time are from April
through September, 1971 and ranged from 85-95 u mohs/cm.
3. Light transmittance - Light intensity at the surface was 2,400 ft.
candles during March, 1971 and 1972. During August, 1971 and
1972 the surface light intensity approached 6,000 ft. candles.
Other data are shown in Tables 7 and 8 (Williams and Clesceri,
1972).
4. Color - Measurements of color of lake water have not yet been
determined for Lake George, NY.
5. Solar Radiation - See Figure 10 (Colon, 1972).
Chemical
1. pH - See Table 9.
2. Dissolved oxygen - See Table 10 (Williams & Clesceri, 1972).
3. Total phosphorus including (fraction) forms - See Table 11.
4. Total nitrogen including (fraction) forms - See Tables 12 and 13.
5. Alkalinity - See Table 14.
6. Ca, Mg, Na, K, SO Cl, Fe - See Table 15 for Fe; insufficient
data on others. (Williams and Clesceri, 1972).
7. Silica - See Table 16.
Biological
1. Phytoplankton
a. Chlorophyll - These data are not available.
b. Primary production - See Figure 12. In addition, data re-
garding annual production of Nitella flexilis (macroalga) and
other macrophytes are given in Table 17 (Stress, 1972).
c. Identification and count - Tables 18 and 19 (Howard, 1973)
and Figure 11 (Williams and Clesceri, 1972).
151
-------
* I
til
§
UJ
o
o
z
UJ
o:
UJ
Q.
2
LU
UJ
-i
S-
§
8
evj
§
at
§
%
^
* CM O
CM (M
-------
FIGURE 7. SEASONAL CHANGES IN THE LAKE GEOR6C
THERMOCLINE
TEMPERATURE - DEGREES CENT.'GRADE
5» 10° IS* 20* 2
30*
153
-------
0)
60
t-i
O
0)
O
fl
tf
rt
O
a
rt
•1-1
Q
I
Q)
H
rt
§
• H
15
n)
i—<
n)
§
nt
•
oo
W
15A
3* Nl lUfUVUUNii
-------
FIGURE 9. Seasonal Variation of Water Temperatures at Diamond
Island, Lake George (1972)
DIAMOND ISLAND 1»72
— ,
31
Table 7.
59 90 120
TIME (DAYS OP VIA*)
SECCHI
DISC MEASUREMENTS
~l
151
(METERS)
— 1
181
1
212
243
Date
Station 1 Station 6
3/26/70
6/26/70
7/17/70
8/16/70
9/28/70
0/05/70
O/il/70
1.08/70
7.0
8.5
7.0
7.0
7.0
7.0
6.0
6.5
8.5
10.0
13.5
9.0
9.5
10.0
9.0
10.0
155
-------
K
H
6
Q
O
3
M
<< «
t% OH
H
3
W
00
4)
i—i
•8
NO
ft
6
•43
t— yj
NO
O
CO
1
CO
NO
•43
o Q
I—I
•-•>. I— <
ON
nt
CO
sO
rj
5
•43
O *
r-
*•*. f" 1
00
•*
nl
rt
o
ON
|
Depth
(meters)
f-
t>- <-H CO NO
NO CO >-« O
1— 1
00 00 O NO
oo r- CM o
CM
oo m co NO
m m NO «-«
CO NO CO fM
r- o co co
m NO NO co
r~ ^ ro •-(
i> o m o
in o r- oa
r>- m cvj T~t
t- fM CXI
rj* co O O
in co CN! •-*
t^. O Cvl ON
OO NO CO i-l
in o CM oo
00 NO CO -H
i— 1 CO NO ON
NO 00
CO ••*
0 0
00 CM
PN! •-<
0 0
-------
a;
CUD
1+
O
a>
O
0)
X
n)
a
^i
2
FQ
§
• H
T)
rt
Pi
)H
rt
T—I
0
o
I—I
W
O
AVQ
157
-------
-3"
CM
CO
CO
o
CO
CO
r*^
if}
m
CM
CO
W iH
& CM
•
W CO
< ^
i 1 CM
04 CO
O r^
co ON
W ON
D r-l
a
» vo co m CM
VO VO h> VO VO
J
QOmrHr-ICMCMCMCMCM
•>>. ifitr^-rsjooo-*
Qg -----00 '
>«. ,
JO fty 0 O O O l»1 >O 0 f
H
°Q£ oocoeoeor<-<4>«4.f»eo»iv.in
go g^--,-^^^^
!H **" •
^M| 0^ ^^ C? ^Q ^O ^1 C^
LU ^O^Jj) OsST>OxflOifl'4tM
1 S06
^^ C ^^^ yp ^o ^3 u» ^sp PO CO
5 H
Q Pj
^^ ^^ • 00 N
0v CQ *** — O ^* %O ^ fl
rv -* *sw CNl IO M *+ O Os o
LU «ft
o H -------
^ O'M**'^^^''!®
N ft ^ ^
«0 — — o o^ in ^f « •
5 t ^^^...noo-^
DP - ~ N
158
-------
r-4
rH
a
a
w
Q
o
W
O
ptj
§
i-3
55
M
CO
S5
O
H
p2
g
o
a
0
o
CO
•— 1
§
o
w
CO
o
«
eu
=3
s
H
rH
«v.
IX,
00
6
to
ctt
09
i
fl
fa
rH
.
0
r-4
.
CO
fs..
vo
o
»
CO
^^*
* *
a)
0
00
o
o
o
•^
o
o
o
f«v
o
o
.
o
•^
o
o
.
o
m
o
o
o
co
r-l
O
O
00
o
o
.
0
r-.
o
0
•
o
g
(f*
d, 10
Id
r>v
O
O
O
\O
O
0
o
l«x
0
o
.
o
vo
o
o
.
o
ON
o
0
o
vO
o
o
o
^.
rH
O
*
O
vO
O
0
•
o
r-
o
o
o
f>»
o
0
o
in
o
o
.
o
00
O
o
0
p^,
O
O
o
00
o
o
.
o
o
o
rH
O
r-l
O
o
!»«.
O
O
o
.
r-4 r-4 r-l O O
o o o o o
o o o o o
00*000
r-. r>. r>» ON
o o o o
o o o o
o o o o
o" o" o" o"
o
o
oo
o
o
o
o
o
o
o o o o m o
m o ......
• o m o r-4 co m
Omr-lr-lCMCMCMCM
159
-------
TABLE 12
TOTAL KJELDAHL N (mg N/l)
Station 1
Pate
73.065
73.186
73.199
73.213
73.241
73.255
73.269
73.304
73.324
Station 6
Date
73.186
73.199
73.241
73.255
73.269
73.324
Station 1 :
Station 6:
0.5
0.218
0.212
0.176
0.230
0.324
0.195
0.267
0.178
0.5
0.101
0.193
0.1?8
0.251
0.199
0.173
Range:
Range :
5.0
0.237
0.220
0.260
0.302
0.146
0.312
0.277
0.230
0.205
5.0
0.062
0.212
0.170
0.246
0.191
0.186
0.130-0.314
0.062r0.343
Depth
10.0
0.187
0.208
0.269
0.132
0.248
0.235
0.266
0.202
Depth
10.0
0.086
0.196
0.105
0.249
0.191
0.175
(»)
15.0
0.157
0.179
0.186
0.236
0.168
0.309
0.216
0.245
0.247
(m)
15.0
0.138
0.269
0.107
0.100
0.190
0.177
Mean: 0
Mean : 0
20.0
0.198(21m)
0.130
0.202
0.167
0.189
0.240
0.202
0.221
0.185
20.0
0*127
0.343
0.137
0.207
0.197
.219 ± 0.046
.198 + 0.141
23.0
0.203
25.0
0.102
0.208
0.200(30)
0.206(35)
160
-------
w
8
g
w
o
g
3
*—«
J25
H
CO W
iH 55
O
r«l Ip-J
cjj ^^
O ^5
2 K
c^ u
55
M
O
1
£3
<(•
K
M
§
g)
"
CO
«0
CO
(B
*J
bO
i-t
fe
rH
rH
-------
Table 14. ALKALINITY (mg CaCOj/l) FOR LAKE GEORGE, N. Y.
Date
Average Alkalinity (mg CaCO3/l)
North Basin South Basin
July, 1972
August, 1972
September, 1972
October, 1972
November, 1972
March, 1973
April, 1973
May, 1973
June, 1973
July, 1973
August, 1973
September, 1973
October, 1973
November, 1973
December, 1973
January, 1974
23.0
16.95
17.5
22.6
23.4
22.0
22.5
21.7
21.5
21.6
20.8
24. 1
22.4
16.7
16.5
22.1
23.6
22.8
22.6
23.2
22.6
21.9
21.4
21.3
162
-------
Table-15- MEAN SEASONAL CONCENTRATIONS OF FE, MN, CU AND
ZN IN THE NORTH AND SOUTH BASINS OF LAKE GEORGE, N.Y.
Season
Winter
(Jan. l-Mar.31)
Spring
(Apr.1-June 21)
Summer
(June 21-Sept.2l)
Fall
(Sept.21-Dec. 7)
Depth(m)
3
9
15
3
9
15
3
9
15
3
9
15
South Basin (ug/1) North Basin (ug/l)
Fe Mn Gu Zn Fe Mh Cu Zn
27.2 2.0 5.2 U3.U 35.2 1.9 2.7 51.1
U2.1 2.1 3.5 ^9.3 3^.8 1.3 2.0 79.6
30.6 1.6 3.7 Mf.U 50.7 2.3 2.2 76.6
25.1 3.2 3-9 32.7 kl.5 2.9 2.6 33.5
17.3 2.5 *».2 28.0 26.2 2.5 3-5 53.2
16.9 i+.o 3.8 30.^ 35.^ 3.2 3-2 38.6
29.0 2.6 3.^ U6.4 29.8 2.0 3-0 7^.9
23.5 2.2 3.1 31.8 23.8 3.3 3-2 ko.h
28.8 U.i 2.9 3^.2 23.6 1.9 2.9 23-9
U6.1 1.8 3.1 25.1 13.8 l.h 1.6 71.1
39.9 1.7 2.5 23.3 20.5 1.2 1.7 88.3
30.3 2.5 2.6 1+3.5 1^.5 1.1 2.0 7^.5
163
-------
w
o
pq
o
w
o
gj
5
£5
M
VO u rH
I 1 1 — 1 ""^
W H CO
" CO
PQ W)
H £E
H Pj
E-l ir\
U ^"^
J-
CM
.
1-1
m
ON
.
o
o
o
• o
ON rH
m
vO
vO
.
0
m
VO
ON
.
o
o
m
00
.
o
o
ON
00
•
O
m
ON
00
0
o
CM
0
,
•-1
o
VO
o
.
rH
O
O
CM
.
rH
O
.
m
rH
m
>^-
00
.
o
o
m
0
.
i-H
0
CO
ON
•
0
0
m
ON
o
o
N^-
o
.
I-l
m
CM
rH
.
rH
m
CO
rH
.
rH
0
O
CM
m
m
ON
.
o
o
o
o
rH
0
-------
FIGURE 11
STATION I
TOTAL PLANKTON DIATOMS
0»V M tl M M » II M I* II M T I 2i IT St M H IS to II II • 7 • 7 tT M M M
FIGURE 12. Mean Daily Rates of Phytoplankton Photosynthesis
JASON D\JFMAMJJAS OND\JFMAMJJA
1970 1971 i9"'2
165
-------
Table 17. ANNUAL PRODUCTION OF Nitella flexilis AND OTHER
MACROPHYTES IN THE SOUTH BASIN OF LAKE GEORGE,
N. Y. FOR THE YEAR 1972. ALL MEASUREMENTS ARE
IN GRAMS (dry wt. )/m2± STANDARD ERROR (Stress,
1972),
Depth Nitella flexilis
.(meters) June Sept.
Other Sepcies
Sept.
Annual
Production
3.0
4.0
5.0
6.0
7.0
8.0
9.0
10.0
11.0
12.0
16.41 + 2.3
30.42 + 7.9
44. 06 + 5. 1
57.69 ±5.0
57.83 + 5.1
57.91 + 5.2
43.79 ± 10. 1
53.68 + 19.8
73.48 + 31.5
76.93 + 16.55
133.00 + 39.3
53.39 + 34.4
105.96 + 36.9
97.65 + 28.0
95.10 + 31.8
39.38 + 31.6
42.42 ± 15.9
32.95 + 18. 1
3.67 + 3.5
97.65 ± 28.0
95.10 ± 3.18
39.38 + 31.6
130.00 ± 26.0
103.04 + 40.2
107.57 + 42.9
120.99 ± 21.6
190.69 + 43.3
111.22 + 39.5
163.93 + 43.1
166
-------
Table 18. SPECIES FOUND IN LAKE GEORGE
PHYTOPLANKTON
Ne: net plankton (maximum dimension greater than 50 u)
Na: nannoplankton (maximum dimension 50 u or less)
*• Eudorina elegans Ehrenberg. (Na)
2« Sphaerocystis Schroeteri (Wolle) W. & G. S. West. (Na)
3. Gloeocystis gigag (Kuetzing) Lagerheim. (Na)
4. Elakatothrix gelatinosa Wille. (Na)
5. Planktosphaeria gelatinosa G. M. Smith. (Na)
k« Oocystis crassa Wittrock. (Na)
'• Qocystis pusilla Hansgirg. (Na)
8* Oocystis sub marina Lagerheim. (Na)
9. Oocystis sp. (Na)
10. Botryo coccus braunii Kuetzing. (Na)
11. Dimorphococcus lunatus A. Braun. (Na)
12. Ankistrpdesmus falcatue (Corda) Ralfs var. acicularis (A.
Braun) G. S. West. (Na)
13. Selena strum minutum (Naeg.) Collins. (Na)
14« Quadrigula closterioides (Bohlin) Printz. (Na)
15« Tetraedron minimum. (A. Braun) Hansgirg. (Na)
16. Scenedesmus bijuga (Turp.) Lagerheim. (Na)
17. Crucigenia rectangularia (A. Braun) Gay. (Na)
18« Crucigenia tetrapaedia (Kirch.) W. & G. S. West. (Na)
19. Cosmarium sp. (Na)
20. Cosmarium sp. (Na)
21. Staurastrum furcigerum De Brebisson.
22. Spondylosium planum (Wolle) W. & G. S. West. (Ne)
23. Tribonema sp. (Ne)
24. Ochromonas sp. (Na)
2s* Bitrichia chodati (Reverdin) Chodat. (Na)
26. Dinobryon bavaracum Imhof. (Na)
27. Dinobryon cylindricum Imhof. (Na)
28. Dinobryon divergens Imhof. (Na)
167
-------
Table 18 (Continued). SPECIES FOUND IN LAKE GEORGE
PHYTOPLANKTON
29. Epipyxis sp. (Na)
30. Mallomonas sp. (Na)
31. Mallomonas ap. (Na)
iz. Melosira sp. (Ne)
33. Cyclotella comta (Ehren.) Kuetzing. (Na)
34- Cyclotella stelligera Clet & Grunow. (Na)
35. Stephanodiscus astrea (Ehren.) Grunow. (Na)
36. Tabellaria fenestrata (Lyngb.) Kuetzing. (Na)
37. Meridion circulare (Grev.) Agardh. (Na)
38. Fragilaria crotonensis Kitton. (Ne)
39. Asterionella formosa Rassall. (Ne)
40. Synedra sp. (Ne)
41. Gymnodinium sp. (Ne)
42. Glenodinium pulvieculus (Ehren. ) Stein. (Na)
43. Peridinium cinctum (Muell.) Ehrenberg. (Ne)
44. Cryptomonas sp. (Na)
45. Chroococcus dispersus (Keissl.) Lemmermann. (Na)
46. ChroQcocciis limneticus Lemmermann. (Na)
47. Gloeocapsa pun eta ta Naegeli. (Na)
48. Aphanocapsa elachista West and West. (Na)
49. Mjcrocystis incerta Lemmermann. (Na)
50. Gloethece linearis Naegeli var. compoeita G. M. Smith, (Na)
51. Aphanothece clathrata G. S. West. (Na)
52. Aphanothece nidulans P. Richter. (Na)
53. Cocloaphaerivim Naegelianum Unger. (Na)
54. Gomphognhaeria apopina Kuetzing. (Na)
55. Lyngbya limnetica Lemmermann. (Ne)
56. Anabaena sp. (Na)
57. - 64., Unknown coccoid cells and flagellates. All (Na)
168
-------
TABLE 19
PHYTOPLANKTON BIOMASS IN LAKE GEORGE
All data collected at Station 1 and reported as micrograms
per liter*.
DATE
DEPTH
(m)
0.5
2.0
5.0
10.0
15.0
72.257
144.
188.
631.
271.
.307 73.
11.0
11.0
5.60
065
10,0
51.0
124.
80.0
103.
.107
511.
758.
558.
531.
721.
.186
325.
129.
261.
190.
188.
.216
189.
461.
260.
260.
.241
79.0
72.0
131.
126.
106.
o
* Assuming a density of 1 gm/cm
Data from Howard (1973)
169
-------
2. Zooplankton (McNaught, et al. , 1972)
a. Identification and count -
Species Numb e r / m^ / day
Diaptomus sicilis 961
Diaptomus minutus 2554
Cyclops bicuspidetus 3737
Daphnia galeata 714
Daphnia longiremus 212
Bosmina spp. 358
3. Bottom Fauna - See Table 20 (Perrotte, 1974).
4. Fish - The data shown in Table 21 are from 1973 surveys of the
littoral region (15 sites) of Lake George. There are no census
figures, etc. for the fish populations of the entire lake. Of major
importance to this trophic level and yet not included herein due to
a lack of reliable figures at this time are the Cisco and Lake trout
populations for this body of water (George, et al. , 1974).
5. Bacteria - The organisms listed are the most abundant bacteria
observed in Lake George, NY:
Achromobacter spp.
Aeromonas liquefaciens
Aeromonas spp.
Arthrobacter spp.
Brevibacterium haelis
Brevibacterium sp.
Cellulomonas sp.
Kurthia sp.
Proteus sp.
Pseudomonas cohaerens
Pseudomonas spp.
6. Bottom flora - These data have not yet been determined.
7. Macrophytes - See Table 22 (Boylen and Sheldon, 1973).
V. NUTRIENT BUDGETS - See Table 23.
170
-------
pa
% s
s
1
e> »3
H CO
W H
5q co
I 19
S25 T «
n
o
(M
on
&
I-l
0)
o
o
09
0)
•P
+3
W)
C
H I CM
O >—<
Q
s
60
a
a-
0]
+>
on C- moo
on CM
CM H
o\on
CM c-
OO
CM
O H
in t-
S
o
•
vjD
O
•
CM
in
00 ON
H on
H
ON on i
on on
in H ONI
CM CM on
3
P.
CO
co
a
CQ W
CO ^
H r-t H
•H fl H
0) U5 0)
ecu
W TO <
CM.
•P
•H
CP
co
h i-l
0) 0)
J3 -P
P
O
To
ft
C
no
•
CM
-4- CO
t- CM
on CM
vo.
ON
HcO H C--CO
CM H H CM
HD
cvj
QVD
ir> CM
Q
5
vo -3- on on
H j-vocq
O 8 O H
P
o o o o o o o
-p
00
c
a-
f
CM
-P
Js
^
so o o o on
H on on CM
g____
•ON o moo cvi
on o cy H in
inco c-co H
in,
i-l
o> in
c- o ONVO on
\O cvi on\o
on
SN
rH
CO
CO
o> -p
-P P<
«
-------
W
i
H
O
§
3
rt
H?
H
H
B
O
HH
EH
a
a
M
O
0 at
Vi o>
^ «>
S
|H O
cL i<
*1
IH
% <°
•2 v
H -t-"
?ti
m
n
9
«!•
J
£>
r-
fM
o
o
00
rt
in
M
o
oo
o
o
CO
oo
co
o
0s
00
.-
-Jl "S
°C
a
m —i
04 ••«
\o
co
M
co
m
m
oo
co
co
o
o
M
o
o
o
o
fO
o
o
CO
o
o
m
o
o
co
o
C—
oo
co
•!-!
3
fl)
«
«U
OB
o
•H
O
W
u
h
«
w>
& I
. ir> o 0s oo ^
f\J O^ O OO CO ^
en* •* (*• o> o rj
«
—• o
ra cj
s
"•-
§
2 <^
^ pa
172
-------
Table 22. MOST COMMON MACROPHYTE SPECIES FOUND
IN THE LITTORAL ZONE OF LAKE GEORGE, N. Y. *
Average Dry
Weight of
_ Species mature plant"*"
Bid en s beckii
Char a globularis
Elatine minima
Elodea canadensis
Eriocaulon septangular e
Heter anther a dubia
la oetes echinospora
Isoetes macrospora
Juncus sp.
Lobelia dortmanna
Myriophyllum alterniflorum
Myriophyllum ten ell urn.
Naias flexilis
Nitslla flexilis
Potamogeton amplifolius
Potamogeton gramineus
Potamogeton perfoliatus
Potamogeton praelongus
Pptampgeton pusillus
Potarn octet on robbinsii
Ranunculus longirostris
Sagittaria sp.
Utricularia resupinata
Vallisneria americana
Subularia sp.
.483 g
.075 g
.540 g
.237 g
.947 g
.268 g
080 g
2.677 g
.307 g
.284 g
.836 g
.081 g
.873 g
.154 g
.394 g
.536 g
.014 g
Average Maxi-
mum Height of
mature plant
56.3 cm
12 cm
60 cm
2.8 cm
84 cm
51.3 cm
24 cm
75.7 cm
84 cm
74. 5 cm
73.3 cm
29. 3 cm
69. 7 cm
«
46 cm
11 cm
77.7 cm
6.2 cm
Depth of
maximum
abundance
2-7 m
1 m
1 m
1-9 m
1 m
1-3 m
1-3 m
3-8 m
1 m
1 m
1-3 m
1 m
1-7 m
9 m
3 m
1-5 m
1-5 m
5 m
2-5 m
7 m
1-3 m
1 m
1 m
1-5 m
1 m
** All species collected from 1 m depth or greater. All were sub-
mergent.
+ Plants were collected on 8/30/73. Visual observation suggests
that plants collected were smaller than mature plants found earlier
in the summer.
173
-------
TABLE 23
Estimated Phosphorus and Nitrogen Budget
Based on Normal Precipitation of Basin
Phosphorus
Sources
Runoff
Precipitation
Sewage Treat-
ment Plant
Effluents
Septic tank
Effluents
Lawn Fertilizer
Total
Sinks
Outflow at
Ticonderoga
Sedimentation
kg
2890
2400
0
2300
208
7800
2040
5760
% of Total
Sources
37.1
30.8
0
29.5
2.6
100
% of Total
Sinks
26.2 *
73.8
Nitrogen
ko
86,700
84,600
18.OOU
9,580
2,080
201,000
62 , 800
138,000
% of Total
Sources
43.1
42.1
9.1
4.8
1.0
10.0
% of Total
Sinks
31.2
68.8
Retention 73.8
Surface loading 0.0684 g/m /yr
68.8
1.76
(From Gibble, 1974)
174
-------
VI. DISCUSSION
The geologic history of Lake George appears to be the primary
element in the present trophic status of the lake. Lying essentially
in a long narrow channel bordered by heights reaching in excess of 600
meters above the lake surface, the ratio of drainage basin surface area
to lake surface area is only 4.3. The bedrock is precambrian meta-
morphic, plutonic and igneous and lies close to the surface with numerou:
outcroppings in the basin. Thus, only a thin soil cover overlies much
of the basin. Precipitation is the only form of hydrologic import, and
the basin represents a headwater for the Lake Champlain catchment area.
If one can assume that 15% of the Lake George basin is repre-
sented by cleared lands, regardless of purpose, then the export of
phosphorus, calculated from runoff loadings (Gibble, 1974) would be
6.9 mg/m /yr. This figure lies within the range of estimates presented
by Dillon and Kirchner (1975) for forested land overlying igneous rock.
The latter category corresponds to Vollenweider's (1968) classification
of "oligotrophic" soils. Apparently, phosphorus exports in the Lake
George watershed are typical for this type of soil-vegetation cover.
The small basin to lake area ratio emphasizes the importance
of precipitation directly upon the lake surface as a source of N and P
loadings to Lake George. Combined with runoff, these two sources
account for 68 and 85% of the phosphorus and nitrogen loadings, respec-
tively. Anthropogenic phosphorus sources are already reduced through
application of treated sewage effluent (from the Lake George Village
area) onto sand beds, and adsorption onto soils in the numerous septic
tank tile fields. There are no known sources of untreated sewage into
the lake.
Having recognized the need for a relatively simple approach
to the classification of the productivity or trophic state of lakes,
Vollenweider (1968) and Vollenweider and Dillon (1974) have concentrated
their attention upon phosphorus as the limiting element. However,
recognizing that as a limiting element its concentration in the water
column would simply represent a "residual, " they have focused on the
importation, or phosphorus loading, as the proper relationship to pro-
ductivity. Internal loading or recycling must also be considered,
especially in small lakes, but external loading is more important in the
larger lakes (Vollenweider, 1968).
The lake volume to phosphorus loading relationship was original-
ly taking into account through the mean depth of the lake. However,
recognizing that retention time was equally significant, Vollenweider and
Dillon (1974) regressed phosphorus loading against an areal water loading,
expressed as mean depth divided by mean residence time. The new
relationship provides a significantly better fit for lakes in which mean
175
-------
detention times are within very long, e. g. , Lake Tahoe, or very short
as is the case of some Canadian Shield lakes.
Referring to the nutrient budget for Lake George (Gibble, 1974),
the estimated phosphorus loading is 0.0684 gm/m /yr. (See Table 23).
With a mean depth of 18 meters and a mean retention time of 8 years,
Lake George can be classified as "oligotrophic" on this basis.
Aulenbach and Clesceri (1973) have emphasized the fact, how-
ever, that Lake George consists of two distinct basins, south and north.
The lake surface area and drainage basin area are 57.6 km and 313.2
km for the south basin and 56.4 km^ and 178.8 km^ for the north
basin. The year-round population in the south basin is approximately
four times that of the north, but during the summer season, this
figure increases to approximately six times. Additionally, the south
basin contains the two sewage treatment plants located within the total
watershed.
Using proportional estimates, the phosphorus loading to the
south basin would be 0.0908 gm/m^/yr. With a mean depth of 15.5
meters and assuming the same mean retention time of 8 years, the
south basin would still lie within the "oligotrophic" classification.
The similarity of the phosphorus loading to the south basin and to the
total lake, once again points to the importance of direct precipitation
to the lake surface as a nutrient source.
The correctness of the loading approach to determine produc-
tivity, at least as it applies to Lake George, is borne out by the rela-
tive success of the process model CLEANX which describes the pelagic
epilimnetic zone (Scavia, 1975; Bloomfield, et al. , 1973). The com-
partments represented are the net- and nannophytoplankton, herbivorous
and omnivorous zooplankton, non-piscivorous and piscivorous fish,
particulate and dissolved organic matter, dissolved inorganic nutrients
and decomposers. The driving functions are the phosphorus, nitrogen
and carbon inputs from streams, as well as water temperature, inci-
dent solar radiation and the level of benthic insect biomass.
The basic processes are obvious but also factual. High spring
nutrient loadings, abetted by winter thaws, in the presence of rising
temperature and solar radiation levels, result in a pulse of phyto-
plankton biomass, principally the net plankton, Asterionella formosa.
Available dissolved nutrients are further increased by decomposer activ-
ity upon organic matter in the runoff. Mean daily production rises to
1.5 gm C/m^/dy or higher (Figure 12). Zooplankton predation follows
with Cyclops bicuspidatus, as a principal species. Cropping by the
non-piscivores reduces pressure upon the phytoplankton, but in the
presence of lower summer concentrations of nutrients, the nannoplankton
become dominant (in terms of biomass, Cyclotella compta becomes the
176
-------
principal species). A biomass and phytoplankton production pulse again
occurs in the August-September period. This pulse precedes turnover
in Lake George, and is therefore probably unrelated to nutrient in-
creases from the hypolimnion.
In Figures 13, 14 and 15 observed levels of biomass are
compared with those sirrmlated by the model. The reasonable fit of
the simulation indicates that the modeling of the ecologic processes is
sound, and that nutrient inputs from streams with subsequent internal
recycling are the principal non-physical driving forces in the Lake
George ecosystem.
100.0'
10.0-
1.0-
s
x
w
T>
01
in
S
O
3
0.1
0.01-
0.001'
A
AA A
A
141
DAY
281
365
FIGURE 13.
Predicted and Observed Biomass Levels of
Cladocerans and Copepods in Lake George.
Observed Values are from McNaught, et al. (1972)
^ « copepods, Jt » cladocerans
177
-------
CD CL
> O E
i- 4-> O
0> >> S-
l/l .C M-
-Q D_
O VI
-!-> CD
-a aj 3
c: ^ F-
(13
ITS
-o >
•a c
cu ro -a
4J OJ
Q.
O
CU C LO
s_ (o -a :
a. -z. o-
* *'P 6) ssvwoia
7
\
A
o
M-
O
> O
(1) Ol -!->
—I CD 0)
_
-o c s:
OJ O
> 4-> 6
S- -^ O
O) O -O
-!->!_ dJ
CJ O >— »
•^ > i- CXI
T3 -i- OJ r--
-------
REFERENCES
Aulenbach, D. B., and N. L. Clesceri. Sources and Sinks of Nitrogen
and Phosphorus: Water Quality Management of Lake George
(NY). In: G. F. Bennett (ed. ). Water - 1972. 69(129).
AIChE. 1972.
Aulenbach, D. B., and N. L. Clesceri. Sources of Nitrogen and
Phosphorus in the Lake George Drainage Basin: A Double
Lake. In; Proceedings of the 19th Annual Meeting, Institute
of Environmental Sciences. Fresh Water Institute Report
No. 73-1. 1973.
Bloomfield, J. A., R. A. Park, Don Scavia, and C. S. Zahorcak.
Aquatic Modeling in the Eastern Deciduous Forest Biome, U. S.
International Biological Program. In: Modeling the Eutrophi-
cation Process, Workshop Proceedings (E. J. Middlebrook, ed.)
Utah Water Research Lab., Utah State Univ., Logan, Utah.
1973.
Boylen, C. W., and R. B. Sheldon. Biomass Distribution of Rooted
Macrophytes in the Littoral Zone of Lake George. Eastern
Deciduous Forest Biome, International Biological Program,
Oak Ridge, Tennessee. EDFB-IBP Memo Report 73-65.
Fresh Water Institute Report No. 73-21. 1973.
Colon, E. M. Hydrologic Study of Lake George, New York. D. Eng.
Thesis. Rensselaer Polytechnic Institute, Troy, NY 1972.
Dillon, P. J., and W. B. Kirchner. The Effects of Geology and Land
Use on the Export of Phosphorus from Watersheds. Water
Res. £, P- 135-148. 1975.
George, C., P. W. Briddell, and J. H. Gordon. Notes on the
Centrarchids of Lake George, NY. Eastern Deciduous Forest
Biome, International Biological Program, Oak Ridge, Tennessee,
EDFB-IBP Memo Report No. 73-72. Fresh Water Institute
Report No. 73-24. 1974.
Gibble, E. B. Phosphorus and Nitrogen Loading and Nutrient Budget
on Lake George, NY. M. Eng. Thesis, Rensselaer Polytechnic
Institute, Troy, NY. 1974.
Howard, H. H. Phytoplankton in the Lake George Ecosystem. Eastern
Deciduous Forest Biome, International Biological Program, Oak
Ridge Tennessee. EDFB-IBP Memo Report No. 73-71. 1973.
179
-------
Langmuir, I. (Posth. ), J. T. Scott, E. G. Walther, R. Stewart and
W. X. Rozon. Langmuir Circulations and Internal Waves in
Lake George. Atm. Sciences Res. Center, SUNY-Albany,
N. Y. Publication No. 42. 1966.
McNaught, D. C. , K. Bogdan, and J. O'Malley. Zooplankton Community
Structure and Feeding Related to Productivity. Eastern Decidu-
ous Forest Biome, International Biological Program, Oak Ridge,
Tennessee. EDFB-IBP Memo Report No. 72-69. 1972.
Nicholson, S. , and J. T. Scott. A Sample of the Vegetation in the Lake
George Drainage Basin: Part II. Composition of the Canopy
Vegetation and some Aspects of Physiographic and Horizontal
Variation Within the Basin. Eastern Deciduous Forest Biome,
International Biological Program, Oak Ridge, Tennessee.
EDFB-IBP Memo Report No. 73-8. 1972.
Perrotte, W. T. In preparation. 1975.
Scavia, Don. Implementation of a Pelagic Ecosystem Model for Lakes.
Masters Thesis. Rensselaer Polytechnic Institute, Troy, New
York.
Schoettle, M. , and G. M. Friedman. Sediments and Sedimentation in
a Glacial Lake: Lake George, N. Y. Eastern Deciduous Forest
Biome, International Biological Program, Oak Ridge, Tennessee.
EDFB-IBP Memo Report No. 71-122. Fresh Water Institute
Report No. 72-11B. 1971.
Schoettle, M. , and G. M. Friedman. Organic Carbon in Sediments in
Lake George, NY: Relation to Morphology of Lake Bottom,
Grain Size of Sediments, and Man's Activities. Eastern Decidu-
ous Forest Biome, International Biological Program, Oak Ridge,
Tennessee. Contribution No. 36. Fresh Water Institute Report
No. 73-9. Geol. Soc. of Amer. Bull. 84: 191-198. 1973.
Stewart, R. Contributions to the International Biological Program -
Year I. Eastern Deciduous Forest Biome, International Bio-
logical Program, Oak Ridge, Tennessee. EDFB-IBP Memo
Report No. 71-124. 1971.
Stewart, R. Contributions to the International Biological Program -
Year II. Eastern Deciduous Forest Biome, International Bio-
logical Program, Oak Ridge, Tennessee. EDFB-IBP Memo
Report No. 72-71. 1972.
Stress, R. G. Primary Productivity of Lake George, NY: Its Estimation
and Regulation. Eastern Deciduous Forest Biome, International
Biological Program, Oak Ridge, Tennessee. EDFB-IBP Memo
Report No. 72-72. 1972.
180
-------
Vollenweider, R. A. Scientific Fundamentals of the Eutrophication of
Lakes and Flowing Waters, with Particular Reference to Nitrogen
and Phosphorus as Factors in Eutrophication. Organization for
Economic Cooperation and Development. Directorate for Scien-
tific Affairs. Paris, France. 1968.
Vollenweider, R. A., and P. J. Dillon. The Application of the Phos-
phorus Loading Concept to Eutrophication Research. Nat'l.
Res. Council Canada Rept. No. 13690 (1974).
Water Resources Commission. Classification and Standards of Quality
and Purity of Waters of New York State. Parts 700-703.
Title 6. Official Compilation of codes, rules, and regulations
prepared and published for the Water Resources Commission
by the New York State Department of Health. November,
1968.
Williams, S. L., D. B. Aulenbach, and N. L. Clesceri. Transition
Metals and Zinc in the Aquatic Environment. In; Alan Rubin
(ed.) Aqueous-Environmental Chemistry of Metals. Ann Arbor
Science Publishers, Inc. Ann Arbor, MI. 1974.
Williams, S. L., and N. L. Clesceri (eds.) Diatom Populations
Changes in Lake George, NY Final Report for US Dept. of
Interior, Office of Water Resources Research Contract No.
14-31-0001-3387. Fresh Water Institute Reports No. 72-1
thru 72-8. 1972.
181
-------
THE LIMNOLOGY OF CAYUGA LAKE, NEW YORK
- A SUMMARY -
Ray T. Oglesby
Department of Natural Resources
N.Y. State College of Agriculture and Life Sciences
Cornell University
Ithaca, New York
The Indians who lived in villages around the lake called it "Tiohero,"
the lake of flags or rushes or lake of the marsh. The first white man known
to have visited its shores was a Jesuit priest whose journal (Raffieux,
1671-72) described the members of the Cayuga tribe as accomplished agricul-
turalists, fishermen, and hunters. They had probably modified the land
extensively by annual burnings (Dudley, 1886; Thompson, 1972) as evidenced
by the "almost continuous plains bordered by beautiful forests" observed by
Raffieux at the northern end of the lake.
The orchards and fields of the Indians were laid waste by the punitive
expedition under Sullivan during the War of the American Revolution. Ten
years later the first white settlement, Ithaca, was started at the south end
of the lake which by then was called Cayuga after its earlier inhabitants.
A large influx of settlers followed the connection of Cayuga Lake to the Erie
Barge Canal in 1821 and the completion of a lock in 1829 (Whitford, 1906).
The 1800's witnessed the growth of numerous small industries in the
Ithaca area as the ready sources of power and water represented by the larger
steep gradient streams such as Fall Creek were exploited (Anonymous, 1879).
The basin was also heavily agriculturalized and as much as 80%vof the land
area may have been under cultivation by the turn of the century. Soil erosion
must have reached massive proportions during periods of heavy runoff.
The development of the Appalachian coal fields, railroads and the
exploitation of fertile prairie soils in the Midwest dictated a rapid decline
in both industry and farming with a major abandonment of land taking place
under Federal programs to combat rural poverty in the late 1920fs and early
1930's.
182
-------
GEOGRAPEY
Cayuga Lake is located (intersection of longitudinal and cross axes)
at 40°41'30" N and 76°41'20" W at an altitude of 116.4 m (382 ft) above sea
level (Greeson and Williams, 1970). Its catchment area (including lake sur-
2 2
face) is 2,033 km (785 mi ) according to the U. S. Department of the
Interior (1971).
The climate is of the humid continental type with warm summers and long,
cold winters. The area lies on the main west to east track of cyclonic storms
and hence its weather is highly variable and is characterized by considerable
cloudiness. Annual precipitation ranges from 71-117 cm (28-46 in) with half
of this normally falling from May through September. Seasonal changes (from
Dethier and Pack, 1963) in several climatological properties are shown in
Figure 1. Cayuga Lake has been frozen over its entire length during at least
ten winters since 1796. Typically, however, sheets of ice extend out from
the north and south ends only to about the 5-10 m depth contours with maximum
coverage in February.
The bedrock of the basin consists mostly of acid shale and sandstone but
is intersected by two major limestone formations (Rickard and Fisher, 1970).
Outcroppings of the southernmost formation extend to nearly the head end of
the lake. The soils of the northern two-thirds of the Cayuga basin are
dominated by moderately coarse textured types with calcareous substrata.
Those of the major tributaries and highlands surrounding the southern part
of the basin are composed of a diverse and complex assemblage and, in general,
are less well drained and more acid (Cline and Arnold, 1970).
Cayuga Lake is located in an elongated, glaciated basin that opens into
rather flat terrain at its north end but becomes progressively steeper towards
the south. On the east side of the lake this rise becomes an obvious feature
183
-------
I6r
14-
EVAPORATION
SOLAR RADIATION
- 25r
- 20
I80i-
150
C\P
~0
°I20
E
C7>
Z
Q Q/~\
P
5
cr
<6°
o
30
0
-
_
,_,
V.
JC
-^20
i—
o
-oio
UJ
o
Li o
12
E
u
O
blO
cr
o
Q.
>
3
z
z
o
^6
Q.
O
UJ
ce.
_ Q. 4
- -2
- 0
- 2
- 2
- ^_^
o
0
*— '
UJ
cr
i>
~s
cr
UJ
Q.
ill
UJ
-
_ •
- 0
L -5
WIND VELOCITY
CQ
UJ
u.
QC
<
cr
a.
O Q.
ID UJ
< cn
o
o
o
u
UJ
Q
Figure 1. Monthly mean values for solar radiation, wind velocity, precipitation,
evaporation and temperature at Ithaca, New York.
184
-------
about one-third of the lake's length from its northern terminus and a
similar increase in elevation occurs on the west side slightly further to
the south. The upland plateau at the southern end is at an elevation of
250-300 m (800-1,000 ft) with the hills beyond occasionally extending to
about 600 m (2,000 ft).
The dominant tree association in the northern one-fourth of the basin
is elm-ash-red maple. The remainder of the lake border and the valleys
are dominated by oak and hickory while the upland association is mainly
beech-hard maple. Forage crops constitute the principal vegetation
associated with agriculture. Child, Oglesby and Raymond (1971) determined
2 2
the 1968 land usage to be: 904 km (48.3%) active agriculture, 292 km
2
(15.6%) inactive agriculture, 582 km (3%) of the usage falls into other
categories such as transportation and mining. Using data from the 1970
census (U. S. Bureau of the Census 1970a and 1970b) the population of the
basin is calculated to be 90,221.
Cayuga Lake serves as a supply of potable water for five towns or
villages in the basin and an additional, combined supply for three other
towns is under development. Water supplied to the major population center
(City of Ithaca) in the basin comes from an impounded upland source. A
435 MWe fossil fueled power plant currently takes its cooling water from the
lake and a second such facility, almost double in size, is under consideration.
Cayuga Lake is extensively used for fishing, boating and swimming. Three
state, one city and one town park are located on its shoreline.
Industrial wastes discharged to Cayuga Lake tributaries are in excess
of 5,109 m3 (1,350,000 gal) day" . All are treated at the industrial sites
prior to discharge and/or are put into the sanitary sewer system of Ithaca.
In the past, large quantities of NaCl entered the lake as runoff from the
185
-------
site of a rock salt mine. Municipal waste is discharged to the lake at the
rate of 23,881 m (6.3 mg) day" with all but about 1% receiving at least
secondary treatment. Additional treatment for phosphorus removal is, or
3 -1
will shortly be, given to 3,369 m day (14%) of the sewage being discharged.
MORPHOMETRIC AND HYDROLOGIC CHARACTERISTICS
Cayuga Lake has a simple eavestrough shaped basin with the steepest
dropoffs and greatest depths occurring in the southern two-thirds of its
length. Morphometric properties according to Birge and Juday (1914) are:
172.1 km2 (66.4 mi2) surface area, 61.4 km (38.1 mi) length, 5.60 km (3.50 mi)
maximum width, 2.80 km (1.74 mi) average width, 153.4 km (95.3 mi) shoreline
length, 3.35 shoreline development, 9,379.4 X 10~6 m3 (331,080 X 10~6 ft3)
volume, 132.6 m (435 ft) maximum depth, 54.5 m (172.3 ft) mean depth, and 1.23
volume development. Their calculations indicate that a plane at the 40.3 m
depth would divide the lake into two equal volumes.
The water level in Cayuga Lake is regulated by Mud Lock at the north
end. The lake level is generally lowered by drawdown about mid-December and
is again raised in the spring by input from snowmelt and rain. A maximum
recorded lake level of 117.7 m (386 ft) occurred following Tropical Storm
Agnes in 1972.
Using the data of Singley (1973) it can be seen that for 1950-52 and
1968-72 the relative volumes of the various thermal strata underwent a complex
pattern of change over the stratified season (Figure 2). Three periods of
downmixing and two when the relative volumes of the thermal strata remained
constant are apparent. Duration of stratification is discussed below.
Sediments in the profundal zone of Cayuga Lake are fine textured mixes
of silts and clays. From Ludlam's (1967) work it appears that 1.2-1.4 m
(4 ft) of sediments have been deposited during the past 100 years. Littoral
186
-------
I.Or-
epilimnion: hypolimnion
O.I
01
epilimnion: me to limn ion
+ hypolimnion
0.01
I
I
I
141- 155- 169- 183- 197- 211- 225- 239- 253- 267- 281- 295- 309- 323-
154 168 182 196 210 224 238 252 266 280 294 308 322 336
DAYS OF YEAR
Figure 2. Ratios (by volume) of epilimnion to hypolimnion and of epilimnion to
metalimnion plus hypolimnion as a function of season.
187
-------
sediments at the south end of the lake, studied by Vogel (1973), were found
to contain from less than 1% to 5% organic matter. Up to 3 m (10 ft) of
sediment appear to have accumulated in portions of this area during the past
three-quarters of a century based on comparisons of bathymetric charts
(Maffa, personal communication).
Seasonal patterns of precipitation are shown in Figure 1. The heaviest
single storm rainfall of record occurred on July 7-8, 1935 when 20.89 cm
(8.22 in) fell and the second heaviest (17.91 cm or 7.05 in) was associated
with a tropical storm June 21-25, 1972.
Cayuga Lake is perpendicularly intercepted at its north end by the
Seneca River which is, at the same time, the major tributary and the sole
surface outlet. In calculating material budgets the most logical course
would seem to dictate the exclusion of Seneca River inputs since its entrance
to and exit from the lake are so contiguous. Most of the other larger
tributaries are located at or near the south end (Figure 3). Fall Creek has
the highest annual flow followed respectively by Cayuga Inlet, Salmon Creek
and Taughannock Creek (U. S. Department of the Interior, 1971). There are
no measurements of subsurface flows, but the close agreement of most inflow
and outflow estimates for surface waters indicates that groundwater is not
likely to be a large component of the hydrologic budget.
Currents have been little studied. Sundaram et al. (1969) estimated
that in mid to late September, 1968 typical wind induced surface currents
were less than 3 cm (0.1 ft) sec . At other times during the stratified
season, major currents with velocities as great as 50 cm (1.6 ft) sec were
associated with seiche motions. They found significant hypolimnetic currents,
shown in an example to be as high as 10 cm (0.3 ft) sec , were found only in
associations with seiches. There are several indications (Sundaram et al., 1969;
Henson et al., 1961; and Wright, 1969a) of geostrophic effects but these have not
188
-------
CAN06A CR.
SHELDRAKE
CASCADILLA CR.
10
15
20
25
30
KILOMETERS
Figure 3. Location map of Cayuga Lake showing principal tributaries and sites
of sampling stations used in the various limnological studies.
189
-------
been systematically studied.
Henson et al. (1961), Wright (1969b), Singley (1973), Likens (1974b) and
Oglesby (unpublished) have used differing methodologies and rationales to
compute water renewal times in Cayuga Lake. Excluding the Seneca River from
the calculations, Oglesby (unpublished) estimates this to have been 8.6 yr
for the 1970-71 hydrologic year. Wright (1969b) has computed that, depending
upon climatic conditions, the water renewal time may vary between 8.1 and
24.1 yr. Singley (1973) calculated that for 1965, an exceptionally dry
year with higher than normal evaporation rates, the water renewal time was
about 18 yr.
LIMNOLOGICAL CHARACTERISTICS - PHYSICAL AND CHEMICAL
Beginning with winter isothermy, a generalized temperature regime
would show minimum homothermy at a temperature of 1.5-3.3°C sometime between
late February and early April. Gradual warming but continued homothermy
occur until about mid-May at which time surface temperatures begin to gradually
increase. Stratification exists by mid-June or early July. Maximum summer
bottom temperatures are largely a function of mixing in May and early June
and vary from year to year between 4.1 and 5.5°C. Maximum recorded surface
\
temperature for a given year ranges from about 20 to 27°C. Annual maximum
bottom temperatures of 6.6 - 9.6°C are associated with fall homothermy which
occurs between early November and December. The water column generally
mixes freely until minimum homothermy is reached. Since 1910, one or more
temperature profiles have been taken during seventeen years.
Specific conductance during the winter is about 600 |imhos cm (Wright,
1969c). As a result of ion dilution by heavy spring runoffs of snowmelt
_ 1
and rain, values decrease to below 500 jumhos cm • A gradual increase takes
place over the summer, especially in the hypolimnion, with temporary
190
-------
decreases occurring in association with, periods of heavy precipitation
(Dahlberg, 1973). The higher specific conductances characteristic of the
hypolimnion during the stratified period are thought to be due to deep
groundwater inflow or solubilization of bedrock within the basin proper.
Data on solar radiation and light extinction coefficients have been
summarized for 1968-70 (Table 1) by Peterson (1971).
Table 1. Monthly means of solar radiation and extinction coefficients during
1968-70. Number of values averaged are shown in parentheses.
Solar radiation Extinction coefficient
Month (gm cal cm~2 day"1) (k)
Jan 112 (3) 0.250 (1)
Feb 221 (3) 0.292 (1)
Mar 293 (3) 0.250 (1)
Apr 421 (3) 0.463 (2)
May 450 (3) 0.301 (4)
Jun 511 (3) 0.370 (3)
Jul 529 (3) 0.854 (4)
Aug 472 (3) 0.598 (10)
Sep 358 (3) 0.403 (4)
Oct 234 (3) 0.321 (2)
Nov 103 (3) 0.286 (3)
Dec 93 (3)
Color was reported (Dahlberg, 1973) to average 6 mg 1 "Xpresumably he
meant color units) in samples taken from various strata at a series of stations
during the summer and early fall of 1972.
In reviewing the published (Wagner, 1927; Burkholder, 1931; Henson et al.,
1961; Wright, 1969d; and Dahlberg, 1973) and unpublished data on hydrogen ion
concentration in Cayuga Lake, a general pattern emerges of minimum water
column averages (pH 7.7-8.0) during the winter months. An increase to a pH
of about 8 occurs prior to stratification. During the summer, hypolimnetic
pH decreases fairly rapidly to a low of 7.7-7.8, with occasional values to
191
-------
7.5 prior to autumnal mixing. At the same time pH in the epilimnion reaches
a maximum (as high as 9.0) averaging 8.2-8.4. The hydrogen ion concentration
then drops during the mixing period and reaches its winter minimum in
January or February.
Dissolved oxygen follows a pattern to be expected for a cold, deep,
moderately productive lake. During the summer, daytime supersaturation is
fairly common in the epilimnion, and hypolimnetic concentrations decrease
seasonally, reaching a minimum of about 6 mg 1 in the deepest portion of the
lake just before fall overturn. The water column is only 80-90% saturated
at the time of complete autumnal mixing. Dissolved oxygen increases gradually
during the winter and reaches 90-95% of saturation by the time thermal
stratification is reestablished in the summer. Hypolimnetic minima do not
appear to have changed since the early part of this century. Data on the
spatial and temporal distribution of dissolved oxygen have been reported by
Birge and Juday (1914), Wagner (1927), Burkholder (1931), Henson et al. (1961),
Wright (1969e), and additional, unpublished (Godfrey and Oglesby) records
are available for 1972-74.
_3
Total phosphorus (TP) typically ranges from about 15 to 22 mg m through-
out the water column during all seasons of the year (Peterson, 1971; Oglesby
and Schaffner, MS 1975). During the stratified season, this becomes parti-
tioned in the epilimnion so that soluble reactive phosphorus (SRP) is only
5-15% of the total (Barlow, 1969) with resultant SRP concentrations being
-3 -3
almost always less than 5 mg m and often only 1-2 mg m and with concomitant
increases in soluble unreactive and particulate phosphorus (Peterson, 1971).
In the hypolimnion SRP was nearly always 50% and sometimes as much as 90%
of the total during 1968 (Barlow, 1969). Over a three year period (1968-70,
n = 133) of sampling Peterson (1971) found that TP ranged from 9.1 to 56.7
-3
mg m . Seasonal variations in the forms and concentrations of phosphorus
192
-------
(Wright, 1969f; Barlow, unpublished; and Godfrey, unpublished), an elegant
series of continuous culture bioassays (Peterson et al., 1973) and alkaline
phosphatase activity (Griffin, 1974) all indicate that phosphorus is the
critical element in controlling the level of summer phytoplankton production.
Nitrate nitrogen varies with depth during the summer but the most
marked fluctuations occur between seasons and, on occasion, between years.
Concentrations are almost always high enough to be in excess of the minimum
needed for unrestricted phytoplankton growth (Barlow, 1969) with the mid-
summer period of 1973 being an exception (Godfrey, unpublished). Maximum
input is via tributary inflow during the spring and concentrations are still
_3
typically 800-900 mg m in mid-May. Following stratification, nitrate
decreases erratically in the epilimnion and a slight vertical cline of
increasing concentration becomes apparent (Federal Water Quality Administra-
tion, 1965; Wright, 1969f; Dahlberg, 1973; Godfrey, unpublished). Data on
ammonium nitrogen are scarce but concentrations appear to be generally low,
ca. 0-40 mg m~3 (Dahlberg, 1973). In the summer of 1972, Kjeldahl nitrogen
_3
ranged from about 200-500 mg m (Dahlberg, 1973) with hypolimnetic concen-
trations being lower than those of the surface water but with maxima some-
times occurring in the metalimnion.
Total alkalinities of Cayuga Lake water are on the order of 100 mg 1
as CaC03 (Wagner, 1927; Burkholder, 1931; Henson et al., 1961; Wright, 1969d;
Dahlberg, 1973; and Godfrey, unpublished). Winter values are generally higher
than this and an annual minimum occurs in July - September. The variation
within a year is 10-15 mg 1 as CaCCL. During the stratified season there
is a slight increase in alkalinity with depth. The only published values of
acidity are those of Dahlberg (1973) for 1972. Mean, minimum and maximum
concentrations were, respectively, 2.6, 0 and 9.3 mg 1 . Increases during
the stratified season were noted for metalimnetic and hypolimnetic samples.
193
-------
Cayuga Lake has a well developed calcium carbonate buffer system, and
concentrations of sodium and chloride are unusually high for an inland lake
in the northeastern United States (Federal Water Quality Administration,
1965; Berg, 1966; Dahlberg, 1973; and Oglesby, unpublished) as shown in
Table 2.
Table 2. Major anions and cations in Cayuga Lake during April, 1973 as
determined from samples composited for depth.
Cations
Anions
MEQ
Ca^
1 i
,, ++
Mg
Na+
K+
TOTAL
2
0
1
0
4
.20
.86
.85
.07
.98
mg
44.
10.
42.
2.
i
0
5
5
8
MEQ
C0=
HC03
so7
4
Cl~
TOTAL
0
2
0
2
5
.07
.00
.76
.34
.17
mg I"1
2
122
37
83
.0
.0
.2
Data on inorganic trace elements are summarized in Table 3.
Table 3,
Element
Fe
Mn
Bo
Zn
Cu
Pb
Cd
Co
Al
Mg
1]
1]
1]
1]
1]
1]
Inorganic trace elements in Cayuga Lake based on data obtained in
the summers of 1971 and 1973. With the exception of those for boron,
"observations" represent averages for samples taken from two or
three depths corresponding to the major thermal strata at from one
to five sampling stations.
Typical
Range concentration
(mg m~3) (mg m~3) observations References
3-220
1-30
22-55
0.51-9.41
0.10-0.93
0.10-0.93
0.015-1.98
0.003-0.093
0-20
0.6-14
-
_
34
2.7
0.6
0.12
0.54
0.005
-
-
Number of
observations
11
4
21
4
4
4
4
4
2
5
Dahlberg Q-973), Oglesby (unpub-
lished)
Oglesby (unpublished)
ii it
Mills and Oglesby (1971)
Dahlberg (1973)
Insoluble form, euphotic zone
194
-------
LIMNOLOGICAL CHARACTERISTICS - BIOLOGICAL
Data on pigment concentrations in Cayuga Lake have been reported by
Hamilton (1969), Wright (1969g), Barlow (1969), Peterson (1971), Dahlberg
(1973) and Oglesby and Schaffner (1975) and detailed information for 1972-73
has been collected by Godfrey (unpublished). An annual maximum is generally
found in late June or July and a secondary peak often occurs in the autumn.
Peterson's (1971) chlorophyll a_ concentrations for June, July and August
_3
of 1968-70 averaged 4.8 mg m in the euphotic zone. For the same period
in 1972-74, epilimnetic mean chlorophyll ji plus phaeophytin ranged from 7.8
to 9.7 mg m~ (Oglesby and Schaffner, MS 1975).
14
Primary productivity, as determined by C uptake, values have been
reported for 1957-58 (Howard, 1963) and 1968-70 (Barlow, 1969 and Peterson,
1971). The variation between years is considerable, but for the latter
-2 -1
period production is about 160 mg C m day averaged on an annual basis.
Bioassays to determine nutrients critical to the growth of Cayuga Lake
phytoplankton are among the best designed and most comprehensive of any so
far done for freshwater systems. Using continuous cultures of naturally
occurring phytoplankton communities in lake water, the role of phosphorus
in limiting growth during mid and late summer of 1971 and 1972 has been con-
vincingly demonstrated (Barlow et al., 1973 and Peterson et al., 1973).
The phytoplankton of Cayuga Lake is comprised of a mixture of associations
some of which have been described in the literature as being indicative of
oligotrophy and others as typifying eutrophic conditions. Myxophycean "blooms"
occur at times during the summer but are not persistent. Seasonal patterns
of succession and peaks of abundance as indicated by cell counts, species
biomass, and pigment concentration are highly variable from year to year.
A general pattern of maximum standing crop from late June into early October
exhibits large week to week fluctuations with surface chlorophyll £ ranging
195
-------
-3 -3
from a low of near 1 mg m to over 20 mg m on one occasion in 1972.
Both cell counts and species composition indicate a probable trend to more
eutrophic conditions when data from 1910-1930 are compared with those for
1950-74. Barlow (1969), Dahlberg (1973), and Godfrey (unpublished) have
compiled comprehensive descriptions of the phytoplankton communities species
composition in recent years.
The zooplankton (Birge and Juday, 1914; Birge and Juday, 1921; Muenscher,
1927; Bradshaw, 1964; Hennick, 1973; and Behrman, unpublished) and benthic
fauna (Birge and Juday, 1921; Henson, 1954; Green, 1965; and Dahlberg, 1973)
are typical of deep, moderately productive north temperate latitude lakes.
There is no evidence of qualitative changes in either over the last sixty
years, but limited data indicate that summer standing crops of zooplankton
may have increased. Cyclops bicuspidatus is the dominant copepod and
Bosmina longirostris the most abundant of the Cladocera in the summer zoo-
plankton. Abundant Mysis relicta are an important food resource for some
species of fish.
The fish population i.s managed to maximize salmonid production (Youngs
and Oglesby, 1972), Significant sport fisheries also exist for smelt, small-
mouth bass and other species. The principal food chain associated with the
limnetic zone is: phytoplankton and detritis ^zooplankton >alewives •—
—» salmonids.
The bacterial flora is virtually undefined. A limited amount of data
are provided by Dahlberg (1973). The benthic flora, exclusive of rooted
plants, is unstudied. Cladophora sp. is abundant is the littoral zone in
some locations and fishermen report that growths of this attached alga have
increased in recent years.
19.6
-------
Dense growths of rooted macrophytes occur in a limited area of shallow
water at the southern end of the lake and over a much larger area at the
northern end. Historical data on plant growths at the head end of the lake
indicate a possible increase in plant density and a shift to species,
especially millfoil, that constitute more of a nuisance (Vogel, 1973; Oglesby,
Vogel? Peverly and Johnson, MS 1974).
NUTRIENT BUDGETS
Budgets and loadings for three different kinds of phosphorus are given
in Table 4. Inputs of total phosphorus and molybdate reactive phosphorus
Table 4. Phosphorus inputs and loadings (excluding the Seneca River) for
total and molybdate reactive phosphorus (1970-71) and for "bio-
logically available" phosphorus (1972).
Total P MRP "Biologically available" P
Source (kg x 1Q~3 yr"1) (kg x 10~3 yr"1) (kg x 10~3 yr~l)
Waste discharges
Land runoff
Precipitation
Ground water
Other
Total
Volumetric loading
(mg m~3 yr-1) 14.9 10.0 12.6
Areal loading
g nr2 yr-1 0.81 0.54 0.69
(unfiltered) are based on a one year study by Likens (1972, 1974a and b) in
which the contributions of P in precipitation and in 25 tributaries (draining
almost 78% of the lake basin watershed) were monitored. "Waste discharge"
and "Land runoff" categories were subsequently determined by calculating the
former based on estimates of per capita discharge of phosphorus to the
tributaries and adding to this the P in wastes discharged directly to the
197
88.6
47.4
3.4
139.4
88.6
2.0
3.4
94.0
88.6
26.1
3.4
118.1
-------
lake (Oglesby and Schaffner, 1975 and Oglesby and Schaffner, MS 1975).
Phosphorus from land runoff was then determined by difference. The budget
for "biologically available" P contains a "Land runoff" estimate based on
the use of export coefficients, determined during an intensive 18 month
study of the Fall Creek watershed (Bouldin, unpublished), for the sum of
SRP, dissolved unreactive P and the fraction of P associated with suspended
particulates that desorbs in aqueous solution. The runoff (export)
-2 -1
coefficients (mg m yr ) for land in various use categories were: 13.2
for agriculture, 8.3 for forest and 100 for residential usage.
A budget for soluble nitrogen exclusive of organic N, is given in
Table 5. The essential components are derived from Likens' (1972, 1974a and b)
Table 5. Soluble nitrogen inputs and loadings (excluding the Seneca River)
for 1970-71.
Soluble N
Source (kg x 1Q~3 yr~l)
Waste discharges 200.3
Land runoff 1,694.1
Precipitation 565.6
Ground water ?
Other ?
Total 2,460.0
-3 -1
Volumetric loading (mg m yr ) 262
-2 -1
Areal loading (g m yr ) 14.2
1970-71 study of tributary and precipitation inputs. As was the case for
phosphorus, the "Waste discharge" category was calculated and "Land runoff"
obtained by difference for the tributary input. In the calculation of the
former a per capita discharge of 4.44 kg yr (01sson,Karlgren and Tullander,
1968) and a treatment efficiency (all types of disposal systems) for N removal
of 50% were assumed.
Other macronutrient budget information calculated by Likens is summarized
in Table 6.
198
-------
Table 6. Sulfur, silicon, calcium, magnesium and bicarbonate inputs and
loadings from precipitation and tributary inflow (excluding the
Seneca River) during 1970-71.
Input Volumetric loading Areal loading
Nutrient (kg x 10~3 yr~l) (mg m~3 yr"1) (gm m~2 yr"1)
S04= - s
Si02 - Si
Ca^
M ++
Mg
HCO~ - C
13,253
2,147
63,802
15,263
31,523
1,410
229
6,800
1,630
3,360
76.6
12.4
369
88.2
182
DISCUSSION
As a moderately large and deep, cold water lake affected by a variety
of human influences, Cayuga is representative of many important bodies of
water formed in north temperate latitudes by the action of glaciers. Its
relatively uncomplicated morphology (low shoreline development, restricted
littoral zone except at the tail end, and single basin) make Cayuga an
excellent site for elucidating limnological principles. The existence of a
substantial body of knowledge, accumulated over the past century, places it
among the limnologically better defined lakes in the world.
For the present emphasis on examining primary production in an ecological
context, adequate data are available on the more static properties, e.g.,
geology and morphometry, and, for one or more years, on many of the more
changeable parameters such as the distribution and loading of primary nutrients,
algal standing crops and transparency. Data on primary production rates,
grazing, and benthic productivity are more limited.
Based on most biotic and associated abiotic descriptive properties,
Cayuga Lake falls in the mesotrophic category; yet, for given parameters and
at specific times, it could be termed either eutrophic or oligotrophic.
199
-------
The composition of the phytoplankton is especially illustrative of an inter-
mediate trophic status since dominant groupings commonly cited as being
typical of both oligotrophic (e.g., Cyclotella, Tabellaria, chrysomonads and
Sphaerocystis) and eutrophic (e.g., Myxophyceae and Melosira) conditions
_3
occur. Mean summer euphotic zone chlorophyll concentrations (ca. 5-10 mg m ),
-2 -1
primary production rates (annually on the order of 160 mg C m day ), hypo-
limnetic dissolved oxygen (minimum concentration of about 6 mg 1 ), the
composition of the fauna (the fishes include both salmonids and carp, Mysis
relicta), and the standing crop of profundal benthos (0.5-1.0 gm organic
_2
matter m ) reinforce the picture of mesotrophy. There is evidence that pro-
ductivity has increased when data from the 1910-1930 period are compared with
those from 1950-1974.
When data on Cayuga Lake are fitted to the graphics of trophic state as
a function of total P loading vs. mean depth (Vollenweider, 1968) or vs. the
ratio of mean depth tr water residence time (Vollenweider as given by Dillon,
MS 1974), a eutrophic condition (about the same as Malaren) is indicated
with total P loadings above the so-called "dangerous" level. The reasons for
this lack of fit to the Vollenweider plots can only be speculated on at
present. Several possible factors are: (1) 15% of the total phosphorus loading,
namely that adsorbed to soil particles, is estimated to remain unavailable
for biological uptake, (2) Cayuga's simplified morphology and aerobic hypolimnion
probably minimize the internal recycling of phosphorus compared with that
which occurs in some lakes, (3) there could be significant errors in the
calculation of specific phosphorus loading, and (4) the parameters used in
the Vollenweider plots are invalid, or at least inaccurate, in defining trophic
state.
Ignoring mean depth and water retention time, Oglesby and Schaffner
(MS 1975) have obtained the following relation between summer chlorophyll
200
-------
(mean for the epilimnion) and the specific loading of "biologically available"
phosphorus for New York's Finger Lakes.
Y = 21.8X - 1.57 (r = 0.62, n = 21)
They postulate that depth becomes an important factor only when it is
necessary to separate lakes that essentially mix to the bottom throughout
most of all of the year from those that exhibit summer stratification.
REFERENCES CITED
Anonymous. 1879. History of Tioga, Chemung, Tompkins and Schuyler Counties,
New York. Everts and Ensign, Philadelphia. 687 p.
Barlow, J. P. 1969. Chapt. XVI. The phytoplankton. In R. T. Oglesby and
D. J. Allee, eds. Ecology of Cayuga Lake and the proposed Bell Station
(nuclear powered). Cornell Univ. Water Resources and Mar. Sci. Center
(Ithaca, N.Y.). Publ. No. 27. 466 p. + appendix.
Barlow, J. P., W. R. Schaffner, F. deNoyelles, Jr. and B. J. Peterson. 1973.
Continuous flow nutrient bioassays with natural phytoplankton populations.
JLn_ G. E. Glass, ed. Bioassay techniques and environmental chemistry.
Ann Arbor Sci. Publishers. 499 p.
Berg, C. 0. 1966. Middle Atlantic States. In D. G. Frey, ed. Limnology
in North America. University of Wisconsin Press, Madison. 734 p.
Birge, E. A. and C. Juday. 1914. A limnological study of the Finger Lakes
of New York. Doc. No. 791 from Bull. Bur. Fisheries (1912) 32:525-609.
. 1921. Further limnological observations on the
Finger Lakes of New York. Doc. No. 905 from Bull. Bur. Fisheries (1919-20)
37:210-252.
Bradshaw, A. S. 1964. The crustacean zooplankton picture: Lake Erie 1939-49-59;
Cayuga 1910-51-61. Verh. Internat. Verein. Limnol. 15:700-708.
Burkholder, P. R. 1931. Studies in the phytoplankton of the Cayuga basin,
New York. Bull. Buffalo Soc. Nat. Sciences 15(2):21-181.
Child, D., R. T. Oglesby and L. S. Raymond, Jr. 1971. Land use data for the
Finger Lakes region of New York State. Cornell Univ. Water Resources and
Mar. Sci. Center (Ithaca, N.Y.). Publ. No. 33. 29 p.
Cline, M. G. and R. W. Arnold. 1970. Working draft soil association maps
for New York. Unpublished.
Dahlberg, M. 1973. An ecological study of Cayuga Lake, New York. Vol. 4.
Report to New York State Electric and Gas Corporation. NUS Corp.
(Pittsburgh, Pa.). 171 p. + appendices.
201
-------
Dethier, B. E. and A. B. Pack. 1963. Climatological summary, RURBAN Climate
Series No. 1, Ithaca, New York. N.Y. State College of Agriculture (Ithaca,
N.Y.). 12 p.
Dillon, P. J. MS 1974. Progress report on the application of the phosphorus
loading concept to eutrophication research. A report prepared on behalf of
R. A. Vollenweider for NRG Associate Committee on Scientific Criteria for
Environmental Quality Subcommittee on Water, Canada Centre for Inland Waters,
Burlington, Ont. 28 p.
Dudley, W. R. 1886. The Cayuga flora. Bull. Cornell Univ. (Ithaca, N.Y.).
Vol. II. 132 p.
Federal Water Pollution Control Administration. 1965. Unpublished notes.
Green, R. H. 1965. The population ecology of the glacial relict amphipod
?OYltopotL
-------
Ludlam, S. T. 1967. Sedimentation in Cayuga Lake, New York. Limnol. Oceanogr.
12(4):618-632.
Mills, E. L. and R. T. Oglesby. 1971. Five trace elements and vitamin
in Cayuga Lake, New York. Proc. 14th Conf . Great Lakes Res. p. 256-267.
Muenscher, W. C. 1927. Plankton studies of Cayuga, Seneca and Oneida Lakes.
In A biological survey of the Oswego River system. Suppl. 17th Ann. Rpt.
N.Y. State Conservation Dept. J. B. Lyon, Albany.
Oglesby, R. T. and W. R. Schaffner, 1975. Nitrogen, phosphorus and eutro-
phication in the Finger Lakes. Cornell Univ. Water Resources Mar. Sci.
Center (Ithaca, N.Y.). Tech. Rpt. No. 94. 27 p .
Oglesby, R. T. and W. R. Schaffner. MS 1975. The response of lakes to
phosphorus .
Oglesby, R. T. , A. Vogel, J. H. Peverly and R. Johnson. MS 1974. Changes
in submerged plants at the south end of Cayuga Lake following Tropical Storm
Agnes .
Olsson, E. , L. Karlgren and V. Tullander. 1968. Household waste water.
Byggforskningens Rapport 24. Natl. Swedish Inst. Bldg. Ros., Stockholm.
162 p.
Peterson, B. J. 1971. The role of zooplankton in the phosphorus cycle of
Cayuga Lake. Ph.D. thesis. Cornell Univ. (Ithaca, N.Y.). 131 p.
Peterson, B. J., J. P. Barlow and A. E. Savage. 1973. Experimental studies
on phytoplankton succession in Cayuga Lake. Cornell Univ. Water Resources
Mar. Sci. Center (Ithaca, N.Y.). Tech. Rpt. 71. 23 p.
Raffieux, P. 1671-72. The Jesuit relations and allied documents 56:48-52.
Rickard, L. V. and D. W. Fisher. 1970. Geologic map of New York. Finger
Lakes Sheet. New York State Museum and Sciences Service (Albany, N.Y.).
Singley, G. W. 1973. Distribution of heat and temperature in Cayuga Lake.
Rpt. prepared for New York State Electric and Gas Corporation by NUS Corp.
(Rockville, Md) . p. 1-91 + appendices.
Sundaram, T. R. , C. C. Easterbrook, K. R. Piech and G. Rudinger. 1969. An
investigation of the physical effects of thermal discharges into Cayuga Lake
(analytical study). Cornell Aeronautical Lab., Inc. (Buffalo, N.Y.). CAL
No. VT-2616-0-2. 306 p.
Thompson, D. Q. 1972. Trees in history. The Cornell Plantations 28(3):39-42.
United States Bureau of the Census. 1970a. Census of population. General
population characteristics. Final Report PC(1) - B 34, New York. U. S.
Govt. Print. Off., Washington, D. C.
1970b. Census of housing. Block
statistics for selected areas of New York State. Final Report HC(3) - 163.
U. S. Govt. Print. Off., Washington, D. C.
203
-------
United States Dept. of Interior. 1971. Water resources data for New York.
Part I. Surface water records. U. S. Geol. Surv. (Albany, N.Y.). 311 p.
Vogel, A. 1973. Changes in the submerged aquatic flora at the south end of
Cayuga Lake between 1929 and 1970. M. S. thesis. Cornell Univ. (Ithaca, N.Y.)
71 p. + appendix.
Vollenweider, R. A. 1968. The scientific basis of lake and stream eutro-
phication, with particular reference to phosphorus and nitrogen as eutro-
phication factors. Tech. Rpt. OECD, Paris, DAS/CSI/68, 27:1-182.
Wagner, F. E. 1927. Chapt. V. Chemical investigations of the Oswego water-
shed. In A biological survey of the Oswego River system. Suppl. 17th Ann.
Rpt., N. Y. State Conservation Dept. 248 p.
Whitford, N. E. 1906. History of the canal system of the State of New York.
Vol. 1. Suppl. Ann. Rpt. State Eng. Surv. N. Y. State. 1025 p.
Wright, T. D. 1969a. Chapt. VII. Currents and internal waves, _In R. T.
Oglesby and D. J. Allee, eds. Ecology of Cayuga Lake and the proposed Bell
Station (nuclear powered). Cornell Univ. Water Resources Mar. Sci. Center
(Ithaca, N.Y.). Publ. No. 27. 466 p. + appendix.
. 1969b. Chapt. V. Hydrology and flushing characteristics.
op. cit.
. 1969c. Chapt. VIII. Conductivity, op. cit.
. 1969d. Chapt. XIV. Alkalinity and pH. op. cit.
1969e. Chapt. X. Chemical limnology and Chapt. XI. Hypolimnetic
oxygen, op. cit.
. 1969f. Chapt. XIII. Plant nutrients, op. cit.
. 1969g. Chapt. XV. Plant pigments (chlorophyll a_ and phaeophytin)
op. cit.
Youngs, W. D. 1969. Chapt. XVIII. Fish and other biota. In R. T. Oglesby
and D. J. Allee, eds. Ecology of Cayuga Lake and the proposed Bell Station
(nuclear powered). Cornell Univ. Water Resources Mar. Sci. Center (Ithaca,
N.Y.). Publ. 27. 466 p. + appendix.
Youngs, W. D. and R. T. Oglesby. 1972. Cayuga Lake: effects of exploitations
and introductions on the salmonid community. J. Fish. Res. Canada 29:787-794.
204
-------
TROPHIC STATUS AND NUTRIENT BALANCE FOR CANADARAGO LAKE
Dr. Leo J. Metling and Dr. Thomas E. Harr
Environmental Quality Research Unit
New York State Department of Environmental Conservation
Albany, New York
and
Dr. G. Wolfgang Fuhs and Susan P. Allen
Environmental Health Center
Division of Laboratories and Research
New York State Department of Health
Albany, New York
INTRODUCTION
Canadarago Lake, located in Otsego County, east-central New York State
has been the scene of an intensive investigation by the New York State Depart-
ments of Environmental Conservation and Health.
Canadarago Lake is a stratified lake of moderate size (759 ha). From its
morphometry (7m mean depth), it can be expected to be moderately eutrophic but
at the beginning of the New York State study, appeared strongly eutrophic with
dense blue-green algae blooms, a condition which appeared to be caused by the
input of sewage from the village of Richfield Springs and from summer camps.
When the study began in 1968, Richfield Springs was under State Health Depart-
ment orders to stop discharging raw sewage into the lake.
The advanced state of eutrophication in this lake called for the construc-
tion of a modern sewage treatment plant which included some form of nutrient
removal. The concern of the local residents, the proximity of the lake to
Albany, and the fact that Canadarago Lake typically represents the condition
of a number of lakes within the state, made it a logical candidate for a pilot
demonstration study.
The only prior published data concerning an investigation of Canadarago
Lake occurred as the result of the biological survey of the Delaware and
Susquehanna watersheds performed by the New York State Conservation Department
during the summer of 1935 (1). Even at this early data Canadarago Lake showed
evidence of eutrophication. Throughout the text comparisons of the present
study with that of 1935 are presented.
205
-------
BRIEF GEOGRAPHIC DESCRIPTION OF WATER BODY
A-D. GEOGRAPHICAL DATA
Canadarago Lake is situated in east-central New York State, Figure 1,
at an elevation of 390m (1280 ft) above mean sea level. Canadarago Lake
together with its 175 km^ of drainage area, Figure 2, forms the northeastern
headwaters of the Susquehanna River watershed, originating in Herk-imer an^
Otsego counties. The drainage basin for this lake is bounded between
74° 53' 33" West Longitude and 42° 46' 18" North Latitude with the centroid
of the lake located at 75° 00' 25" West Longitude and 42° 49' 00" North
Latitude. The surrounding terrain is hilly, with ground elevations ranging
from 396m (1300 ft) to 579m (1900 ft) above mean sea level.
Four major tributaries, Figure 3, drain 78.3 percent of the watershed:
Ocquionis Creek which discharges at the north end of the lake, and Mink
Creek, Hyder Creek and Herkimer Creek which discharge along its western
shore. The eastern portion of the watershed is too narrow and steep to
support permanent streams. The lake is drained at its southern end by
Oaks Creek, which flows south to join the Susquehanna River at Index, New
York.
FIGURE I.
LOCATION OF CANAOARAGO LAKE
IN NEW YORK STATE
FIGURE Z.
CANADARAGO LAKE WATERSHED
206
-------
OCQUIONIS CR
N
N.YS. BOAT LAUNCHING
FIGURE 3.
CANADARAGO LAKE AND
ITS TRIBUTARIES
E.
GENERAL GEOLOGICAL CHARACTERISTICS
The bedrock geology and Pleistocene glacial modifications are strongly
reflected by the present physiography of the Canadarago Lake drainage basin.
The bedrock of the drainage basin is predominantly Onondaga and Helderberg
limestone in the north and the Hamilton shales and siltstones in the south.
The contact between these two formations is the boundary between two dis-
tinct physiographic units.
This area of New York State was glaciated several times during the
Pleistocene epoch, but evidence is preserved only for the latter stages
of the Wisconsin Glacial period. Two major glacial lobes thrust over the
drainage area during this Glacial period, approximately 11,000-12,000 years
ago. One advance was in the north-south direction and was probably respon-
sible for the outwash deposits found to the south of the drainage basin.
This advance may have been responsible for forming the oversteepened north
faces of the shale siltstone ridges which predominate in the southern half
of the drainage basin. The second advance was in the west-southwesterly
207
-------
direction. This advance is marked by several endmorainic deposits in the
northern section of the drainage basin. Also, the lack of high-lime
glacial drift on the southern portions of the drainage basin indicates
little movement of limestone in the north to south direction. Flint (2)
estimated the thickness of the ice sheet at the time of its maximum advance
to have been 1000 to 1200m (3281 to 3937 ft). The glacial and subsequent
periglacial periods strongly influenced the character of soils found in
the drainage basin. Ocquionis and Mink Creeks originate in Herkimer County
and drain from the gently undulating east-west oriented limestone unit.
The stream forms a typical trellis drainage pattern. The valley floors
contain many swamps and muck deposits. Local relief between valley floors
and ridge tops is generally less than 30m (98.5 ft). Hyder and Herkimer
Creeks, in contrast, originating in Otsego County, are in the shale upland
unit. Physiographically, this area is characterized by a strong local
relief and dendritic drainage patterns. The local relief is as much as
200m (656 ft) from valley floors to surrounding ridges in some places.
The streambeds are on gravel or bedrock. There are no muck deposits within
the major stream system.
F. VEGETATION
On the slopes and hills of the Canadarago Lake watershed are woods of
mixed deciduous trees, primarily maple and oak. A narrow band of trees
surround the lake anrf an agricultural belt is located between them. A
swampy woodland is located at the southern end of the lake.
G. POPULATION
The village of Richfield Springs is the only significant, permanent
population concentration in the watershed. In 1970, the population of the
village was 1527 (3) and records indicate that the population has been
nearly constant for 20 years (4, 5). During the summer months, approxi-
mately 1300 additional people occupy summer cottages around the lake shore.
The total permanent resident population of the entire watershed is not
known but it is estimated to be on the order of 3500 people.
H. LAND USAGE
About 49 percent of the watershed is devoted to agriculture, mostly
dairy farms, and approximately 34 percent is in forest or brushland (6,7,8),
Table 1 is a summary of the land use within the watershed. Using the
Table 1. LAND USE IN THE LANADARAGO LAKE MTERSHEb
Area > Watershed Area
(k.2) ! (Percentage)
Agriculture and Agriculture 86.93 49.00
Facilities
Forett
Mater Resources
Wetlands
Residential
Conerclal
Industrial
Mining
60.10 | 34.02
12.38 j. 7.01
11.49 6.SI
3.88 2.26
0.66
.38
0.07 j .04
0.35 ' .20
Public, Semlpubllc and
Transportation I 0.46 ; .26
Outdoor Recreation , 0.56 .32
Total
176.61 . 100.00
208
-------
1964 agricultural census, (9, 10), it has been estimated that there are
approximately 6000 cattle, 40 hogs, 50 sheep and 5000 chickens in the
watershed. A more extensive study of soil type and land use has been con-
ducted by the Department of Agronomy at Cornell University, Ithaca, New York
which adds support to these data (ll).
I, WATER USAGE
The lake is used primarily for recreational purposes, offering
recreationat opportunities for the urban residents of Albany, 100 km
(60 .miles) to the east, and Utica, 40 km (25 miles) to the
northwest. The recreational potential of Canadarago Lake has long been
recognized and utilized. Around the turn of the century, this lake and its
larger sister lake, Otsego Lake, were sites of summer homes and health spas
for the wealthy. Although the economic strata of the users have changed,
the recreationists today are the source of a substantial portion of the
area's economy.
A study of the economic contribution of the recreational aspects of
Canadarago Lake by the Soil Conservation Service of the United States De-
partment of Agriculture (12) revealed that more than $663,000 annual sales
were directly related to the lake and its existing recreational facilities.
In addition, the lake oriented properties contribute about $90,000 annually
in local real estate and school taxes. This study further concluded that
the lake and its recreational assets are a significant contributor to the
local community and that, if the Richfield Springs area was deprived of the
lake, the area could undergo the economic decline being experienced by many
other rural communities in New York State.
J. SEWAGE AND EFFLUENT DISCHARGE
The village of Richfield Springs has been served by a combined sewer
system which discharged through a primary wastewater treatment plant, to
Ocquionis Creek, at a point approximately 0.8 km (0.5 mile) upstream of
its mouth. The plant had not been operational for several years since it
needed significant repairs. The cottages and residences located around
the perimeter of the lake are served by septic tanks. In 1969, a New York
State Health Department survey revealed that 24.4 percent of the septic
tanks had some type of direct discharge into the lake, by-passing the
leaching fields (13).
During 1972 the village of Richfield Springs constructed a modern
wastewater treatment facility to replace the former sewage treatment plant.
The effluent from the new facility is discharged to Ocquionis Creek at the
same point as from the previous facility. Construction of the facility
was completed in the summer of 1973. In November 1972, the plant began
operation as a secondary treatment plant. In January 1973, the tertiary
system for removal of phosphorus was completed.
This facility, operating as a tertiary treatment plant, is capable
of treating 0.37 x 10° gal • day'1(1.4 x 103m3 • day'1). The lagoon system,
which provides secondary treatment, can handle up to 2.5 x 10 gal • day"-'-
(9.5 x 103m3 • day"1). Flow in excess of 0.37 x 10° gal • day"1(l.4 x 103
m3 • day"-1-) is given only secondary treatment and disinfection at the plant.
209
-------
Wastewater processed through tertiary treatment will provide 93-94% BOD
removal and up to 90% phosphorus removal, or to a maximum effluent concen-
tration of 0.5 mg P • liter .
In addition to the wastewater treatment plant discharge, natural
mineral springs effluents enter the lake through the Richfield Springs
wastewater treatment plant and Ocquionis Creek, introducing quantities of
sulfate, sulfide, magnesium and calcium as pollutants. Another source of
pollution is a stockpile of road salt located near Mink Creek which in-
troduces additional chlorides to the lake.
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF MORPHOMETRIC AND HYDROLOGIC CHARACTERISTICS
A. LAKE LOCATION AND DESCRIPTION
Canadarago Lake is nearly 6.4 km (4 mi) long, running north-south
but is only 1.9 km (1.2 mi) wide at its maximum width. The shore length
of- the lake is 14.4 km (9 mi) and 80 percent of the area around the lake
is densely populated with summer homes, trailer parks and year-round
residences. During the summer months, seasonal transient occupancy of
these facilities increases the population of the area by approximately
1300 people.
An island, Deowongo Island, is located nearly midway between the
northern and southern extremes of the lake and approximately 400 m (1300 ft)
west of the eastern shoreline. The island possesses an area of approxi-
mately 3 ha (7.5 acres) and has a shoreline of approximately 0.8 km (0.5 mi).
In addition, a shoal, submerged in 1 to 2 m (3.3 to 6.6 ft) of water, is
located approximately 0.4 km (0.25 mi) from the western shore and 1.5 km
(0.93 mi) south of the northern extreme of the lake. Nearly 10 ha (24 acres)
of this shoal is submerged in 3 m (10 ft) or less, of water. Normally, in
the summer, it is heavily covered with weed beds.
B. VOLUME
The volume of the lake has been calculated as 57.5 x 106 m3 (2.03 x 109 ft3)
(14).
Until 1956 the lake was alloweH to seek its own natural level. This
frequently resulted in the lake becoming so low that large areas of the
lake bottom around the perimeter of the lake became exposed. This condition
reduced the lake's attractiveness for recreational and sporting use, de-
creased the asthetic quality of the area and frequently caused obnoxious
disagreeable odors. To correct this situation, the Canadarago Lake Property
Owners Association, in 1955, obtained permission from New York State to
erect a regulatory barrier in Oaks Creek, the outlet from the lake. This
barrier could be raised or lowered, as required, in order to maintain the
lake at a convenient level. The barrier was constructed and put into
operation in 1956 and still is controlled by the Property Owners Association.
210
-------
C-D. DEPTH
The maximum water depth in Canadarago Lake is 12.8 m (42 ft) and the
average depth is 7.7 m (25.3 ft). The lake area is 759 ha (2050 acres).
The lake can be divided into two shallow areas, less than 5 m (16.4 ft) deep
in its northern and southernmost parts. The remainder of the lake is be-
tween 5 and 10 m (16.4 and 32.8 ft) deep. The deepest points occur in a
trench just north of the center of the lake and in a spot south of the center
of the lake.
E-F. STRATIFICATION
Extensive mixing by the wind of this well-exposed lake produces a
thermocline that is not very sharp and, during most of the season, is
found at a depth of 6 to 8 m (19.7 to 26.3 ft) while secondary thermo-
clines move in from the surface. The mean depth of the epilimnion during
the summer stratification is 6.7 m (21 ft). The epilimnion encloses
approximately 72 percent of the lake volume and is maintained from June
through September.
G. NATURE OF LAKE SEDIMENTS
The appearance of the sediments of Canadarago Lake is that of a silty
black mud. Some sand which contains snail shells can be found along shore-
line^areas.
In August 1973, a sediment core was taken from Canadarago Lake by
driving through 30 cm (12 in.) of sediment with a Kojak Brinkhurst (KB).corer.
The core was extruded, fractionated in the field into 7.5 cm (3 in.)
intervals, placed in polyethylene bags, frozen, and stored at -20°C (-4°F)
until analysis. Chemical analysis of the core showed the macrocomponents
of the sediment to be in a range typical of hardwater lakes: silica
270 mg • g~^, calcium 100 mg • g , aluminum 50 mg • g~ , magnesium 0.6 mg *
(expressed on a dry weight basis). Organic carbon and total phosphorus con-
tents of the sediments, commonly regarded as indicators of the lake's trophic
level, were found to be 50 mg • g~l and 5 mg • g~* respectively, suggesting
moderate eutrophication. From previous surveys it was known that the sedi-
ments in the northern, unstratified portion of the lake, off Ocquionis Creek
which has carried raw sewage, were softer and higher in organic matter than
the sediments in the main basin and particularly in its southern part.
H. PRECIPITATION
The area has a humid climate with cold winters and mild summers. The
watershed is subject to occasional local cloudburst type of storms. A
deficiency of rainfall frequently occurs extending through the upper few
inches of soil during part of the summer.
The total annual precipitation for the Canadarago Drainage Basin over
the 1951-1960 period was 1005 mm (39.3 in.) which includes an average annual
snowfall of 2.5 m (8.2 ft). The mean temperature for this location, over
the same period of time was 6.9°C (44.4°F) with varying extremes of 37°C
(98°F) down to -36°C (-32.8°F) (15).
211
-------
I. INFLOW AND OUTFLOW OF WATER
The watershed for the Canadarago Lake area can be divided into four
natural areas, Figure 4, each drained by a creek which flows throughout
the year, and the remaining area, which contains no year-round flowing
drainage system, located primarily on the steep slope east of the lake.
The former areas constitute 78.2 percent of the entire watershed.
FIGURE 4.
CANADARAGO LAKE SUBWATERSHEDS
From April 15, 1969 through April it, 1970, data were collected for
determining a water balance for Canadarago Lake (16). Flows of the four
major influent streams, Figure 3, Ocquionis, Mink, Hyder and Herkimer
Creeks, and the effluent stream, Oaks Creek, were measured using staff
gauges, set by the U. S. Geological Survey, located near the mouth of each
of the influent streams and at the head of the effluent stream.
The effluent from the wastewater treatment plant for the village of
Richfield Springs, which flows into Ocquioni's Creek below the gauging
station and before its entrance to Canadarago Lake, was measured employing
a 90 degree V-notch weir.
Using the flow data obtained from these sources, calculations were
performed to synthesize a daily hydrograph for each source. A summary of
these hydrographs is given in Table 2.
212
-------
Table 2 . WATER BALANCE FOR CANADARAGO LAKE
April 15, 1969 through April 14, 1970
Source Average Flo* Drainage Area
">3/s Percent of Oaks Creek to"2
Oaks Creek \ 2.865 [ 100.0 175.0
Gauged Tributaries
Ocqulonls Creek 0.684 ' 23.9 51-3
Mink Creek ! 0.414 14.5 27.2
Hyrter Creek . 0.375 13.0 27.5
i
Herkimer Creek 0.741 25.8 ' 30-8
Sub Total 2.214 77.2 136.7
Wastewater Treatment Facility 1 0.021 Q.7
Total Gauged Inputs j 2.235 78.0
i i
Percent of Oaks Creek
100.0
29.3
15.5
15.7
17.6
78.1
Evaporation losses from the lake were estimated by using surface
water temperature over the same time period and climatological data from
Albany, Binghamton and Syracuse, New York (17). These data yielded a total
evaporation for the study period of 37,000 m3 (1.3 x 106 ft3), only 0.04
percent of the total annual effluent flow from Oaks Creek. During the
summer, the evaporation rate was as high as two percent of the Oaks Creek
flow. As shown in-Table 2, the gauged influent tributary streams accounted
for 77.2 percent of the effluent Oaks Creek flow and 78.2 percent of its
watershed. A calculated value of influent, equal to the average gauged
area runoff, was assumed for the ungauged areas. Examination of the morph-
ology of the lake led to the conclusion that ground water outflows are
negligible. Oaks Creek flow is, therefore, approximately equal to the total
water input.
J. WATER CURRENTS
Very little study has been made of the water currents in Canadarago
Lake. One dye study did, however, indicate that Herkimer Creek, which enters
the lake at its southern end and near the mouth of the Oaks Creek outlet,
may, at times, be shunted into the outlet without having much influence on
the lake.
K. WATER RENEWAL TIME
In both 1969 and 1970, the spring melt occurred in late March and early
April. The peak flows recorded during the 1970 melt, from the influent
streams are listed in Table 3. The peak gauged input from these four streams
was 33.1 m3 • sec"1 (1169 ft3 * sec"-1-). The peak lake discharge through
Oaks Creek lagged behind the input by four days and reached only 18.8 m3
The minimum recorded summer flows in the four tributaries, also listed in
Table 3, occurred in late August and early September 1969. The minimum flow
in Oaks Creek was 0.048 m3 • sec"1 (1.7 ft3 • sec"1) and occurred in late
September, nearly one month after the minimum flows were recorded in the
influent tributaries.
213
sec
-1
-------
* 3. MAXIWW AK» MIHIMIW IKW> ") IM I'.';'.!
TRlMirTAHlLb M < ,ANAl>AHAr\\ 14, 1970
( t
S^rCt1 '' Ha^lmim Flow j Minimum F
(cfsl I"3/"? , (cfs)
OequlJ-l* ^-sek 2S4 7.95 ^ 0.69
V.i-.K Crtek : 240 6.72 ' 0.16
:-/••«• :r««K 272 7.70 0.10
•i«rjilni«r Cresk 439 12.4 0.10
tlltar/s;
2C
4.i
2.5
2.5
Because of the great variation in stream flow during the year, the
spring melt constitutes one of the major annual events. During the
period April 15, 1969 through April 14, 1970, about 43 percent of the
lake's total gauged input and 32 percent of the gauged output occurred
during the month of April, when the lake was not stratified (16). As a
result, the average lake turnover time during April was about 60 days,
whereas the annual average was about 231 days during the time period in-
dicated. Based on 31 years of outflow data from Canadarago Lake through
Oaks Creek (17), the average lake turnover time was calculated to be 217
days.
A summary of the Morphometric Characteristics of Canadarago Lake
is shown in Table 4 (14).
Table 4. MORPHOMETRIC CHARACTERISTICS OF CANADARAGO LAKE
A. Area
B. Mean Depth
C. Maximum Depth
D. Mean Depth i Maximum Depth
E. Relative Depth
F. Volume
G. Development of Volume
H. Mean Slope
I. Altitude
J. Latitude
K. Longitude
L. Shore Length
M. Development of Shoreline
N. Littoral Development
0. Number of Islands
P. Area of Island
Q. Shore Length of Island
R. Drainage Area
S. Average Outflow
T. Tina of "Flushing"
U. Average Precipitation
759 ha
7.7 m
12.8 m
0.60
0.41*
57.51 x 106m3
1.8
0°36f8" exclusive of island and shoal
390 m
42349'00" North
75°00'25" West
14.4 km
1.47
Town of Richfield Springs) 80% of area
around lake is dsnsely populated with
summer homes
One - Deowongo Island. One shoal.
3.0 ha
0.8 km
175 km2
2.95 m A calculated from average discharge
for a period of 31 years
217 days
1005 mm
214
-------
LIMNOLOGICAL CHARACTERIZATION SUMMARY
A. PHYSICAL
1. Temperature
The temperature profile of Canadarago Lake for 1968, Figure 5,
is typical for this lake. It is observed that the maximum temperature
in the deepest sections of the lake occurred in September (15°C, 59°F).
It will be noted that the Deepest 2jjr meters (8.2 feet) of the lake
seldom exceed a temperature of 15°C (59°F). During the winter season,
usually from December through April, the lake is covered with a layer
of ice that reaches a thickness of 3- meter (20 inches).
CANADAMMO
10* II* 20
FMIME t.
LAKE IMI TIMPEKATUftC* I'd
»«• M" W §• 10' ••
UI9UIT 9trTtMCIt OCTOKIt HOVdMfll DICCMU
2. Conductivity
Conductivity measurements of Canadarago Lake were recorded as
part of the New York State Water Quality Surveillance Network. Data
for a five year period (1968-1972 inclusive) indicated a maximum con-
ductivity of 374.0 i\ mhos • cm and a minimum value of 174.0 u mhos*
3. Light Attenuation
Vertical light extinction in Canadarago Lake was determined from
simultaneous measurements of surface anr? subsurface irradiation with a
submarine photometer. The readings were converted to vertical extinction
coefficients (per meter, in base-10 logarithms) using Table 10 by Sauberer
(19) with estimate^ values of cloud cover and a calculated value for the
zenith distance of the sun at true local time, and the geographical
coordinates (43°N, 75°W), i.e. the elements of the "nautical triangle",
and the procedures of spherical trigonometry (18). Figure 6 displays
the 99 percent light attenuation depth for white light and the blue,
green, and red regions of the spectrum as measured in 1969 at Station 5»
located in the deepest section of the southeastern quadrant.
215
-------
I «
* .
FIGURE 6.
1969 CANADARAGO LAKE LIGHT ATTENUATION
STATION 5
K X X
X X
SCHOTT M 12,
439 urn BLUE FILTER
tCNOTT V« 9,
KHOTT M 2,
MO Ml RED FILTER
APWL HAT JWC JULY MNUST KPTCMDI OCTOKR NCWEMn OtCEWtH
4. Secchi Disc Measurements
Measurements were made from May through November. During this
period of time, when measurements were marie at 10 Different locations on
the lake, a depth of greater than 2 meters (6.5 ft ) was infrequently
recorder?. The highest reading recorded was 3.2 meters (10.5 ft ) and
the lowest reading recorded was 0.9 meter (2.9 ft ) Averaging the readings
recorded from the ten stations, the highest average reading occurred in
the middle of September, 2.62 meters (8.6 ft ), and the lowest average
reading occurred in the middle of July, 1.08 meters (3.5 ft). All readings
were made between 10:00 AM and 4:00 PM.
5. Solar Radiation
Solar radiation was measured at Canadarago Lake as part of the
data recorded by the New York State Automatic Water Quality Acquisition
System station on an hourly basis. During 1969 the maximum solar radiation
recorded was 1.66 gram calories • cm~2 • hr~l.
B. CHEMICAL
The pH of Canadarago Lake has been measured as part of the New York
State Water Quality Surveillance Network, the New York State Automatic
Water Quality Acquisition System and during the New York State Canadarago
Lake Eutrophication Study. Five years data (1968-1972 inclusive) from
the Water Quality Surveillance Network indicates a surface pH of 8.76 as
a high value and 6.9 as a low value. During the Canadarago Lake Eutro-
phication Study, pH measurements were taken at approximately 14 day in-
tervals during 1968 and 1969 at 10 different stations and, where possible,
at three different depths. From this investigation values of pH from a
low of 6.92 to a high of 9.16 were obtained. A summary of the average
pH of the lake at three different depths is shown in Table 5.
216
-------
Table 5. AVERAGE pH OF CANADARAGO LAKE, 1968-1969
Depth
(meters)
pH
1968 1969
0-4.5
4.5-8.0
8.0-12.5
8.12
8.03
7.26
8.11
7.93
7.66
2. Dissolved Oxygen
Dissolved oxygen profile measurements were made at Canadarago
Lake during 1968 and 1969. The measurements were made Curing the hours
of 10:00 AM and 4:00 PM. A dissolved oxygen profile for 1968 is shown
in Figure 7 (18). This profile is typical for the lake and indicates
that the bottom 3 m (10 foot) depth of the lake becomes void of oxygen
from early in July until late September. The 1935 survey (l) also re-
ported the absence of oxygen in the deepest portions of the lake at the
end of July.
FIGURE 7.
1968 CANADARAGO LAKE AVERAGE DISSOLVED OXYGEN CONCENTRATION
( port* per million * mg /1 )
0
9
10
K "
UJ
UJ
U. 20
SB -
40 -
48
II 10 9
10 II
3210
01 234 567 8 9 10
APRIL
MAY
JUNE
T I i i ii
JULY AUGUST SEPTEMBER OCTOBER NOVEMBER DECEMBER
217
-------
3. Phosphorus
Phosphorus Determinations were made on Canadarago Lake samples
collected at approximately 2 weeks intervals Curing 1968 and 1969. A
variety of Different forms of phosphorus were determined, including:
orthophosphate, soluble and particulate phosphorus. The soluble and
particulate phosphorus components were separated by means of vacuum
filtration through a 47 mm diameter, 0.8 u membrane filter. A summary
of the average values of total phosphorus and the various phosphorus
forms at three different depths of the lake are shown in Table 6 (18).
Table b. AVERAGfc CONCENTRATION OF CHEMICAL CHARACTERISTICS 01 CANADARAGO Lr'KE, 1968-1969
Depth
0-4,5
4.5-9.0
0.0-12.6
Total Lake
0-4.5
4.5-9.C
9.0-12.6
Total Lake
0-4.5
4.5-9.0
9.0-12.6
Total Lak"
0-4.5
4.5-9.C
9.0-12.6
Total Lake
0-4.5
4.5-9.0
9.0-1?.6
Total Lake
1968 1969
(nlcroqrams per lltor)
Depth
Soluble Phosphorus
16.4 13.7
16.2 II.'
25.2 2'-.2
17.2 13.';
Particuiate Phosphorus
31.4 20.1
29.3 30.0
50.0 37.7
32.4 30.5
Total Phosphorus
47.B 42.°
•;5.5 41.3
75.2 t2.<-
49. A 44.4
Organ!: Nitrogen
130P. 4
1122.4
1297
1246.7
Ammonia Mitroqen
70.9
131.3
5»5.5
127.5
764.9
585
573.3
120
14?,. 3
439.1
151.3
Nitrite and Nitrate Nitrogen
0-4.5 160.5 125.6
4.5-9.0 163.4 157.8
9.0-12.6 192.5 108.2
Total Lake 163 134.4
I
0-4.5
4,5-9.0
9.'-12.6
1968 1969
(milligrams per liter)
Soluble Organic ' arbon
2.96 4.66
2.47 3.59
1.40 4.27
Total Lai"- ?.61
1.41
Particular Organic Carbon
0-4.5 1.55 1.96
4.5-9.0 1.36 1.56
a.r-12.,. 1.28 1.37
Totil LA 1.49 1.82
Total Organic Carbon
4.51
3.83
2.68
4.13
6.62
5.15
5.64
6.23
Depth 1968 1969
(meters) (micrograms per liter)
0-4.5
4.5-9.0
9.5-12.6
Total Lake
Chlorophyll a
13.3
12.7
7.5
12.5
8.5
6.1
4.9
7.5
Depth
(meters)
0-4.5
4.5-9.1
9.0-12.6
Total Lake
0-4.5
4.5-9.0
9.0-12.6
Total Ldk._
|
0-4.5
| 4.5-9.0
9.0-12.6
Total Lake
0-4.5
4.5-9.0
9.0-12.6
i Total Lake
0-4.5
4.5-9.0
9.0-12.6
Total Lake
0-4.5
4.5-9.0
9.0-12.6
Total Lake
1968
(Milliequivalents
Sodium
0.225
0.247
0.226
0.229
Potassium
0.045
0.038
0.040
0.044
Total Calcium
1.76
1.S5
1.90
l.PO
Magnesium
0.527
0.545
0.461
0.540
Chloride
0.185
0.190
0.184
0.186
Sulfate
0.295
0.304
0.327
0.299
1969
per liter
0.159
0.151
0.189
0.153
0.&
2.78
2.78
3.72
2.84
0.483
0.496
0.614
0.4=0
0.182
0.175
0.214
0.179
0.311
o.sie
0.428
0.342
4. Nitrogen
Nitrogen determinations were made on Canadarago Lake samples
collected at approximately 2 week intervals during 1968 and 1969. A
variety of different forms of nitrogen were determined, including:
ammonia, nitrate and nitrite, soluble and particulate-organic nitrogen
and total organic nitrogen. The soluble and particulate organic nitrogen
components were separated by means of vacuum filtration through a 47 mm
diameter, 0.8 ^ membrane filter. A summary of the average values of
various forms of nitrogen at three different depths of the lake are shown
in Table 6 (18).
218
-------
5. Alkalinity
Total alkalinity determinations were made on Canadarago Lake
samples collected at approximately 2 week intervals during 1968 and 1969.
Alkalinity was determined by titration with mineral acid with time
allowed for any suspended calcium carbonate to dissolve and for a stable
end point to be attained (18). A summary of the average values of alka-
linity at three different depths of the lake are shown in Table 6 (18).
6. Cations
Analyses for concentration of the cations of Ca, Mg, Na, K and
Fe were made on Canadarago Lake samples collected at approximately 2
week intervals during 1968 and 1969. A summary of the average values of
these cations at three different depths of the lake are shown in Table
6 (18).
7. Anions
Analyses for concentrations of the anions of chloride and sul-
fate 'were made on Canadarago Lake samples collected at approximately
2 week intervals during 1968 and 1969. A summary of the average values
of these anions at three different depths of the lake are shown in Table
6 (18).
8. Trace Metals
Copper, zinc, cadmium and lead concentrations have been measured
in Canadarago Lake water and sediments to characterize the heavy metal
distribution at the sediment-water interface. Composite epilimnion and
hypolimnion lake water samples were taken in August 1973 with a Van Dorn
type sampler. Sediment cores and sediment supernatant water were ob-
tained using a Kajak-Brinkhurst (KB) corer. Results showed very low
concentrations of heavy metals in the lake water, with cadmium below
2 }\g • i~l and copper, zinc, and lead in the range of 5 to 20 ^g • 1~1.
Sediment cadmium content was less than 10 ^g ' g~l and lead less than
20 ^g • g~l, while copper was in the range of 40-80 ^g • g"*. Zinc con-
tent increased with sediment depth, ranging from 100^g • g in the
0-7.5 cm section of the core to 275 jjg • g'1 'in the 19.0-26.5 cm section.
(All analyses of sediments are expressed on a dry weight basis.)
C. BIOLOGICAL
1. Phvtoplankton
a. Chlorophyll
Chlorophyll,, a concentration of Canadarago Lake, was
determined from samples collected at approximately two week intervals
during 1968 and 1969. The average concentration of chlorophyll a that
was determined at three different depths, are shown in Table 6.
b. Primary Production
Primary production in Canadarago Lake has been calculated
in terms of phosphorus and carbon for the period between May and December
1969, using an improved sedimentation trap designed by G. W. Fuhs (20).
The contents of the traps weie analyzed for total phosphorus and total
carbon, as well as other parameters. Tables 7 and 8 present data for
219
-------
Table 7 . CARBON PRODUCTION 1969 CAN/UARAGO LAKE
Sedimentation
Period
5/9 - 23
5/23 - 6/6
6/6 - 6/20
6/20 - 7/1
7/1 - 7/18
7/18 - 8/1
8/1 - 8/20
8/20 - 9/3
9/3 - 9/15
9/15 - 10/1
10/1 - 10/15
10/15 - 10/31
10/31 - 11/12
11/12 - 12/4
C production -
C
rag/1
57**
105
101
63
38
0
?
25
54
89
63
389
37
191
1166.5
•j
kg/ha
0.08**
0.15
0.14
0.088
0.053
0
?
0.035
0.076
0.1246
0.088
0.5446
0.052
0.267
X 1Q°Q
609 x 104m2 • 195
C- total carbon, top
replicates
(see te
Trophogenic
Zone*
ha
611
633
633
613
620
527
600
588
600
634
671
641
631
533
ave.
609
= i _n fjT
days
minus bottom con^artmcntc
xtj
S A 11
m< tnr
tons, rog/1
49** 1 1 .55
9[J -0.7.v
89 *0.20
54 +0.50
33 0
0 -0.10
^ +0.4
21 -0.8
46 -0.7
79 +1.0
59 +1.1
349 +3.4
33 -4.2
142 +2.7
. m~2 . day "^
of sedimentation
Trophog* me
Zone
xK/*1
40
J4.2
34.8
40
38
35
42
45
43
33
27
33
35
37
ti^p, dv^rag<
At A t'S
mctri' m^ti:1:
torii tons
+62 +111**
-25 +70
+7 +9t
^20 +74
0 + 33
-3.5 -3.3
+17 eit. -5
-36 -15
-30 +16
+33 -112
+ 30 -8'-
+112 -461
-147 -114
-IOC -242
total
1166.5
value of
i mid-d«pth 6ita of
S sedimentation, represented by CT in st-dimtnt tr.ips (sn- t. xt)
AB change in bioma^ of CT in ldk<- at 1-3 ro* t. r d. pth
£B*S iuo oi bioma^i, ehang< and "..fdimtntdtion
M coiTfettion obtained from f./\' atoni< ratio', usiritj I' v,.lu. L. in
Table 6 . PHOSPHORUS PRODUCTION 1969 CANADMUGO LAKE
Sedimentation
Period
5/9 - 23
5/23 - 6/6
6/6 - fc/20
6/20 - 7/1
7/1 - 7/16
7/W - 8/1
8/1 - 8/20
8/20 - 9/3
9/3 - 9/15
9/15 - 10/1
10/1 - 10/15
10/15 - 10/21
10/21 - 11/12
11/12 - 12/4
P production =
C production o
P,
US/1
552
1077
525
473
81
628
460
149
314
111
0
3990
2042
-"52
11719 kQ P
609ha • 195
n C/P atonic
g/ha
773
1508
735
662
113
879
644
209
440
155
18
5586
2858
4553
days
ratio
Trophogenic
Zone*
ha
611
633
633
613
620
527
600
588
600
6)4
671
641
631
533
ave.
609
11719 x 106 mo
609 x 10%^ .
basis - 1229.9
S AB
kg ng/1
472
954
455
406
70
463
387
123
264
93
12
3580
1803
24/7
-6.2
+8.4
-9.7
+ 4.4
>2.5
-13.3
+5.8
-•1.5
+ 24.3
-19.7
+14.4
-1.7
-8.2
195 days
10 mgP
x 106Q
Trophogenic
40
34.2
34.8
40
38
35
42
43
33
27
33
35
37
. »-? • day-1
1.0gC • m-2 •
A ' AB+S
kg kg
-248
+ 237
-338
+ 167
+88
-559
+65
+802
-532
+475
-60
-303
+ 224
+ 1241
H27
+237
+551
-172
+330
+990
-520
+4055
+ 1744
+2124
total
11719
day -1
P_ total phosphorus, top minus bottom compartments of sedimentation trap, average value of
replicates (see text)
* aid-depth area of trophogenic zone
S »edi*ent«tionf represented by P. in sediment traps (see text)
AB change In bio»a&6 of PT in lake at 1-3 meter depth
*u* of bioaatf. change and sedimentation
220
-------
the calculation of primary production via total phosphorus (Py) and
particulate organic carbon (Cy) determinations. The biomass (B) of
phosphorus or carbon in the lake is that amount retained by a 0.8 u
membrane filter. Total phosphorus production yielded 10 mg P ' m .
Total carbon production determined from the C/P atomic ratios and
experimentally via the sedimentation traps yielded 1.0 g C • m * day .
c. Algal Assays
A long term bioassay with lake water collected from Cana-
darago Lake in May 1969, and phosphate additions (but no additional
inoculum) showed a very clear response to phosphates. The increase in
biomass with 1 mg ' 1~1 P added as compared with the effect of 100
}\g ' I"! P indicates a plentiful supply of nitrogen (including organ-
ically bound N) and minor elements.
Short-term bioassay studies with C were run on two days
in 1968. Additions of nutrients were made to produce the identical
final concentrations in both short-term and long-term experiments and
included K2HP04, NaNC>3, Fe as Fe+ - EDTA chelate, chelator alone,
unchelated trace metal mix and vitamin mix. All additions showed stimu-
ulation or inhibition except nitrate additions which were always without
effect.
d. Identification and Count
Phytoplankton from Canadarago Lake were sampled and
quantified from 1968 to 1973, with the exception that during 1970 only
qualitative analyses were performed. Major plankton organisms from
the standpoint of number and size were chosen and identified to genus or
species.
Prior to 1968 there had been massive blooms of
Oscillatoria prolifica(Grev.) Gomont in the lake. Such blooms recurred
in 1972 and 1973. The most commonly occurring predominant algae quan-
tified between 1968 and 1973 are shown in Table 9. During the summer
of 1935 slight shore blooms were noted in Canadarago Lake but there
was never a bloom over the entire lake. The shore blooms consisted of
the blue-green algae Anabaena and Coelosphaerium (l).
T»bll 9. MOST CaMONLY OCCURRING PRElXHINAMT ALGAE
IN CANADARAGO LAKE, 1966-1973
Anacvitlt i3£lli4 Urou.t and Daily
a,.lo.i>h..rlji
-------
2. Zooplankton
Zooplankton sampling was initiated in August 1972 as
part of the Canadarago Lake Eutrophication Project with samples being
collected every two weeks during the ice free season (21,22,23).
a. Identification and Count
Peak abundance for zooplankton during the fall of 1972 was
on October 14, with 179,309 organisms • m . The peak in zooplankton was
due mainly to Eubosmina coregoni (74,944 organisms • m~3) which comprised
42 percent of the total. Along with the E. coregoni, the cladocerans
made up 70 percent of the population. From July 6 to July 19, 1973
there was a drastic change in the zooplankton population from 76 percent
composition of rotifers on July 6 to 16 percent composition of rotifers
on July 19; while at the same time, cladocerans made up 13 percent of
the total composition on July 6 and changed to 75 percent composition
of the total number of zooplankton on July 19. There have been 20
species of cladocerans, six species of copepods and six species of
rotifers identified from Canadarago Lake. The main pulse of zooplankton
occurred in early July with 311,677 organisms • m~3. The spring pulse,
typical of many lakes in April and May was not present or was delayed
possibly due to the heavy bloom of Oscillatoria prolifica present in the
lake until mid July. Changes in the zooplankton population from the
1935 survey (l) appear to be negligible.
3. Bottom Fauna
Monthly benthos samples are collected from seven stations
representing different water column depths and substrates. Samples dur-
ing a one year period (Sept. 72-Sept. 73) of benthic organisms from the
combined substrates were comprised mostly of chironomic larvae. The
percent composition of chironomids ranged from a low of 21.5 percent in
September 1973 to a high of 66.2 percent in November 1972. The only
other group of invertebrates that were numerically important in combined
substrates were the oligochaetes. The percent composition of these
species ranged from a low of 26.4 percent in November 1972 to a high of
67 percent in July 1963. The peak in the abundance of bethnic invertebrates
occurred in March 1973 and was due almost exclusively to chironomide
larvae which, after peak abundance in March, gradually decreased until
mid July.
As depth increases, difference in abundance of benthic inverte-
brates becomes apparent. With a depth of 3 m (10 ft) or greater, the
numbers of oligochaetes decrease as depths increase; however, the percent
composition of oligochaetes appears to remain consistent. The chironomid
numbers and percent composition decreased with increasing depth, while at
depths of 4.6 m (15 ft) or greater, the numbers and percent composition
of Chaoborus increased as depth increases. In general, the tot'al
number of benthic fauna decreased as depth increased.
In 1935 the major organisms below 6 m (20 ft) were Chaoborus
and large chironomid larvae with no mention of the presence of oligo-
chaetes (l). The 1972 survey samples contained large quantities of
empty mollusc shells indicating that large numbers of clams and snails
222
-------
were at one time present in this lake. Harman (24) reports that Cana-
darago Lake once supported dense populations of mollusks that are now
severely depleted.
4. Fish
In 1972 a detailed study of the fisheries of Canadarago Lake
was initiated by Cornell University's Department of Natural Resources
(23,25). This effort is being conducted to measure changes in the
structure and dynamics of fish populations in a highly eutrophic lake
following a reduction in cultural eutrophication with the objective of
developing fish management techniques applicable to lakes undergoing
nutrient control and examine nutrient control as a fish management tool.
Yellow perch are the most abundant fish in Canadarago Lake. Other
abundant species are golden shiner, spottail shiner, white sucker, Johnny
darter, black crappie and brown bullhead. Principal game species are
smallmouth bass, chain pickerel and largemouth basri. Smelt and black
crappie, recently introduced in the late 1960's, have rapidly expanded
their populations. Walleye, American eel, banded killifish,bridle
shiner, satinfin shiner, blackchin shiner and blunt-nose shiner have
either decreased greatly in numbers present or are no longer present.
New species reported for the lake are bluegill sunfish, brook trout,
burbot, shortnosed redhorse, fathead minnow and stoneroller.
Surveys of the Canadarago Lake fish populations during a period
of increasing eutrophication from 1935 to 1972 indicate three species
maintained their dominance throughout the period. During the 1935 Bio-
logical Survey (l) the golden shiner and yellow perch were the most
abundant forage fish and the chain pickerel the most predominant preda-
tor. Subsequent surveys in 1958, 1964 and 1969 (26) found the same
species were predominant.
Table 10 lists the species of fish that have been found in
Canadarago Lake. Historical records are not adequate to evaluate pos-
sible changes in abundance of all of the species reported from this
lake.
5. Bacteria
No bacteriological studies of major significance have been
undertaken in Canadarago Lake as yet. Gassing (release of marsh gas)
from sediments, indicative of methane fermentation, can be observed in
the northern half of the lake, increasing in intensity from mid-lake to
the northern shore. The phenomenon is observed when an anchor is
dropped from a boat during surveys. Spontaneous gas release hgs not
been observed, e. g. as gas accumulation in the inverted reference com-
partment of sediment traps. A preliminary study of sulfate reduction
(27) showed organic matter, not sulfate, to be the limiting factor in
bacterial sulfate reduction in the sediments. L. W. Wood (28) found
indication of oxidation of Rhodamine B dye in the sediments, presumably
by microbes.
223
-------
T.ibU- 111. C/WN>ARM10 I.AKh H'JI '.PL'.IF,
Erown trjut--Salmo trutta
Jhair. rlckfr?l--Esox nijer
LarJewjth ba5s--Hlcroptgrus salmoides
Sbal'lauuth bass--M. ^olomieui
Yellon ctrch-'Perca, flavescens
Como-, sunflsn—Lecomis aibbotus (punpkinsee^)
Redbreast sjnfish--L_. aurltm
Rock ba5S--Ar,bloclvtes ructttrls
Brown bjllhei'l--lctalurus n»bulosus
American eel--Anauilla rostrata
Johnny -»arter--£theostoma n^jjijm olmsteHl
Ban-«»-i killlfish—FunHulus Hlaehanus
Bluntnose minnow-Pimephales notatus
GoHen shiner--Hoteiniaonus crvsoleucas
Cutlips minnow--Exoalossum maxillinqua
Common shiner-'llotropis cornutus
Spottail shiner—N. hu^sonlus
Bridle shiner—N. bifrenatus
Satinfin shiner—N. analostanus
Blackehin shiner~N. heteroHon
Creek chutsijcker — £r^"-«zc' ; c .-.-'•,.;
Rainbow smelt— Osnsr.s aor-'sx
Ifalleve—Stizost ;•*!;- . itraj .^"i'.m
Northern pika — £53 x l-:'-^^
Muskellunae--Esox T,a3J-.l";"q'.
Burbot— Lota lotj
Brook trout--Salvs?Ii "~:j r.'^ti^al-j
Black crappie--Pomjxi» 'i-ironjc. !.<:. i
Blueqill r.imt'ish--Lei'JiT'.ig '^3C"ro>""-r'. ?
Fallf lsh--Semotllus corporal la
Shorthea^ rf^horse--Moxostoiia m
Stonerol lt?r--Ca">poston\d di'gmjlu
River chub--Ndcomib micropogo."
6. Bottom Flora
No bottom flora studies of major significance have been under-
taken in Canadarago Lake as yet. Algae attached to rocks located near
shore, October 1973, included:
CHRYSOPHYTA
Navicula sp.
Cymbella sp.
7. Macrophytes
CHLOROPHYTA
Spiroqyra sp.
Oedogonium sp.
Canadarago Lake supports emergent, floating, and submersed
aquatic macrophytes around its periphery. The main species observed
between 1968 and 1973 are shown in Table 11.
224
-------
Table 11. CANADARAGO LAKE MACROPHYTE SPECIES,
1. Softstem bulrush - Scirpua validus Vahl.
2. Harstem bulrush - Scirpus acutus MuM.
3. PickerelweeH - Ponte^eria cor^ata L.
4. Narrow-leaveH cattail - Typha anqustifolia L.
5. Bur reeH - Sparganium eurvcarpufn Engelm.
Floating
6. Yellow water Illy - Nuphar varieqatum Engelir
7. (Hhite) water lily - Nvmphaea o^orata Ait.
8. Narrow-1 eaveH ponriweeri - Potamogeton spp.
9. Hater milfoil - HvrioohyUum sp.
10. MaterweeH - Anach^ris canaHensis (Michx.' Fl.
11. Coontail - Ceratophvllum rtgmersum L.
12. Ojrly-leaf ponrtweeH - Potamoqeton cri^c'jj "-.
The plants ranking highest in lake surface area coverage in
1968 and 1969 were the two bulrush species and yellow water lily. The
location of greatest abundance of emergent plants is at the southwestern
end of the lake where hardstem bulrush, yellow water lily and pickerel
weed predominate. A great increase in the amount of submersed vegetation
occurred between 1969 and 1973. Water milfoil, curly-leaf pondweed,
narrow-leaved pondweed, and water weed predominated. The submersed
plants existed around almost the entire periphery in water 3 m (10 feet)
or less in depth. Areas of greatest density were primarily in the
northeastern end, where milfoil was extremely abundant, and secondarily
the southwestern end.
NUTRIENT BUDGET SUMMARY
A. ESTIMATION OF INPUTS
1. Waste Discharges
There are no significant industrial waste discharges in the Canada-
rago Lake Basin. There are two significant sources of sanitary waste, the
village of Richfield Springs sewage system and the unsewered homes, mostly
summer cottages, along the lake shore.
As noted elsewhere, the village of Richfield Springs is served
by a combined sewer system which discharges into Ocquionis Creek about
840 m (2750 ft) upstream from Canadarago Lake. Until 1973, the village
had a primary wastewater treatment plant. Detailed estimates of the
major nutrients discharged from this source were made by direct measurement
of the plant effluent, the difference between upstream and downstream
samples and calculation from per capita contributions. The details of
these estimates are presented elsewhere (16). The results for those major
nutrient studies are summarized in Table 12.
Estimation of chemical contributions to the lake from the unsewered
homes on the lake shore is especially difficult. During the summer months,
about 1300 people occupy summer cottages around the lake shore and are
served by septic tanks and leaching fields (12). In 1969 a sanitary survey
of these systems revealed that 24 percent of the septic tank systems had
some sort of direct discharge to the lake, bypassing the leaching fields (13),
225
-------
Tat'l. 12. ' ANAHARAGO I AH ' 111 Ml'Al Illl'TT
mau Rinn n 11> ;,I'R?««> ',< MV THI ATMI NT I'LAI
It-
Mo"
-T
N03-+N
NH4-N
Nos
Nop
Nt
Pit
4150
8710
20.030
33
3563
1771
200
5567
2310
343
4.39
0.47
0.23
0.03
0.73
0.30
0.05
Table 1*. IANADARAGO LAKE fHEMIl'AL INPl/T
FROM SEPTTr TANK AND LEAITIING TILLD SYSTFMS
of lak' surfa^ • vr"
2220
121
0.29
0.02
Assuming that any phosphorus entering a septic tank leaching field was re-
tained in the field* and that none of the nitrogen was retained, Table 13
was constructed. No estimate of inputs of other chemicals were made.
2. Land Runoff
The Candarago Lake Eutrophication Study has shown that stream loadings
with soluble mineral species derived mainly from bedrock may be estimated by
the regression method. Errors become larger in the case of constituents
that are subject to or products of biological processes or that are in
particulate form and therefore subject to sedimentation and sudden dis-
location during periods of high flow.
Utilizing measured stream flows and concentrations, regression
analysis was employed to estimate the chemical runoff and lake loading
from land. Details of the regression models are described elsewhere (29).
The results of these estimates are shown in Tables 14, 15, and 16.
3. Precipitation
Because of the large ratio of the watershed area to that of the
lake surface (23:1), the contribution of chemicals from precipitation is
very small in the lake, in most cases less than two percent, and can be
neglected.
Table 14. HYDROLOGICAL DATA FOR OWUTAriONS OF CHMICAL LOADINGS FRO* C/WADARAGQ LAKE TRIBUTARIES
after Hetllng and Sykes (16)
Xante Drainaoe Ana
Kerk inter creek
Hyder Creek
Mink Creek
Ocg\:ioni« creek
gauged total
Oaks Creek
mi2
11.9
10.6
10.5
19.8
52.8
67.4
ha
3077
2741
2715
5120
13653
17427
MMSU
cf«
26.1
13.2
14.6
24.1
78.0
101
fft Annual Flow isasyred Jnnual Flow
mVs
1.020
0.423
0.581
0.829
2.853
5.144
106i«3/yr
23.3
11.8
13.1
21.6
69.8
90.4
0»»r Drainaq^ Area
m/yr
0.759
0.431
0.481
0.421
0.511
0.519
Cent/ Lhu ted to Lake
m/yr
3.03
1.53
1.70
2.30
9.06
11.74
Lak* areai 759 ha.
226
-------
Table 15. CHEMICAL RUNOFF PER HECTARE Of WATERSHED PER YEAR1
Hyder
Ocquionis Gauged
(except STP) Watershed
Na+
K+
Mg++
Cat
F«t
cr
so/
N03"
NOj
NH4+
NOS
Nop
Nt
"o
pst
ppt
cos
Cop
kg
kg
kg
kg
gm
kg
kg
+N02"-N gm
-N gm
-N gm
gm
gm
gm
gm
gm
gm
kg
kg
kg
23.4
11.4
21.1
649
1.27
25.5
222
4350
6.11
477
1130
636
6590
13.9
66.7
105
33.6
6.18
695
1 K+, Mg++, Cl", N03~+N02"-N, NH4*-N
estimated by summation of the prod
tributary. The remaining elements
concentration by the average flow.
16.6
11.6
14.5
617
0.92
22.5
126
5590
5.70
309
861
344
7100
8/15
23.6
134
13.5
4.22
572
28.3 14.3 19.5
11.6 7.8 10.1
24.1 23.1 21.1
701 581 629
0.92 0.76 0.94
42.3 20.7 26.5
196 197 188
5970 4170 4860
7.90 26.0 13.8
444 425 417
2260 1300 1360
424 232 403
9100 6180 7040
23.4 24.7 18.7
47.7 57.2 50.7
125 188 133
20.1 28.0 24.8
4.80 3.29 4.43
655 538 603
. Nos, Nop, Nt, Pst, and Ppt inputs were
uct of the measured daily flow and the con-
were estimated by multiplying the log mean
Table 16. CANADAHAGO LAKE CHEMICAL INPUT FROM LAND RUNOFF
,+
K+
Mg++
Cat
Fet
ci-
S04=
N02-+'103--N
NO/-N
4
Nos
V
Nt
po
Pst
ppt
Cos
Cop
£C02
Units
gm
gm
gm
gm
mg
gm
gm
mg
mg
mg
mg
mg
mg
mg
mg
mg
gm
gm
gm
PER
Herkimer
9.51
4.62
3.56
263
0.51
10.3
90.0
1760
2.48
193
458
257
2670
5.64
27.0
42.6
13.6
2.51
281
SQUARE METER
Hyder
5.98
4.18
5.24
223
0.33
8.12
45.4
2020
2.06
117
311
124
2560
2.94
8.52
48.4
4. Ht>
1.32
207
OF LAKE
Mink
10.1
4.14
8.61
251
0.33
15.2
70.1
2140
2.83
159
809
151
3260
8.37
l,.l
44.7
7.19
1.72
234
SURFACE PER YEAR
Total Estimated
Gauged Ungauged
Ocquionis Watershed Watershed
9.61 35.2 9.8
5.24 18.2 5.1
15.7 38.1 10.6
392 1129 314
0.51 1.69 0.47
14.0 47.6 13.2
132 338 94
2820 8730 2430
17.5 24.9 6.9
287 751 209
875 2453 682
190 724 201
4170 12700 3520
16.7 33.6 9.3
38.6 91.2 25.3
126.8 262.5 73.0
18.8 44.5 12.3
2.22 7.97 2.21
363 1080 301
TatiJ
Land
Runoff
44.9
23.2
48.7
1440
2. 1C
60.8
432
11200
31.8
959
3135
92t)
16200
43.0
116
336
56.9
10.2
1390
227
-------
4. Groundwater
During our study 78.2 percent of the watershed, including all
significant tributaries, was gauged. An estimate of nutrient contribution
from the ungauged areas was achieved by assuming that the runoff for these
areas would be equal to the average of the area drained by the tributaries,
not counting the wastewater treatment plant effluent (16). The total
nutrient input from ungauged sources was thus calculated by dividing the
gauged land runoff by 0.782. This is groundwater and surface runoff, in
part routed through small and ephemeral streams.
B. PHOSPHORUS
Utilizing the monthly average loadings from the gauged sources
and flows from the hydrographs that had been generated, nutrient budgets
for phosphorus and nitrogen were calculated (16). Phosphorus data have
been given the greatest attention because it was determined that the
algal-limiting nutrient in the lake was phosphorus (30).
On an annual basis, the principal source of phosphorus in the
watershed was the village of Richfield Springs which contributed 44.1
percent of the total annual input (16). If computed for the growing season,
June through September, the village's share of the phosphorus input rises
to 66.4 percent. These figures are equal to about 4.8 g (0.17 oz) P •
day"-*- ' capita"-*- and include commercial as well as domestic sources. In
determining the contribution of phosphorus from lake shore cottages and
trailers, it was assumed that only failing septic tank systems with direct
discharge into the lake contributed phosphorus. In 1969, 24.4 percent of
the septic tanks, servicing 317 people on the lake, had some type of direct
discharge into the lake (13). Using 2.9 g (0.1 oz) P • day'1 • capita'1
(31, 32) for phosphorus production and an average residence time of 151
days (12), the annual phosphorus input from the cottages were estimated
at 140 kg (309 Ibs) P • year'1, or 2.3 percent of the annual total.
The gauged tributaries carried 42.4 percent of the total phosphorus
input to the lake for an average areal rate of 0.187 kg * yr"1 • ha"1
(0.167 Ibs • yr"1 • acre"1) (16). Applying the same rate for the area
that did not have gauged tributaries yielded another 570 kg (1257 Ibs)
P • yr'1 for a total of 3120 kg (6880 Ibs) P • yr"1, 51.8 percent of the
total. During the growing season, when the stream flows became very small,
the streamborne phosphorus was only 23.5 percent of the total summer input.
Phosphorus inputs caused by rainfall and dustfall were estimated
from literature values. The reported range was about 0.206 to 0.612 kg
P04 • yr"1 • ha"1 (0.184 to 0.546 Ibs P04 • yr"1 • acre"1) (33), which
suggests an atmospheric contribution of about 100 kg (220.5 Ib) P * yr'1
onto the lake surface itself, less than 2 percent of the total. The results
of the phosphorus input data are shown in Table 17.
Similar estimates were made for soluble phosphorus alone. These
calculations are summarized in Table 17. Because the wastewater phosphorus
228
-------
Table 18. ESTIMATED TOTAL NITROGEN INPUTS TO CANADARAGO LAKE
April 15, 1969 - April 14, 1970
Source
Village of Richfield Springs
Lake Shore Dwellings
Sub Total
Gauged Tributaries
Ungauge^ Tributaries
Sub Total
Rainfall
Total Input
Oaks Creek Output
Total Value
Percent of
kq/vr Total Value
5730
2020
7750
97350
27100
124450
4200
136400
82500
4.2
1.5
5.7
71.3
19.9
91.2
3.1
100.0
60.5
kq
1920
1630
3550
7660
2130
9790
1100
14440
10400
: Growing
Percent of Annual
Value of Source
33.5
80.7
45.8
7.9
7.9
7.9
26.2
10.6
12.6
Season Values*
Percent of Growing
Season Value
13.3
11.3
24.6
53.0
14.8
67.8
7.6
100.0
71.7
Net Accumulation anH
Dissipation
53900
39.5
4040
7.6
28.3
*June 1, 1969 through September 30, 1969
Table 17. ESTIMATED SOLUBLE, PARTICIPATE AND TOTAL PHOSPHORUS
INPUTS TO CANADARAGO LAKE, APRIL 15, 1969 - APRIL 14, 1970
Source
Total P Percent of Soluble P Percent of Percent of! Particulate P Percent of Percent of
(kg/yr) Total P kg/yr Total P Soluble P (kg/yr) Total P Particulate P
Village of Richfielrf
Springs
Lake Shore
Dwellings
Sub Total i
3augeH Tributaries
JngaugtH Tributaries
Sub Total
Rainfall
Total Input
Oaks Creek Output
Net Accumulation
2660
140
2800
2550
570
3120
100
6020
4660
1360
44.1
2.3
46.4
42.4
9.4
51.8
1.7
100.0
77.5
22.5
2310
121
2431
723
200
923
: 3354
1740
1614
38.4
2.0
40.4
12.0
3.3
15.3
1 55.7
28.9
26.8
68.9
3.6
72.5
21.5
350
19
369
1827
6.0 370
27.5 2197
100.0 2566
52.0 2920
48.0 - 354
5.8
.3
6.1
30.3
6.1
36.5
42.6
48.5
- 5.9
13.6
.8
14.4
71.2
14.4
85.6
100.0
113.8
- 13.8
229
-------
is about 87 percent soluble, whereas the streamborne phosphorus is only
28 percent soluble, the wastewater contribution to the soluble phosphorus
inputs is very large, amounting to 72.5 percent on an annual basis and
88.6 percent during the growing season. In addition, Table 17 includes a
value for particulate phosphorus. Here the soluble phosphorus has been
subtracted from the total phosphorus to yield the value for particulate
phosphorus. The output of particulate phosphorus is larger than the input.
This may be misleading, however it is assumed that algae within the lake
converted some of the soluble phosphorus to an insoluble form which accounts
for a larger output than input of particulate phosphorus.
C. NITROGEN
The gauged nitrogen contribution from various sources was calculated
in a manner similar to that for the phosphorus contributions. The waste-
water treatment plant loadings for soluble organic nitrogen were deduced
from Ocquionis Creek data. The remaining wastewater data were based on
raw wastewater analyses (16).
About 62 percent of the wastewater nitrogen was in the form of
ammonia, and another 31 percent was present as soluble organic nitrogen (16).
In contrast, about two-thirds of the nitrogen in the tributaries was either
in the form of nitrite or nitrate, therefore, there are qualitative as well
as quantitative differences among the nitrogen sources.
Estimates of the different nitrogen sources are given in Table 18.
The village contribution is equivalent to about 10.3 g (0.363 oz) N * day" .
capita"! and seems to be a result of domestic activities only. The same per
capita rate was taken for the lake shore residences. This time it was
assumed that the nitrogen was not retained in the septic tank leaching fields,
so the contributing population was taken as the entire lake shore dwelling
population of 1300 people. The data indicated that human wastes were a
minor source of nitrogen input to the lake and were the same order of magnitude
as rainfall and dustfall. The atmospheric rate was taken to be 1.50 kg
N • yr"1 ' ha"1 (1.34 Ibs N • yr"1 • acre"1) (33, 34).
The principal sources of nitrogen were the tributary streams, which
accounted for approximately 91.2 percent of the annual input. The predomi-
nance of the tributary streams is marked, even during the summer months when
over two-thirds of the nitrogen input is transported by streams. The aver-
age annual nitrogen loading carried by these streams was 7.10 kg N • yr"1 *
ha'1 (6.34 Ib N • yr"1 • acre"1).
D. MISCELLANEOUS ELEMENTS
Summary data for chlorides, magnesium and potassium that were deter-
mined during the study period, April 15, 1969 through April 14, 1970 are
given in Table 19 (16). In each case, the contribution of these materials
from wastewater were relatively minor.
230
-------
T«bl» 19. GAUGED MISCELLANEOUS UTUTS NO OUTPUTS TO CAHADMtfO UKE
April 15, 1969 through April 14, 1970
I. Pot ••111*
Tlw Period
April 15-30, 1969
Hey 1969
June 1969
July 1969
August 1969
Septe^er 1969
October 1969
(lovelier 1969
December 1969
January 1970
February J970
March 1970
April 1-14,1970
Average
Tine Period
April 15-30, 1969
Hay 1969
June 1969
July 1969
August 1969
September 1969
October 1969
November 1969
December 1969
January 1970
February 1970
torch 1970
April 1-14, 1970
Average
Tine Period
April 15-30, 1969
Mty 1969
June 1969
July 1969
Augu*t 1969
September 1969
October 1969
Nc-ve^er 1969
OeceAer 1969
January 1970
February 1970
(torch 1970
April 1-14, 1970
Average
I
i
356
106
104
37.9
13.3
6.0
14.1
131
125
82.7
128
85.4
636
109
909
343
335
150
65.0
34.9
68.4
404
393
294
402
289
1430
324
985
273
271
926
30.6
13.1
32.5
345
327
210
334
218
1820
291
Qua
Inou
n
215
72.9
81.0
25.2
9.4
4.7
14.5
120
116
56.5
B9.7
67.9
574
86.1
b.
Qua
Inou
Mink Creek
431
160
175
60.0
23.9
12.9
36.0
251
244
131
194
149
1050
179
c. Chlo
On
JIlnLCfreek,
729
297
320
121
52.1
30.1
76,0
443
435
249
355
278
1630
315
itltv of Potas
213
62.9
76.1
16.6
5.8
2.6
6.5
113
102
49.7
98.0
57.7
788
66.9
Ifegtwilua
tltv of Maane
265
84.5
100
24.1
8.69
4.31
10.1
145
133
66.2
104
77.9
900
109
rl*.
tltv of Chlor
Hvder Gteek
413
114
140
27.7
9.06
5.65
10.3
215
190
87.9
142
104
1670
169
Hum (ka * H.V1)
1 Hmi-r Cteek
184
72.3
84.5
30.0
11.1
6.3
21.9
176
125
64.4
99.3
99.6
632
96.1
slum (ka • d»Vll
343
132
156
55.4
204
11.6
40.3
326
232
119
164
147
1160
178
de (kg • 4CV*1)
Herki^r Creek
412
157
167
65.5
24.0
13.5
47.7
394
279
142
220
176
1440
215
Outout
2544
1064
689
227
74.3
16.6
142
845
865
536
871
497
3018
713
OutDut
3390
1550
1020
370
133
36.1
240
1230
1270
817
1270
763
3940
1020
OutDut
O.k. Creek
5690
2430
1540
508
166
41,6
317
1890
1940
1200
1950
1110
6750
1600
f
231
-------
DISCUSSION
A. LIMNOLOGICAL CHARACTERISTICS
Canadarago Lake shares many of its features with its western
neighbors, New York's Finger Lakes, and with many other lakes located
between 40 and 60 degrees latitude.
The climate at 43°N and 75°W is neither humid nor arid and in
this respect resembles many areas in northern to southeastern Europe.-
The region is somewhat sheltered from the Atlantic Coast but is readily
exposed to rain and snowstorms originating in the Gulf of Mexico and
certainly exposed to those from the St. Lawrence Great Lakes. At 43°N
on the North American Continent, winters are relatively severe and com-
parable to Europe at 6QON or, in eastern Europe, in the fifties. Ice
cover on Canadarago lasts from December through April and reaches a
thickenss of 3- m (20 in.). Summers are as warm as in comparable latitudes
of Europe, causing considerable warming to the bottom of lake of Canada-
rago 's depth, 12.8 m (42 ft). Correspondingly, the annual cycle of
Canadarago is characterized by a very short period of spring overturn which
may be preceded by an algal bloom developing under the ice. Stratification
proceeds in a typical manner, and since warming at the bottom is substantial,
16°C (28.8°F), breaks down early (in September) when the water is still
warm enough to support considerable primary production. After a prolonged
cooling period in autumn, winds, to which Canadarago is well exposed, may
not permit the formation of an ice cover until the entire lake is cooled
down to somewhere between 4° and 0°C (39 and 32°F), and the stability of
winter stratification varies accordingly.
Located in hilly terrain, the morphometry of the lake is not
unusual (Table 4). Hydrologic conditions and the size of the watershed
provide for a mean retention time of 217 days.
The basic chemistry of Canadarago Lake is summarized in Figure 8.
Calcium and bicarbonate ions predominate, followed by magnesium and sulfate
ions. Sodium and chloride ions are nearly matched. Sulfur springs in
.the vicinity of the lake account for part of the sulfate and may account
for the fact that in spite of the eutrophy of the lake, bacterial sulfate
reduction is not limited by sulfate but by the organic carbon source (27).
The calcium balance of the lake is such that extensive precipitation of
this element must occur, particularly during productive periods in summer.
Epilimnion calcium concentrations are about 0.5 meq • 1 lower than those
found in the tributaries. Similarly, iron is precipitated and presumably
plays an important role in the ultimate deposition of phosphate.
LAKE CANADARAGO
RELATIVE IONIC COMPOSITION
(LAKE AVERAGE)
JULY 23,1968
HCO,-
C«**
Figure 8. Canadarac/o Lak^. rnlativp Ionic canposit ion. Miaqram after Manclia
shows shafifMj arnas proportional l.o <-onc«*nt rat iong Reprint <*d from 30.
232
-------
Conditions for primary productivity are favorable and until recently
were enhanced by substantial inputs of nutrients from untreated sewage.
Although wind exposure and basin shape would suggest excellent mixing,
the lake has exhibited, from time to time, a slight but significant
gradient in characteristics such as chlorophyl and particulate phosphorus
and other parameters expressing biomass, indicating greater productivity
in the northern part which is not only more shallow but also received the
discharge of untreated sewage. In agreement with this observation, the
sediments in the northern part have greater organic content and, upon in-
cubation under aerobic conditions, release soluble phosphorus in greater
amounts.
The principal limiting nutrient in the lake is phosphorus as
indicated by:
1. The atomic ratios of the major nutrients in the tributaries
(Table 20).
2. The disappearance of reactive phosphates from the epolimnion
during most of the growing season (Figure 9).
3. The relative chemical composition of the plankton
(C:N:P ratios, Figure 10).
4. Long and short-term bioassay (see Section IV).
C:M
HwUmr CrMfc
MM
»•* CrMk
Ocqulonfci CrMk
M2
Ocqutonto * STP •Mm* Ml
fclMt
m
K
•I
92
It
1)
Tibi* ». Tributtrlti to Candtrtgo Ukt atonic
ratio* CiNiP (P>1). lUprlntM fro* 30.
Figure 9. soluble phosphates and foms of nitrogen in canadarago Lake, 1969.
Reprinted from 30.
233
-------
M J
Figure 10. Elementary composition of participate matter in Canadarago Lake,
summer 1969. ordinates scaled according to the atomic ratios
C:N:P - 106:16:1. Reprinted from 30,
Nitrogen is present as nitrate except in late summer when ammonia
is the only available form (except organically bound nitrogen) but both
are found in concentrations that can be considered higher than limiting.
Among the Cyanophyceae, the Chroococcales and Oscillatoriales are predomi-
nant, and one possible nitrogen fixing form, Aphanizomenon, occurred during
short periods which were definitely not caused by nitrogen depletion.
Carbon dioxide depletion can occur in a spotty fashion during summer after-
noons. The thesis that such a condition favors the development of blue-
green algae is not generally supported by observations in Canadarago Lake.
Blue-green algal blooms do occur in summer, but the same species were found
to produce blooms in winter, in early spring, and immediately after fall
overturn. Simulation of growth by the availability of phsophorus in the
presence of high concentrations of C02 is a more likely explanation of these
blooms.
Silicon depletion may affect species composition in Canadarago Lake.
Silicon has been a neglected element in the earlier studies on which this
report is largely based. Data on this element are now being gathered.
Iron appears to become limiting at times when the solubility of the element
is affected by high pH which in turn is caused by phosphate eutrophication.
Other forms of nutrient limitation were looked for but were not discovered.
A strange and thus far unexplained phenomenon is the reoccurrence
of blooms of Oscillatoria prolifica, a red-colored member of the blue-green
algae, in summer and in winter from 1972 until 1973-74. This alga was
predominant also until 1967-68, and was the cause for many citizen's com-
plaints. In the intervening years, the algae was scarce and never developed
234
-------
a bloom. The effect of this bloom on the food chain deserves study because
much grazed-upon populations of green algae are virtually absent when
0. prolifica blooms, and the collapse of 0. prolifica blooms is followed
by periods of great clarity of the water, suggesting the presence of sub-
stances inhibitory to the growth of other algae.
The antagonism of rooted aquatics and plankton algae is another
object for study. Macrophytes, more predominant 40 years ago then they
are now, may gain as algal growths are controlled by phosphate removal
from sewage, and indications to this effect are seen.
A more complete assessment of secondary production and fisheries
will emerge as the Canadarago study progresses.
B. DELINEATION OF TROPHIC STATES
Canadarago Lake is eutrophic by all criteria employed. The
hypolimnion becomes depleted of oxygen during the summer. The lake carries
algal blooms with great regularity although species composition of the
blooms, duration, and time of year can vary from year to year.
Productivity during the 1969 season (May-November) was 1.0 g C •
m~2 • day~l, a value also observed in eutrophic Lake Erken, Uppland,
Sweden (35).
C. TROPHIC STATUS vs NUTRIENT BUDGETS
Phosphorus loading on Canadarago Lake is 0.8 g • m~2 * yr"1. If
Vollenweider's (35) representation of phosphorus loading and mean depth is
expressed numerically as follows:
E = 40 - L - 2'0'6
Where: L = P loading (g • m~^ * yr"1) Z = mean depth (meters)
lakes with EO would tend to be oligotrophic, and those with E>2 eutrophic.
Canadarago with 2 = 7.7 m gives E = 9.4, in agreement with its eutrophic
conditions. This statement requires that the mean residence time in the
lake is sufficient to allow complete conversion of phosphate inputs to biomass.
With a theoretical retention time of 217 days, this condition is met. It
is also seen that even after reduction of phosphate inputs to 3800 kg
(6020 kg less 90 percent of 2660 kg, Table 17), by improved sewage treat-
ment, Canadarago Lake is likely to remain eutrophic (loading of
0.51 g P • m~2 • i~l, E = 6.0). Canadarago Lake, therefore, appears to
be a naturally eutrophic lake, a condition regularly found in lakes in a
reasonably average setting with regard to nutrient runoff, which are
characterized by a similar mean depth and, related to this, similar or
larger ratios of littoral and deep water area and of epilimnic and hypo-
limnic volume.
235
-------
Another representation proposed by Vollenweider (36) involves
utilization of flushing time. In this representation a plot of phos-
phorus loading (g P • m~2 « year"-'-) vs mean depth (m) divided by detention
time (years) is constructed. Applying this to Canadarago Lake, with
phosphorus loading equal to 0.79 g P • m~2 • yr"1, and flushing time
equal to 0.595 years, the plot of loading vs mean depth divided by re-
tention time results in a point that lies above the dangerous line,
indicating that Canadarago Lake is eutrophic by this evaluation.
The retention of phosphorus in Canadarago is rather low, even
for a eutrophic lake, 22.5 percent over the year April 15, 1969-April 14,
1970, or 59.1 percent over the growing season June 1-September 30, 1969
(see e.g. Ref. 37). Figure 11 shows that inputs account for only 10 percent
of the seasonal production in terms of phosphorus as determined by the
sedimentation technique. This means that incoming phosphorus was utilized
approximately 10 times before it was lost by flushing or, to a greater
extent, by deposition. Much of this recirculation of phosphate occurred
during fall overturn. Erosion of the thermocline during summer may be
a contributing factor as in Lake Mendota (38) but increasing exposure
of the lake bottom accompanies this and its effects may exceed those of
thermocline erosion, Figure 12.
By fall of 1974 Canadarago Lake showed clear signs of recovery
from phosphate eutrophication after phosphate removal was instituted at
the Richfield Springs Wastewater Treatment Facility approximately two
years earlier.
TTT • S ' 0 ' N r
Figure iJ. E*cess ol input over output (lower curve) and total produ<
Canaaaraqo Ltke, measured aa phosphorus, 1969 data.
by a O.x-yi numl'i a
236
-------
SUMMARY
For the past seven years, New York State's Departments of Environ-
mental Conservation and Health have been conducting a technical investi-
gation on Canadarago Lake, and its tributaries, at Richfield Springs, New
York as part of the State's program on lake eutrophication. Portions of
these data have been included in more than 30 different publications.
Canadarago Lake is situated in East Central New York in the Susque-
hanna River watershed. The surrounding terrain is hilly with ground elevations
from 396 m (1300 ft) to 579 m (1900 ft). The lake's drainage area encom-
passes 175 km2 (67.5 sq mi) with four major tributaries draining 78.3 percent
of the watershed. The bedrock of the basin is predominantly limestone in the
north and shales and siltstones in the south. The soils of the area consist
of glacial deposited materials with some isolated recent alluvial deposits.
The permanent population of the lake basin is about 3500 people.
Additionally, approximately 1300 people occupy lakeside cottages during
the summer. About 49 percent of the watershed is devoted to agriculture,
primarily dairy farms, and 34 percent is in forest or brushland. The lake
is used primarily for recreational purposes.
Canadarago Lake is nearly 6.4 km (4.0 mi) long and is 1.9 km (1.2 mi)
wide at its widest point. The mean depth of the lake is 7.7 m (22 ft) with
the maximum depth being 12.8 m (42 ft). The lake has 759 ha (2050 acres)
of surface area and 14.4 km (9 mi) of shoreline. The lake has a poorly de-
fined thermocline which is seasonally found at 6 to 8 m (20 to 26 ft) depth.
The epilimnion accounts for about 72 percent of the lake volume from June
to September. The average hydraulic retention time of the lake has been
calculated at 217 days. The lake is ice-covered from December through April.
The depth of 99 percent attenuation of white light averages about 7
meters (23 ft) with the Secchi disc depth ranging seasonally from 1 to 3 m
(3.3 to 10 ft). The pH is commonly above 8, with pH's above 8.5 occasionally
observed in May and September. Dissolved oxygen in the top 6 m (20 ft)
averages about 10 mg • 1~* from May to November, but the region below 11 m
(36 ft) becomes anoxic from the middle of July to the end of September.
Total phosphorus averages about 50 L\g • I"-*- with about 50 percent
of this being soluble. Summer orthophosphate phosphorus is below 5 ^g • 1"
in the surface water, but commonly exceeds 50 ug • 1~1 in the anoxic deep
region during August and September. Ammonia nitrogen averages 150 ug • 1 ,
and nitrate plus nitrite nitrogen drops from over 500 ug • I"-- in spring to
less than 50 g • I"* from July to November.
Total organic carbon is about 5 mg • 1~1 of which about two-thirds
is soluble. The highest levels of dissolved organic carbon occur in the
237
-------
euphotic zone Curing May and June. The lake water can be considered a
moderately hard water lake. Calcium carbonate precipitation occurs to a
measurable extent.
The highest chlorophyll a concentrations exist in the top 5 m
(16.4 ft) with the average concentration Curing 1968 and 1969 being about
10 jvg • 1~1. Mean primary production is about 1 g carbon • m~2 • day'l.
Algal assays have indicated that phosphate and iron - EDTA innocula sig-
nificantly increased CC>2 fixation while nitrate additions were always
without effect. Cyanophyta dominate summer plankton samples while
Chrysophyta are most common in spring and fall. Common phytoplankton
include Aphanizomenon flos-aquae, Anacystis incerta, Stephanodiscus
niagarae, Cyclotella comta, Sphaerocystis schroeteri, Ceratium hirundinellat
and Trachelomonas spp. The common zooplankton include Eubosmina, Paphnia,
and Diaptomus with the assemblages evenly divided between Cladocerans and
Copepods. Chaoborus and six genera of rotifers have also been identified.
The benthic fauna consists primarily of Chirpnomidae with the
remainder primarily Oligochaetes. Ongoing fish studies indicate yellow
perch and golden shiner to be the most common pelagic fish and chain
pickerel the most predominant predator although a total of 40 species have
been identified. No microbiological work has been attempted, but benthic
algae and aquatic macrophyte communities have been characterized.
The prime emphasis of this project has been to develop nutrient
budgets for the biologically important chemical elements and to relate the
budget to the trophic status of the lake. From April 1969 to April 1970,
44.1 percent of the phosphorus input entered the lake from the Richfield
Springs Sewage Treatment Plant, 42.4 percent from the lake's four major
tributaries, 9.4 percent from the ungauged portion of the watershed,
2.3 percent from lakeside dwellings and 1.7 percent from direct precipi-
tation on the lake surface. The net accumulation of phosphorus in the
lake during this period (inputs minus outflow) was 790 kg/yr (2742 Ibs/yr).
A major portion, 68.9 percent, of the soluble phosphorus entered the lake
from the Richfield Springs Sewage Treatment Plant. In contrast, 91.2
percent of the total nitrogen input during the same period resulted from
stream discharge.
The phosphorus loading has been calculated to be 0.8 g • m~2 • yr~l,
Following Vollenweider's work, the lake should be considered eutrophic
and indeed it is.
During 1972, a modern wastewater treatment facility was constructed
to replace the existing sewage treatment plant at Richfield Springs. The
new plant provides phosphorus removal, and preliminary results indicate
that the problem of cultural eutrophication seems to be lessening in
Canadarago Lake.
238
-------
REFERENCES
1. Tressler, W. L. and Bere, R., "VIII .A. Limnoligical Study of Some
Lakes in the Delaware and Susquehanna Watersheds", A Biological
Survey of the Delaware and Susquehanna Watersheds, Biological
Survey (1935) No. X, Supplement to the 25th Annual Report, 1935,
State of New York Conservation Department, 222-236 (1936).
2. Flint, R. F., "Glacial Geology and the Pleistocene Epoch",
John Wiley and Sons, Inc., New York, 589 p. (1947)
3. "Preliminary 1970 Population Data, U.S. Census", U.S. Government
Printing Office, Washington, D.C.
4. "U.S. Census for 1960", U.S. Government Printing Office,
Washington, D.C.
5. "U.S. Census for 1950", U.S. Government Printing Office,
Washington, D.C.
6. "New York State Land Uses and Natural Resource Inventory", Center
for Aerial Photographic Studies, Cornell University, Ithaca, New York
7. Boulton, P.W., "Land Use in Canadarago Lake Watershed", unpublished
data, New York State Department of Environmental Conservation,
Albany, New York
8. Wright, S.K., "Canadarago Lake Watershed Land Usage", unpublished
data, State Soil and Water Conservation Committee, Cornell Univer-
sity, Ithaca, New York
9. "1964 Census of Agriculture - Herkimer County", A.E. Ent. 475-20,
Dept. of Agriculture Economics, New York State College of Agriculture,
Cornell University, Ithaca, New York
10. "1964 Census of Agriculture - Otsego County", A.E. Ent. 475-20,
Dept. of Agriculture Economics, New York State College of Agriculture,
Cornell University, Ithaca, New York
11. Kling, G.F., "Relationships among Soils, Land Use, and Phosphorus
Losses in a Drainage Basin in East-Central New York State".
12. "An Analysis of the Contribution of Canadarago Lake Recreational
Properties to the Economy of the Richfield Spgrings-Schuyler Lake
Area", Soil Conservation Service, U.S. Dept. of Agriculture,
Syracuse, New York (1970)
13. Smith, P.J., Cunnan, J.F., VanCleef, T., and Hamm, R., "Report -
Canadarago Sanitary Survey", Oneonta District Office, New York State
Department of Health (1967)
239
-------
14. Carcich, I.G., "Canadarago Lake Morphometric Data", unpublished,
New York State Department of Environmental Conservation, Albany,
New York
15. "Climatological Data", U.S. Department of Commerce, Washington,
D. C., (1951 through 1960)
16. Hetling, L,J. and Sykes, R.M , "Sources of Nutrients in Canadarago
Lake", Journal Water Pollution Control Federation, 4, No. 1, 145(1973'
17. "Climatological Data", U.S. Department of Commerce, Washington,
D.C. (1951-1972)
18. Fuhs, G.W., Allen, S.B., Lyons, T.B. and LaRow, E.J., "Canadarago
Lake Eutrophication Study, Lake and Tributary Survey, 1968-1970",
Technical Paper No. 18, New York State Department of Environmental
Conservation (1972)
19. Sauberer, J. Mitt. Int. Ver. Limnol. No. 11, (1962)
20. Fuhs, G.W., "Improved Device for the Collection of Sedimenting
Matter", Limnol. Oceanoqr. 18, 989-993 (1973)
21. Green, D.M., "Fisheries Investigation of Canadarago Lake - Quarterly
Report for July-Sept. 1972", Department of Natural Resources, N.Y.
State College of Agriculture and Life Sciences, Cornell University,
Ithaca, N.Y. (1972).
22. Green, D.M., "Fisheries Investigation of Canadarago Lake - Quarterly
Report for Oct.-Dec. 1972", Department of Natural Resources, N.Y.
State College of Agriculture and Life Sciences, Cornell University,
Ithaca, N.Y. (1973).
23. Green, D.M. and Smith, C.B., "Fisheries Investigation of Canadarago
Lake, Revised". A Proposal, Department of Natural Resources, Cornell
University, Ithaca, N.Y. (1973).
24. Harman, W.N., "The Mollusca of Canadarago Lake and a New Record for
Lasmigona Compressa (Lea)", The Nautilus, 87, No. 4, 114 (1973).
25. Forney, J.L., "Fisheries Investigation of Canadarago Lake". A
Proposal, Dept. of Natural Resources, Cornell University, Ithaca,
New York (1972).
26. New York State Department of Environmental Conservation, Region IV
Files, 1958, 1964, 1969.
27. Fuhs, G.W. and Rhee, G.Y., Unpublished data, New York State Depart-
ment of Health, Albany, N.Y.
28. Wood, L.W., Unpublished data, New York State Department of Health,
Albany, New York
240
-------
29. Hetling, L.J., Harr, I.E., Fuhs, G.W. and Allen, S.P., "Phase I,
Canadarago Lake, Otsego County, New York" Technical Paper No. 34,
New York State Department of Environmental Conservation (1974).
30. Fuhs,G.W., Demmerle, Susanne D., Canelli, E., and Chen, M.,
"Characterization of Phosphorus-Limited Plankton Algae (with
reflections on the limiting-nutrient concept)". In: Nutrients
and Eutrophication, Amer. Soc. Limnol. Oceanogr. Spec. Symp.
No. 1, 113-133 (1972).
M it it
31. Manczak, H., "Uber die Auswertung von Gewasserguteuntersuchungen",
Vom Wasser, 35, 237-265 (1968)
32. Watson, K.S., Farrell, P,R., and Anderson, J.S., "The Contribution
from the Individual Home to the Sewer System", Journal Water Pollution
Control Federation, 39, 2039 (1967)
33. Weible, S.R., "Urban Drainage as a Factor in Eutrophication", In
Eutrophication: Causes, Consequences, Correctives, National Academy
of Science, Washington, D.C. (1969).
34. Hetling, L.J., and Carcich, I.G., "Phosphorus in Wastewater",
Water and Sewage Works, 120, No. 2, 59, February (1973)
35. Vollenweider, R.A., "The Scientific Basis of Lake and Stream
Eutrophication, with Particular Reference to Phosphorus and
Nitrogen as Eutrophication Factors", Tech. Rept. to OECD, Paris,
DAS/CSI/68, No. 27 (mimeogr.) 182p. (1968)
36. Vollenweider, R.A., "Input-Output Models", Canada Centre for Inland
Waters, Burlington, Ontario, Canada
37. Thomas, E.A., "Sedimentation in oligotrophen und eutrophen Seen
als Ausdruck ihrer Produktivitat", Verh. Int. Ver. Limnol., 12
383-393 (1955)
38. Stauffer, R.E., and Lee, G.F., "The Role of Thermocline Migration
in Regulating Algal Blooms", In Modeling the Eutrophication Process.
Proceedings of a Workshop held at Utah State University, Logan,
Utah, Sept. 5-7, 1973. E. Joe Middlebrooks, Donna H. Falkenborg
and T.E. Maloney, eds. Logan, Utah, Utah Water Research Laboratory,
Utah State University, p. 73-82 (1973)
2A1
-------
SECTION IV - OHIO
LIMNOLOGICAL AND GEOCHEMICAL CHARACTERISTICS
OF THE TWIN LAKES WATERSHED, OHIO
G. Dennis Cooke, David W. Waller,
Murray R. McComas and Robert T. Heath
Center for Urban Regionalism and Environmental Sciences
and Departments of Biological Sciences and Geology
Kent State University
Kent, Ohio
I. INTRODUCTION
The Twin Lakes Watershed is a heavily urbanized ecosystem with three cul-
turally eutrophic glacial lakes and four small upland, manmade ponds (Cooke,
et al. 1973). In 1973, sewage (septic tank) diversion was essentially com-
pleted. The Twin Lakes Project was established in late 1971 to measure the
response of the two main lakes (East and West) to diversion, and to investi-
gate the efficacy of phosphorus precipitation by aluminum sulfate as a means
of accelerating recovery. Monitoring data for 1972-1974 from that project
(EPA 16010 HCS, R801936) is reported here.
Methods of measurements for hydrologic, geological, and limnologic data
are given in Section IV.
II. GEOGRAPHIC DESCRIPTION OF WATER BODY
A. Latitude and Longitude. These data are listed in Table 1.
B. Altitude Above Sea Level. These data are listed in Table 1.
C. Catchment Area. These data are listed in Table 1.
Table 1.
Morphological and Hydrological Data of the Twin Lakes Watershed
Latitude-Longitude
Area of Watershed (ha.)
Population Estimate (1975)
41° 12' N. Latitude, 81°
334.5 (including lakes)
1510 (452/km.2)
Area (ha.)
Maximum length (km.)
Maximum width (km.)
Volume (m3) (V)
Maximum depth (m.)
Mean depth (m.)
Elevation (m.)
Water renewal time
(yrs.) (=V/Q)
Area of other lakes in
in sub-watershed
West Twin Lake
34.02
(including canals § lagoons)
0.65
0.60
14.99 x 105
(including canals § lagoons)'
11.50
4.
34
318.73
1.
1.
1.
15
64
81
03
(1972)
(1973)
(1974)
21 ' W. Longitude
East Twin Lake
26.88
0.85
0.50
13.50 x 105
12.00
5.03
318.42
0.79 (1972)
0.93 (1973)
0.58 (1974)
*These shallow areas are excluded from calculations of mean concentrations
and amounts of nutrients.
242
-------
D. General Climatic Data. Portage County has a humid-temperate
continental type climate with an average frost-free season of 168 days.
Average dates of spring and fall killing frosts are May 2 and October 17.
Average January temperature is -3°C, the average July temperature 21.8°C.
Temperature extremes are 39°C and -30°C (Ritchie and Powell, 1973).
Insolation has not been measured.
Precipitation-evaporation data for 1972-74 is summarized in Tables
4 and 50 The highest occurred in September 1972 with 20.7 cms. and
one storm of 9.1 cms. Highest evaporation occurs in June-August.
E. General Geological Characteristics. Geologic materials in
the watershed are comprised of up to 45.7 meters of deposits overlying
sandstone bedrock. The Twin Lakes are situated on the axis of a buried
bedrock valley (Winslow and White, 1966), filled with outwash deposits
of silt, sand and gravel derived from the Kent Ice advance, which occurred
about 15,000 years ago. The western belt of the deposits left by the
Kent moraine is composed of a high proportion of sand and gravel. Kettle
holes are common. The deepest are sites of ponds and lakes, including
Twin Lakes. Earth materials surrounding the lakes are sand and fine
gravel on the uplands, silts and organic soils in the undrained depression
areas. Underlying sand and gravel is gray silt varying in thickness
from 3 to 10 meters. The silt forms a confining layer over coarser
sand and gravel deposits which lie at depths from 12 to 20 meters below
the surface. The deep sand and gravel serves as the principal aquifer
for the wells of residents in the Twin Lakes area. Soils developed on
the glacial materials are well drained and moderately permeable, except
in lowlands. Erosion potential is low where the soils are protected
by vegetative cover. Construction in the steep areas has caused
severe erosion and sedimentation.
F. Vegetation, Open space in the watershed is comprised of small
upland areas of oak, beech, hickory, and sugar maple woods, low poorly
drained areas of elm, maple, and willow, and swampy areas with poison
sumac, swamp maple, alder and sparse tamarack. No extensive open fields
or pasture land are in the basin, except for large lawns.
G. Population. There are approximately 1510 people living within
the watershed in 430 houses.
H. Land Usage. The watershed contains two types of land: residential
and open space. The major land use is single family residential.
I. Use of Water. The water in the lakes is used solely for
recreation.
J. Sewage and Effluent Discharge. Until 1972, sewage was dis-
charged into septic tanks and thence by groundwater and stream flow
to the lakes. Sewage was diverted during late 1971 through 1972 to
a package plant which discharges away from the watershed. All storm
drainage enters the lakes. There is no industrial discharge.
243
-------
i o s ~ J,
1......L L.-_L. - 1 . . J T__. ._
-------
w
OJ
:=
CJ
Q
IX.
r
CO
a:
UJ
V)
UJ
:*:
z
5
245
-------
III. MORPHOMETRIC AND HYDROLOGIC CHARACTERISTICS OF THE TWIN LAKES
The two lowermost lakes of the Twin Lakes Watershed, East (ETL)
and West (WTL) Twin Lakes, are small eutrophic kettle-type lakes of
similar morphology (Figure 2). WTL is slightly larger in area and
volume and lower in mean depth, due primarily to the construction of
a lagoon and canals on the west and northwest sides of the lake (Figure
1).
A. Surface Area, Length, Width. See Table 1.
B. Volume of Water and Regulation. Lake volumes and volume-area
relationships are given in Tables 1 and 2. The lakes receive water
from precipitation, outflow of small, upland, man-made ponds, storm
flow, small spring-fed woodland streams, and groundwater. Water is
lost by evaporation, and by outflow from ETL. Rate of outflow is
partially controlled by a small marsh and golf course pond. WTL and
Dollar Lake flow into ETL.
C. Maximum and Average Depths. See Table 1.
D. Exceptional Depths and Ratio of Surface Area of Deep and
Shallow Waters.See Table 1 for depths.Shallow waters are considered
to be the zone of macrophyte growth. Using areas of Table 2 and areas
of macrophytes (see Section IV, C. 7), the ratio of deep to shallow
waters of WTL and ETL are 3.96 and 2.49 respectively.
Table 2. Volumes and Areas of Lake Strata
Depth or
Top of
Stratum
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Total
Volume (m )
319,250
247,333
223,659
202,391
175,592
141,592
94,406
49,886
25,824
13,627
5,459
203
1,499,222m3
Area (m )
340,152
276,112
234,702
213,700
191,290
160,350
123,630
67,940
33,800
18,600
9,200
2,440
Volume (m )
252,911
218,156
188,917
169,883
151,315
127,240
98,825
68,660
38,331
19,305
10,217
3,389
1,350,568m3
Area (m )
268,820
237,330
199,530
178,500
161,410
141,440
113,550
84,800
53,700
24,800
14,290
6,630
E. Ratio of Epi- Over Hypolimnion. The principal metalimnetic
strata were identified from temperature data. Table 3 catalogs this
feature for all observation days. Table 11 shows average extents,
volumes, and volume-ratios of the epilimnion and hypolimnion. During
1971-74, the metalimnion has tended to occur deeper in each lake.
246
-------
TABLE 3
Catalog of Observation Dates. Thermal conditions indicated in parentheses: Ice = ice
present; = unstratified; Str or numbers = metalimnion present, with numbers
indicating depths (m) at which the bounds of the metaUmnion occurred.
East Twin Lake
1971
Total Visits
35
Apr
May
Jun
Jul
Aug
Sep
Oct
days
5 (---)
9 (---)
14 (---)
17 (2,3)
21 (1,4)
5 (7,8)
12 (1,4)
19 (2,5)
28 (Str)
4 (Str)
8 (1,7)
18 (Str)
23 (2,7)
29 (2,6)
7 (2,7)
13 (2,7)
20 (3,8)
27 (3,7)
3 (3,7)
10 (3,7)
17 (3,7)
24 (3,8)
2 (3,8)
8 (2,8)
1 (2,8)
11 (5,8)
14 (6,9)
21 (6,9)
Oct 28
Nov 5
11
15
18
26
Dec 7
1972
(6,9)
(8,10)
(---)
(---)
(---)
(...)
(---)
Total Visits
47 days
Jan 31
Feb 10
17
24
Mar 2
9
24
28
Apr 4
11
18
25
May 2
9
16
23
30
Jun 6
13
20
(Ice)
(Ice)
(Ice)
(Ice)
(Ice)
(Ice)
(...)
(...)
(...)
(...)
(2,6)
(5,7)
(1,8)
(3,8)
(2,8)
(2,8)
(2,9)
(3,9)
(2,8)
(1,8)
Jun 27
Jul 5
11
18
25
Aug 1
8
15
22
29
Sep 5
12
19
26
Oct 3
10
17
24
31
Nov 7
14
21
28
Dec 5
12
19
26
(1,9)
(2,9)
(1,8)
(1,8)
(2,7)
(3,7)
(3,7)
(2,7)
(2,7)
(2,8)
(3,8)
(4,8)
(4,9)
^,4,10)
(6,10)
(6,10)
(6,8)
(8,9)
(9,11)
(9,10)
( •-)
-(,..)
(...)
(...)
(Ice)
(Ice)
(Ice)
1973
Total Visits
43 days
Jan 2
16
Feb 13
20
27
Mar 6
13
20
27
Apr 3
10
17
24
May 1
8
15
29
Jim 5
12
19
26
Jul 3
10
17
24
31
Aug 7
14
(Ice)
(Ice)
(Ice)
(Ice)
(Ice)
(Ice)
(...)
(...)
(...)
(...)
(...)
(8,9)
(Str)
(2,8)
(2,9)
(5,9)
(3,9)
(2,8)
(2,7)
(2,8)
(2,9)
(2,9)
(3,8)
(Str)
(2,8)
(Str)
(3,8)
(3,8)
Aug 21
28
Sep 4
11
18
25
Oct 2
9
16
23
30
Nov 6
13
27
Dec 11
1974
(3,8)
(1,8)
(2,7)
(3,7)
(4,8)
(4,8)
(5,8)
(5,8)
(5,8)
(7,9)
(Str)
(Str)
(...)
(...)
(...)
Total Visits
47 days
Jan 7
28
Feb 11
27
Mar 6
18
Apr 1
9
16
24
30
May 7
(Ice)
(Ice)
(Ice)
(Ice)
(...)
(...)
(...)
(...)
(7,9)
(4,6)
(2,5)
(4,6)
May 17
24
31
Jun 7
14
20
26
Jul 2
11
18
25
30
Aug 6
13
20
27
Sep 3
10
17
24
Oct 1
8
15
22
29
Nov 5
12
19
26
(2,7)
(1,8)
(2,8)
(2,7)
(3,7)
(3,7)
(3,7)
(3,7)
(2,8)
(2,7)
(Str)
(3,8)
(3,8)
(3,8)
(Str)
(2,8)
(4,8)
(4,9)
(4,8)
(5,8)
(6,8)
(7,9)
(4,8)
(Str)
(9,10)
(Str)
(10,11)
(---)
(...)
West Twin Lake
1971
Total Visits
24 days
Apr 20 (2,5)
28 (8,9)
May 15 (2,5)
Jun 8 (2,6)
22 (2,6)
28 (1,7)
Jul 6 (2,6)
12 (2,6)
19 (2,6)
26 (2,6)
Aug 2 (2,6)
9 (3,6)
16 (2,6)
23 (2,5)
Sep 1 (2,6)
7 (1,6)
29 (4,6)
Oct 12 (6,7)
19 (5,6)
26 (5,7)
Nov 4 (8,9)
11 (---)
18 (---)
26 (---)
1972
Total Visits
47 days
Jan 11 (Ice)
Feb 8 (Ice)
15 (Ice)
22 (Ice)
29 (Ice)
Mar 7 (Ice)
24 (---)
31 (---)
Apr 6 (---)
13 (4,5)
20 (4,6)
27 (5,8)
May 4 (2,7)
11 (Str)
18 (3,7)
25 (0,8)
Jun 1 (3,8)
8 (4,7)
15 (3,9)
22 (3,7)
29'(3,7)
Jul 6 (4,8)
13 (2,9)
20 (2,7)
27 (1,8)
Aug 3 (4,8)
Aug 10 (4,8)
17 (3,7)
24 (3,9)
31 (2,7)
Sep 7 (4,9)
14 (3,9)
21 (4,7)
28 (5,8)
Oct 5 (5,8)
12 (6,9)
19 (8,10)
2k (---)
Nov 2 (---)
9 (---)
16 (---)
22 (---)
30 (---)
Dec 7 ( )
14 (Ice)
21 (Ice)
29 (Ice)
1973
Total Visits
45 days
Jan 4 (Ice)
11 (Ice)
18 (Ice)
Feb 15 (Ice)
Feb 22 (Ice)
Mar 1 (Ice)
8 (Ice)
15 (---)
22 (---)
29 (---)
Apr 5 (---)
12 (---)
19 (5,6)
26 (2,6)
May 3 (5,8)
10 (5,8)
17 (7,8)
24 (6,7)
31 (4,9)
Jun 7 (4,8)
14 (3,8)
21 (3,8)
28 (3,9)
Jul 5 (2,9)
12 (3,8)
19 (2,7)
26 (3,8)
Aug 2 (3,8)
9 (3,8)
16 (3,7)
23 (4,7)
30 (1,9)
Sep 6 (2,7)
Sep 13 (4,7)
20 (5,9)
27 (5,8)
Oct 4 (5,9)
11 (5,8)
18 (8,9)
25 (9,10)
Nov 1 (---)
8 (---)
15 (---)
27 (---)
Dec 11 (---)
1974
Total Visits
40 days
Jan 7 (Ice)
28 (Ice)
Feb 11 (Ice)
27 (Ice)
Mar 6 (---)
18 (---)
Apr 1 (---)
12 (---)
19 (3,4)
27 (Str)
May 3 (3,6)
14 (4,7)
21 (2,7)
May28 (3,7)
Jin 4 (2,7)
11 (3,6)
18 (4,7)
25 (3,7)
Jul 1 (4,7)
9 (1,7)
18 (2,7)
25 (3,8)
30 (3,6)
Aug 6 (3,7)
13 (3,8)
20 (Str)
27 (2,7)
Sep 5 (4,7)
12 (2,7)
19 (4,7)
26 (5,7)
Oct 3 (7.10)
10 (8,9)
17 (Str)
24 (---)
31 (---)
Nov 7 (---)
14 (---)
21 (---)
27 (---)
247
-------
F. Duration of Stratification. Both lakes are dimictic second
class lakes.For purposes of discussion an annual cycle of four
stadia is defined: WINTER (ice present), SPRING (unstratified,
SUMMER (metalimnion present), and FALL (unstratified). Table 3
catalogs the occurrence of these conditions for all days the lakes
were visited. For convenience in this report, the start of winter
has been defined as January 1.
Ice usually appears in December and disappears in early March.
The lakes commonly thaw and refreeze at least once during this interval.
Ice thickness is usually 7-10 cm.; thickness of 30 cm.+ has been
reported.
The 1971-74 average onset of summer was April 14 for both lakes.
The 1971-74 average summer lasted 211 days in ETL (to November 11) and
196 days in WTL (to October 27). During 1971-1974, summer conditions
have lengthened in ETL from 207 to 217 days and have shortened in WTL
from 206 to 188 days.
G. Nature of Lake Sediments. Sediment characteristics of the
surficial (upper 2 cm.) muds of the littoral, metalimnion (sublittoral)
and hypolimnion (profundal) were determined in 1972-73 by Lardis (1973)
(Table 4). Littoral sediments contain mainly decaying vegetation,
shell fragments, and allochthonous debris. Sublittoral muds are brown
to black-gray with lesser and varying amounts of decaying vegetation.
Profundal zone muds are dark gray-black in ETL, brownish-black in WTL,
and are much blacker during anoxic periods; rusty-brown above a gray-
black layer during oxygenated periods. Profundal sediments throughout
the year are very fluid and easily disturbed. Both lakes exhibit an
increased amount of organic phosphorus (method of Mehta et al. 1954)
with depth of overlying water. Mean phosphorus content of ETL sediment
is significantly less than WTL (0.66 mg.P/g. vs. 0.85 mg.P/g«), even-
though loading to ETL indicates ETL to be more enriched. Lardis attributec
this to the organic phosphorus added to WTL during the dredging of
the canals in 1969.
The mean phosphorus content of the littoral zones are similar and
vary little from season to season. The sublittoral of WTL has con-
siderably more phosphorus than ETL and exhibits a decline from fall to
winter. The greatest difference between lakes is in profundal samples.
In both lakes, the phosphorus content of profundal surficial muds in-
creases from fall to spring, then declines after onset of summer anoxic
conditions (13% mean decrease in WTL, from spring levels), suggesting
that the increase in dissolved ortho phosphate in hypolimnetic waters
may in part be from this decrease in sediment-interstitial water phos-
phorus .
The organic content of ETL and WTL surficial sediments increases
with depth of sample; WTL profundal samples have more organic matter
than ETL. The percent organic content of dry sediment samples ranges
from 14% in littoral to 39% in profundal in ETL, 14% in littoral to
41% in profundal in WTL. The water content of surficial sediments
ranged from 71.5 to 97%; highest values were found in profundal samples.
Most samples were 94-96% water.
248
-------
Table 4. Means of Total Organic and Dissolved Inorganic Phosphorus in
the Sediments of Each Limnetic Zone (+25 x; n = number of
samples; P04-P in mg.P/g. dry sediment) from Lardis (1973).
West Twin Lake
Littoral
Sublittoral
Profundal
Littoral
Sublittoral
Profundal
Fall
.54^.08
.89+_.03
1.19+.08
n
19
9
21
Winter
.54+. 09
.78+. 05
1.26+.13
n
8
8
9
Spring
.53+. 09
.79+. 05
1.27+.11
.43+_.07 19
.65+..06 9
.80+.03 20
n
East Twin Lake
.53+_.13 9 .52+_.10 9
.65+.05 7 .67±.06 8
.83+.06 9 .87+.07 9
Summer
.57+..12
.77+..06
1.04+.03
n
7
. 53+_. 08 9
.67^.06 7
.77+.04 9
H. Seasonal Variation of Preciptation and Evaporation
Table 5. Precipitation and Evaporation. Twin Lakes Watershed.
Mo.
J
F
M
A
M
J
J
A
S
0
N
D
Total
Mean
Precip.
Cm)
.0356
.0511
.1001
.1628
.0955
.1018
.0823
.0612
.2070
.0386
.0996
.0886
1.1242
0.0937
1972
Volume
(m3)
118904
170674
334334
543752
318970
340012
274882
204408
691380
128924
332664
295924
3754828
312902
Evapo.
Cm)
.0527
.0606
.0970
.1356
.1577
.1516
.1233
.0880
0.8665
0,1083
1973
Precip.
(m)
.0417
.0483
.0623
.0875
.1270
.1028
.0655
.0726
.0708
.1143
.0657
.0617
0.9202
0,0767
Volume
(m3)
139278
161322
208082
292250
424180
343352
218770
242484
236472
381762
219438
206078
3073478
256123
Evapo.
(m)
.0247
.0529
.0896
.0929
.1074
.1119
.1180
.1000
0.6974
0.0872
1974
Precip.
(m)
.0907
.0706
.1044
.1270
.1155
.0767
.0723
.1750
.0558
.0695
.1270
.0589
1.1434
0.0953
Volume
(m3)
302938
235804
348696
424180
385770
256178
241482
584500
186372
232130
424180
196726
3818956
318246
Evapo.
Cm)
.0660
.0889
.1092
.1499
.1727
.1372
.0805
.0559
0.8603
0.1075
Area of watershed = 334 hectares. Volume to lakes obtained by multiplying
lake area (m^) by precipitation (m).
I. Inflow-Outflow of Water
Table 6. Water Inflow-Outflow (m3x!03)
A. West Twin Lake 1972
surface streams 145.45
groundwater 307.37
precipitation on lake 382.35
runoff 382.96
total inflow 1218.12
evaporation 343.61
outflow (to ETL) 916.84
B. East Twin Lake
surface streams 1057.31
groundwater 246.02
precipitation on lake 251.36
runoff 379.66
total inflow 1934,34
evaporation 268.70
outflow (out of watershed 1700.01
1973
1F9779
321.33
313.01
362.56
1177.68
273.53
826.24
956.12
247.02
246.61
iffi'.ft
1444!$2
1974
3T2T45
307.33
401.96
598.60
1640.33
270.33
1461.58
1479.02
246.02
317.66
416.23
2458.93
223.68
2307.49
249
-------
J. Water Currents, No investigations of water currents in the
Twin Lakes have been made.
K. Water Renewal Time. Water renewal times (years) are listed in
Table 1.
IV. LIMNOLOGICAL CHARACTERIZATION SUMMARY
Methods
1. Limnological Methods. Unless otherwise noted, all limnological
observations were made from a water column over the deepest point in
each lake at depths 0.1, 2, 4, 7, and 10 meters. Table 3 catalogs all
days on which the lakes were visited. Visits were generally weekly from
late spring through early fall, but less frequently otherwise. The list
of features monitored was complete for most but not all visits. An
annotated list of quantitative methods is given below:
a. Physical
(1) temperature—at one-meter intervals; Whitney resistance
thermometer.
(2) transparency--20 cm. diameter, alternating black-white
quadrants, Secchi Disc.
(3) light—Whitney LMD-8A photometer with sea and deck cells.
(4) conductance—in the laboratory; YSI Model 31 conductivity
bridge.
b. Chemical
(1) pH--in laboratory; Corning Mod.el 7 meter and combination
electrode.
(2) alkalinity — titration with 0.02N H2S04; endpoint pH 4.5.
(3) dissolved oxygen—at one-meter intervals; titration with
0.0125N sodium thiosulfate, azide modification.
(4) sulfate—turbidmetric, using Hach Chemical Co. reagents;
standard curve prepared in our laboratory.
(5) nitrate--cadmium reduction using Hach Chemical Co. reagents;
standard curve prepared in our laboratory.
(6) ammonia--direct nesslerization, using Hach Chemical Co.
reagents; standard curve prepared in our laboratory.
(7) ortho PC>4-P —at one meter intervals; ascorbic acid-ammonium
molybdate, on 0.45ju Millipore filtered samples.
(8) total P04~P unfiltered—at one-meter intervals; persulfate-
sulfuric acid digestion. P04~p determined as in (7).
(9) total P04-P filtered—persulfate-sulfuric acid digestion of
0.45 /a filtered samples. PO.-P determined as in (7).
c. Biological
(1) phytoplankton--2S ml. samples filtered on 0.45 /i Millipore
filters, dried, cleared with immersion oil, counted at 140 x,
11 Whipple fields; of dominant species, using appropriate
geometric shapes to calculate cell volume (McNabb, 1960.
Limnol. Oceanogr. 5:57).
(2) Chlorophyll A--500 ml. sample filtered through GF/A filter,
extracted with 901 buffered acetone, using tissue grinder;
equations (trichromatic) of Parsons and Strickland, no acid
correction (Long and Cooke, 1971. Limnol. Oceanogr. 16:990).
250
-------
(3) zooplankton—vertical tow, #20 rjet, lake bottom to top of
hypolimnion (or 6 m. when unstratified) and bottom of
metalimnion to surface (6 m. to surface when unstratifled),
using rim line and weighted bucket to close net. 10 ml.
aliquots counted in duplicates.
(4) macrophytes--outer limit of plant distribution from shore
measured at several points around lake perimeter. Percent
cover estimated, and plant samples obtained by use of SCUBA.
Dry weight per area multiplied by percent cover and area of
macrophyte community. Net yield estimated by difference.
(5) potential plankton metabolism—plankton samples were incubated
in the laboratory at 5000 lux. Metabolism was measured by
the pH method in light and dark bottles after 4 hours of
incubation.
2. Surface Water Measuring Methods.
Twin Lakes Stream
Station
1
2
3
4
5
6
Measuring Method
90° V notch weir and stilling well
90° V notch weir and stilling well
3'H flume, Agriculture Research Service
design
15" Culvert discharge, current meter
24" Culvert discharge, current meter
Stage-Discharge Rating Curve, stilling
well
2 submerged culverts 15" diameter,
current meter
8
9
Culvert, bucket
90° V notch weir, bucket
Dollar Lake
Stream Station
Culvert discharge, bucket
1
2
3
4
5
Culvert discharge, bucket
60° V notch weir and stilling basin
Culvert discharge, bucket
90° V notch weir, and stilling well
Frequency of Measure
Continuous recorder
Continuous recorder
Continuous recorder
Daily
Daily
Continuous
Daily
Daily
Daily
Daily
Daily
Daily
Daily
Daily
3. Surface Run-off. Land runoff or storm flows were computed from
lake level increases,as recorded by limnographs, in excess of that from
direct precipitation and stream inflows.
4. Ground Water Methods. Twenty-eight shallow wells were installed
around the perimeter of the lakes and a flow net was constructed. Specific
discharge was determined from the hydraulic gradient and field measurement
of permeability. Average cross-sectional discharge depth between these
wells was assumed to be 3.0 meters (range 1-6 meters). Wells were sampled
monthly for water chemistry. A deep piezometer nest beside WTL was used
to estimate the upward hydraulic gradient and discharge into the lakes of
deep ground water. Ground water inflow and loading is the sum of shallow
and deep groundwater discharge.
251
-------
5. Precipitation-Evaporation. Precipitation was measured with a
recording Leupold-Stevens type Q 6 weighing bucket, located at WTL.
Rain and snow samples were collected at the University (8 km. south of
watershed) for chemical analysis. These samples included dry fallout.
Evaporation was measured in 1972 from daily temperature data, using
the Blaney-Criddle equation, and in 1973-74 with a U.S. Weather Bureau
Class A Evaporating Pan and a Weather Measure Recording Evaporimeter.
Results. Averaged data are displayed in tabular form as indicated in
the annotated list below. Wherever appropriate in averaging, values for
limnological features were weighted with respect to time in days. Where
appropriate, both unweighted (COL) and volume-weighted (LAKE) values
were averaged. For features expressed as concentrations, average total
amounts in the lake may be found by multiplying the LAKE averages by the
total lake volumes (Table 1). The surface densities of these average
total amounts may be found by further dividing by total lake areas
(Table 1).
A. Physical
1. Temperature. Tables 7 and 8.
2. Conductance. Tables 9 and 10.
3. Light. Secchi disc transparency is summarized in Table 12.
Depths of light extinction at 10%, 1% and 0.1! of surface light intensity
are presented in Table 13 for selected dates in 1971 and 1972.
4- Color. No measurements of color have been made.
5. Solar Radiation. No measurements of incident solar radiation
have been made.
B. Chemical.
1. pH. Tables 14 and 15.
2. Dissolved 0xygen. Tables 16 and 17.
3. Phosphorus. Total phosphorus concentrations are summarized
in Tables 18 and 19.Filterable total "soluble" phosphorus concentrations
are summarized in Tables 20 and 21. Filterable ortho phosphorus
concentrations are summarized in Tables 22 and 23.
4. Nitrogen. "Total" nitrogen (ammonium and nitrate nitrogen
only) concentrations are summarized in Tables 24 and 25. The two fractions
recorded are summarized in Tables 26, 27, 28, and 29.
5. Alkalinity. Tables 30 and 31.
6. Electrolytes. Sulfate concentrations only are summarized in
Tables 32 § 33.
7. Trace Metals. No measurements of trace metal concentrations
were made.
25 Z
-------
Table 7. TEI1P COL: Average Temperatures in the Column (°C) .
West
Year
1971
1972
1973
1974
East
1972
1973
1974
West
1971
1972
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
Twin
Lake
Winter
Season
2
2
3
Twin
2
2
3
Table
Twin
2
2
3
Twin
1
1
3
.296
.346
.179
Lake
.163
.011
.208
8.
Lake
.161
.312
.116
Lake
.930
.992
.189
Spring
Season
3.
6.
6.
6.
3.
5.
6.
TEMP
3.
6.
6.
7.
3.
5.
5.
776
469
209
845
538
049
075
LAKE:
782
661
333
232
729
322
895
Summer
Season
14.146
13.405
15.643
13.853
13.737
12.559
14.539
12.732
Average
17.125
17.200
18.707
17,041
17.083
15.952
17.679
15.618
Epilim
Only
Hypolim
Only
20.533 10.
18.831 8.
20.506 11.
19.446 9.
20.945 8.
19.156 7.
20.496 9.
18.241 8.
Temperatures
20.554 10.
18.844 8.
20.501 11.
19.462 9.
20.972 9.
19.171 7.
20.504 9,
18.271 8.
713
240
095
766
930
027
552
001
in
853
389
289
943
065
147
663
119
Fall
Season
6.737
5.155
7.377
7.488
4.234
3.848
6.875
6.055
the Lake i
6.784
5.150
7.440
7.550
4.262
3.788
6.950
6.154
All
Seasons
12
8
10
10
11
8
10
9
15
10
12
11
13
10
11
11
.902
.657
.743
.042
.347
.649
.011
.740
.388
.586
.398
.773
.833
.604
.770
.520
Table 9. COND COL:
West Twin Lake
T97I =
1972
1973 428.02
1974
East Twin Lake
HTfl -
1972
1973 429.29
1974
Average Conductances (20°C) in the Column (jamho)
430.52
420.95
400.76
399.72
415.68
412.47
413.31
375.47
381.54
398.61
376.85
391.00
378.80
357.69
362.45
373.29
435.07
430.49
449.44
384.72
413.14
417.63
400.81
-
400,75
373.34
-
376.21
412.39
417.89
414.12
375.12
393.59
397.10
Table 1°. COND LAKE: Average Conductances (20°C) in the Column
West Twin Lake
428.19
Twin Lake
1972
1973
'1974
East
TSI
1972
1973
1974
420.53
426.54
420.95
393.54
400.24
403.01 377.09 434.40 390.45 400.23
400.08 390.97 428.77 _ 409.22
390.37 378.10 466.45 403.18 403.23
363.78 357.36 384.38 373.56 365.36
367.94 363.23 409.29 . 381.74
382.58 372.83 415.45 378.05 388.46
253
-------
Table 11. Average Dimensions of Epilimnion and Hypoliranion.
A. Lowest Extents of Epilimnion (m)•
1971 1972 1973 1974
All
B
West Twin Lake
East Twin Lake
West Twin Lake
East Twin Lake
West Twin Lake
East Twin Lake
West Twin Lake
East Twin Lake
West Twin Lake
East Twin Lake
Table 12. SECCHI TRANSPARENCY:
West Twin Lake
3.114 3.375 4.179 3.604
2.944 3.367 3.600 4.044
Highest Extents of Hypolimnion (m) .
6,243 7«821 7.964 7.114
7.167 8.369 8.250 7.906
C. Volumes of Epilimnion (m3) .
715866 796415 937229 829430
609036 665854 725323 770224
D. Volumes of Hypolimnion (m*) .
186099 68646 58244 108873
158646 72691 64412 97291
Ratios of Volumes, Epilimnion/Hypolimnion
3,847 11.602 16.091 7.618
3.839 9.160 11.261 7.917
3.562
3.496
7.275
7.926
818380
693600
106405
98001
a
7.691
7.077
Average Secchi Disc Depths (m)
Year
1971
1972
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
Winter
2.728
2.519
1.593
Twin Lake
1.384
1.858
1.886
Spring
1.050
1.181
1.432
1.043
1.590
1.535
Summer
1.622
1.437
2.948
2.177
2.261
1.655
2.402
1.903
Fall
2.031
4.034
3.282
3.883
1.701
2.188
2.988
1.962
All
1 .707
2.170
2.754
2.323
2.146
1.623
2.304
1.866
Table 13 . LIGHT EXTINCTION
Depths at Intensities .100, .010 and .001 of Surface.
Light Intensity
.100
.010
.001
West Twin Lake
East Twin Lake
1971
1.4679
3.5357
4.9536
1972
2.4286
5.3571
6.7833
1971
2.0250
4.6393
5.6857
1972
1.7600
3.6800
5.1600
254
-------
Table 14. pH COL: Average pH Values in the Column.
West Twin Lake
Winter Spring
Year Season Season
1971
1972
1973
1974 8.0271 8.4577
East Twin Lake
Summer Epilim Hypolim
Season Only Only
Fall All
Season Seasons
7.4575 7.7643 7.3466 7.6872
7.4127 7.8504 7.2345 7.2826
1971 -
1972 -
1973 - - 7.3699 8.0661 7.2452 6.8887
1974 ''.0596 8.2168 7.3405 7.7181 7.1212 7.4599
Table 15. pH LAKE: Average pH Values in the Lake.
West Twin Lake
1971
1972
1974 8.0449 8.4584
East Twin Lake
1971
1972
1973
1974 8.0074 8.2128
Table 16
Average
West Twin Lake
1971
1972 11670.7 14396.2
1973 10522.9 10932.5
1974 12770.6 12153.7
East Twin Lake
7.6143 7.7824 7.3455 7.6890
7.6337 7.8672 7.2464 7.2674
7.5462 8.0850 7.2416 6.8445
7.5601 7.7505 7.1344 7.4586
[02-OXY] COL: Dissolved Oxygen Gas,
Concentrations in the Column (jig O^)..
3363.9 9234.8 544.0 5005,8
3702.5 7776.7 950.2 8483.0
3952.3 8247.5 454.7 8739.4
3864.8 8318.2 466.4 6991.4
1971 - 12983.3 3733.1 9045.1 614.2 8347.8
1972 8970.3 12143.0 3582.9 8782.8 530.9 8057.1
1973 9859.0 10674.6 4357.0 8622.2 722.6 9056.6
1974 11318.1 11735.9 4191.1 8096.5 569.9 8150.9
Table 17. [02-OXY] LAKE: Dissolved Oxygen Gas,
Average Concentrations in the Lake (jig 02/1) „
West Twin Lake
1971
1972 13265.3 14250.1
1973 12018.9 11079.3
1974 13262.9 12245.5
East Twin Lake
1971 - 13920.8
1972 11792.9 12596.2
1973 11563.9 11029.9
1974 12457.3 11986.7
5840.3 9287.6 566.9 5592.7
6070.5 7853.0 1016.1 8476.0
6579.9 8309.8 509.5 8676.6
6554.7 8405.7 621.6 7479.7
6135.2 9124.9 717.7 8598.6
5865.9 8827.7 588.7 8657.4
6752.5 8650.6 733.8 9038.5
6551.3 8226.9 669.4 8299.4
7.4955
7.5018
7.2460
7.4699
7.6285
7.6299
7.3271
7.6464
3617.3
7184.1
6735.2
6910.3
5029.5
5925. 1
6705.0
6631.8
5802.1
8766.1
8419.6
8533.6
6909.8
7930.5
8403.0
8330.7
255
-------
Table 18. [TOT-P] COL: Unfiltered Total Phosphorus,
Average Concentrations in the Column (ug P/l).
West Twin Lake
Year
1971
1972
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
Winter
Season
152
125
122
Twin
100
112
97
.79
.17
.31
Lake
.68
,54
,41
Spring
Season
170,82
85,12
78.04
96.42
77.53
65.60
Summer
Season
417
257
277
229
289
181
187
189
.76
,09
.26
,90
.24
o26
.98
.06
Epilim
Only
37.63
57.21
53.02
48.35
29.76
43.95
38.07
45.30
Hypolim
Only
779
494
616
512
687
377
430
466
.76
.35
.97
.02
.23
.55
.73
.55
Fall
Season
122.
132.
135.
125.
66.
97.
72.
94.
86
20
52
79
81
45
27
11
All
Seasons
343.04
204.85
206.28
173.67
226.56
145.96
147.77
148.79
Table 19. [TOT-P] LAKE: Unfiltered Total Phosphorus,
Average Concentrations in the Lake (ug P/l).
West
1971
1972
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
Twin Lake
-
-
134.84 171.55
111.02
136 72
Twin Lake
-
81.27
95.44
81.23
Table 20 .
90,46
79.78
-
98.18
75.74
66.88
[TOT-P
161.
108,
99.
78.
104.
79.
74.
73.
44
63
78
66
39
48
28
52
D1SS] COL:
Average Concentrations
West
1971
1972
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
Twin Lake
-
-
98.18
84.13
Twin Lake
-
.
79.59
46.63
Table 21 .
-
-
43.32
26.73
-
_
26.05
18.69
[TOT-P
-
-
236.
210.
-
_
195.
160.
DISS
75
88
21
05
] LAKE
35.
55.
52.
47.
28.
43.
37.
44.
94
55
44
17
94
27
58
46
756.
483.
598.
483.
671.
362.
416.
447.
Filterable
in
-
-
44.
31.
-
.
69.
27.
the
02
88
85
04
21
66
30
40
17
22
93
11
Total
Column (ug
-
-
520.
492.
-
_
414.
438.
: Filterable
Average Concentrations in the
"West
1971
1972
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
Twin Lake
-
-
80.82
84.03
Twin Lake
-
-
61.27
30.32
-
-
43.82
28.14
-
.
25.42
19,82
-
-
88.
65.
-
_
57
34
100.03
49.
56
-
_
40.
28.
-
.
68,
24.
58
81
.70
74
Lake
-
_
494.
434.
-
^
391.
399.
30
15
34
62
122.86
127.53
133.87
121,08
66,78
95.66
76.41
93.83
151
122
106
96
93
83
78
76
.67
.17
.49
.83
.79
.70
.61
.12
Phosphorus ,
P/l).
-
-
95 .79
112.12
-
_
105.43
48.09
-
-
168
147
-
_
145
112
.70
.97
.08
.04
Total Phosphorus ,
(Jig
71
21
48
16
P/l).
-
•
99.27
100.98
-
_
102.71
46.58
.
_
84
70
-
_
85
42
.40
.26
.43
.25
256
-------
Table 22 . [P04-P DISS] COL: Filterable Ortho-Phosphate
Phosphorus, Average Concentrations in the Column (jjg P/l) .
West
Year
1971
1972
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
Twin Lake
Winter
Season
106.66
75.56
57.78
Tt^in Lake
23.91
54.05
31.95
Spring
Season
14.64
22.83
6.53
21.45
14.40
4.99
Summer
Season
207.12
181.69
219.32
178.85
142.62
129.27
147.30
139.85
Epilim
Only
18.26
11.02
16.42
12.01
17.40
9.69
8.20
9.52
Hypolim
Only
256.00
405.53
516.28
451.15
326.36
329.86
381.35
404.12
Fall
Season
84.16
98.07
84.52
48.70
35.04
26.24
All
Seasons
207.12
134.40
152.81
119.20
142.62
84.43
101.83
93.47
Table 23. [P04-P DISS] LAKE: Filterable Ortho-Phosphate
Phosphorus, Average Concentration in the Lake (ug P/l).
West Twin Lake
1971
1972 82.73
1973 56.63
1974 52.10
East Txvin Lake
1971
1972 8.25
1973 36.29
1974 13.82
14.
18.
6.
23.
11.
5.
10
92
32
59
46
09
69
51
58
35
52
36
39
31
.76
.58
.64
.44
.09
.12
.31
.55
13.
10.
15.
10.
17.
9.
7.
8.
32
82
75
02
33
59
71
54
392.
393.
507.
419.
310.
316.
371.
385.
12
39
92
48
74
84
01
34
82
96
78
48
33
25
.80
.93
.48
.20
.75
.58
69.76
62.69
60.47
42.20
52.09
29.73
35.08
24.62
Table 24 • [TOT-N] COL: Total Nitrogen, Average
Concentrations in-the Column (mg N/1J.
West Twin Lake
T57I :
1972
1973
1974
East
0.4152
0.9693
Twin Lake
1F7T
1972
1973
1974
0.2332
1.0470
0.2431
0.3599
0.1835
0.5944
3.9208
1.8772
2.0837
3.0609
1.5944
1.7621
0.4150
0.3788
0.3861
0.3131
3.8550
4.7491
3.2371
3.6645
Table 25 . [TOT-N] LAKE:
Concentrations
in
Total Nitrogen,.
the Lake (mg N/l)
1.2810
1.5051
1.2768
1.1608
Average
West Twin Lake
3.9208
1.2471
1.5979
3.0609
1.0622
1.4239
1971
1972
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
0.
0.
Twin
0.
0.
4041
8834
Lake
1832
9542
0.2616
0.3187
0.1821
0.5647
1.9289
0.7854
0.7507
1.3446
0.7089
0.8065
0
0
0
0
.3987
.3528
.3602
.3206
3
4
3
3
.6490
.4626
.0889
.4919
1.
1.
1.
1.
3300
3716
2251
1118
1.9289
0.7291
0.8326
1.3446
0.582S
0.8395
257
-------
Table 26. [NH4-N] COL: Ammonium Nitrogen, Average
Concentrations in the Column (mg N/l).
West
Year
1971
1972
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
Twin
Lake
"Winter
Season
0.
Oc
1.
Twin
0,
0
0.
.
1364
7975
0024
Lake
1153
8422
8494
Spring
Season
—
0.0808
0.2440
0.3390
0.0734
0.4023
0.2751
Summer
Season
3.
1.
2,
2,
2.
1,
I.
1.
8199
8204
0288
1483
9723
5287
7011
6661
Epi lin
Only
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
4381
3816
3296
3184
3350
3429
2627
2971
Hypolim
Only
6.
3.
4.
4.
6.
3,
3.
4.
2037
7723
6866
4126
1336
1380
6008
7045
Fall
Season
.
1.1561
1,3330
0.5185
Iol605
0.9450
0.0776
All
Seasons
3.8199
1.1070
1.4960
1.4520
2.9723
0.9716
1.3090
1.2076
Table 27 o [NH4-N] LAKE: Ammonium Nitrogen, Average
Concentrations in the Lake (mg N/l).
West Twin Lake
1571
1972
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
0.0995
0.7023
0.9996
Twin Lake
0.0652
0.7360
0.6193
0
0
0
0
0
0
.0951
.2191
.3129
.0731
.3668
,2883
1.
0,
0.
0.
1.
0.
0.
0.
8383
7440
7009
7647
2649
6594
7517
5082
0.4371
0.3654
0.3051
0.3178
0.3342
0.3175
0.2694
0.2978
5 ,
3,
4,
3.
^f 0
2,
3 „
4.
8251
5696
4019
8305
8155
9913
4298
1861
1.
1,
0.
1.
0.
0.
2061
2031
4882
1113
8886
0757
1.8383
0.5886
0.7337
0.6994
1.2649
0.5004
0. 7247
0.4589
Table 28= [N03-N] COL: Nitrate Nitrogen, Average
Concentrations in the Column (mg N/l).
West Twin Lake
1971
1972
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
.27878
.17181
Twin Lake
.11789
.20480
.16230
,11592
.11016
.19212
.03363
.05676
.05490
.02953
.06567
.06095
.07084
.03340
.04922
.06117
.04318
.05043
.00089
.08273
.06246
.00000
.09910
.06369
.12494
.17208
.11631
.21583
.03363
.14008
.10192
.02953
.09064
.11489
Table 29 . [N03-N] LAKE: Nitrate Nitrogen, Average
Concentrations in the Lake (mg N/l).
West Twin Lake
1971
1972
1973
197'4
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
.30458
.18106
Twin Lake
.11804
.21822
,16650
.09957
.10898
.19791
.05917
o04142
.04980
.04908
.04953
.05478
.07100
.03327
.04767
.06126
.04274
.05115
,00265
.07937
.06072
.00000
,,09759
,06206
.12391
.16846
.11383
.22323
.05917
.14045
.09887
.04908
.08211
.11478
258
-------
Table 30 . ALK COL: Average Alkalinities
in the Column (mg CaC03/l).
West
Year
1971
1972
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
West
1971
1972"
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
Twin
Lake
Winter
Season
-
-
120
Twin
,
-
115
Twin
_
-
119
Twin
:
-
114
.36
Lake
.79
Lake
.55
Lake
.26
Spring
Season
-
-
116.54
-
-
110.61
Table 31 .
in
-
-
116.98
-
-
110,87
Summer
Season
-
122
118
-
120
115
ALK
the
-
108
100
-
104
102
.29
.91
.04
.87
LAKE:
Column
.07
,16
.79
.06
Epilim Hypol
Only Only
-
102.38
92.32
-
95.80
95.69
-
149.
150.
-
144.
141.
im
17
33
83
31
Fall
Season
-
116
105
-
107
104
.76
.05
.65
.49
All
Seasons
-
121.16
116.54
-
118.02
114.14
Average Alkalinities
(mg CaC03/l).
-
102.30
91.99
-
95.41
95.36
-
146.
147.
-
142.
138.
70
24
40
80
-
116
104
-
105
104
.08
.53
.67
.43
-
109.70
106.29
-
104.94
105.42
Table 32 . [S04] COL: Sulfate, Average
Concentrations in the Column (mMoles/1).
West
1971
1972
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
Twin Lake
0.490
0.5?3
Twin Lake
0.444
0.470
0.294
0.416
0,533
0.227
0.387
0.4-50
0.399
0,362
0.357
0.315
0,331
0 327
0.446
0.433
0.423
0.390
0.398
0.359
0.320
0.252
0.278
0.232
0.221
0.260
0,374
0.433
0.357
0.262
0,388
0.284
Table 33 , [S04] LAKE: Sulfate, Average
Concentrations in the Lake (mMoles/1).
West
1971
1972
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
Twin
0.
0.
Tw in
0.
0.
Lake
480
526
Lake
440
470
0
0
0
0
0
0
.305
.416
.527
.232
.380
.450
0,448
0 417
0.400
0.362
0.376
0.353
0.446
0.434
0.424
0.391
0.399
0.360
0.324
0.263
0.290
0.237
0.229
0.269
0.376
0.434
0.374
0.260
0.383
0.278
0.375
0.405
0.408
0.290
0.366
0.363
0.507
0.433
0.436
0.322
0.390
0.378
259
-------
C. Biological
1. Phytoplankton
a. Chlorophyll. Chlorophyll A concentrations are summarized
in Tables 34 and~T5^ "
b. Primary Production. We have adopted polarographic and
titrimetric methods of measuring pliytoplankton potential productivity
rather than in. situ methods (Long, 1971). Maximum potential productivity
in situ was estimated by correcting laboratory data for phytoplankton
(Tensity, day length, and epilimnetic temperature (assuming a QIQ °f 2)
(Tailing, 1957, 1965). In 1970, at the height of the bluegreen algal
bloom the maximum productivity In sjLtu was estimated to be 3400 mg.
C/m2/day for ETL. In 1974 the potential productivity estimate of each
lake was lower than that found in 1970 (Table 36).
The production of macrophytes was estimated in 1972 (Rogers,
1974) by the harvest method, using SCUBA. The rate, from 15 April to
1 July was (mg.C/mz/day) 375 for ETL, 267 for WTL, or about 10% to 301
of the maximum rate of the plankton. Reduced growth rates were
correlated with plankton blooms. No measurements for 1974 are available;
we estimate that macrophyte production at least equalled the 1972 rate,
thus bringing it up to about 50% of the net community metabolism of the
lakes.
Oxygen deficits have been used to estimate productivity.
The contributions of allochtonous and autochthonous production are not
easily separated, and, as pointed out by Edmondson (1966) sedimentation
during periods of blue-green blooms is not rapid. In the Twin Lakes,
some of this production may leave the lakes because of the low residence
time. The deficits have declined since diversion, particularly in ETL
which does not have the canals and the heavy import from that area of
the watershed (Table 37).
c. Algal Assays. We have monitored acid and. alkaline phos-
phatase in limnetic waters of both lakes from 1972-74. Aphanizomenon
flos-aquae appears to produce it adaptively, particularly in late summer,
and both cell volume and potential productivity increase following the
appearance of alkaline phosphatase (Heath and Cooke, 1974). This alga
(the dominant species in each year) appears to be phosphorus-limited in
August.
Levels of total PC^-P at spring circulation are high (Table
40) and the relationship to mean euphotic zone Chlorophyll A is not as
strong as most lakes reported in Dillon (1974), particularly in 1972-73.
In 1974, the summer chlorophyll was much more closely related to spring
phosphorus levels.
We conclude that these lakes have been phosphorus-limited
primarily in late summer, as evidenced by the phosphatase studies. They
appear to be moving towards more general phosphorus limitation as loading
declines.
d. Identification and Count. See Table 38 and Figure 3.
260
-------
Table 34. [CHLOR-A] COL: Chlorophyll a, Average
Concentrations in the Column (mg Chl/m J.
West Twin Lake
Winter Spring
Year Season Season
Summer
Season
Epilim
Only
Hypolim
Only
Fall
Season
1971
1972
1973
1974
East
1971
1972
1973
1974
30.
14.
20,
Twin
15.
11.
19,
107
126
083
Lake
183
072
369
66
34
36
40
27
30
o324
.870
.916
.992
.372
.661
31.
67.
53.
42.
28 =
26,
25.
33,
280
838
641
741
986
364
988
000
28
21
12
21
10
23
16
19
.018
.849
.246
.651
.162
.500
.021
.076
37.
107,
97.
59.
37.
16,
21.
26.
436
Oil
310
256
201
044
747
969
11.462
8.165
7.967
19.649
15.083
23.567
All
Seasons
31.280
47.584
36.619
32.328
28.986
23.201
22.017
29.527
Table 35. [CHLOR-A] LAKE: Chlorophyll a. Average
Concentrations in the Lake (mg Chl/irH) .
West Twin Lake
T9~7T~
1972
1973
1974
E_as_t_
1971
1972
1973
1974
53.903 68.742
19.101 43.987
28.250 40.030
Twin Lake
26.791
37.770
24.888
29.944
28.249
21.551
12.110
22.106
38.737
108.878
94.954
62.435
11.233
8.257
9.164
20.719 41.840
15.006 33.400
24.199 31.443
20.712
28.555
23.011
28.869
10.191
23.521
16.010
19.429
40.111
17.222
24.507
31.556
20.208
14.958
21.530
26.791
39.971
22.939
27.655
20.712
26.120
21.636
27.757
Table 36. Estimated Net Plankton Community Photosynthesis (mg C/m^/day)
Date
TT~June 1974
4 July 1974
11 July 1974
20 July 1974
2 Aug. 1974
9 Aug. 1974
West
mean
Table' 37.
Twin Lake
1758.8
298.1
135el
439.8
387.5
433.8
STTSTT
Oxygen De
East Twin Lake
mean
Date
T5TF
1971
1972
1973
1974
West Twin Lake
0.0525
0.0523
0.0558
0.0223
East Twin Lake
0.0400
0.0740
0.1150
0.0362
0.0300
261
-------
Table 38. Major Phytoplankton Species.
1972
West Twin Lake - O.lm.
Summer Aphanizomenon flos-aquae*
Sphaeroecystis Schroeteri
Cvclotella sp.
Melosira granulata
Fall Aphanizomenon flos aquae*
Sphaeroecystis Schroeteri
Asterionella formosa
Winter Asterionella formosa
Spring Ast.firtonel la formosa*
Aphanizomenon flos-aquae
Miscellaneous greens
Summer Aphanizomenori flos-aquae*
Anabaena limnetica*
Microcystis aeruginosa
Fall Aphanizomenon flos-aquae
Anabaena limnetica*
Winter Asterionella formosa*
Fragilaria crotonensis
Spring Fragilaria crotonensis*
Asterionella formosa
*=dominants
1974
East Twin Lake - O.lm.
Aphanizomenon tlos-aquae*
Anabaena limnetica
Aphanizomenon flos-aquae*
Asterionella formosa
Aphanizomenon flos-aquae
Asterionella formosa*
Aphanizomenon flos-aquae
Fragilaria crotonensis
Aphanizomenon flos-aquae*
Anabaena limnetica*
Microcystis aeruginosa
Stephanodiscus niagarae
Aphanizomenon flos-aquae*
Stephanodiscus niagarae*
Aphanizomenon flos-aquae*
Asterionella formosa
Aphanizomenon flos-aquae*
Stephanodiscus niagarae
Fragilaria crotonensis
Table 39. Species of Microcrustacea Identified from the
East and West Twin Lakes, 1969-1970.
Leptodora kindtii (Focke)**
Diaphanosoma leuchtenbergianum Fischer
Daphnia ambigua Scourfield
D_. galeata Sars Mendotae Birge
EL, retrocurva Forbes
D. pulex Leydig, Richard**
Simocephalus exspinosus (Koch)**
S. _serrulata (Koch)**
Ceriodaphnia reticulata (Jurine)
Bosmina longirostris (0. F. Muller)
Camptocercus rectirostris (Schodler)*
Leydigia quadrangularis (Leydig)**
Alona guttata Sars
A_. Costata Sars**
A_. quadrangularis (0. F. Muller)**
Pleuroxus procurvas Birge
I\ denticulatus Birge*
Chydorus sphaericus (0. F. Muller)
Diaptomus reighardi Marsh
Orthocyclops modestus (Herrick)
Eucyclops speratus (Lilljeborg)**
Tropocyclops prasinus mexicanus
Kuefer
Cyclops bicuspidatus thomasi S. A.
Forbes
Mesocyclops edax (S. A. Forbes)
Ergasilus chautauquaensis Fellows
* = East Twin Only
** = West Twin Only
262
-------
Ham
saain-oaDiv
-------
2. Zooplaukton. Limnetic microcrustacea were sampled on 26
dates between May 1969-May 1970 by Heinz (1971). The species are listed
in Table 38. Epilimnetic density ranged from 85/liter in May to I/liter
in late summer. The periods of greatest density were May and December
(WTL) or January (ETL), with a small bloom in August. The dominant
species were Daphnia galeata, Bosmina longirostris? Cyclops bicuspidatus
thpmasi, and Mesocyclops ecTax.The species composition of ETL and
WTLstrongly resembled that of littoral communities, and the mean number of
species/sample in limnetic waters was 2-3 times that of other lakes,
indicating in both instances that the littoral had a strong influence
on the limnetic waters. Species composition and abundance were most
alike at spring circulation when Cyclops dominated. The lakes diverged
in summer: WTL was dominated by D. galeata, Bosmina, and Diaptomus
reighardi, but ETL by just D. galeata. Fall circulation was dominated
by Daphirra and Cyclops, and winter stagnation primarily by Cyclops in
both lakes.
3. Bottom Fauna. Bottom fauna are rare, presumably due to the
long anoxic period.Macroinvertebrates of ETL, identified primarily to
genus, as available in Wilbur (1974).
4. Fish. The fish are dominated by Centrarchidae, primarily
bluegill, black crappie, pumpkinseed, and largemouth bass. Fish size
has declined in recent years.
5. Bacteria. Fecal coliform bacteria in surface waters fell
from 200 colonies/100 ml. (swim beach on WTL was closed in 1970 and 1971)
before diversion to near 0 in surface waters to 10 colonies/100 ml. in
deep water in 1972 and 1973. Total bacteria/100 ml. ranged from 600-44,000
in both lakes in 1972, with the highest counts in the metalimnion and
at bottom. Surface inflows were highly contaminated with fecal coliforms
before diversion, particularly those flowing into WTL, where samples
contained 90,000 colonies/100 ml. or more (1971 and 1972). In 1973,
counts dropped to 0-600. Groundwater samples were not as contaminated
as surface drainage samples, except for wells located directly below
leach fields where colony counts/100 ml. ranged from 30-5000.
6. Bottom Flora. No studies of bottom flora have been conducted.
7. Macrophytes. This community ranks with at least equal
importance to algae as a nuisance. The distribution and biomass was
surveyed in 1972, using SCUBA (Rogers, 1974). The species are:
Ceratophyllum demersum L., Najas guadulapensis (Spreng) Magnus, Elpdea
canadensis Michx., Nuphar acTvenum (Ait) Ait., Potamogeton crispus L.,
and Chara vulgaris L (Chlorophyta). Macrophytes covered about 28% of
the lake area in ETL and 23% in WTL. P. crispus was dominant in early
summer, N. guadulapensis (Etl) and C. demersum (WTL) during the rest
of the season.Total dry weight in ETL declined from 200 kg. (July)
to 100 kg. (September); in WTL it declined from 80 kg. (July) to 50 kg.
(August). The total P04.-P content in ETL was about 2.5 kg., in WTL
about 1.5 kg. Nuphar contained about 6 kg. PO.-P.
264
-------
IV. NUTRIENT BUDGETS SUMMARY
A. Phosphorus
1. West Twin Lake kg./year
source
Waste Discharges
Land Runoff
Precipitation
Ground Water
Surface Streams
Total Inflow
Total Outflow 106.16 79.25 131.69*
2- East Twin Lake
Waste Discharges 0.00 O.UO 0.00
Land Runoff 66.12 34.53 24.97
Precipitation 6.20 5.24 7.17
Ground Water 5.31 17.25 19.60
Surface Streams 114.05 81.52 132.86
Total Inflow 191.00 138.22 184.62
Total Outilow 123.40 132.80 144.47
#Apparently due in part to sewer pipe leak in outflow of WTL (inflow of ETL)
B. Nitrogen (Total Combined Inorganic) kg. /year.
1. West Twin Lake 1972 1973
Waste Discharges 0.0 0.0
Land Runoff 2067.5 1957.5
Precipitation 1146.5 937.6
Ground Water 1301.9 1439.1
Surface Streams 937.4 763.9
Total Inflow 5453.3 5098.1
Total Outflow 3845.6 2048.6
2. East Twin Lake
Waste Discharges 0.0 0.0
Land Runoff 2714.2 1797.3
Precipitation 897.5 737.0
Ground Water 979.0 963.0
Surface Streams 3845.0 1688.2
Total Inflow 8435.7 5185.5
Total Outflow 6408.6 4371.4
265
-------
VI. DISCUSSION
East and West Twin Lakes are early eutrophic and mesotrophic.
respectively, with the trend in both (except ETL in 1974 after the
sewer leak) towards mesotrophy after sewage diversion. Evidence for
this is based primarily upon changing characteristics of the plankton.
If macrophytes are included, the lakes are eutrophic. Briefly the
basis for this is:
1. The oxygen deficits are lower than often found in eutrophic
lakes (Table 37).
2. While Aphanizomenon flos-aquae now dominantes the plankton, an
increasing fraction of the community is diatoms. Mean cell
volume (from Figure 3) for 1972-74 for WTL ranged from 1.05-
5.86; for ETL 3.44-6. 59/il./I. Vollenweider (1968) suggests
that 3r5/il./l. might be the borderline between mesotrophy and
eutrophy. Mean summer photic zone chlorophyll A (Table 34) is
on the low end of Sakamoto's (1966) range of 5-140 mg. ChlA/nr
for eutrophic lakes. Maximum net plankton community photosynthesis
(Table 36) has dropped, since diversion, from 3400 (ETL) to a
mean of 474 (ETL) and 575 mg.C/m2/day (WTL). These latter
values are in the range of borderline eutrophic lakes (Vollenweider,
1968).
3. Secchi disc transparency (Table 12) averages are like those of
moderately eutrophic lakes.
How well does the degree of eutrophy, as assessed above, compare to
that predicted by the loading models of Vollenweider QL968, 1973) and
Dillon (1974)? Data for the models are summarized in Table 40. The
log phosphorus loading—log mean depth (1968) model indicates the lakes
to be more eutrophic than they are, based on plankton data. The 1973
model (log phosphorus loading-log mean depth/water residence (Tw))
indicates the lakes to be moving towards mesotrophy, with WTL now (1974)
mesotrophic and ETL eutrophic. This position is supported by the evidence
about plankton presented above, and is due in large part to the low
water residence time. Dillon's model places both lakes well into the
eutrophic range, which they are not if only plankton-based indicators
are employed.
The Vollenweider (1973) model accurately predicts the degree of
eutrophication of the Twin Lakes, as described by characteristics related
primarily to plankton production. However, nearly half the productivity
of the lakes is due to macrophytes, and 25% of the area is littoral.
The lakes are in fact of poorer quality, particularly from the view of
the lake user than might be indicated by the mesotrophic label. For
planning or management purposes for lakes and watersheds of this type,
models based primarily on plankton characteristics may not tje applicable,
or are at least insensitive to the effects of very low mean depth. We
suggest a fruitful approach will include estimates of total community
productivity for lakes with a mean depth less than 10 m. and a ratio
of deep to shallow areas of less than 10 into classification models.
Perhaps the 1968 model, which includes a factor primarily related to
plankton biomass or productivity (phosphorus loading) and a factor
primarily related to macrophyte growth (mean depth) is most applicable
to shallow lakes, and the other models most applicable to deeper lakes.
266
-------
Table 40
Summary Hydrologlcal and Limnological Data for Lake Classification Models
A.
1 .
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
1 1 .
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20;
West Twin Lake
Lake Area (Ao), ha.
Lake Volume (V), m3 1
Mean Depth (2), M
Annual Outflow (Qo), m3
Annual 1 nf 1 ow (Q j ) , m*
Water Residence Time (Tw), yr.
V/Q
F 1 ush i ng Rate (p ) , Yr.~ 1
I/TW, Q/V
Areal Water Loading (?/Tw)
Phosphorus Loading (L), gms. P/m2/yr.
Outflow Phosphorus Amt. (L~Pna), kg./yr.
Inflow Phosphorus Amt. (L"P3j), kg./yr.
Retention Coefficient (ReXp)
"exp '
r\ , f p I
Ice Out, Mean Total P04-P Cone, (mg./m3)
Spring Circulation Period, Mean Total
P04-P Cone, (mg./m3)
Mean Summer Photic Zone Chlorophyl 1 A
Cone . (mg/m3 )
L (1 = Rovp)
P
Area of Land Drainage (Ad), ha.
Bas i n population ( C )
Per Capita Phosphorus Discharge (Ec)
Total Phosphorus Import ( [>3 j ) /Ad/yea r
1972
34.015
4.99 x I05
4.34
916835
I2I8I2I
1 .64
0.61
2.65
0.354
106. 16
120.52
0.337
212.0
137.0
28.58
0.205
184
-
65.5
1973 1974
34.015
1 4.99 x 1
4.34
826235
1 177684
1 .81
0.55
2.40
0.303
79.29
103.04
0.460
1 18.0
85.0
18.57
0.297
184
-
56.0
34.015
O5 14.99 x 1
4.34
1461576
1640332
1 .03
0.98
4.23
0.267
131 .69*
90.87
1 .291
94.0
78.0
23.54
-0.079*
184
1 124
0.08kg/
person/yea r
49.30
Og.
^Apparently an artifact. L~Pl!a [PiD in 1974 was partly caused by leaking
sewer line which crosses lake outlet.
267
-------
Table 40
Summary Hydrological and Limnological Data for Lake Classification Models
B.
1 .
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
1 1 .
12.
15.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20..
East Twin Lake
Lake Area (A0^» ha.
La ke Vo 1 ume ( V ) , m -1
Mean Depth (I), M
Annual Outflow (Qo) , m^
Annua 1 1 nf 1 ow (Q j ) , m3
Water Residence Time (Tw), Yr.
V/Q
F 1 ush i ng Rate ( p ) , Yr.~ '
I/TW, Q/V
Areal Water Loading (Z/TW)
Phosphorus Loading (L), gms . P/m^/yr.
Outflow Phosphorus Amt. (L~PHa), kg./yr.
Inflow Phosphorus Ami. ([P]j), kg-/yr.
Retention Coefficient (RexD^
90 CPDa
r - i
exp " Q| CP],
Ice Out, Mean Total P04~P Cone, (mg./m3
Spring Circulation Period, Mean Total
P04-P Cone, (mg./m3)
Mean Summer Photic Zone Chlorophyl 1 A
Cone, (mg./m-')
L (I _- Rexp)
P
Area of Land Drainage (Ad), ha.
Basin Population (C)
Per Capita Phosphorus Discharge (Ec)
Total Phosphorus Import ( [P] j ) /Ad/y r.
1972
26.88
1 3.50 x I05
5.03
1700006
1934340
0.79
1 .26
6.37
0.711
123.4
191.0
0.432
) 118.0
94.0
26.08
0.32 1
255
74.9
1973
26.88
13.50 x 1 O5
5.03
1444921
1678127
0.93
1 .07
5.4!
0.514
132.8
138.2
0. 173
75.0
65.0
19.14
0.397
255
54.20
1974
26.88
1 3.50 x 105
5.03
2307490
2458930
0.58
1.71
8.63
0.687
144.5
1 84.6
0.265
77.0
65.0
18.57
0.295
255
1510*
. 122kg/
cap i ta/yea r
72.39
(mg.P/M2/yr)
'^Includes West Twin Lake sub-watershed (184 ha.) since WTL drains
Into East Twin Lake. Drainage areas obtained by subtracting lake areas
from watershed area. Small lakes of watershed = 18 hectares. Watershed
area = 334 hectares.
268
-------
LITERATURE CITED
1. Cooke, G. D., T. N. Bhargava, M. R. McComas, M. C. Wilson, and
R. T. Heath,, 1973. Some aspects of the phosphorus dynamics
of the Twin Lakes Watershed. In Modeling the Eutrophication
Process. E. J. Middlebrooks, D. H. Falkenberg,and T.E^
Maloney (eds.). Utah Water Research Laboratory, Logan, Utah.
PRWG 136-1
2. Dillon, P. J. 1974. The phosphorus budget of Cameron Lake,
Ontario: The importance of flushing rate to the degree of
eutrophy of lakes. Limnol. Oceanogr. 20:28-39
3. Edmondson, W. T. 1966. Changes in the oxygen deficit of Lake
Washington. Verh. Int. Ver. Limnol. 16:153-158,
4. Heath, R. T. and G. D. Cooke. 1974. The significance of alkaline
phosphatase in a eutrophic lake. Verh. Int. Ver. Limnol.
19:(in press)
5. Heinz, M.H.E.F. 1971. A limnological study of the Twin Lakes,
Portage County, Ohio; the annual variations of microcrustacea,
and physical, chemical, and biological parameters. M.S. Thesis:
Kent State University
6. Lardis, A. E. 1973. A comparison of the seasonal distribution of
phosphorus in the sediments of two eutrophic lakes, Portage
County, Ohio. M.S. Thesis, Kent State University
7. Long, E. B. 1971. Biological and physical evidence of eutrophication
in an Ohio lake. M.S. Thesis, Kent State University
8. and G. D. Cooke. 1971. A quantitative comparison of
pigment extraction by membrane and glass-fiber filters.
Limnol. Oceanogr. 16:990-992
9. McNabb, C. D. 1960. Enumeration of freshwater phytoplankton
concentrated on the membrane filter. Limnol. Oceanogr. 5:57-61
10. Mehta, N. C., J. 0. Legg, C. A. I. Goring, and C. A. Black. 1954.
Determination of organic phosphorus in soils. I. Extraction
method. Soil Sci. Soc. Amer. Proc. 18:443-449
11. Ritchie, A. and K. L. Powell. 1973. An inventory of Ohio soils -
Portage County. Ohio DNR, Division of Lands and Soils. Progress
Report 38
12. Rogers, W. G. 1974. Productivity study and phosphorus analysis of
the macrophytes in two eutrophic lakes in Northeastern Ohio.
M.S. Thesis, Kent State University.
13. Sakamoto, M. 1966. The chlorophyll amount in the eutrophic zone
in some Japanese lakes and its significance in the photosynthetic
production of phytoplankton communities. Bot. Mag. Tokyo 79:77-88.
Z69
-------
14. Tailing, J. F. 1957. Photosynthetic characteristics of some
freshwater plankton diatoms in relation to underwater radiation.
New Phytol. 56:29-50
15. ___^ 1965. Comparative problems of phytoplankton pro-
ductlon and photosynthetic productivity in a tropical and
temperate lake. Mem. Inst. Itol. Idrobiol. 18(Suppl.):339-424
16. Vollenweider, R. A. 1968. Scientific fundamentals of the
eutrophication of lakes and flowing waters, with particular
reference to nitrogen and phosphorus as factors in eutrophication
OECD Tech. Rept., Paris DAS/CS1/68.27:1-182
17. 1973. Input-output models. Schwerz. Z.
Hydro 1". (in press)
18. Wilbur, D. L. 1974. The effect of aluminum sulfate applications
for eutrophic lake restoration on benthic macroinvertebrates
and the Northern Fathead Minnow (Pimephales Promelas Raf.)
M.S. Thesis, Kent State University
19. Winslow, J. D. and G. W. White. 1966. Geology and groundwater
resources of Portage County, Ohio. U.S.G.S. Prof. Paper 511
270
-------
SECTION V - OREGON
WALDO LAKE, OREGON
Charles F. Powers, William D. Sanville
and Frank S. Stay
Corvallis Environmental Research Laboratory
U. S. Environmental Protection Agency
Corvallis, Oregon
INTRODUCTION
Waldo Lake, the second largest lake in Oregon, is one of the most pristine
lakes on record. Located near the summit of the Cascade Mountains, the lake
was accessible only by foot or by a primitive road system until 1969, when a
paved road was constructed linking it with the Willamette Highway. Three large
campgrounds have been developed on the east side of the lake by the U.S. Forest
Service, and the lake has become subject to greatly increased summer recrea-
tional use over the past six years. The Environmental Protection Agency began
limnological studies in 1969 to investigate possible effects of development on
this unique lake. Except for the summers of 1969 and 1970, work has been con-
fined to one annual visit, in August or September, from 1970 to 1974. Results
from 1969 and 1970 have been reported by Malueg et al. (1972).
GEOGRAPHICAL DESCRIPTION OF WALDO LAKE
Waldo Lake is located at latitude 43°43'N, longitude 122°03'W, 1650 m
above mean sea level on the western slope of the Cascade Mountains (Fig. 1).
Precipitation amounts are moderately heavy, occurring for the most part in
the non-summer months (Table 1). Average yearly precipitation is approxi-
mately 180 cm. Evaporation is not measured at the lake, but is estimated as
approximately 109 cm annually from NOAA measurements in Detroit and Wickiup
Reservoir. Between 1969 and 1973, yearly extreme temperatures varied between
-30° and 38°C. Mean temperature for the period 1969-1972 was 6.0°C. (All
precipitation, evaporation, and temperature information is from U.S. Depart-
ment of Commerce, NOAA, Environmental Data Service, Climatological Data).
271
-------
45'41'00-N-f \\
I22'04'00"W •,
LANE COUNTY, ORE.
CONTOUR HTERVHL C METERS
DATE OF" SURVEY: 25,26 AUGUST »69
Figure 1. Bathymetrie map of Waldo Lake.
272
-------
Table 1
Precipitation Record, Waldo Lake
Ppt'n Since
Last Reading
Ppt'n Since
Date
Aug. '65
July '66
Aug.
Nov.
July '67
Oct.
Jan. '68
May
Aug.
Sept.
Oct.
Inches
Gage instal
54.20
0.20
12.80
—
3.70
18.80
25.10
5.15
—
4.05
Cm
led
137.7
0.5
32.5
—
9.4
47.8
63.8
13.1
—
10.3
Date
July '69
Oct.
Apr. '70
June
July
Sept.
April '71
Aug.
Oct. 7
Oct. 20
June '72
Inches
76.85
—
47.35
10.20
0.45
3.35
79.70
9.95
3.00
1.80
74.25
Cm
195.2
___
120.3
25.9
1.1
8.5
202.4
25.3
7.6
4.5
188.6
The lake is surrounded by coniferous forest, predominantly Douglas
fir, pine, and hemlock. A large meadow lies at the south end. The soil
mantle is generally less than 1 m thick, consisting of moderately weathered
volcanic materials and glacially rounded boulders up to 1.5 m in diameter.
Underlying bedrock is principally hard basalt. Numerous intermittent
streams, unchannelled runoff, and direct precipitation constitute the
lake's principal sources of water.
No permanent human population exists around the lake; however,
vacationers utilize camping facilities developed by the U. S. Forest
Service on the east side and the numerous hiking trails which radiate
from the area. This use is for the most part confined to the period
July 15-September 15. Fish production is low, and fishing is of
relatively minor importance. In 1973 the Forest Service estimated a
total of 27,900 vistor days for the campsites and 2100 additional, non-
camping visitor days by boaters and swimmers. Figures for 1972 were
16,400 and 2,500 visitor days. They estimate that use during 1971,
1970, and 1969 (when the campgrounds were opened) was comparable to
1972. Drinking water for two of the campgrounds is taken from the lake.
3
Estimated daily water usage during the 1973 season was 45 m , with a
season's total of 2700 m3.
273
-------
Sewage and effluent discharge is via septic tank drain fields and
drain seepage from outdoor faucets. The discharge volumes are not
measured and the quantity and chemical quality of the ground water
entering the lake is not known. Ground water and effluent movement away
from one septic tank drain field was measured in the summer of 1970
(Tilstra et al, 1973), but direct entrance of the effluent into the lake
was not demonstrated.
MORPHOMETRY AND HYDROLOGY
The combined area of Waldo Lake and its watershed is 7900 ha (79
p
km ). The maximum length of the lake is 9.6 km on an approximate N-S
axis; maximum width is 4.3 km, and the surface area is 2700 ha. Maximum
8 3
depth is 127 m, mean depth 35.6 m, and the volume, 9.5 x 10 m (0.95
o
km ). The greatest depth (127 m) occurs in a restricted hole in the
northwest part of the lake; this is closely matched by a 125 m
depression near the south end.
Thermal stratification has been observed each year, with an
epilimnion of 5-10 m thickness. The ratio of epilimnion to hypolimnion
(E/H) is roughly 0.3. Sufficient data are not at hand to permit
determination of the duration of stratification; it has been estimated
at five months.
Little information exists on the nature of the lake sediments. A
great deal of the bottom is rocky. Sediments taken from the 127 m
location contained 0.2% total P, 0.9% total N, and 5.1% total C (dry wt)
(Malueg et al). However, the areal extent of the sediments is not
known.
There are no permanent influent streams. The U. S. Geological
Survey maintains a recording gage on the outlet, the origin of the North
Fork of the Willamette River. The average outflow for the period 1969-
1973 was 44.7 x 106 m3/yr (1.42 m3/sec). The retention time of the
lake, calculated as volume/outflow, is 21.2 years.
274
-------
LIMNOLOGICAL CHARACTERIZATION
Limnological observations are made at nine stations, including the
two deep holes. Water quality differences from station to station are
slight, and in this report only data from the North Hole (the deepest
point in the lake) are reported.
PHYSICAL CHARACTERISTICS
As noted previously the lake stratifies thermally. Midsummer
surface temperatures range between 14° and 18° C; minimum deep water
temperatures of 3.9° and 3.8° C were observed in 1972 and 1974,
respectively. Temperatures from the North Hole for 1969-1974 are listed
in Table 2.
Table 2
North Hole
Temperature, °C
August
Depth, m
0
5
10
15
20
25
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
100
1969
16.6
16.6
13.1
9.8
7.9
6.7
6.1
5.3
5.0
4.6
4.4
4.3
4.2
4.1
1970
18.0
17.9
17.2
11.6
9.3
7.7
6.5
5.6
5.1
4.8
4.6
4.6
4.5
4.4
1971
17.5
16.8
12.0
10.0
8.0
7.8
6.4
5.5
5.1
4.9
4.6
4.5
4.5
4.4
1972
14.1
13.9
13.8
10.6
7.3
7.1
6.4
5.2
4.3
4.1
3.9
3.9
3.9
3.9
1973
16.5
16.0
13.6
10.5
9.1
8.0
7.4
6.3
5.7
5.3
4.8
4.6
4.4
4.4
1974
—
15.4
11.7
8.6
7.3
6.1
5.6
5.0
4.3
4.0
4.0
3.8
3.8
3.8
275
-------
Specific conductance of the lake waters is extremely low, ranging
between 2.0 and 5.0 ymhos/cm at 25°C (Table 3). This reflects the very
dilute concentration of all solutes for which determinations have been
made; total solids as determined by Malueg et al were nearly
undetectable at 3 mg/1.
Table 3
Specific Conductance, ymhos/cm @25°C
August
Depth, m 1969 1970
0 3.2
20 3.2
40 3.0
60 2.9
80 3.0
100 2.9
1971
3.4
3.1
2.9
2.9
2.9
2.8
1972
3.0
—
3.0
3.0
3.0
3.0
1973
4.0
3.9
3.8
3.6
3.5
3.5
1974
5.0
4.0
4.0
—
4.0
4.0
Measurements taken with a white 20-cm secchi disc have shown
considerable variation during our period of record. In 1969 values from
24.0 to 32.5 m were obtained between June and September. Observations
since 1969 have been as follows:
1970 — 27.5 m
1971 -- (missing)
1972 — 25.0 m
1973 -- 23.0 m
1974 -- 35.0 m
Fluctuations in secchi disc transparency appear to be caused by
meteorological conditions and coniferous pollen rather than by the
presence of phytoplankton.
276
-------
CHEMICAL CHARACTERISTICS
Total alkalinity (Table 4) ranges between 1.0 and 3.0 mg/1 (as
CaCO,), with essentially uniform distribution from surface to bottom.
Accurate determinations of pH are difficult because of the extremely low
buffering capacity and dissolved solids content of the water. Levels of
pH are consistently less than 7.0 except for the 1972 measurements,
which are suspect (Table 5). Measurements in 1974 were made with a
Hydrolab Surveyor Model 6D in situ water quality analyzer, and would be
expected to be of greater accuracy than earlier determinations made in
vitro.
Table 4
North Hole
Total Alkalinity
mg/1 CaC03
August
Depth, m
0
20
40
60
80
100
1969
2.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
1970
2.0
2.0
2.0
2.0
2.0
2.0
1971
—
2.0
2.0
2.0
1.0
2.0
1972
2.0
—
2.0
2.0
2.0
2.0
1973
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.0
3.0
1.0
1974
1.0
2.0
2.0
3.0
2.0
3.0
Depth, m
0
20
40
60
80
100
1969
5.5
5.4
5.3
5.3
5.2
5.2
1970
6.6
6.3
6.2
6.2
6.4
6.3
Table 5
North Hole
pH
August
1971
6.3
6.3
6.3
6.3
6.1
6.0
1972
7.1
7.1
7.2
7.1
6.8
1973
1974
6.4
5.6
6.0
5.0*
5.3*
5.1*
*Data from South Hole
277
-------
Dissolved oxygen exhibits an orthograde distribution as would be
expected in such an extremely unproductive lake. Epilimnetic values are
usually about 2 mg/1 lower than at greater depths. Percent saturation
varies between 89 and 114, and is usually very near 100 percent.
Dissolved oxygen distribution is summarized in Table 6.
Table 6
North Hole
Dissolved Oxygen, mg/1
August
Depth, m
0
20
40
60
80
100
1969
8.1
10.3
11.2
10.8
10.9
10.7
1970
7.7
10.4
10.8
10.7
10.8
9.4
1971
8.2
9.8
10.4
10.2
10.7
10.2
1972
8.5
--
10.5
10.5
11.0
10.6
1973
8.5
10.8
11.2
11.2
11.2
11.2
1974
8.1
10.2
10.8
10.1
10.0
9.5
Phosphorus measurements have consisted of total and orthophosphate
phosphorus. Concentrations of both forms are consistently below 5 yg/1,
and significant differences or trends cannot be distinguished within the
limits of the analytical technique. Nitrite, nitrate, and ammonia
nitrogen are almost invariably below this laboratory's minimum detection
limit of 10 ug/1 and apparent differences are probably due to analytical
limitations.
Chlorophyll ^determinations have been made on North Hole samples
for each year of the study. The reliability of the data for 1971 and
1972 are uncertain, although the expected very low pigment levels were
indicated. Chlorophyll a_ was not detectable in the 1973 samples.
Measurements for 1969, 1970, and 1974 are given in Table 7. Values are
consistently below 1.0 vig/1, and exhibit no trends over the five year
period of record.
278
-------
Table 7
North Hole
Chlorophyll a_
U9/1
Depth Sept. August August
m 1969 1970 1974
0 0.4 0.1 0.2
20 0.6 0.1 0.1
40 0.2 0.4 0.1
60 0.2 0.6 0.2
80 0.6 0.7 0.2
100 0.5 0.2 0.4
Primary productivity measurements by Larson and Donaldson (1970)
showed an average carbon uptake rate in the summer of 1969 of 38 mg
2
C/m /day. Powers et al (1972) showed carbon uptake rates in the summer
•j
of 1970 ranging between 0.03 and 0.10 mg C/m /hr. Both sets of data
indicate extremely low productivity rates.
Laboratory algal assay tests were conducted on Waldo Lake water by
Miller et al (1974). Autclaved-filtered water did not support growth
beyond 0.06 mg dry wt/1, even with the addition of 1.0 mg N/l and 0.05
mg P/l. However, in the in situ primary productivity experiments
carried out by Powers et al, addition of 0.05 mg P/l alone increased
photosynthetic rate on three of four occasions. The influence of
phosphorus plus nitrogen was not significantly different from the effect
of phosphorus alone.
Summaries of algal cell counts and group identifications are
presented in Table 8. Clump counts were made on a Sedgwick-Rafter
cell, using concentrated samples prepared by settling 500 ml to 50 ml
over a 12-day period. In the clump count method, all unicellular,
colonial, and aggregated organisms are tallied as single units, and have
equal numerical weight. Samples obtained in 1973 and 1974 have not been
processed.
279
-------
Table 8
North Hole
Phytoplankton
organisms/ml
0
10
20
30
21
21
2
7
94
103
67
19
86
20
30
40
70
10
10
2
4
19
25
2
197
199
1969
Depth,
40
10
10
90
110
1970
10
10
10
1971
20
2
22
1972
594
5
599
m
60
30
150
180
10
10
^
10
184
2
186
2
857
859
80
10
190
200
10
10
177
10
187
3
379
381
100
10
10
120
140
100
1
101
728
728
Diatoms
Greens
Blue-greens
Dinoflagellates
Unknown
Total
Diatoms
Greens
Blue-Greens
Dinoflagellates
Unknown
Total
Diatoms
Greens
Blue-Greens
Dinoflagellates
Unknown
Total
Diatoms
Greens
Blue-Greens
Dinoflagellates
Unknown
Total
Although Larson and Donaldson (1970) reported an average of 4.5
organisms per #6 net tow near shore, Malueg et al reported no
zooplankton. Repeated vertical tows from the deep stations and near
shore horizontal tows, using a 0.5 m #10 plankton net, have failed to
produce a single zooplankter during our entire study.
The extreme clarity of the lake is emphasized by the presence of
the hepatic, Jungermannia triris Nees, and a moss Hygrohypnum
(molle?), at the bottom of the North Hole at 127*m.
280
-------
NUTRIENT BUDGETS
Sources of nutrients to Waldo Lake are precipitation (principally
snow), intermittent surface runoff, and ground water. Septic tank
drainage from campgrounds is a presumed source, although the 1973 study
did not demonstrate transport of effluent to the lake. There are no
permanent tributaries. The 30,000 visitor days estimated by the Forest
Service for 1973, when prorated over an entire year, are equivalent to a
permanent population of 82 persons (30,000/365 = 82). Assuming an
average phosphorus loading rate of 1.1 kg P/capita/yr, this amounts to
93 kg P/yr, or 0.003 g P/m2/yr to the lake.
Lacking measurements of surface and ground water contributions, it
is not possible to measure directly the nutrient loadings to the lake.
Phosphorus and nitrogen budgets have therefore been calculated by
several different indirect methods. Constants used in the calculations
include:
Average annual precipitation = 181.4 cm
Estimated annual evaporation = 109 cm
Catchment area of lake (including lake surface) = 7900 ha
Surface area of lake = 2700 ha
/• ^
Average outflow from lake = 45 x 10 m /yr
Average total P concentration of outflow = 3.5 yg/1
Average total P concentration of lake =3.5 ug/1
Average total P concentration of precipitation on catchment area =
5 yg/1 (after Malueg et al)
Average N concentration of precipitation on catchment area =
83 yg/1 (after Malueg et al).
281
-------
PHOSPHORUS
1. Using information from Vollenweider (Input-Output Models),
assume that P loading is three times the measured lake concentration and
also (in this case) three times the measured phosphrous flowing out of
the lake:
Measured P out = 157.5 kg/yr
P in = 3 x 157.5 = 472.5 kg/yr = 0.0175 g P/m2/yr.
2. Using unpublished data of Miller, assume from the innate
characteristics of the watershed that P loading to Waldo Lake is the
same as that from undisturbed forest land in the Upper Klamath Lake,
o
Oregon, drainage (5.25 kg/km /yr):
Waldo Lake watershed = 5200 ha
5200 x 0.052 kg P/ha/yr = 270 kg P/yr = 0.01 g P/m2/yr.
3. Using average annual precipitation for the Waldo Lake
watershed, and snow analyses of Malueg et al:
(a) Assume that all precipitation onto the watershed eventually
enters the lake, and that the total P content of the
3
precipitation is 5 mg P/m :
(143.4 x 106 m3 water) (5 mg P/m3) = 716.5 kg
P/yr to lake = 0.027 g P/m2/yr.
(b) Assume that only that part of the precipitation equal to
the measured outflow plus the estimated evaporation from
the lake actually enters the lake:
282
-------
measured outflow = 45 x 10 m /yr
est. evaporation = 29 x TO m /yr
runoff to lake = 74 x 106 m3/yr, (74 x 106)(5 mg P)
= 370 kg P/yr = 0.014 g P/m2/yr.
4. Using information from Vollenweider and Dillon (1974), Tables
2
5 and 6, assume a total P soil export factor of 0.010 g total P/m of
land/year. This is the value used by Patalas (1972) for Lake Superior
(igneous forested land).
Area of Waldo Lake watershed = 5200 ha
5200 x 0.01 = 5.2 x 105 g/m2 P from watershed soil/year.
Assume remainder of P loading is via direct precipitation onto lake
surface:
(1.81 m3 ppt'n/yr)(27 x 106 m2 lake surface)
/TO O
= 48.87 x 10 m ppt'n onto lake surface x 5 mg P/m
= 2.4 x 105 g P.
5.2 x 105 g P from soil + 2.4 x 105 g P from ppt'n
= 7.6 x 105 g P to lake = 0.028 g P/m2/yr.
NITROGEN
Total nitrogen loading to the lake has been estimated by methods 2,
3a, and 3b (above). Method 1, in which measured output was related to
input in the phosphorus estimates, has not been attempted for nitrogen
because estimates of nitrogen retention in lakes are even more tenuous
than for phosphorus. Method 4 could not be used because of lack of
information on soil loading.
283
-------
Method 2. Using unpublished data of Miller for the Upper Klamath
2
Lake watershed, assume N loading = 22 kg/km /yr:
Waldo Lake watershed = 5200 ha
5200 x 0.22 kg N/ha/yr = 1144 kg N/yr = 0.042 g N/m2/yr.
Method 3a. Using average annual precipitation for the Waldo Lake
watershed, and snow analyses of Malueg et al:
(a) Assume that all precipitation onto the catchment area
eventually enters the lake, and that total N content is
83 mg N/m3: (143.3 x 106) (83 mg N/m3) = 11,894 kg N/yr
to lake = 0.44 g N/m2/yr.
fi ^
(b) Assume that runoff to lake = 74 x 10 m /yr (outflow plus
evaporation):
(74 x 106)(83 mg N) = 6142 kg N/yr = 0.23 g N/m2/yr.
DISCUSSION
All available limnological criteria confirm the extremely pristine
state of Waldo Lake. Comparisons with Crater Lake and Lake Tahoe, two
other well-known ultraoligotrophic lakes, show that Waldo Lake's
specific conductance is one to two orders of magnitude less and its
total dissolved solids an order of magnitude less. Secchi disc values
for Waldo fall within the range for Tahoe and Crater. Based on our 1969
and 1970 measurements, primary productivity in Waldo is significantly
less than in the other two, as are phytoplankton numbers. As stated
earlier, zooplankton have not been found at any time during our
investigations of Waldo Lake.
284
-------
Based on the calculated loading rates for phosphorus and nitrogen,
Waldo Lake falls near the extreme lower end of the "Vollenweider scale."
Using the highest rates yielded by the several estimates,
P = 0.028 g P/m2/yr
N = 0.44 g N/m2/yr
(N/P loading ratio = 15.7).
The ratio of mean depth to retention time is 1.68. Because of this low
value, the lake, when entered on a plot of P loading vs mean
depth/retention time, falls near the lower left portion of the diagram
in the critical part of the oligotrophic region, implying that a
relatively slight increase in phosphorus loading could strongly alter
the trophic status. Such an implication appears to be substantiated by
the primary productivity experiments of Powers et al where phosphorus
was shown to stimulate photosynthetic activity. However, Miller et al
were unable to increase algal production with an addition of phosphorus
alone or phosphorus plus nitrogen, indicating that nutrients in addition
to nitrogen and phosphorus were limiting to algal growth. This could
well be the case in a lake where all dissolved constituents are in very
low concentration. The relative importance of phosphorus in Waldo Lake
is therefore uncertain, but there is no question that introduction of
nutrient or polluting materials of any kind to such a unique resource
should be held to a minimum. Increased concentrations of micronutrients
could result in a condition where slight increases in phosphorus loading
could significantly change the trophic state.
SUMMARY
Waldo Lake, in the Cascade Mountains of Oregon, is extremely
oligotrophic, ranking amount the most pristine lakes of the world. The
recent development of access roads and campground facilities has raised
285
-------
questions concerning the possible response of the lake to the pressures
of increased recreational use, and was the primary reason for the
inception of our studies. The lake has no permanent tributaries, and
the hydrologic and nutrient budgets are not amenable to accurate
measurement. Several different methods of estimation place the rates of
2
phosphrous and nitrogen loading at 0.028 and 0.44 g/m yr, respectively.
The N/P loading ratio is 15.7. On the "Vollenweider scale" the lake is
definitely oligotrophic, but lies in that area of the diagram where
relatively small increases in P loading are significant. However, the
relative importance of phosphorus in Waldo Lake is uncertain because of
the very low concentrations of all measured nutrients.
REFERENCES
Larson, D. W., and J. R. Donaldson. 1970. Waldo Lake, Oregon: A
special study. Water Resources Research Institute Report No. 2,
Oregon State Univ. 21 p.
Malueg, K. W., J. R. Tilstra, D. W. Schults and C. F. Powers. 1972.
Limnological observations on an ultraoligotrophic lake in Oregon,
U.S.A. Verh. Internat. Verein. Limnol., 18:292-302.
Miller, W. E., Pacific Northwest Environmental Research Laboratory,
Corvallis, Oregon. Personal Communication.
Miller, W. E., T. E. Maloney, and J. C. Greene. 1974. Algal
productivity in 49 lake waters as determined by algal assays.
Water Research, 8:667-679.
National Oceanographic and Atmospheric Administration, Environmental
Data Service. 1969-1973. Climatological Data. Vols. 75-79.
Patalas, K. 1972. Crustacean plankton and the eutrophication of the
St. Lawrence Great Lakes. J. Fish. Res. Bd. Canada, 29:1451-1462.
286
-------
Powers, C. F., D. W. Schults, K. W. Malueg, R. M. Bn'ce, and M. D.
Schuldt. 1972. Algal responses to nutrient additions in natural
waters. II. Field experiments. Iru Nutrients and
Eutrophication, Special Symposia, Vol. I, Amer. Soc. Limnol.
Oceanog., p. 141-154.
Tilstra, J. R., K. W. Malueg, and C. F. Powers. 1973. A study on
disposal of campground wastes adjacent to Waldo Lake, Oregon.
Working Paper #7, Pacific Northwest Environmental Research
Laboratory, EPA, Corvallis, OR, 22 p.
Vollenweider, R. A. Input-output models. Unpublished manuscript.
Vollenweider, R. A., and P. J. Dillon. 1974. The application of the
phosphorus loading concept to eutrophication research. National
Research Council Canada Rpt. No. 13690, Ottawa, Ontario. 42 p.
287
-------
SECTION VI - WASHINGTON
LAKE WASHINGTON
W. T. Edmondson
Department of Zoology
University of Washington
Seattle, Washington
I. INTRODUCTION
A. History. In its natural state, Lake Washington drained from the south
end through the Black River into the Duwamish estuary and Puget Sound. It had
one major inlet, the Sammamish River from Lake Sammamish, and about a dozen
small streams. In the 1890s a small cut was made between Union Bay of Lake
Washington and Portage Bay of Lake Union to permit passage of logs to a sawmill.
Later this cut was enlarged and a canal with locks made, between Lake Union and
Puget Sound. It opened in 1916, at which time the level of the lake was lowered
by about 3.3 m (10 feet) and the Cedar River was diverted into the south end of
the lake. In the 1940s and 1950s small amounts of salt water entered Lake
Washington and formed a transitory layer of very dilute sea water in the deep-
est parts. The latest intrusion was in 1952.
II. GEOGRAPHIC DESCRIPTION
A. Latitude 47° 38' N. Longitude 122° 14.5' W.
B. The level of the lake is regulated between 6.1 and 6.7 m above mean
low water in Puget Sound except in unusually dry years. The lowest level,
5.6 m, occurred in 1958.
C. The catchment area of land including Mercer Island in the lake is
1588 km2. The water area is 88 km2, total 1676 km2.
D. General climatic data (1931>-1960). Monthly mean air temperatures
vary from 5.1°C (41.2°F) in January to 18.67°C (65.6°F) in July.
Rainfall varies from a monthly mean of 1.6 cm (0.63 in.) in July to
13.77 cm (5.42 in.) in December. Yearly mean 86.61 cm (34.1 in.), range
48.58 cm to 114.07 cm.
In general, winds are from the southerly directions most frequently in
winter, northerly in summer. The strongest winds come from southwest in spring
or early summer. The mean velocity at Sand Point is 11.1 km/hr (6.9 mph).
Total evaporation is about the same as the rainfall with an average excess
of rainfall of about 3 cm. Net monthly evaporation varies from -14.1 cm to
+13.1 cm. 288
-------
The lake never freezes across. In the most severe winters
thin ice can develop in the bays, but this is a rare occurrence.
E. General geological characteristics. The lake occupies
a deep, narrow through sculptured by the Vashon ice sheet. Most
of the upland area is occupied with glacial till covered with a
few feet of weathered soil. In the lowland valleys, alluvial
deposits of clay are prevalent with sand and gravel deposits in
places. Erosion appears not to be a major problem.
F. Vegetation.
The original vegetation was a thick forest dominated
by Douglas fir (Pseudotsuga menziesii), red cedar (Thuja
plicata) and western hemlock (Tsuga heterophylla). Spruce
(Picea si t chens is) and fir (Abies grandis) were less common
(Scott, 1962). Red alder (Alnus rubra) and cottonwood
(Populus trichocarpa) were the only abundant deciduous trees.
They grew on river floodplains and as pioneer trees on other
disturbed sites.
The second- or third-growth forests currently around
Seattle have a different distribution of species. In cut-
over areas, red alder has become much more abundant, some-
times being the dominant species for a time. Alder dominance
last 30-50 years, until conifers regenerate and overtop the
alder. The success of alder varies, depending on soils and
fire. Douglas fir grows with alder in many areas, cottonwood
is sometimes common and willow is an important pioneer on
other sites. Burning of slash and brush after clear-cutting,
a frequent occurrence in the early years of this century,
destroyed the conifer seed in the soil, encouraging the
growth of alder, which has abundant and easily transported
seeds. Large areas from which conifers had been removed
completely were without a source for conifer seed and went
over completely to alder forest and brush (modified from
Davis, 1973).
The Cedar River watershed is under control of the Seattle
Water Department. While it has been intensively managed, the
characteristics of the soil are such that erosion into the
Cedar River is not a serious problem.
G. Population. The lowland area is heavily urbanized, but
most of the Cedar River watershed is fenced and uninhabited because
it is the major source of water for the metropolitan area. The
city of Seattle borders much of the west side of the lake and
several small towns are at the ends and on the east side. The
human population within the Lake Washington watershed is approxi-
mately 525,000.
289
-------
H. Land use. In the Lake Washington watershed, land use
includes residential, commercial and industrial, but large areas
are undeveloped. Intensive lumbering takes place in the Cedar River
watershed, which is otherwise largely undeveloped. A relatively
small amount of agriculture is done, mostly in the Sammamish River
area.
Shoreline use: residential, 64.5%; recreation, 19.0; unde-
veloped, 7.1; public service, 3.7; industrial, 2.8; commercial,
1.6; private club, 0.8; circulation and utilities, 0.5.
I. Use of water. To a large extent Lake Washington is used
as a recreational amenity for boating, fishing and swimming. Com-
mercial traffic on the lake consists mainly of rafted logs and of
barges of sand and gravel in transit to construction companies.
A commercial flying service at the north end of the lake and about
thirty private planes use the lake for landing.
A Naval Air Station at Sand Point was partly deactivated in
1970, and recently a large part of the area has been released for
two developments. One will be a public park, the other will be
an establishment at which NOAA will station its ships and have
some research and administrative activities.
The lake itself is no longer used as a general source of
drinking water, but the Cedar River is a primary source of water
for Seattle and a number of smaller towns in the area. It is
also a spawning area for an important run of sockeye salmon, so
there is public pressure to maintain an adquate flow.
An unusual feature of Lake Washington is the two multilane
floating bridges that carry more than 85,000 vehicle crossings per
day.
J. Sewage. The maximum input of treated secondary effluent
took place in 1962, for in March 1963 a program of diversion was
put into effect. The amount of sewage was progressively decreased
from about 76,000 m per day (20 million gallons), and the project
was finished in 1968. Seattle has had combined sewer systems with
storm overflows into Lake Washington. At the present, a project
of sewer separation is being carried out. There has been no major
source of industrial waste, although the Boeing Company put a waste
rich in phosphate into the Cedar River in the 1950s. In the late
1950s some of the streams carried septic tank overflow, but this
has been greatly reduced by local sewerage projects.
III. Description of Lake Washington.
A. Area 87.615 km2
Length 21 km
Width: maximum 5.5 km, mean about 3
290_
-------
B. Volume 2885.3 million m3
C. Maximum depth 62.5 m (approx)
Average depth 32.9 m
D. The deepest parts are shallow grooves or troughs between
the middle and sides. About 83% of the lake is deeper than 10 m.
E. Typically the epilimnion is 10 m thick, and the E:H ratio
then is 0.387.
F. The lake is monomictic. Secure stratification is usually
established about the middle of May, although in calm years tran-
sitory stratification occurs in April and in windy years stratifi-
cation may be delayed until June. Maximum temperature occurs in
August. The lake begins to cool then and the epilimnion thickens
progressively until homothermal conditions are established in
November or December. During very cold weather, cold water masses
form in the shallower bays and slide down to the bottom of the lake
and out toward the middle, causing decreases in temperature that
cannot be accounted for by mixing.
G. The deep sediments are a black planktogenic gyttja, dominated
by diatom frustules. In shallow water most of the bottom is covered
with boulders, gravel and sand.
H. At Seattle the maximum mean monthly rainfall is 13.8 cm
(5.42 in) in December, the minimum 1.6 cm (0.63 in) in July. The
extremes for individual months have been a trace in July and 38.9
cm (15.33 in) in January 1880. The maximum during the period of
recovery from eutrophication was 25.6 cm (10.07 in) in December
1968. Annual total rainfall has varied from 143.4 cm in 1879 to
49.6 cm in 1952 (56.44 in to 19.52 in). Rainfall is greater in
the upper part of the Cedar River watershed and heavy snows occur
in some years.
I. Inflow and outflow of water. According to calculations
by a hydrological model developed for METRO, the mean volume of
water entering-through all inlets in the period 1942-1972 was
1211 million m per year. The minimum was 466.9 million m in
1944 and the maximum 1681.8 million m in 1950. The Cedar River
is responsible for about half the total flow. Of the rest, the
Sammamish River contributes about 72%, the other 28% being brought
in by the various small streams around the lake. Thus, the two
main rivers account for about 86% of the total inflow,
3
The mean rainfall of 0.8661 m amounts to about 75.9 million m
falling directly on the lake. The volume of the lake is 2885.3
million m .
Nothing quantitative is known about ground water.
291
-------
J. Surface water currents have been studied by METRO using
dye patches and streaks. No consistent current pattern exists.
The drift from inlets to outlet is masked by wind-blown currents,
but the movement of water is not clearly and directly related
to momentary wind direction, evidently because of the constraints
of the shores, and because of delayed effects of previous wind
conditions.
K. Water renewal time. By dividing the volumes of inflow
listed in Part I above into the volume of the lake, the following
retention times for calendar years are obtained: mean 2.38 years,
maximum 6.18 years (1944), minimum 1.72 years (1950). For 1957
when the first loading was calculated, it was 2.97 years by the
model, 3.32 by calculations using U.S.G.S. gauge data.
The reciprocals of the numbers given above, the renewal rates
per year are, in order: 0.420, 0.162, 0.583, and for 1957 (model)
0.336.
IV. Limnological characterization.
A. Physical
1. Temperature. Surface temperature in the open water
varies from about 6 to about 25 C. The maximum temperature at
the bottom in summer is about 8 .
2. Conductivity in recent years has varied between 76 and
87 ymhos.
3. Light. Some measurements of light penetration have been
made with a photometer and many Secchi disc measurements of trans-
parency taken. During the period of eutrophication at a time when
the Secchi disc transparency was 1.1 m, 10% of the surface light
intensity occurred at 2.4 m. During the period of de-eutrophication,
Secchi values have increased, and the maximum value ever observed,
7.5 m, occurred in February 1975. The largest summer value ever
observed, 5.5 m, occurred in July, 1975.
4. Lake Washington has no measureable humic color. When
the lake is clearest in the winter, the Secchi disc appears green.
5. Solar radiation. During June-September, the mean daily
solar radiation has varied between 391 and 468 langleys.
B. Chemical
1. The maximum pH occurs during the spring and summer when
primary production is maximum. The highest value in 1933 was 8.6.
292
-------
During the eutrophic years it got as high as 9.9 in 1963 and progress-
ively decreased over the years, getting down to 8.5 in 1973, although
it went back to 8.96 in 1974.
2. Dissolved oxygen. Although large volumes of the lake did
not become anoxic during the period of eutrophication, values less
than 5.0 were prevalent in late summer. Since diversion of sewage,
oxygen concentrations in the hypolimnion remain in the order of 8
mgm/1.
3. Total phosphorus has varied greatly over the years with
different degrees of eutrophication. The maximum annual mean was
65.7 yg/1 in 1963, minimum 16.8 in 1973. Mean dissolved inorganic
phosphate P in January-March was 56.9 yg/1 in 1964, 8.8 in 1972.
4. Nitrogen has varied considerably, but not as much as
phosphorus. The mean in January-March of inorganic N was 495 yg/1
in 1965, 313 in 1973.
5. Alkalinity has not varied a great deal, being about 20-30
yg/1 expressed as CaCO .
6. Few complete ion analyses are available for Lake
Washington. A typical analysis, from 1969, is:
Ca 8.8 HCO 40.0 TDS 54
Mg 3.3 SO/3 8.2
Na 4.6 Cl4 3.1 (all as mg/1)
K 1.1 SiO 8.6
7. Few trace metal analyses has been published for the
water of Lake Washington, although there is considerable interest
in the sediments. The lake has been relatively enriched in a
number of trace elements by emissions from a smelter near Tacoma
40 miles to the south.
C. Biological
1. Phytoplankton
a. Chlorophyll. The mean chlorophyll in summer was
41.0 yg/1 in 1964, 4.8 in 1973.
b. Primary production (see Table 1).
c. Algal assays. In recent years, the natural
population of phytoplankton has tended to respond to addition of
phosphate more than to addition of nitrate in bottle tests. In
the mid 1960s when the lake was still enriched with sewage, it
tended not to be responsive to added phosphate.
293
-------
d. Lake Washington has characteristically had a
spring bloom of diatoms dominated by Stephanodiscus, Fragilaria,
Melosira and Asterionella. In 1933 and 1950, the summer population
was mostly a small mixture o£ species of green algae and some
flagellates. During the period of eutrophication this basic
pattern had superimposed on it a dense population of blue-green
algae in the summer. The blue-greens included Oscillatoria
rubescens, 0_. agardhii, Micro cyst is, Anabaena and A phanizomenon.
2. Zooplankton. The most abundant zooplankton include
Diaptomus. ashlandi, Epischura lacustris, two species of Cyclops,
Diaphanosoma leuchtenbergianum and Bosmina longirostris. Several
species of rotifers become prominent, the most prevalent being
Keratella cochlearis and Kellicottia longispina.
3. The bottom fauna is dominated by a variety of
chironomids, with lesser numbers of tubificids and small molluscs
(Pisidium).
4. Fish. A variety of species of fish live in the lake.
Of special interest is the sockeye salmon (Onehorhynchus nerka)
which became abundant in 1964 and is heavily fished.
5. Bacteria. Dr. James Staley is studying the bacteria
with special attention to Metallogenium and Caulobacter.
6. Bottom flora and macrophytes. No systematic study
appears to have been made. Genera growing in shallows include
Potamogeton, Myriophyllum, Naj as, Anacharis, and Ceratophyllum.
Emergent plants include Scirpus, Typha and Sagittaria.
V. Nutrient Budget Summary.
The nutrient input to the lake varied greatly with the increase
of sewage and then with the diversion. Data are summarized
in Table 2.
294
-------
Table 1. Primary production in Lake Washington
A. Gross oxygen production, g/m^/day in 24 hour runs
July-Aug. June-Sept.
1-958 4.2
1963
1964
1965
1966
1967
1968
1969
1970
1971
1972
1973
1974
1975
1976
4.2
3.0
4.8
5.2
4.6
2.7
3.3
0.9
1.2
1.8
1.4
1.8
1.2
4.0
3.8
4.6
4.7
3.3
3.7
2.7
3.0
1.1
1.4
2.0
1.4
1.7
1.0
Year
2.1
1.9
2.0
3.3
3.7
2.2
2.3
2.0
1.9
0.9
1.2
1.3
1.3
1.4
0.8
B.
14
C fixation in 24 hour runs
Annual
1972
1973
1974
1975
1976
Mean
mg/m^/day
198
282
371
187
Total
gm/m^/year
72
103
135
68
June-Sept.
f\
mg/m^/day
246
265
353
493
219
Note: Measurements of carbon uptake rates were started in 1963,
but were not done often enough to permit calculation of means
in the earlier years.
295
-------
Table 2. Nutrient income to Lake Washington, kg/year
A. Income
1957
Phosphorus
Streams
Sewage plant effluent
Industrial waste (est.)
Septic tank drainage (est.)
Combined sewer overflow (est.)
Total wastes
Total (full)
Total - septic tanks
- combined sewers
Nitrogen
Streams
Sewage plant effluent
Industrial waste (est.)
Septic tank drainage (est.)
Combined sewer overflow (est.)
Total wastes
Total (full)
Total - septic tanks
- combined sewers
Total P
42,600
42,100
7,800
8,600
7,100
65,600
108,200
99,600
92,500
Total N
1,471,000
172,600
1,688,900
1,672,800
1,654,200
Dissolved P
36,000
37,900
7,800
7,800
6,500
60,000
96,000
88,200
81,700
Dissolved N
1,331,000
133,300
10,600
16,100
18,600
178,600
1,509,600
1.493.500
1,474,900
Nitrate-N
253,100
19,600
272,700
Data from Hollis M. Phillips, Seattle Department of Engineering.
Stream values based on measurements of concentration and flow. Flow
data for two rivers and two small streams from U.S.G.S. Other flow data
estimated from drainage area. Septic tank drainage, combined sewer over-
flow and industrial waste estimates from Brown and Caldwell. The full
total of all items listed is probably an overestimate since some of the
septic tank drainage would have entered the streams and appeared in the
measurements there. The underlined totals are probably the best to use.
1962
Phosphorus
Streams
Sewage plant effluent
Combined sewer overflow
Total
Total P
80,900
128,300
21,600
230,800
This was the year of maximum sewage input but no measurements were made.
Diversion started in March 1963. To obtain the figures listed, sewage
plant effluent was calculated by proportion with the populations served
by the treatment plants in 1962 and 1964 (see below). Combined sewer
overflow was estimated by proportion with the estimate of 1957 and the
sewage plant effluent. Septic tank drainage was ignored, since many of
296
-------
Table 2. (Continued)
the formerly unsewered areas were now sewered. A sewage treatment
plant served the town of Bothell on the Sammamish River from 1959 to
March 1967, and the effluent went into the river where the nutrients
would appear in the stream analyses. The population served by the
plant was 2,460 in 1962 and 2,600 in 1964.
1964
Phosphorus
Total P
Streams 80,900
Sewage plant effluent 103,900
Combined sewer overflow 17,500
Total 202,308
Nitrogen
Total Organic N Inorganic N Sum
Streams 380,500 527,000 907,500
Sewage plant effluent 271,000 33,000 304,000
Combined sewer overflow 45,700 5,600 51,300
Total 697,200 565,600 1,262,800
Data from Municipality of Metropolitan Seattle. By 1964, three of the
sewage treatment plants had been diverted. In 1957 they had contributed
34.2% of the dissolved P and 33.2% of the total P. However, the popula-
tion served by each plant had increased. Combined sewer overflow was
calculated as for 1962. Inorganic N means nitrate and nitrite.
1970-1974
Streams only
Total P Dissolved P* Total Organic N Nitrate-N
1970 43,700 442,600
1971 37,600 401,600 559,800
1972 91,200 21,240 647,800 719,900
1973 26,800 14,000 807,200 398,400
1974 41,300 16,700 386,900 453,300
1975 66,300 7,300 607,900 640,500
*Perchloric acid
digestion of filtered
sample
Sewage diversion started in 1963 and was finished early in 1968, although
most had been diverted by 1967. Floods in the Cedar River in early 1972
and in winter 1975-1976 brought in much silt, accounting for the ele-
vated phosphorus input in those years. The 1972 flood was accompanied
by more erosion and landslides than the later one.
297
-------
Table 2. (Continued)
B. Loading
The values in Part A were used to calculate the annual loading figures.
The area of the lake is 87,615 thousand m , the volume is 2,853.0 million
the mean depth 32.9 m.
tn3,
1957
1962
1964
1970
1971
1972
1973
1974
1975
Inflow
Thousands m-*
973,600
964,400
1,554,061
1,207,800
1,539,706
1,513,606
898,300
1,329,300
1,479,740
Total P
g/m2-year
1.2
2.6
2.3
0.5
0.43
1.0
0.31
0.47
0.76
Dissolved P
g/m^'year
1.1
Inflow
0.24
0.16
0.19
0.08
Lake Volume
0.338
0.334
0.539
0.419
0.534
0.525
0.311
0.461
0.513
Hydraulic
loading
11.
11.
17.
13.8
17.6
17.3
10.2
15.2
16.9
All the values in this table involve a certain amount of estimation
and extrapolation since measurements of flow and concentration were not
made in all the small inlet streams each year. There is more than one
way to approximate some of the values, as by proportion with watershed
area, by regression of one stream that has been gauged only part of the
time on one that has a complete record, or by hydrological calculation.
The most elaborate study of the small streams was made in 1957 by the
Seattle Engineering Department (Hollis M. Phillips, personal communica-
tion; see Edmondson 1972). In 1957, 10 small permanent streams contri-
buted 8.8% of the water, 13.5% of the total phosphorus, 24.7% of the
phosphate, 30.3% of the nitrate, and 15.2% of the Kjeldahl nitrogen.
The chemical content of the small streams is more like that of the Sam-
mamish River than of the Cedar, and the following proportions of the
Sammamish input were used for calculating stream input for later years
when all the streams were not measured: water 24.5%, total phosphorus
13.5%, phosphate 50.6%, nitrate 43.8%, Kjeldahl nitrogen 38.6%. In 1957
the volume of sewage effluent was 8,608 thousand m , less than 1% of the
streamflow. The maximum rainfall in the years listed was 104.5 cm in
1972, amounting to 91,557 thousand m-* on the lake, about 3% of the vol-
ume of the lake. These volumes have been ignored in calculating inflow
which is limited to stream flow.
The loading calculations for 1970-1974 do not include flow from
Seattle's storm sewers nor overflow from the remaining combined sewers
that occurs during rainy periods. In 1976, this amounted to about
7,000 kg/year of total phosphorus, or 0.08 g/m^, about equally divided
between the two sources (personal communication, Glen Farris and John
Buffo of METRO). The calculations also do not include overland drain-
age or inflow from temporary streams.
Some of the differences between this table and previously pub-
lished values are accounted for by improvements in the information
available and in the calculations. Some values in this table for years
after 1971 may be revised in future calculations as more information
becomes available, but any changes are expected to be small. Phosphorus
and water loading for any year are unlikely to be increased by as much
as 20% over the values presented here.
298
-------
References
The following list gives sources of. information in addition
to the papers cited in the text.
Comita, G.W. and G.C. Anderson. 1959. The seasonal development
population of Diaptomus ashlandi Marsh, and related phyto-
plankton cycles in Lake Washington. Limnol. Oceanog.
4.: 37-52.
Davis, M.B. 1973. Pollen evidence of changing land use around
the shores of Lake Washington. Northwest Science. 47:133-148.
Edmondson, W.T. 1963. Pacific Coast and Great Basin, p. 371-
392. In D. G. Frey (ed.) Limnology in North America.
University of Wisconsin Press, Madison, Wisconsin.
Edmondson, W.T. 1961. Changes in Lake Washington following an
increase in the nutrient income. Verh. Internat. Verein.
Limnol. 14:167-175.
Edmondson, W.T. 1966. Changes in the oxygen deficit of Lake
Washington. Verh. Internal. Limnol. Verein. 16:153-158.
Edmondson, W.T. 1968. Water quality management and lake
eutrophication: The Lake Washington Case. Water Resouces
Management and Public Policy, pp. 139-178. T.H. Campbell
and R.O. Sylvester (eds.) University of Washington Press.
Edmondson, W.T. 1970. Phosphorus, nitrogen and algae in Lake
Washington after diversion of sewage. Science 196:960-691.
Edmondson, W.T. 1972a. Nutrients and phytoplankton in Lake
Washington, pp. 172-193. In Nutrients and Eutrophication,
American Society of Limnology and Oceanography, Special
Symposia No. 1. G. Likens (ed.).
Edmondson, W.T. 1972b. The present condition of Lake Washington.
Verh. Internat. Verein. Limnol. 18:284-291.
Edmondson, W.T. 1973. Lake Washington, pp. 281-298. In
Environmental Quality and Water Development. Ed., C.R.
Goldman, James McEvoy III and Peter J. Richerson. Freeman.
(Originally published as a report to the National Water
Commission).
Edmondson, W.T. 1974a. Review of The Environmental Phosphorus
Handbook. Limnol. Oceanog. _19_:369-375. (contains extensive
comments on concepts of eutrophication).
Edmondson, W.T. 1974b. The sedimentary record of the eutrophication
of Lake Washington. Proc. Nat. Acad. Sci. 71; 5093-5095.
299
-------
Edmondson, W.T. 1977. The recovery of Lake Washington from eutrophication.
pp. 102-109 in Recovery and restoration of damaged ecosystems., ed.
John Cairns, Jr., K.L. Dickson and E.E. Herricks, Univ. Press of
Virginia.
Edmondson, W.T. (in press). Trophic equilibrium of Lake Washington.
Final Report on E.P.A. Project R 8020 82-03-1, Corvallis, Oregon.
(Contains description of chemical methods used).
Scheffer, V.B., and R.J. Robinson. 1939. A limnological study of Lake
Washington. Ecol. Monogr. JJ: 95-143.
Shapiro, J., W.T. Edmondson and D.E. Allison. 1971. Changes in chemical
composition of sediments of Lake Washington, 1958-1970. Limnol.
Oceanog. 16: 437-452.
Thut, R. 1969. A study of the profundal bottom fauna of Lake Washington.
Ecol. Monogr. 39: 79-100.
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
The main project on Lake Washington reported here has been supported
for many years by the National Science Foundation, supplemented in 1973-
1976 by the Environmental Protection Agency.
300
-------
NUTRIENT LOADING AND TROPHIC STATE
OF LAKE SAMMAMISH, WASHINGTON
E. B. Welch, T. Wiederholm,
D. E. Spyridakis and C. A. Rock
Department of Civil Engineering
University of Washington
Seattle, Washington
INTRODUCTION
Lake Sammamish is best characterized as mesotrophic and sediment core
analyses indicate that its status has remained relatively constant for more
than the past 100 years. The lake has been studied continuously since late
1969 with only two previously recorded studies; a nearly two-year study by
the Municipality of Metro Seattle in 1964-65 and a one day survey in 1913
(Kemmerer et al., 1924). In addition to continuous monitoring of limnological
characteristics since late 1969 to the present, special studies of secondary
production (zooplankton and fish), nutrient exchange rates between sediment
and water, phytoplankton uptake of nutrients, feeding rates of zooplankton,
profundal bottom fauna, and dynamic modeling of the phosphorus cycle have con-
tinued, as well as a careful evaluation of the nutrient (particularly P) income.
Most of this effort has been for the purpose of defining the processes
that have permitted the lake to remain mesotrophic in spite of alteration
of the P loading. Because the lake was thought to be showing early signs
of eutrophication (Isaac et al., 1969), the Municipality of Metropolitan
Seattle (Metro) diverted the secondary effluent from the town of Issaquah
and waste from a dairy processing plant in the fall of 1968. This diversion
was subsequently shown to have amounted to one-third of the lake's P loading.
The lake's internal sediment-water interchange mechanism controlled by iron
can resist P loading changes over a range of at least 0.66-1.0 g P/m2 year.
This allows the available water column P content to remain remarkably stable
and is probably the main cause for the lake's lack of response to diversion.
However, stability could not be expected to persist over a much greater
range in loading and when viewed over the range of trophic state and loading
301
-------
that exists in the world's lakes, the range examined in Sammamish appears
rather small.
GEOGRAPHIC DESCRIPTION OF LAKE SAMMAMISH
The waning of the Wisconsin glaciation (14,000 BP) left the Puget Sound
lowlands dominated by striated hills, rolling uplands, and deeply cut troughs.
Today one trough is occupied by Lake Sammamish, a second by Lake Washington
with the -meandering Sammamish River connecting the two. A mild, maritime
climate now prevails, annually producing 90 centimeters of precipitation and
a mean monthly temperature of 11.5°C (52.7°F). Direct sunshine is present
45 percent of the daylight hours. Table I provides a summary of the pertinent
geographic conditions.
Parameter Lake Sammamish
Location
Altitude (meters above mean sea level) 12
Longitude 122°05'W
Latitude 46°36'N
o
Size of Drainage Basin (km ) 253
Duration of ice cover none
Evapotranspiration (cm) 23.7
Evaporation (cm) 5.1
Precipitation (cm) 90
Maximum monthly precipitation (cm 39
Minimum monthly precipitation (cm) 0
Table I. Summary of Basin Geography
The predominant surface stratum of the drainage basin is a light-gray
till. This till is a hard unsorted mixture about 46 meters thick, consisting
of clay, sand silt, and gravel. Although the till is relatively impermeable,
thin beds of sand and gravel commonly yield small quantities of perched water.
3Q2
-------
Aquifers transect the basin, with several artesian wells surfacing within the
basin (Liesch, et_ al., 1963). Coal seams are located in the southern half
of the watershed, while high quality sand and gravel,'refractory grade clay,
quarry basalt and cinnebar deposits are scattered throughout the basin
(Livingston, 1971).
A geologic cross-section cutting through Issaquah in an east-west
direction shows base rock consisting of marine sedimentary rocks on the west
side of the Lake Sammamish valley. On the east side is volcanic rock with
overlying layers of clay, advanced stratified drift, till and sedimentary
deposits (Liesch, eit al. , 1963).
Prior to the arrival of European settlers in 1862, the Lake Sammamish
basin was covered in a climax formation of Western Red Cedar (Thuja plicata),
Western Hemlock (Tsuga heterophylla), and Douglas Fir (Fseudotsuga taxifplia)
(Hansen,1938). Heavy logging around the turn of the century left the basin
in second growth forest. Today 80% of the watershed remains in second
growth, primarily red alder (Alnus oregona) with scattered maple (Acer, sp.)
and willow (Salix sp.). Hence tjie impact of land erosion upon the lake is
minimized.
The population of the basin has grown from three families in 1862 to the
present 40,000, the majority of the growth coming in the last 10 years. The
only sizeable concentration is located in the town of Issaquah, population
4,500. The town is comprised of the small businesses required to support a
residential community. The only industrial development is a dairy processing
plant and a state salmon hatchery. Within the watershed are several gravel
operations and a county sanitary landfill. Large residential developments
have been built throughout the entire west side of the lake. The east side
is dotted with small farms, but the mjaor portion of the land remains in
second-growth. A narrow strip of land along the east shore of the lake has
303
-------
been subdivided into residential tracts. The upper valley drained by
Issaquah and Tibbetts Creeks is primarily forested with scattered farms
and small clusters of houses (Fig. 1).
The primary point sources of wastewater within the basin were the town
of Issaquah, the milk processing plant, and the fish hatchery. Since 1968,
3
the effluent from the town's trickling filter plant (568 m /d) and the milk
plant (284 m /d) have been diverted out of the basin. Today only the milk
o
plant cooling water (227 m /d from groundwater) and the hatchery passthrough
water, which originally comes from Issaquah Creek, are discharged through
Issaquah Creek, to Lake Sammamish. Only the sparsely settled east side and
upper valley sections of the watershed remain on septic tanks.
MORPHOMETRIC AND HYDROLOGIC DESCRIPTION OF LAKE SAMMAMISH
Lake Sammamish occupied a 13 km section of the Sammamish River Valley
after the Wisconsin glaciation when the retreating Vashon glacier left a
terminal maraine blocking the valley. Today the lake level is controlled
by a weir at the head of the Sammamish River. Morphometric and hydrologic
data on the lake are summarized in Table II. Sixty five percent of the lake
surface has a depth greater than 15 m. The ratio of epilimnion to
hypolimnion volume is 1.0.
The preliminary mapping of surface lake sediments completed to date
include particle size distribution and mineralogical composition, cation
exchange capacity and chemical analysis shown below (Horton, 1972):
Properties Mean Value Properties Mean Value
CEC, meq/lOOg
Size distribution, %
Sand
Silt
Clay
23.9
13
60
27
Chemical Analysis,
C
N
P
Fe
Mn
Ca
Mg
Na
K
mg/g dry weight
5.1
4.8
1.3
52.0
1.1
8.1
15.7
21.2
2.9
304
-------
'X Figure 1. Land Use Map of the Lake
V Sammamish Watershed
>
(
v.- —.
-LAKE SAMMAMISH
Phantom —TT=
Beaver Lake /
Lake ^ZS
Tibbetts
Creek
Drainage
Boundary
East Fork
Issaquah
Creek
kilometers
Issaquah
Creek
:;;:; INDUSTRIAL
COMMERCIAL
RESIDENTIAL
N
A
305
-------
Parameter Lake Sammamish
Drainage Area (km2) 253
Surface Area of lake (km2) 19.8
Lake Volume (km3)* 0.35
Depth
Mean (m) 17,7
Maximum (m) 32.0
Epilimnion (m) 8.8
Euphotic (m) 7.3
Width
Mean (km) 1.5
Maximum (km) 2.4
Length of Lake (km) 13.0
Length of Shoreline (km) 34.0
Water Retention Time (yrs) 2.2
Stream Inflow (knr/yr) 0,167
Stream Outflow (km3/yr) 0.162
Groundwater Infiltration (km3/yr) 0.0
Groundwater Exfiltration (km3/yr) 0.01
Duration of Stratification (mos) 7
*influenced by wier
Table II. Summary of Pertinent Rydrologic and Morphometric
Characteristics for Lake Sammaroish
The study of water currents has been limited to the movement of Issaquah
Creek water in the lake (Moon, 1973). During the period of winter mixing the
creek water dispersal was primarily influenced by wind direction and velocity.
The water was sufficiently dispersed at a distance of 500 m to make the tracer
undetectable. Similar studies made during thermal stratification showed the
creek water plunging into the metalimnion (9-12 m) and dispersing in a fan-
like pattern.
306
-------
LIMNOLOGICAL CHARACTERIZATION
The limnological monitoring of Lake Saramamish has been continuous since
1970. Prior to 1970, Metro monitored the lake for a 1.5 year period in 1964
and 1965. Monitoring has been conducted largely at one centrally located
station which has been shown to represent the limnetic area, and at a
frequency of usually twice per month.
Physical
Temperature
The lake is monomictic and begins thermal stratification in May. Maximum
water column stability occurs by late August and destruction of the thermocline
is complete by late November. The surface temperature range is from a
minimum 5.5°C to a maximum 25.5°C. The bottom water remains below 7°C.
Light Penetration
The depth of visibility has been determined by means of the Secchi disc.
The annual mean for the six years of data is 3.3 m. The lowest seasonal
readings (3.0 m) occur in the winter due to turbidity from the winter mixing
and runoff. The springtime mean is only slightly higher (3.1 m), but the
low values are due to the diatom pulse. The light penetration increases
during the summer (3.5 m) and reaches its highest mean value in autumn
(3.6 m).
Light extinction was determined by a submarine photometer. The bottom
of the euphotic zone was considered to be at a depth receiving 1% of the
surface light intensity. The mean depth of the euphotic zone is 7.3 m,
while the range is from 5.0 to 12.5 m.
307
-------
Solar Radiation
Insolation was determined at the University of Washington campus with an
2
integrating Epply pyranometer. The ten year mean insolation is 3000 kcal/m /
2 2
day and the range is 700 kcal/m /day in December to 5700 kcal/m /day in August.
Chemical
pH and Alkalinity
The pH ranges from 6.3 to 9.6 due largely to biological activity.
Correspondingly the alkalinity as CaCO- ranges from 26 mg/1 (0.52 meq/1)
to 42 mg/1 (0.84 meq/1), while the mean is 33.3 mg/1 (0.67 meq/1).
Dissolved Oxygen
During the winter, the oxygen content essentially remains at an air
saturation level, approximately 12 mg 0^/1, due to continual circulation.
The development of thermal stratification in early May results in a clino-
grade Q curve that approaches zero oxygen content (0.1 mg 0/1) in the
bottom waters by mid-August. The hypolimnetic oxygen deficit continues to
increase until early October. By this time the entire hypolimnion (below
15 meters) has less than 1 mg 0/1. Oxygen levels start to increase with
the coming of the autumnal circulation.
Phosphorus
Total and ortho-phosphorus have been measured from 1969 to the
present. The five-year mean concentrations for the 7.3 m photic zone are
as follows:
Total-P (yg/1)
Soluble ortho-P (yg/1)
yearly
26
6
3Q8
winter
(Dec . -Feb . )
30
13
growinj
(March-
25
4
-------
The winter total P content in 1975 remained identical to the previous five-
year mean - 30 yg/1. The winter mean total phosphorus concentration for the
entire water column was 36 yg/1. This reflects the higher total phosphorus
concentrations found in the hypolimnion. The mean total P content in the
water column prior to fall turnover is greater - 40 yg/1. The range in total
and ortho P over the five years has been 10-90 and 1-21 yg/1, respectively.
Nitrogen
Although all forms of N have been determined for only the past year,
inorganic nitrogen (NO-+NO.-N) data are available for the past five years.
The five year annual mean for the photic zone is 180 yg N/l and 275 yg/1
for the growing season (March-Aug.).
Annual surface water values have been computed for calendar year 1973
and are summarized below:
Mean Annual Range
Concentration (yg N/l) (yg N/l)
Organic N 225 60 - 403
NH3-N 41 5 - 125
The 1973 inorganic nitrogen (NO^+NO -N) mean compares favorably with
the four year photic zone mean (191 vs 180 yg N/l), indicating that the
single year's data may be representative of the long-term nitrogen
concentrations.
Metals
Only preliminary data are available for metals. Neither SO, nor Cl
I i
have been measured, while the only trace metals measured have been Mn ,
i [ i i
Zn and Pb . The results from a single central station survey during
the stratified period are shown as follows:
309
-------
location
Lake Surface
Surface
8 m
16 m
25 m
Inflows
Issaquah Ck.
Tibbetts Ck.
Outflow
Sammamish
River
Ca
12.80
8.40
8.95
12.40
24.70
6.05
Mg
3.42
3.44
3.68
3.70
8.15
3.00
cr/1
g/J-
Na
8.43
8.47
8.15
8.17
9.31
14.59
8.16
K
1.01
0.98
0.94
1.00
0.94
1.52
1.13
Fe
40
63
280
1020
450
110
25
IIS*/
yg/
Mn
19
40
600
1660
35
20
9
Zn
376
300
35
34
318
150
7
Pb
0.5
0.5
0.8
0.8
0.9
4.2
0.6
Biological
Phytoplankton
Phytoplankton has a peak in the spring composed primarily of diatoms.
The dominating genera during winter and spring are Melosira and Stephanodiscus.
During the summer and fall, Fragilaria, Synedra, Melosira, Rhizosalenia and
Asterionella are the major diatoms. The bluegreen algae are comprised pre-
dominantly of Aphanocapsa, Microcystis, Coelosphaerium, Anabaena and
Aphanizomenon. In 1973-74 the appearance of Aphanizomenon has been less
pronounced than earlier while the abundance of an Oscillatoriaceae species
has increased. Predominant chlorophyseans are Oocystis, Sphaerocystis,
Closteriopsis, Chlamydomonas and Staurastrum. Also predominant in the
phytoplankton of the lake is the chrysomonad Mallomonas.
Mean values for phytoplankton chlorophyll a. and primary productivity
are given in Table III. Peak values during the years 1970-74 were 25.1,
28.3, 7.7, 12.2 and 13.9 mg/m3 for chlorophyll a_ and 1257, 1061, 1730,
2
1581 and 2389 mg C/m -day for primary productivity, respectively. The blue-
green algae have decreased in importance over the 1970-74 period compared
to the pre-sewage-diversion period in 1964-65. The average decrease has
been nearly 40%.
-------
Year
1970
1971
1972
1973
1974
Average
Chlorophyll a_
(mg/m3)
yearly growing season
5.
6.
4.
4.
6.
5.
7
6
3
0
0
3
7.7
10.9
4.8
4.7
6.8
7.0
Primary
(mg C/m
yearly
711
467
799
496
789
652
Productivity
2 -day)
growing season
899
575
952
545
904
775
Table III. Annual and growing season means of phytoplankton chlorophyll a_
(weighted means for the euphotic zone) and daily rate of primary
productivity in 1970-1974.
Zooplankton
Vertical net hauls was the procedure used to collect zooplankton at
frequencies varying from twice weekly to once per month with the least fre-
quency at periods of low reproductive activity. The zooplankton fauna were
dominated in 1972-73 by copepods, among which Diaptomus ashlandi was the most
abundant species. The following species of zooplankton have been found
Vindicates common species) :
Copepods
*Diaptomus ashlandi
*Epis chura nevadensis
* Cyclops bi cuspi datus
Cladocerans
*Daphnia thorata
*D.
_
*Bos_mina longer ostris
*Diaphanasoma leuch tenb er gianum
Leptodora kindtii
Scapholeberis king!
Rotifers
*Kellicottia longispina
BC. bos ton ien sis
*Polyarthra sp.
Keratella cochlearis
K^. quadrat a
*Conochilus unicornis
Collotheca mutabilis
CL.' pelagic a
Notholca squamula
Ploesoma hudsoni
Gastropus sp.
Synchaeta sp.
Trichocerca sp.
Filinia sp.
311
-------
The mean biomass and production rate of zooplankton in the lake during
the two-year period 1972-73 was:
annual mean growing season
3
Biomass (mg/m dry wt.)
Production rate
(mg/m-Vday dry wt.)
44.3
.98
46.1
1.26
The growing season secondary productivity was only 4% of the primary produc-
tivity. Discussion of this low efficiency is given by Pederson, et al.
(in press).
Bottom Fauna
A survey of the bottom fauna was made in July 1974. The macro fauna was
dominated by chironomids in sublittoral (5 m) and deep profundal areas (25 m).
Oligochaetes were dominating in the upper profundal (15 m) (Table IV).
Cladotanytarsus and Tanytarsus were the dominating chironomid genera at 5 m
depth. Chironomus larvae of the salinarius type (probably identical with
Ch. atritibia), followed by Phaenop sectra were the most abundant forms at
15 m. The high density of Chironomus at 25 m depth was almost exclusively
larvae of the Ch. salinarius type. The growth and development of this
species is closely correlated with phytoplankton production and the duration
of anoxic conditions in the deep profundal (Bissonnette, 1974).
5m 15 m 25 m
(7 Ekmans) (10 Ekmans) (8 Ekmans)
Chironomidae 8330 3040 22640
Ollgochaeta 1870 7010 4960
Mollusca 310 270 40
Crustacea 10 60
Others 50
Table IV. Abundance of major groups in the bottom fauna in July 1974
(ind/m ; 0.4 mm mesh size)
312
-------
Bottom Flora and Macrophytes
Meager data exist on this topic. The littoral zone is not extensive
in the lake but moderate sized areas of submergent macrophytes do occur at
either end of the lake. Periphyton growth occurs at some points adjacent
to stream or storm water inflows, which is a topic presently under study.
NUTRIENT LOADING
Phosphorus
Earlier estimates of the nutrient loading to Lake Sammamish were made
difficult by the quick response to rainfall in the tributaries, particularly
Issaquah Creek, which contributes 70% of the surface water and 72.5% of the
total phosphorus to the lake (Emery, et_ jil^. , 1973). For example, as much as
5% of the total annual phosphorus load has been calculated to enter the lake
in one day due to a combination of high flow and high nutrient concentrations,
The installment of an automatic sampler in the main tributary in 1973 has
permitted accurate estimates of phosphorus loading for the last two years.
Through comparison of similar hydrological years and the results of earlier
monthly samples, the decrease in loading through sewage diversion was
estimated. Limited rainwater analyses during water year 1971 established an
atmospheric input to the lake surface. Groundwater input was considered
insignificant relative to the other sources because the water balance was
roughly explainable from a consideration of surface inputs and outputs. The
loading rate of phosphorus from three sources is shown below:
Percentage
Source
Waste Discharges
Land Runoff
Precipitation
Groundwater
before
div.
37
58
5
0
after
div.
3
89
8
0
kg P/yr
before
div.
7,500
11,500
1,000
0
after
div.
500
11,500
1,000
0
Total 100 20,000 13,000
313
-------
Nitrogen
The data for a nitrogen loading are not as extensive as for phosphorus.
The contribution from ground water has been assumed to be zero, while the
contribution from precipitation has not been evaluated. On the basis of
the following estimates before and after sewage diversion in 1968 there
appears to be no significant change in nitrogen loading (Guttormsen, 1974):
Organic N+NH--N NO +NO--N Total N
- / O £, J , I
*~*'yL kg/yr ^'yL
1965 Water Year
March 1972-Feb. 1973
69,000
60,000
174,000
198,000
243,000
258,000
DISCUSSION
Limnological Characteristics
The outstanding characteristic in Lake Sammamish is its consistently
2
high oxygen deficit rate of about 0.05 mg/cm 'day and complete hypolimnetic
anaerobiosis from August through October. This is caused more from the
lake's morphometry than high productivity since the epilimnion-to-hypolimnion
volume ratio is rather high at 1.0 and the growing season mean productivity
2
is only about 700 mg C/m "day, which is more typical of mesotrophy. Iron
and phosphorus content are inversely related to oxygen content in the
hypolitnnion and, thus, the process of phosphorus release and complexation
and resultant availability is controlled by the lake's anaerobic character.
Because the lake is monomictic a winter stagnation period does not exist.
The lake usually has one large phytoplankton maximum - a diatom out-
burst in April. In springs with lower light and slower onset of water
column stability the maximum is less, is delayed until June and is mixed
314
-------
with green and bluegreen algae. However, mean growing season chl ji content
and productivity show much less variance from year-to-year ranging from
2
4.7-10.9 yg/1 and 545-952 mg C/m -day, respectively. Secchi disk depth is
similar from year-to-year, with a growing season mean slightly in excess
of 3.3 m and the maximum exceeding 5 m at times.
The minimum nutrient content and chl a_ occur in August, but usually
show a slight increase in September and October as the metalimnion is forced
downward proceeding toward the November turnover. Total P is then maximum
at overturn reaching 40 yg/1 (in excess of 100 before sewage diversion), with
the December through February mean remaining very constant at about 30 yg/1.
Nitrate-N at this time is typically around 275 yg/1.
Trophic State
The present trophic state of the lake was determined by a comparison
of the above mentioned limnological characteristics with criteria for
eutrophication (National Academy of Sciences, 1972). It appears that Lake
Sammamish can be considered as mesotrophic with respect to phytoplankton
biomass (expressed as chlorophyll a), daily and annual primary productivity
and the composition of the benthic communities. Oxygen deficit rate and
nutrient concentrations are more indicative of mesotrophy-eutrophy. The
2 2
loading of total phosphorus (0.66 g/m -yr) and total nitrogen (13 g/m -yr)
are both considerably above the eutrophic danger limit of Vollenweider's
(1968) guidelines. With his recent correction of mean depth for flushing
time the loading rates are nearer the danger limit, however.
Paleolimnological studies of diatom profiles, phosphorus and organic
content, and distribution of chironomid head capsules show no change in
the trophic state of the lake during the last 120 years.
315
-------
Trophic State vs. Nutrient Loading
The fact that both producers and consumers in the lake do not seem to
respond to the eutrophic level of nutrient loading suggests that some internal
factor(s) is controlling the availability of the incoming phosphorus to the
phytoplankton (Welch, &t_ a^., 1973). The evidence to support the hypothesis
centers around the lake phosphorus content being controlled by iron. Horton
(1972) has shown that total iron is closely correlated with total phosphorus
as oxygen is exhausted in the hypolimnion during late summer. Although
phosphorus increases in the surface waters following lake turnover in late
November, P is rapidly complexed by what are probably ferric hydroxides.
Much of the released phosphorus is thereby largely resedimented and rendered
unavailable to the phytoplankton when light is adequate in April and May.
The pattern of response in the lake since diversion is shown in Fig. 2.
Although considerable year-to-year variation has occurred in chl a. content,
the photic zone total P content has remained rather constant. The year-to-
year variation in chl a_ observed was no doubt largely a response to light and
extent of early spring stratification, but the constant P content is indica-
tive of the lake's resistance to P loading change in the range of at least
o
0.66 to 1.0 g P/m 'yr. However, when viewed over a wider range of loading
known for lakes of varied trophic state its general significance is question-
able. Fig. 3 shows a very strong correlation between volumetric P loading
and "potential" chl a. (chl a. r residence time - yr) . Here one can see the
controlling significance of P loading with respect to chl a_ accumulation
(in so far as water residence time allows P utilization) over a wide range
of loading. Also, the relatively small aberration in chl a_ that could be
caused by the observed P loading change in Lake Sammamish is clear. With
further loading change Sammamish might well be expected to conform to the
linear relationship in Fig. 3.
316
-------
150
CO
cu
m
v£>
C
o
•l-l
CO
•H
T3
(1)
t-l
p-l
d
0)
o
)-l
OJ
125
100
Figure 2.
75
50
25
0
Waste
Water
Diversion
i
% Blue Green Algae
Fraction \
\
V
65 70 71 72 73 74
Year
Mean concentrations in the photic zone (usually top 8 m) of growing
season chl a_ (Mar-Aug), summer blue green algal fraction (June-Oct)
and winter (Dec-Feb) total phosphorus and nitrate nitrogen relative
to pre-diversion 1965 levels. The 1965 levels were: chl a. 6.5 yg/1
(actually a mean of 1964 and 1965 data), total P 31 yg/1 and
N03-N 390 yg/1.
317
-------
500
CO
LU
I-
O
CL
O>
6
P •'
-------
Acknowledgements
This project was supported in part by EPA research grant No. R-800512
and in part by the National Science Foundation grant No. GB-36810X to the
Coniferous Forest Biome, Ecosystem Analysis Studies, US/IBP. This is
contribution No. 110 from Coniferous Forest Biome.
References
Bissonnette, P. 1974. Extent of mercury and lead uptake from lake sediments
by Chironomidae. M. S. Thesis, Univ. of Wash.
Emery, R. M., C. E. Moon and E. B. Welch. 1973. Enriching effect of urban
runoff on the productivity of a mesotrophic lake. Water Research, 7:
1505-1516.
Guttormsen, S. 1974. A nitrogen budget for Lake Sammamish, Washington.
M. S. Thesis, Univ. of Wash.
Hansen, H. 1938. Postglacial forest succession and climate in the Puget
Sound Region. Ecology 19;528-542.
Horton, M. 1972. The chemistry of P in Lake Sammamish. M. S. Thesis,
Univ. of Wash.
Isaac, G. W., R. I. Matsuda, and J. R. Walker. 1966. A limnological
investigation of water quality conditions in Lake Sammamish. Water
Quality Series No. 2. Metro, Seattle, Wa.
Kemmerer, G., J. Bovard, and W. Boorman. 1924. Northwestern lakes of the
U.S.: Biological and chemical studies with reference to possibilities
in production of fish. Bull. U.S. Bur. Fish., 39;51-140.
Liesch, Price and Walters. 1963. Geology and groundwater resources of
northwest King County, Wash. Water Supply Bull. No. 20, USGS.
319
-------
Livingston, Jr., V. 1971. Geology and mineral resources of King County,
Wash. Wash. Dept. of Nat. Res. Bull, No. 63.
Moon, C. E. 1973. Nutrient budget following waste diversion from a
mesotrophic lake. M. S. Thesis. Univ. of Wash.
National Academy of Sciences. 1972. Water Quality Criteria 1972, Aesthetics
and Recreation Section, Wash. D. C.
Pederson, G. L., E. B. Welch and A. R. Litt. Plankton secondary productivity
and biomass; their relation to lake trophic state. Hydrobiologia (in
press).
Vollenweider, R. A., 1968. The scientific basis of lake and stream
eutrophication, with particular reference to phosphorus and nitrogen
as eutrophication factors. Tech. Rep. OECD, Paris. DAS/CSI/68,
27:1-182.
Welch, E. B., C. A. Rock, and J. D. Krull. 1973. Long-term lake recovery
related to available phosphorus. Proceedings of Workshop on Modeling
the Eutrophication Process. Utah Water Resources Lab., PRWG 136-1,
pp. 5-13.
Welch, E. B., G. R. Hendrey, and R. K. Stoll. 1975. Nutrient supply and
the production and biomass of algae in four Washington lakes. Oikos.
26:47-54.
320
-------
SECTION VII - WISCONSIN
LAKE MENDOTA - NUTRIENT LOADS
AND BIOLOGICAL RESPONSE
Jose M. Lopez and G. Fred Lee
Institute for Environmental Sciences
University of Texas at Dallas
Richardson, Texas
INTRODUCTION
Lake Mendota is the largest of the Madison lakes which form a chain along
the Yahara River in south-central Wisconsin. It is classified as a hard-water,
eutrophic lake according to most standards. The drainage area of Lake Mendota
is composed mostly of fertile farm land and the urban area. The hypolimnetic
waters become devoid of oxygen during summer stratification. After fall reox-
ygenation, oxygen depletion again occurs in the bottom waters during late win-
ter. Excessive weed growth and periodic algal blooms create offensive condi-
tions during the summer months.
GEOGRAPHIC DESCRIPTION
Lake Mendota is located in Madison, Wisconsin, the latitude and longitude
of the centroid of the water area being 43°7' N and 89°25' W. The surface of
the lake stands at an altitude of 849 feet above sea level (Cline, 1965). The
lake has a cumulative drainage area of 265 sq. miles (Lee, 1962). The climate
of the basin is typically continental, the summers are hot and the winters are
cold. The average annual temperature at Madison is 46.2°F and ranges from an
average 72.7°F in July. During each of four winter months, December through
March, the mean monthly temperature is below 32°F. The growing season extends
generally from late April to mid-October and averages 175 days (Cline, 1965).
From 1852-1948, Lake Mendota showed an ice cover duration of 112 days
(14 December to 4 April) on the average. Duration of ice cover ranged from
65 days in the winter of 1931-32 to 161 days in 1880-81. The earliest the lake
has frozen over is 25 November 1857, and the latest it has thawed is 6 May 1957
(Frey, 1963).
321
-------
The precipitation varies widely during the year. The
maximum average monthly precipitation occurs in June, and
the minimum average precipitation occurs in February.
Generally 3 to 4 inches of precipitation per month occurs
during May through September. Most of this precipitation
is associated with thunderstorms. Between one and two
inches of precipitation per month generally occurs during
November through February. The total yearly precipitation
averages 31.2 inches, which includes an average annual
snowfall of 37.8 inches or about seven inches precipita-
tion. The evapotranspiration rate from that part of the
Yahara River basin covered by lakes and marshes is about
equal to the precipitation (Cline, 1965) .
Figure 1 is a schematic diagram of Lake Mendota
showing depth contours and direction of the prevailing
winds in summer. The maximum fetch is about 9 Km and
occurs when the wind is out of the southwest.
INLET
LAKE MENDOTA
WISCONSIN
OUTLET
DEPTH CONTOURS IN METERS
Figure l. LAKE MENDOTA, WISCONSIN, SHOWING BATHYMETRY
322
-------
Lake Mendota occupies a pre-glacial valley system
excavated by streams in sandstones and sandy dolomites of
upper Cambrian age. The lake was formed as a result of
moranic damming during the most recent ice age (Twenhofel,
1933). Rocks of Cambrian age, principally sandstone and
dolomite, were deposited in shallow seas on a surface of
igneous and metamorphic rocks of Precambrian age. Dolo-
mite and sandstone of Ordovician age were deposited on the
Cambrian rocks. Glacial drift and loess overlie these
formations (Cline, 1965).
Approximately 200,000 people live in Madison on the
southeast shore of Lake Mendota. Land usage estimates
for the Mendota basin provided by Sonzogni and Lee (1974)
are shown in Table 1. A large area of the drainage basin
is predominantly agricultural (dairy farms and mixed
crops).
Table 1. ESTIMATE OF LAND USE WITHIN THE LAKE MENDOTA
WATERSHED*
Land Use Acres Percent
Rural 115,000 83
Urban 16,000 12
Marshland 6,000 4
Woodland 1,000 1
Total 138,000 100
*After Sonzogni and Lee (1974)
Lake Mendota water is mainly used for sports, fishing
and recreation. A limited amount of lake water is pumped
into the University of Wisconsin water supply system. The
municipal supply for the City of Madison comes almost
entirely from ground water.
In 1958, discharges of treated sewage effluent were
diverted around all Madison lakes. By 1973, waste water
from several small communities was diverted from Lake
Mendota tributaries (Sonzogni and Lee, 1974) .
MORPHOMETRIC AND HYDROLOGIC DESCRIPTION
Lake Mendota has a surface area of 15.2 square miles
(39.4Km2), a length of 5.9 miles (9.5Km) and a width of
4.6 miles (7.4Km). The shoreline is 20 miles (32.2Km)
long. The water volume is approximately 128 x 10^ gallons
(486 x 106m3). Maximum depth of the lake is 84 feet (25m)
while the mean depth is 40 feet (12m) (Cline, 1965).
Depths greater than 12m occur in about 50 percent of the
surface area. Details of the hypsometry of the lake are
given in Table 2. The stratification period in Lake
323
-------
Mendota may extend from May to October. The volume ratio
of epilimnion over hypolimnion varied from 0.93 in June
to 5.34 in October, 1971. This ratio was 2.66 during
August, the time of maximum stability (Stauffer md Lee, 1973).
Table 2. HYPSOMETRIC FACTORS FOR LAKE MENDOTA
SURFACE AREA OF LAKE MENDOTA 39.4 x 10^ m2
Depth Average % of Surface Volume Contained
Meters Area Within Interval Within Interval x
1Q-7 m3
0 - 0.5 98 1.88
0.5 - 1.5 92 3.60
1.5 - 2.5 87 3.40
2.5 - 3.5 82 3.20
3.5 - 4.5 77.5 3.03
4.5 - 5.5 73.5 2.87
5.5 - 6.5 71 2.78
6.5 - 7.5 69 2.70
7.5 - 8.5 66.5 2.60
8.5 - 9.5 64 2.50
9.5 -10.5 61.5 2.40
10.5 -11.5 58 2.27
11.5 -12.5 54 2.11
12.5 -13.5 51 1.99
13.5 -14.5 47 1.84
14.5 -15.5 45 1.76
15.5 -16.5 42 1.64
16.5 -17.5 39 1.52
17.5 -18.5 35 1.37
18.5 -19.5 29 1.13
19.5 -20.5 22 0.86
20.5 -21.5 15 0.59
21.5 -22.5 9 0.35
22.5 -23.5 4 0.16
23.5 -24.5 0.2 0.01
48.6 x 107m3
The hydraulic residence time for the lake is 4.5
years (Sonzogni and Lee, 1974). A water balance of Lake
Mendota for October 1, 1948 to October 1, 1949, is given
in Table 3.
Abrupt sedimentation changes have occurred in Lake
Mendota in the recent past. Buff marl is overlain by
black gyttja, gray-colored gyttja-marl forms the inter-
face between buff marl and balck gyttja. The marl and
gyttja differ in being high carbonate-low clastic and low
carbonate-high clastic sediments, respectively.
324
-------
Table 3. WATER BALANCE OF LAKE MENDOTA,
1 OCTOBER 1948 TO 1 OCTOBER 1949*
INFLOW
a) Measured tributaries — Stations 1-10 78.4 cfs
(192.27 mi2 of drainage basin) 2
b) Unmeasured tributary area (31.87 mi
of drainage basin, by computation) 13.0 cfs
c) Precipitation onto lake surface
(31.65 in.) 38.7 cfs
Total Inflow (4,100,000,000 ft3)
OUTFLOW
a) Storage 3.5 cfs
b) Evaporation
(51.17 in., by computation) 58.2 cfs
c) Outflow, Station 11 70.0 cfs
d) University pumpage 1.5 cfs
Total Outflow (4,200,000,000 ft3) 133.2 cfs
Unaccounted for: 133.2-130.0 = 3.1 cfs
= 2.33 % of outflow
*After Rohlich, in Frey (1963)
The change in sedimentation is ascribed to increased
deposition of clastic material in the lake as a conse-
quence of farm and domestic practices (Murray, 1956).
Cores of Lake Mendota show increased deposition of P, Fe,
K, and Organic-C while carbonate-C has decreased in most
recent periods (Bortleson and Lee, 1972) .
CURRENTS
Bryson and Ragotzkie (1955) found that University Bay
(Lake Mendota) was normally occupied by a clockwise gyre,
the rotation rate of which is nearly constant (period=0.5
pendulum day) and independent of the current volocity. A
jet of particularly high velocity extends out into the lake
along the side of Picnic Point peninsula. Clarke and
Bryson (1959) found that, following diminution of stress
from the surface wind, a countercurrent rapidly develops
below the surface as observed at Second Point Bar. Shulman
and Bryson (1961) found that wind driven currents deviate
to the right of the wind in a pattern which fits the loga-
rithmic spiral hodograph of classical theory. Density
325
-------
currents were observed by Bryson and Suomi (1952) in Lake
Mendota. Turbid runoff following periods of rain either
flows along the bottom and spreads at the thermocline or
moves deep into the hypolimnion as dictated by density
relations.
LIMNOLOGICAL CHARACTERIZATION
In Lake Mendota the temperature of the water ranges
from 0°C to 27°C. Specific conductance varies from 250 to
350 umhos/cm at 20°C. True color of the lake water is
from 5 to 15 mg/1 chloroplatinate. During the summer
months very little light penetrates below 4-6m. Turbidity
caused by the biomass acts to absorb and scatter incident
light. On May 13, 1971, light penetrated all the way to
the bottom of Lake Mendota and 21 percent of the surface
light reached 4m. Light continued to reach the bottom
until mid-June and after July 14, 1971, less than 4 percent
of the surface light reached 4m (Torrey, 1972).
Table 4 presents a typical chemical analysis of Lake
Mendota, giving the range of value of the most important
parameters of water quality (Lee, 1966).
Algal populations of Lake Mendota include the bloom-
forming Microcystis, Oscillatoria, and Lyngbya. In addi-
tion, the acetylene-reducing genera Anabaena, Aphanizo-
menon, Nostoc, Calothrix, and Gloeotrichia are commonly
observed (Torrey, 1972). Typical blue-green algae counts
for the summer are on the order of 10 cells/liter. Total
lake chlorophyll during the summer months averages 5,OOOKg,
with maximum values reaching 8,OOOKg of chlorophyll. The
average and maximum chlorophyll concentrations per unit
area for the lake are 125 mg/m and 200 mg/m , respec-
tively (Stauffer and Lee, 1973). Primary production,
calculated from light intensity and chlorophyll data2
(Ryther and Yentsch, 1957), is on the order of 4gC/m /day
during the summer.
Table 5 summarizes identities and counts of common
summer zooplankters in Lake Mendota. These include
species of Daphnia, Cyclops, Copepods, Diaptomus, Chydorus,
Lecane and Asplanchna (Frey, 1963).
Fish populations in Lake Mendota have changed since
the turn of the century. Two major changes that have
been found are the decrease in number and increase in
average size of perch. Cisco, once a very abundant fish
in Lake Mendota, has almost reached extinction; only rare
occurrences have been reported in recent years. The dis-
appearance of Cisco from Lake Mendota has been attributed
to increase fertility of the lake. Conway (1972) has
shown that the rate of dissolved oxygen depletion in
the hypolimnetic waters of Lake Mendota has increased
significantly from the early 1900's to the present. Since
326
-------
Table 4. TYPICAL ANALYSIS OF LAKE MENDOTA,
1965-1966
Based on a 1.5 Year Study by Students and Staff of Water
Chemistry Program, University of Wisconsin-Madison*
Water
Range**
Temperature C
Specific Conductance umhos/cm at 20 C
pH
Turbidity ppm SiC>2
Color (true) chloroplatinate mg/1
Sodium mg/1
Potassium mg/1
Magnesium mg/1
Calcium mg/1
Nitrate mg N/l
Nitrite mg N/l
Ammonia mg N/l
Organic mg N/l
Total Phosphate mg/P/1
Orthophosphate mg/P/1
Dissolved Solids mg/1
Filterable Solids mg/1
Silicon Dioxide mgSi02/l
Chloride mg/1
Iron mg/1
Manganese mg/1
Dissolved Oxygen mg/1
Chemical Oxygen Demand mg/1
Dissolved Organic Carbon mg/1
Flouride mg/1
Alkalinity total mg/1 of CaCO-
Sulfate mg/1
0-27
250 - 350
6.5 - 9.2
10 - 50
5-15
4.5 - 8.0
3.5 - 4.0
23 - 28
26 - 30
0 - 0.7
0.0025 - 0.02
0.04 - 0.9
0.5 - 5.0
0.05 - 0.65
0.02 - 0.4
200 ± 20
10 - 60
0.1 - 1.5
6.2 - 9.6
0.02 - 0.2
0.005 - 0.5
0-15
7.0 - 20
10 ± 1
0.09 - 0.25
140 - 193
18 - 30
*Compiled by Lee, 1966.
*Concentrations dependent on sampling location and date.
the hypolimnion of Lake Mendota has become completely
anoxic each year since the early 1900Ts, it is felt
that the Cisco inhabited a narrow layer of water just
below the thermocline. The oxygen in this layer is
maintained by diffusion through the thermocline. By the
early 1940's, the rate of oxygen depletion in this region
of the lake was sufficient to cause anoxic conditions
immediately below the thermocline with the result that
the Cisco were deprived of their niche and died in large
numbers. Of the 61 species of fishes reported for Lake
Mendota, 60 are listed among the 173 species in 29 families
found in the Great Lakes drainage. The families Cyprinidae
and Centrarchidae contribute the largest number of species,
The Percidae ana Ictaluridae are also well represented
(McNaught, 1963).
327
-------
Changes in the populations of aquatic macrophytes
have also occurred. In the past 50 years Myriophyllum
spicatum has invaded the lake and is presently the most
abundant aquatic vascular plant in Lake Mendota. In
1921, the most abundant species, in descending order of
abundance, were Vallisneria spiralis, Najas flexidis,
Potomogeton Richardsonii, P. zostenformis and P. pectin-
atus (Nichols and Mori, 1971).
Table 5. DISTRIBUTION OF COMMON SUMMER ZOOPLANKTERS
IN LAKE MENDOTA (SUMMER, 1947)
Based on Clarke-Bumpus and Juday trap samples at 0-1 meter:
m, mean number of organisms per liter; s2, single haul
variance.*
Species
Clarke-Bumpus
Juday Trap
LAKE MENDOTA
Daphnia
longispina
Diaptomus sp.
Cyclops viridis
Copepod
nauplii
Chydorus sp.
Lecane sp.
(Rotatoria)
Asplanchna sp.
(Rotatoria)
m
36
10
6
20
26
24
9
S2(s2/m)
106(2.9)
29(2.9)
4(0.7)
15(0.8)
63(2.4)
75(3.0)
8(0.9)
m
26
11
7
39
31
35
11
S2(s2/m)
67(2.6)
38(3.4)
13(1.9)
180(4.6)
70(2.3)
126(3.6)
38(3.4)
*After Hasler, in Frey (1963).
NUTRIENT BUDGETS
Estimated nutrient sources for Lake Mendota after the
1971 diversion of wastewater discharges are listed in
Table 6 (Sonzogni and Lee, 1974). A breakdown by chemical
species of the nutrients input from each source is provided,
From these data a generalized nutrients budget for the lake
can be obtained (Table 7). The phosphorus and nitrogen
loadings are 1.2 g P/m2/yr and 13 g N/m2/yr> respectively.
328
-------
CM
c*.
CD
H
1
<^
EH
O
P
W
s
M *
^ rf^N
< CO
iJ ,O
H
OH
O 0
PM o
0
CO H
M
0 -P
P4 CO
ID a)
O £4
co id
EH §
w o
H -P
EH
3 TO
0)
Q >i
W -v.
EH CO
M
EH
CO
M
•
CO
a)
H
,Q
fd
EH
H
•PS
O
EH
bO
$-> 53
O
53
1
1
CO
O
3
^
1
+
j-
|r|
jg
H
rd
•P Pi
EH
a)
H
r£} p ,
3 1
HO
O
CO
O O
o o
CD O
CO CO
f-
o o
o o
O 0
•» r>
co co
LO
o
o
0
rt
o
H
4.
o
o
to
«\
co
o
o
o
•\
r-»
0 O
0 O
0 O
CM CO
H
0 O
0 O
CO O
o r*
H CD
D UH
Pi bO'H
0) fc O
•p fd a
CO
CM
o
o
o
«\
J-
CM
o
0
o
CM
o
o
o
r.
CM
•p
0) 3
o o
fd H
IH H
CO
J>,
Cl|
Q
o
o
o
LO
CO
H
o
o
o
•N
o
r~
o
0
o
«
o
CO
o
o
0
f\
LO
co
o
0
0
t^r
o
o
o
r*
,— (
c^
0)
0) Q) -P
X o fd
rd fd 15
H CM
P 'd
a d c
O CO 3
o
C_|
a
o
o
0
H
t*s.
H
O
0
o
»>
H
f-
H
O
O
o
H
o
o
o
«•>
H
Q)
bO
fd
ft
Q)
Q)
CO
0 0
0 0
0 0
LO OO
CO CO
H
0
o
o
n
CO
CO
o
o
o
" 1
LO
CO
,— (
1
o
0
o
n 1
•^ 1
CM
H
o
o
o
r, |
CM
H
1
^
•l-l
CM
u
o d C -d
H a) o d
IH bO'H rd
0 -P H
d) £-i ftf 'O
CO -P O
fd-H 0
03 3 ^
o
o
CD
r-
CD
H
H
o
0
H/
00*
OO
J-
J-
o o
0
0
co
r.
CO
to
f-.
o o
o
o
o
CD
o
H
o
o
co
o o «
0
co
a)
bO
rd
a
•l-l
l|_l nJ
14-1 c_|
o *d
P w fd
H -P
td o
SEn
r^
J-
[-^
CD
H
Q)
Q)
J
c
0) T3
bO C
o fd
f-l
•H c:
C bO
O
tsl
0 C
•M O
C co
fd
bO It
SH a)
O -P
C«4H
H <
+ *
329
-------
Table 7. NUTRIENT SOURCES FOR LAKE MENDOTA*
A. Phosphorus
Domestic Wastewaters
Urban Runoff
Rural Runoff
Precipitation
Dry Fallout
Ground Water
Base Flow
Kg/yr
908
7,264
31,326
908
3,178
454
5,448
TOTAL
49,486
B. Nitrogen
Wastewater
Urban Runoff
Rural Runoff
Precipitation
Dry Fallout
Ground Water
N-Fixation
Base Flow
Kg/yr
3,133
33,142
236,080
31,326
61,290
77,634
39,952
61,290
TOTAL
''After Sonzogni and Lee (1974).
543,847
Despite the wastewater diversion, the mean phosphorus
content of Lake Mendota has increased during the period
between 1970-1973. Data collected by Sonzogni (1974) pre-
sented in Table 8, show the mean phosphorus content of the
lake for this period. The calculated mean phosphorus lake
concentration, based on these values and the total lake
volume (486 x 106m3), ranges from 0.12 to 0.15 mg/1. A
mean value of 0.10 mgP/1 is obtained if one divides the
estimated phosphorus input by the volume of the lake. This
is interesting in that it appears that one could predict
the mean annual total phosphorus concentration for Lake
Mendota based solely on input data.
330
-------
Table 8. MEAN MONTHLY, WINTER AND ANNUAL PHOSPHORUS
CONTENTS FOR LAKE MENDOTA*
Mean
Content
Aug
Sept
Oct
Nov
Dec
Jan
Feb
March
April
May
June
July
Wintera
Annual
19
kg
70-19
x 10
DRP
5.
5.
5.
5.
4.
5.
5.
5.
1.
1.
3.
4.
5.
4.
7
5
8
3
9
2
0
3
7
9
6
8
1
6
71
-4
TP
7.
7.
7.
5.
5.
5.
5.
6.
4.
3.
4.
6.
5.
5.
0
2
2
9
8
9
8
1
6
0
8
3
8
8
1971-1972
kg x 10~4
DRP
5.
6.
5.
5.
5.
4.
4.
4.
4.
4.
4.
5.
4.
5.
3
3
6
5
2
2
3
7
9
6
2
1
6
0
TP
6
8
7
6
6
6
5
5
6
6
5
6
5
6
.9
.0
.3
.9
.4
.0
.4
.6
.4
.0
.8
.9
.9
.5
1972-1973
kg x 10~U
DRP
6.
6.
6.
6.
6.
6.
6.
7.
7.
6.
4.
3.
6.
6.
2
2
4
1
2
2
5
2
1
4
5
9
3
1
TP
8.1
7.6
7.7
6.9
6.9
7.1
7.1
8.4
8.1
7.2
6.6
6.2
7.0
7.3
Average for Dec, Jan and Feb
Average for Aug through July
*After Sonzogni (1974)
DISCUSSION
A summary of available nutrient loading data is
presented in Table 9. The Vollenweider (1974) loading
curve values based on the data presented here, are
1.2 gP/m /yr for phosphorus loading and 2.7 m/yr for
discharge height, q . When these values are plotted in
the loading vs. q flot (Vollenweider, 1974), Lake
Mendota falls in The eutrophic category (Figure 2). In
addition, this plot shows Lake Mendota to be in a
higher eutrophic state than was thought in 1965. It
should be noted that Vollenweider (1974) uses a q
value significantly smaller than the 2.7 m/yr whiSh was
an error in his original phosphorus loading lake response
curve relationships.
331
-------
Table 9. SUMMARY OF AVAILABLE NUTRIENT LOADING DATA
(1) Nutrient Loadings
Total Phosphorus
Total Nitrogen
(2) Chlorophyl-a
49,500 Kg/yr 1.2 g/m /yr
543,800 Kg/yr 13 g/m2/yr
Average total in lake 5,000 Kg
Maximum total in lake 8,000 Kg
Average for euphotic zone
Maximum for euphotic zone
Average primary production
(estimated)
(3) Physical Features of Lake Mendota
Mean Depth
Maximum Depth
Area
Total Volume
Depth of Euphotic Zone
Volume of Euphotic Zone
Hydraulic filling time
Discharge height, q
12 m
23 m 7
39.4 Km\
486 x 10 m
3m c Q
90 x 10 m
4.5 yr
2.7 m/yr
125
200
25
40 mg/m
4g C/m2/day
Examination of chemical characteristics through an
annual cycle, and algal assay studies such as those of
Walton and Lee (1972) as well as others at the University
of Wisconsin at Madison (G. P. Fitzgerald), have shown
the phosphorus concentration of the water is the key
factor governing the excessive growth of planktonic
and attached algae during the summer. Stauffer and Lee
(1973) have demonstrated that many of the obnoxious
blue-green algal blooms that occur in summer are caused
by thermocline downward migration. This results in the
transport of hypolimnetic phosphorus to the epilimriian.
According to Vollenweider (1974), the current phos-
phorus loading of Lake Mendota is about ten times the
"permissible" loading. Because the lake receives its
nutrients primarily from diffuse rural sources (Table 7),
reduction of phosphorus loading to the "permissible" level
does not appear to be likely. In fact, it appears that
technical, economic and political factors involved
would make significant reduction of these loads difficult,
if not impossible (Lee, 1972).
332
-------
J 1
-
-
-
-
^
-
••
"
-
~
_
-
-
"
-
-
_
1 1
3
III! t
>
o
O
cc
LJ
O
Z
^t
0
\
\
\
\
^" *£
""•x^ '5
10^_ E
1 [ ^^^_ ^ — — — —
"*\
01
-H'
,£
w
£
0
•* e
4-> -
I \> I! " i •
""^^~ *^^ ^ — — — 1\~- ~Q 1 v
\ \ " " .
\ S IN 5 '
^^ \ \ — 1 '
^-N \ N t
:3 V x X ? "
* \\ \ K 1
— * \ «\ x 1
\ Z «-A^-\^«\ 1
Is A \ \\ i
S* o>* »2 Nv ^
o *•* -"i ~* \ T -
: s i\. Pv >l:
5 • + o *~« \ \4c ' 5 :
• Q. \ ^ \» ' ^
: • \ \ V 1 ^ '
! -0 \ \ \ If
2 \ \ 1 T O
^^ \ V 3 1 li_
t^. S c»\ ^ X 0 -
Q!^ @y ^ > \ !\i *^ "^" z
^F 0^ ^••^ * ^4^ 0 1 O
^~ 2 x x \ ! 1 % '
•* o • \ oo \l i o
£ \ * 1 1 <->
S \ ^ K i -
co Z v ^^ -^— ' * ^x ^^
^^ \^^ Ol \ ^i "^
5 ^ .^1 . \ o ^ o *T Q.
\ i jov :0 • !° | * \
\ *~ \ ^ 1 oi
\ \ 3 '
- N \ • il-
ls \ P j|
1 \ \ 1
\ , uj
_i
o •
>
LJ
UJ
1 j 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 t
S 3 c
^/d& 9NIQV01
333
^•x
O
O
O
t
V)
o cr
ii
4-
IN
>
-------
In order for the public to perceive a significant
reduction in the frequency and severity of excessive blooms
of planktonic blue-green algae, the phosphorus loadings
would have to be decreased by at least a factor of five.
Yet according to Vollenweider (1974), despite a re-
duction of this magnitude, the lake would still have a
"dangerous" phosphorus loading level.
From an overall point of view, as a result of increased urban-
ization of the Lake Mendota watershed, it is highly likely that water
quality in the lake will slowly deteriorate. Increased
frequency of severe blue-green algal blooms and excessive
growth of attached algae and macrophytes in littoral
areas during the summer can be expected. Based on the
current technology, it appears that efforts to control
water quality deterioration from excessive fertilization
of the lake should be directed towards maximal reduction
of the phosphorus input from agricultural drainage and
urban storm drainage. With respect to the former, par-
ticular emphasis should be given to controlling phos-
phorus input from animal manures associated with dairy
farming. While it appears very unlikely that efforts
to curb phosphorus input to Lake Mendota will create a
measureable improvement in lake water quality, they
probably will benefit area residents by slowing the de-
terioration.
As Lee noted in 1972, the use of chemicals such as
alum to precipitate phosphorus could improve Lake Mendota
water quality. This potential solution is both technically
and economically feasible. The evidence available today
clearly indicates that such a procedure would reduce
significantly the frequency of the severe blue-green
algal blooms that occur each summer. While alum should
be used to treat the open waters of the lake, simultaneously
a combination of mechanical weed harvesters and aquatic
herbicides should be used to control excessive attached
algae and macrophyte growth in selected areas of the lake.
It is technically and economically feasible to
improve the water quality of Lake Mendota through judi-
cious use of chemicals to control both excessive phos-
phorus and excessive plant growth. However, it is not
politically feasible at this time because environmental
activist groups wield sufficient political power to pre-
vent use of such techniques although they have proven
highly successful elsewhere.
334
-------
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
Information which serves as a basis for this report was collected through
the support of numerous granting agencies. However, primary support for
many of these studies was derived from US EPA and its predecessor organi-
zations. In addition, substantial support to these studies was given by
the University of Wisconsin-Madison, especially the Departments of Botany,
Zoology, and Civil and Environmental Engineering. Special recognition is
given to the assistance of J. Magnuson and A. D. Hasler of the University
of Wisconsin-Madison laboratory of limnology for their help in compiling
various reports used in this investigation.
REFERENCES
1. Bortleson, G. C. and G. F. Lee, Recent Sedimentary
History of Lake Mendota, Wisconsin. Environ. Sci.
Teohnol. 6_: 799-808, 1972.
2. Bryson, R. A. and R. A. Ragotzkie, Rate of Water
Replacement in a Bay of Lake Mendota, Wisconsin.
Amer. J. Sci. 253: 533-539, 1955.
3. Bryson, R. A. and V. E. Suomi, The Circulation of
Lake Mendota. Trans. Amer. Geophys. Union. 33:
707-712, 1952
4. Clarke, D. B. and R. A. Bryson, An Investigation of
the Circulation over Second Point Bar, Lake Men-
dota. Limnol. Oceanogr. 4_: 140-144, 1959.
5. Cline, D. R. Geology and Ground-Water Resources of
Dane County, Wisconsin. USGS Water-Supply Paper
1779-U, 1965.
6. Conway, C. J. Oxygen Depletion in the Hypolimnion.
M.S. Thesis, University of Wisconsin, 1972.
7. Frey, D. G. (ed.) Limnology in North America. The
University of Wisconsin Press, Madison, 1963.
8. Lee, G. F. Studies on the Fe, Mn, SO^ and Si Balances
and Distribution for Lake Mendota, Madison,
Wisconsin. Trans. Wisconsin Acad. Sci. Arts Lett.
51: 141-155, 1962.
335
-------
9. Lee, G. F. Ways in Which a Resident of the Madison
Lakes Watershed May Help to Improve Water Quality
in the Lakes. A report of the Water Chemistry
Program, University of Wisconsin, 1972.
10. Lee, G. F. Water Chemistry Program Report No. A-18
University of Wisconsin, 1966.
11. McNaught, D. C. The Fishes of Lake Mendota. Wis. Acad.
of Sci. Arts and Lett. 52: 37-55, 1963.
12. Murray, R. C. Recent Sediments of Three Wisconsin
Lakes. Bull. Geol. Soc. Amer., 67: 883-910, 1956.
13. Nichols, S. A. and S. Mori, The Littoral Vegetation
of Lake Wingra. Trans. Wise. Acad. Sci. Arts and
Letters. _59_: 107-119, 1971.
14. Ryther, J. H. and C. S. Yentsch, The Estimation of
Phytoplankton Production in the Ocean from
Chlorophyll and Light Data. Limnol. Oceanogr.
2_: 281-294, 1957.
15. Shulman, M. and R. A. Bryson, The Vertical Variation
of Wind Driven Currents in Lake Mendota. Limnol.
Oceangr. 6_: 347-355, 1961
16. Sonzogni, W. C. "Effect of Nutrient Input Reduction
on the Eutrophication of the Madison Lakes", Ph.D.
Thesis, Water Chemistry, University of Wisconsin,
Madison, 1974.
17. Sonzogni, W. C. and G. F. Lee Nutrient Sources for
Lake Mendota - 1972. Trans. Wisconsin Acad. Sci.
Arts and Letters. 62: 133-164, 1974.
18. Stauffer, R. E. and G. F. Lee, The Role of the Ther-
mocline in Regulating Algal Blooms. In: Modeling
the Eutrophication Process, Workshop Proc., Utah
State University, Nov. 1973.
19. Torrey, M. S. Biological Nitrogen Fixation in Lake
Mendota. Ph.D. Thesis, University of Wisconsin,
1972.
20. Twenhofel, W. H. The Physical and Chemical Character-
istics of the Sediments of Lake Mendota, A Fresh-
water Lake of Wisconsin. Jour. Sed. Pet. _3_: 68-76,
1933.
21. Vollenweider, R. A. Input-Output Models. Canada
Centre for Inland Waters, Mimeo, 1974.
22. Walton, C. P. and G. F. Lee, A Biological Evaluation
of the Molybdenum Blue Method for Orthophosphate
Analysis. Verh. Internat. Verein Limnol. 18:
676-684, 1972.
336
-------
REPORT ON NUTRIENT LOAD - EUTROPHICATION RESPONSE
OF LAKE WINGRA, WISCONSIN
Walter Rast and G. Fred Lee
Institute for Environmental Sciences
University of Texas at Dallas
Richardson, Texas
INTRODUCTION
Lake Wingra is the smallest of the lakes of the Yahara River chain at
Madison, Wisconsin. It is a shallow, hardwater eutrophic lake. The drainage
area of Lake Wingra is composed of the University of Wisconsin Arboretum and
a portion of the urban region of southwest Madison.
GEOGRAPHIC DESCRIPTION
Lake Wingra is located within the city of Madison, Wisconsin. The lati-
tude and longitude of the centroid of the water area are 43°04.2' N and
89°23.6' W, respectively. The lake surface stands at an altitude of 848 feet
above sea level (Huff et al., 1973). The size and location of Lake Wingra
relative to the other lakes of the Yahara River chain are illustrated in
Figure 1. The drainage basin is composed of a portion of the urban region
of southwest Madison, and the University of Wisconsin Arboretum, approximately
one-third of which drains directly to the lake. The urban area enclosed by
the Lake Wingra drainage basin comprises residential middle- and upper middle-
class homes (Kluesener and Lee, 1974). The lake has a cumulative drainage
area of 8.1 mi2 (2.1 x 107 m2) including lake surface area, but 2.2 mi2
(9 x 106 m2) drain directly into Murphy Creek, bypassing Lake Wingra proper.
Murphy Creek is the major outlet from Lake Wingra and flows directly into
Lake Monona.
CLIMATE
The climate of the basin is typically continental. The summers are hot and
the winters cold. The annual average temperature at Madison is 46.2°F and ranges
from an average of 17.7°F in January to an average of 72.7°F in July. During
337
-------
Figure I
Lakes of the Yahara River chain at Madison, Wisconsin*
338
-------
the winter months, December through March, the mean monthly
temperature is below 32 F. The growing season generally
extends from late April to mid-October and averages 175 days
(Cline, 1965).
Although the record for Lake Wingra is incomplete, from 1877
to the present the lake froze over, on the average, on No-
vember 25 and thawed on March 29, for an average ice-bound
period of 125 days (Noland, 1950, cited in Frey, 1963).
The precipitation varies widely during the year. The maximum
and minimum monthly precipitation occur in June and February,
respectively. During May through September, there are
generally three to four inches of precipitation occurring
per month. Between one and two inches of precipitation per
month usually occurs during November through February. The
total yearly precipitation at Madison averages 31.2 inches,
which includes an average annual snowfall of 37.8 inches, or
about seven inches of precipitation. The evapo-transpiration
rate from that part of the Yahara River basin covered by
lakes and marshes is about equal to the precipitation (Cline,
1965).
GEOLOGIC DESCRIPTION
Lake Wingra occupies a pre-glacial valley system evacuated
by streams in sandstones and sandy dolomites of upper Cam-
brian Age. The lake was formed as a result of morainic dam-
ming during the most recent ice age (Twenhofel, 1933). Rocks
of Cambrian Age, principally sandstone and dolomite, were
deposited in shallow seas on a surface of igneous and meta-
morphic rocks of Precambrian Age ; dolomite and sandstone of
Ordovician Age were deposited on the Cambrian rocks. Glacial
drift and loess overlie these formations (Cline, 1965).
339
-------
Most of Lake Wingra's immediate shores are swamp and bog,
and its shoreline material is mostly the lake's own organic
deposits (Murray, 1956).
CHARACTERISTICS OF WATERSHED
Most of the vegetation surrounding Lake Wingra is that of
the University of Wisconsin Arboretum. It is composed
principally of coniferous and decidous forests, prairies,
gardens and marshes. The Arboretum comprises approximately
800 acres, 20 percent of the drainage area of the lake. Of
this 800 acres, approximately 470 acres consist of forests,
while the remaining 330 acres consist of prairies, gardens
and marshes (Kluesener, 1972).
Approximately 200,000 people reside in Madison, Wisconsin,
on the northeast shore of Lake Wingra. Land usage in the
Lake Wingra drainage basin is summarized in Table 1.
Table. 1. LAND USAGE IN LAKE WINGRA DRAINAGE BASIN*
Lake Wingra Basin
Area draining to Lake Wingra
Residential Area
Arboretum
Lake and Ponds
Area draining directly to Murphy Creek
Acres
5200
3800
2600
775
337
1400
Area
Hectares
2104
1538
1052
314
136
566
*After Kluesener, 1972
340
-------
The residential drainage area consists mainly of storm sewer
drain outlets, and also includes approximately 100 acres of
golf courses and cemeteries (Kluesener, 1972).
Lake Wingra is used mainly for sports, fishing and recrea-
tion. There have never been any sewage or industrial dis-
charges into Lake Wingra (Sonzogni, 1974) except for oc-
casional sewer overflow due to failure of the sewage pump-
ing station.
MORPHOMETRIC AND HYDROLOGIC DESCRIPTION
Lake Wingra has a surface area, including lagoons and ponds,
c o
of 137 hectares (1.37 X 10 m ). It has a maximum length of
2.09 km, a maximum effective length of 2.16 km, a maximum
width of 1.11 km and a mean width of 0.63 km. The shoreline
is 5.91 km long. It has a shoreline development figure of
1.45 and a development of volume of 1.19. The water volume,
p
including ponds and estimated lagoon volume, is 3.35 X 10 -
3
m . The maximum depth of the lake is 6.10 m and the mean
depth (volume/surface area) is 2.42 m (Figure 2) (Huff et
al. , 1973). Because of its shallow mean depth (2.42 m) ,
the lake does not permanently thermally stratify; the epi-
limnion generally extends to the bottom all year round
(Murray, 1956).
CHARACTERISTICS OF SEDIMENTS
The sediments of Lake Wingra have been studied extensively.
The shore and bottom deposits are predominantly marl. In
the sixties, Frey (1963) established that the recent bottom
consists of gray marl, which becomes shell marl in shallow
water. Murray (1956) established that the top six inches
of recent sediment are a gray to dark gray marl. At least
341
-------
342
-------
some locations in the lake contain abundant gastropod shells
and clam shell fragments. The carbonate content is approxi-
mately 54 percent in the most recent sediments. The organic
matter present in the sediment ranges from 11.7 to 13.5 per-
cent (similar in organic content to the black sludge and
buff marl of Lake Mendota). The elastics appear to be con-
centrated in the fine sizes. The surrounding bogs of Lake
Wingra permit very little clastic deposition because little
clastic material is available on the shore. The lack of
black sediments similar to those found in Lake Mendota is
thought to be evidence that Lake Wingra has a constant avail-
ability of oxygen throughout the epilimnion, which extends
to the bottom. A sediment core analysis was conducted by
Bortleson (1970), and the results of the upper five cen-
timeters are summarized in Table 2.
Table 2. SEDIMENT ANALYSIS FOR THE UPPER
5 CM OF DRY SEDIMENTS*
Component
Fe
N
P
Ca
Lake Mendota
(mg/g dry wt)
20-25
10
2
125
Lake Wingra
(mg/g dry wt)
9
7-8
0.6
230-240
*After Bortleson, 1970
More recently, Bannerman (1973) examined Lake Wingra sedi-
ments in some detail for interstitial concentrations of in-
organic phosphorus. He found that levels of total phosphorus,
total inorganic phosphorus and total organic phosphorus
343
-------
present in core samples from both the open water areas and
littoral zone were in good agreement with values for Lake
Wingra sediments reported previously by others (Williams
et al_. , 1971; Li et_ a^. , 1972). By contrast, sediments
from lakes Mendota and Monona revealed levels of phosphorus
approximately twice as large as those in Lake Wingra
(Williams et_ al., 1970). It is believed this is due to the
nature of the input waters into these lakes. Lake Wingra
receives primarily urban runoff (Lee and Kluesner, 1971),
while Lake Mendota and Lake Monona receive a combination of
urban and agricultural runoff.
HYDROLOGY
The hydraulic residence time (water body volume/annual in-
flow volume) was calculated to be 0.4-4 years, based on
data from Kluesner (1972) and Huff et_ al. (1973). The
annual input for Lake Wingra is the sum of the precipitation,
springflow, urban runoff and groundwater input. The USGS
data as reported by Kluesner (1972) was used for the annual
precipitation, springflow and urban runoff inputs (1 X 10°
m3/yr, 1.4 X 106 m3/yr and 1.0 X 106 m3/yr, respectively).
Kluesner did not report the groundwater input to the lake.
As the groundwater input is considered to be essentially
constant, Huff's groundwater input for the period April 10
to September 15, 1970 (158 days) was extrapolated to a full
year (=2.3 X 10^ m3/yr) and used in the calculation of the
hydraulic residence time. Thus, the hydraulic residence
time is calculated to be 0.44 years (i.e., lake volume
(2.5 X 106 m3)/total annual input (5.7 X 106 m3/yr)).
A water balance summary for Lake Wingra for the period
April 10, 1970 to September 15, 1970 is presented in Table 3.
344
-------
•K
pis
( — (
u
y, r.
< o
J rH
rH
• -H
CO £-<
O.
0) <
2 *"*
(0
H
0)
O
ro
M-l
3 bO ^
CO C oo
(B E
0) ,C ^
rX CJ
5
3
4) O -~~
IB MH E
-J -P -—
3
O
0)
O 3
IB O '-•
^ rH 00
k 'P E
3 C ~
CO M
j_,
01
•P
IB
3 to --N
1.3 °5
o
t,
CD
Sj
p
n) 3
C *M E
3 C ~
0 M
CJ
c
o
•H
4-i
rd -N
0 E
a --^
IB
W
c
o
•H
^_j
rC ^N
•fJ ro
O. ^
•H
0
(U
t,
p
13
O
•H
fci
01
a.
o o o o o o
o o o o o o
CD CNJ J O LO LO
rj- oo LO en o r~
1 LO oo r~ CN a
1 1 CN> CNI
1
O O O O 0 J-
O O O O CNI
I-) CM O 00
CN 3- a LO
tt) C^ CO
CM X rH
O O O O O O
O O O O O 0
o LO oo oo en ai
00 CO CO rH J -J
FN rH CN) U r—i OO
CXI rH
O O O O O O
0 O 0 0 O O
r^ O OO CD CO O
LO OO LO rH ^ CD
CNI 00 00 LO CNJ LO
rH CNI rH
O O 0 0 0 0
O O 0 0 0 O
LO CD CO J3" rH CO
O CNI LO r-- r~ OO
oo 3- o oo — I r-
CNI CNI CNI rH rH
0 O 0 O O O
0 O O 0 0 0
3- O O ro CO rH
rH CN r^- ro CO C£>
oo j3~ r^ co LO ^
rH rH rH pH
O O O O O O
000000
O O OO CO CD rH
i — 1 i — [ Co ro oo en
CO rH r- 00 CO 00
CV rH
0
00 rH O rH rH LO
1 ro no no ro rH
011(11
-H rH rH rH rH rH
t. >i c -H oo a,
LX ro 3 3 3 0
< S '-o >-D < CO
O
0 1 1
OO 1 1
** 1 1
no
CO
1
o r-
o
rH 1 CO
" t 00
r~ I
o
en
3
o ro o
0 • J
LO LO 1 EH
^ CNI 1 f— I
r- 0
1/5
O
fr1
or- 2
o • W
CM i r- o
en i w
ID
CO
1/3
ro
"
O co ro
o . e
00 J3- 1
CNJ | O
iH CO
0
« no
rH CO
ro M
£
ro
0 £
o
o to j- o
o • *• o
rH 1 CO J ID
co t ro o
co no *> UD
r- £ CM CNI
O M CNJ
O
to <— > 1
- 13
o o o
CD -J O
o en CN fj.) j
o ^ H
CO CD 1 CNI -0 J
LO I u ^^ ro
r- ~
LO 3 CO CNI
O W
•J CO
UH CO ••
H 2 o a;
H 2 M J O
2 W U,
W U J J
O IX < < Q
OH W E-< E-l W
w a. o o H
3 3
3 O O O O
J O -3 O O O
< J UH rH rH O
H LL. H CK Di <
O 2 3 U U 2
H HH O CL O. 3
ro
r-
r— 1
p
.
rH
iB
•P
CD
<4_(
UH
D
X
t4
0)
OH
<£
*
345
-------
PHYSICAL AND CHEMICAL DESCRIPTION
Dissolved oxygen studies (Kluesener, 1972) have shown that
the lake is poorly mixed in the vertical plane when covered
with ice. This is contrasted with relatively infrequent
vertical stratification, with respect to dissolved oxygen,
during the summer.
Lake Wingra was sampled for temperature, pH, dissolved
oxygen (DO), alkalinity, calcium and total phosphorus and
nitrogen, including N and P species, at four open water and
four littoral zone stations. Sampling frequency was limited
to collecting samples every two weeks. The sampling period
ranged from twelve to eighteen months, depending on the
parameter studied. Samples were collected at the one and
two meter depths, with occasional sampling at three meters
if the lake was sufficiently high. Kluesener (1972) pro-
vides the details on the characteristics of the sampling
program, analytical methods and data obtained in the study.
A summary of Kluesener's (1972) results are presented below.
Throughout most of the year the temperature was constant
over the extent of the water column (Figure 3). Differences
were seen at 1 m and 3 m depths during the winter as the
bottom waters gained some heat from the lake sediments.
After ice-out the lake warmed rapidly and was about 13 C by
the end of April of both 1970 and 1971. The normal summer
temperatures averaged approximately 23°C until the cooling
trend began in September (Kluesener, 1972). In the winter
when the water is clear, the Secchi disk reading was approxi-
mately 2 m (Figure 3). It was reduced to about 1 m after
ice-out in both 1970 and 1971. From May to September in
both 1970 and 1971, it was further reduced to 0.6-0.7 m.
346
-------
Hd
3-
O
CJ
O
O
IHDD3S
wnionvo
347
-------
Light intensity was measured throughout the ice-free period
in the air above the water, just below the water surface and
at the depths of 0.5, 1.0 and 2.0m. Between April and
August, 1970, average values were 32 percent, 13 percent
and 3.2 percent transmitted through the first 0.5 m, the
upper 1 m and the upper 2 m, respectively (Table U). The
corresponding Secchi disk reading was about 0.85 m.
The pH (Figure 3) averaged 7.7 throughout the winter of
1970. It increased after ice-out to a maximum of 9.4 dur-
ing September and October, and then decreased to 7.7 again
by March, 1971.
The annual variations in the dissolved oxygen content for
1 and 3 m are also given in Figure 3. The dissolved oxygen
(DO) content was approximately zero by late winter of both
1970 and 1971 and remained at that level until ice-out. In
the upper meter of the lake water column, the DO decreased
at a relatively constant rate in January and February of
both 1970 and 1971. The average oxygen depletion rate was
approximately 0.18 mg DO/l/day. In March, 1971, the oxygen
depletion rate was much slower, and it took nearly the
entire month to remove the remaining 1.5 mg/1 DO at the 1 m
depth. The DO then rose sharply as soon as ice-out occurred,
and the water column remained essentially saturated at all
depths throughout the open water period. The only excep-
tions were moderate DO stratifications during sampling in
June and July, 1970. In the mornings, the DO in the litto-
ral sampling stations showed a slightly higher concentration
than in the main body of the lake. Also, the DO showed a
definite increasing tendency in progressing from the first
lake station to the final station. It is believed this
higher DO concentration in the littoral zones was due to
the presence of macrophytes, especially Myriophyllum, in
348
-------
Table 4. PERCENT OF LIGHT MEASURED JUST ABOVE THE
SURFACE OF LAKE WINGRA WHICH ACTUALLY PENETRATES
TO A SPECIFIED DEPTH (0.5, 1.0, 2.0m)
IN THE LAKE*
Date
Apr 11 1970
Apr 27
May 11
May 25
June 5
June 22
July 6
Aug 3
Aug 17
Aug 31
Sep 14
Sep 28
Oct 12
Oct 26
Nov 23
Apr 13 1971
Apr 26
0.5m
33
33
26
26
63
28
26
35
18
34
44
44
37
55
65
48
38
Depth
1.0m
16
21
7.3
11
32
10
10
12
7
9
19
16
12
22
30
24
18
2.0m
4
7
2
12
3
2
2
1
6
4
7
10
Secchi Depth
m
1.0
1.0
0.75
0.90
1.5
0.85
0.75
0.65
0.60
0.60
0.65
0.70
0.80
1.05
0.65
0.95
•'After Kluesener, 1972
349
-------
the littoral zone throughout the winter, as these organisms
are able to undergo photosynthesis even under ice and at
light intensities below those required for algae (Kluesener,
1972). A relatively sharp oxygen stratification between the
1 and 3 m depth in the winter indicates this lake is very
poorly mixed in the vertical plane when covered with ice.
The data for the average phosphorus concentrations are sum-
marized in Figure H. After mid-January, the total phosphorus
(t-P) concentration of the lake remained nearly constant at
approximately 0.06 mg P/l. The annual average t-P concentra-
tion was 0.07 mg P/l; the annual average dissolved reactive
phosphorus (DRP) concentration was 0.02 mg P/l. The average
DRP concentration was approximately 0.08 mg P/l throughout
the growing season, and nearly O.OU mg P/l at the end of the
winter season.
The average annual variation for the nitrogen species in
Lake Wingra is summarized in Figure 5. The total nitrogen
concentration varied from 1.0 to 1.8 mg N/l for the study.
The inorganic nitrogen (i.e., NO--N and NH^-N) concentration
averaged 1.51 mg N/l for the entire year and 1.01 mg N/l
for the growing season (i.e., May through September).
Comparison of both the phosphorus and nitrogen data with
earlier studies (Domogalla and Fred, 1926; Tressler and
Domogalla, 1931; and Clesceri, 1961) suggests that there
has been little change in the average levels of nitrogen
and phosphorus in Lake Wingra in the last M-5 years (Kluese-
ner, 1972).
The inorganic nitrogen/dissolved reactive phosphorus and
atomic ratios during the annual cycle and during the
growing season, are greater than 30. As a critical N:P
atomic ratio of 16 or greater in natural waters is indicative
of phosphorus limitation, this suggests that Lake Wingra
is phosphorus limited with respect to aquatic plant nutrients .
350
-------
fc
970 to June
Figure 4
Average concentration of phosphorus in the open water of Lake Wingra from January 1
CM
N
0)
luesener,
*After K
imit for phosphorus LEGEND1
V
1
1 phosphorus 1 o.009 ma/I
Ived reactive L
phorus
reactive [-DRP+0.002 mg/l
jhorus (unfiltered)
filterable
Chorus
s 1% ssss
O •- .C ,O C. .O.C
1- o a 1— a. J- Q.
U U U n
CL a. a. a.
1 or or u.
0 I- \-
ID
CVJ ,_
OJ O
o
- CO
ro
0
N Z>
ro <
c\j Z CD
— 5
in
— Q_
CE
5
•*> ~
OJ QD
UJ
u.
en
"Sz
CM CD ^ O
O o
-------
in
0)
k.
3
O»
iZ
fe
k.
V
c
a>
W
3
*
k. 0»
a> c
1 1
a
c
4>
O* x.
2 ^
± «» E
<= £ CM
H §
1 8 $
tt 1
§8 V
*= *
>£ >» i_i
i o
S^ TJ
cn o
1 1 I
_
fc«J *-- T
1 J «- *
i^^^^ •-
i • 1 .
i 1 i_3"™
1 • ' i B
x ' ' *~*
_1 I— > U
0
6
4-1 u LJ
1 l_l U
O l-J ""^
U U
k-JU
UJ •_•
LJ
"•^
V V
JZ *- c —^-^^.^K—
U.
O O^
w
1 .„ ^ft ^J ^J
O t ^™
C 0 >,
O w u.
E jj °
< O J3
4> Q) fO
O> Q. CJ
§ ° C
oj
Ojg
0 2
U)
OJ
1-
cvjo
00
CJ Q.
cn
N. "^
O _j
iO ">
OJ Z
OJ ^
If) '
tf> >.
- s
oj o:
a.
(£
UJ
o o o o
CM CD ^T Q
- o 6
N
01
LJ
h-
<
O
N390dllN
352
-------
Alkalinity was at a maximum during the winter months (see
Figure 3), decreasing after ice-out as the temperature and
biological activity increased. It .decreased, in a nearly
linear fashion from the end of April to the end of Septem-
ber. It remained constant in October, and then increased
to approximately 200 mg/1 as CaC03 in March, 1971. The
calcium concentration showed more variability during this
same time period, but it followed the same general trend
as the alkalinity (Kluesener, 1972).
BIOLOGICAL DESCRIPTION
ALGAE
The mean annual freshweight phytoplankton biomass in Lake
2
Wingra was approximately 16 g/m in 1970-71, with a growing
2
season average of approximately 25 g/m (Figure 6). The phyto-
plankton primary productivity was found to be about 2.4- g C/
2 2
m /day (870 g C/m /yr), with a growing season average of about
2
4.6 gC/m /day. The phytoplankton class composition pattern
for the same time period (Figure 7) shows the winter phyto-
plankton biomass to be dominated by the algae Cryptophyceae,
while the spring season shows a dominance by the diatoms.
They rapidly give way to the green algae. This is followed
in the late summer and early fall by a dominance of the blue-
green algae.
FISH
Early management practices (e.g., introduction of carp in
the late 1880's, fish rescue and stocking operations during
the 1930's, and carp removal programs during the 1930's,
1940's and 1950's) have had marked effects upon the fish
populations in Lake Wingra. A total of 23 fish species have
353
-------
Figure 6
Average daily productivity and freshweight biomass of
phytoplankton in Lake Wingra.*
• • PRODUCTIVITY
o—o FRESHWEIGHT
80 m
en
x
601
401
A
•^
3
Figure 7
Class composition pattern for phytoplankton in Lake Wingra*
100
H h
ICE COVER
QCRYPTOPHYCEAE
QTJ CHLOROPHYCEAE
2) CHRY30PHYCCAE
=3 BACILLARIOPHYCEAF
MYXOPHYCEAE
DINOFHYCF-AE
EUGLENOPtlYCEAE
After Huff et al., 1973
354
-------
been introduced into Lake Wingra at one time or another in
the past. Of these, two—the yellow bass and white crappie-
have become abundant. The carp was introduced into Lake
Wingra in the 1880's and became extremely abundant by the
1950's. Consequently, an intensive carp seining program
was instituted by the Wisconsin Conservation Department
between 1953 and 1955 because earlier efforts had not re-
duced the population to low enough levels (Neess et al,,
1957, cited in Hasler, 1963). Both largemouth bass and
blueg.il! populations have recovered since the carp popu-
lation became somewhat controlled (see Figure 8). The blue-
gill responded by becoming the dominant species in the lake.
This increase, together with the establishment of white
crappie and yellow bass, have produced the large, stunted
panfish population which characterizes the present sport
fishery (Baumann et al., 1974).
ZOOPLANKTON
Of the 48 cladoceran species present in Lake Wingra in
1891, only 23 are still present today (Table 5) (Baumann
ejt al. , 1974). Only four new species have been added to
the list during this period. Sampling of the benthos dur-
ing 1970-1972 has shown an invertebrate fauna dominated by
small chironomids. No live mollusks or relatively large
insects were found. The macroinvertebrate Hyalella azteca
has virtually vanished. Intense fish predation on larger
invertebrates may explain the rather recent decline of
larger cladocerans and benthos in Lake Wingra.
355
-------
(xlO)
(xlO)
Figure 8
Relative abundance of major fishes in Lake Wingra
from 1890 to 1973, reconstructed from the literature*
LONGNOSE GAR
//////////////////////TTTv
IORTHERN PIKE
LARGEMOUTH BASS
(xlO)l
WALLEYE
YELLOW PERCH
CARP
i i i r i i r i T
1890 1900 1910 1920 1930 1940 1950 I960 1970
V)
Q
0:6x0
OCEQ.Z
-
^
02
H
3o
23
CD <
After Baumann etal.1974
356
-------
Table 5. CLADOCERAN SPECIES RECORDED FROM LAKE WINGRA
BY BIRGE (1891) AND MORE RECENT STUDIES BY
WHITE AND HASLER (1972)*
SPECIES
Acroperus harpae
Alona affinis
Alona costata
Alona guttata
Alona quadrangularis
Alona rectangula
Alonella excisa
Alonella exigua
Bosimina longirostris
Camptocercus macrurus
Camptocercus rectirostris
Ceriodaphnia laticaudata
Ceriodaphnia megalops
Ceriodaphnia pulchella
Ceriodaphnia quadrangula
Ceriodaphnia reticulata
Chydorus globosus
Chydorus ovalis
Chydorus sphaericus
Daphnia ambigua
Daphnia galeata
Daphnia pulex
Daphnia retrocurva
Daphnia schodleri
Diaphanosoma brachyurum
D. leuchtenbergianum
Drepanothrix dentata
Dunhevia crassa
Eurycercus lamellatus
Graptoleberis testudinaria
Holopedium gibberum
Ilyocruptus sordidus
Ilyocryptus spinifer
1891
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
PRESENT
1971
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
(continued)
357
-------
Table 5 (continued)
SPECIES
PRESENT
1891
* After Baumann et al. , 19 7 M-
1971
Latona setifera
Latonopis occidentalis
Lathonuria rectrirostris
Leptodora kindtii
Leydigia quadrangular is
Macrothrix laticornis
Macrothrix rosea
Ophryoxus gracilis
Oxyurella tenuicaudis
Pleuroxus denticulatus
Pleuroxus procurvus
Pleuroxus striatus
Pleuroxus trigonellus
Polyphemus pediculus
Sida crystallina
Scapholeberis aurita
Scapholeberis kingi
Simocephalus serrulatus
Simocephalus vetulus
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
TOTAL 48
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
27
358
-------
MACROPHYTES
Around 1900, the shallow areas of Lake Wingra were dominated
by cattails and bulrushes. Wild rice abounded in slightly
deeper water, while submerged vegetation included water
celery and pondweed. Dredging and filling in areas of the
original lake (in 1900 Lake Wingra had a shallower maximum
depth and covered about twice its present area) have pro-
duced water level fluctuations which have reduced the area
available for littoral growth. In addition to hydrographic
changes, from the 1920's to the mid-1950Ts the carp popula-
tion essentially denuded Lake Wingra of macrophytes. After
the carp removal program of the 1950's, vegetation of a
different type returned to the lake. The Eurasian water
milfoil, Myriophyllum spicatum, now dominates the macroflora
of Lake Wingra.
Presently, five littoral communities occur in Lake Wingra.
In shallow water, Myriophyllum constitutes 68 percent of the
macroflora. In deeper waters, the communities are Myriophyl-
lum, 13 percent; Potamogeton-Myriophyllum, 17 percent;
Nuphar, 5 percent; and Nymphaea, 2 percent. Dominant emer-
gents are Typha latifolia, T_. angustifolia and Scirpus
validus. The littoral zone covers approximately one-third
of the lake's surface area and extends to 2.7 - 0.4 meters.
It is believed the littoral zone depth is dictated by light
penetration, and that major reduction in turbidity would
allow water milfoil stands to develop throughout the lake
(Baumann ejt al. , 1974). Foraging by the carp population and
resultant mixing of the muds are believed to have caused an
increased turbidity and reduced light penetration. Their
removal to less than 10 percent of their 1953 numbers by
seining has been followed by an increased macrophyte popula-
tion, indicating that control of the spread of macrophytes
359
-------
may have been one of their functions (Neess e_t al. , 1955,
cited in Kluesener, 1972).
NUTRIENT BUDGETS
Major potential nutrient sources for Lake Wingra have
been shown to be precipitation, dry fallout, springflow,
groundwater flow, urban runoff, surface runoff from the
Arboretum and drainage from the marshes. The annual average
nutrient loadings from precipitation, dry fallout, spring-
flow and urban runoff are presented in Tables 6, 7, 8 and 9,
respectively.
Groundwater loading into Lake Wingra could not be estimated
by Kluesener because there was insufficient information
available concerning the piezometric head and transmissi-
bility of the soil in the lake vicinity. It is likely that
any groundwater flow other than surface springs enters the
lake through submerged springs, but these sources have not
been identified. The marshes are believed to have input
nutrient loads roughly equal to output nutrients.
The nutrient budget for Lake Wingra is summarized in Table
10. The most significant source of phosphorus to Lake
Wingra is the urban runoff. More than 80 percent of the
total phosphorus (980 kg/yr) and 90 percent of the dissolved
reactive phosphorus (570 kg/yr) influent to Lake Wingra
comes from this source (Kluesener, 1972). Very little dis-
solved reactive phosphorus enters the lake between storms
(Huff e_t al. , 1973). Precipitation, dry fallout and spring-
flow contribute almost equally to the dissolved reactive
phosphorus input (25, 21 and 30 kg/yr, respectively). Pre-
cipitation on the lake surface contributes less than 2 per-
cent to the total phosphorus input. The groundwater phos-
phorus contributions to the lake are not known at present,
360
-------
Table 6. AVERAGE ANNUAL LOADING OF NITROGEN
AND PHOSPHORUS TO LAKE WINGRA FROM
PRECIPITATION*
Loadings:
Ibs/ac/in
kg/yr/lake
0.089
390
NO~-N
0.10
440
Org-N
0.059
260
DRP
t-P
0.0057 0.0073
25
32
6 3
Volume of water to the lake/30.16 in of rain = 1 X 10 m
*After Kluesener, 1972
Table 7. NUTRIENT LOADING OF LAKE WINGRA DUE
TO DRY FALLOUT*
Period
N
Hj-N
kg/da
Sep 26-Oct 4
Oct 15-Oct 24
Dec 10-Jan 1
Jan 1-Jan 31
Mar 6 -Mar 14
Mar 2 8 -Apr 4
Apr 2 6 -May 4
May 12 -May 18
Jun 6-Jun 14
0
1
0
2
1
1
2
2
1
.76
.85
.62
.08
.31
.06
.30
.50
.50
NO~-N
kg/da
0
1
1
2
1
0
1
0
0
.32
.25
.35
.08
.44
.36
.47
.59
.76
Org-N
kg/da
1.
1.
1.
0.
—
5.
2.
9.
1.
40
41
22
93
-
4
02
5
8
DRP
kg/da
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
027
050
045
042
018
09
10
12
03
t-P Exposure
Time
Days
kg/da
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
10
18
060
23
060
59
16
93
35
7.8
9.9
29 .0
22.0
8 .3
8.5
7.5
5.6
8.5
Average load
1.60
Average Annual Lake
Load (kg/yr) 565
1.30
475
3.0
1100
0.06 0.30
21
110
*After Kluesener, 1972
361
-------
Table 8. AVERAGE ANNUAL LOADINGS FOR SPRINGS
FLOWING INTO LAKE WINGRA*
Sparing
Flow NH
(cfs;
Wingra
Nakoma
Council Ring
East Spring
Duck Creek
April-Dec 20
Dec 20 -Apr 1
Total Spring
Input
Total Lake Input
0.
0.
0.
0.
0.
-
1.
= 1.
64
30
06
10
45
—
55
37
-N
l kg/yr
14.
44.
0.
3.
39.
70.
170.
X 106 m3
3
0
4
1
0
0
8
/yr
NO~-N DRP
O
kg/yr kg/yr
1690 8.5
700 5.5
46.5 0.3
12.2 1.6
1100 8.4
480 6.2
4138.5 30.5
t-P
kg/yr
14
19
0
2
18
22
77
.0
.7
.4
.7
.6
.0
.4
-After Kluesener, 1972
362
-------
2
O
M
H
M
PH
M
O
w
ptj
cu
Q
<;
P-.
O
2
3
PS
^^
03
§ X
£
Sr.
M
0 0
(v; ^j
Ps CO
O bo
2 -*
1 i ^^
Q
O
2
W
M
2
PH
O
JH
PS
§
D
CO
•
cn
Q)
rH
,Q
frj
H
0)
rH CO
•H T3
•P -H
rrj i — I
rH O
O CO
>
13
CU CO
t? T?
C -H
Q) rH
ft 0
CO CO
3
CO
(X
1
rj
T""1
PH
Q
2
1
r n
PS
o
2
I
1 00
2
2
I
+ d-
T*
M-«|
2
^j
K ''"^
C 3 C
.,-4 Q .,_(
rd 6 "^
PS <
LM cu x~v
LM ^
C H ^
30s-'
PS >
0)
-p
rrj
Q
I I
CO
rH 1
rH
CN
d- rH
d- o
0 O
CN
CD O
rH 0
0 O
LO
LO CN
CM O
C- O
LO H
o o
00 LO
rH rH
0 O
CO
00
O
o
LO
J-
CD
iH
O
p-
^
CN
v^
cn
I
co
CM
CM
CN
O
[-,
rH
O
rH
CD
O
j-
CN
O
O
,— (
o
o
co
00
co
o
Cx
x^
oo
"V.
cn
I I 1
o
1 CM |
CM
r-^
o oo
O LO 1
o o
CM
o cn
O rH I
O O
cn co
O r>- i
O O
c^ oo
o a- i
o o
co co
o o i
0 O
oo a-
rH r^
o o
o
rH
_^f-
oo
co
o
rx.
x^
CO
CN
•x.
cn
llll
LO
H LO
CM 1 00 1
r*
CN
LO LO CD
LO o co i
CM O O
oo iH
CD 1 LO 1
O 0
r- a-
LO rH 00 I
CO rH O
r**. j*
LO co H 1
H H 0
cn r~
CO CM O 1
OHO
O
LO CO
rH O
O 0
O O
CD O
LO O
P» rH
H
O O
r>- r-
•^ -^
co cn
CM -x.
^v rH
cn H
F--
d- 1
CM
O
cn i
CO
LO
rH 0
cn o
0 O
CM
CO O
0 O
o o
oo
0 O
d- o
O CD
co o
O 0
d- rH
CM rH
o o
CD
H
O
O
o
o
LO
CM
H
c«-
•v.
J^-
rH
^
CO
CO
H 1
CM
cn i
00
0 H
00 O
O O
CO
LO O
iH O
O O
H CD
cn cn
o o
r>- LO
CM CM
O o
rH CN
J- J-
o o
CO
CO
o
O
o
CN
CN
rH
rH
rx.
^
co
rH
•v,.
d-
o cn
rH I CD
rH
d- 1 oo
CO rH
-r
LO rH CO
rH O LO
0 O O
cn
r^ o CD
O O CN
000
r-
o co i
o d-
r> o LO
rH H CO
O O O
d- LO LO
rH CM H
0 0 O
0
CM
O
O O
CM LO
00 LO
CO LO
rH
rH C-x
C-- \
"x. CO
d- rH
LO LO
CO
1 LO 1
00
1 LO I
H
CN LO
1 CO O
0 O
LO
OO CM
1 CM O
0 O
00
CO 1 CM
- 1 -
* 1 *
d- rH
LO CM
1 CO CM
0 0
1 00 CO
1 CM OO
0 O
rH 00
rH CM
0 0
O
O
H
CO
CN
H
[^,
x^
OO
CM
-x.
LO
CN H
CM
CM CN
yf
iH
00 CN
d- o
0 O
rH
CM rH
CM O
O O
1
H CO
00 rH
O O
C"^ OO
rH CN
O O
O
CO
O
O
o
0
o
CM
rH
r>.
^.
d-
CM
•x.
LO
CN
cn
rH
r*
C_(
C
CU
CO
0)
3
H
**
p_(
0)
p
<£
•X
363
-------
Table 10. SUMMARY OF MEASURED NUTRIENT
SOURCES FOR LAKE WINGRA*
Source
Precipitation
Dry Fallout
Springf low
Urban Runoff
Total =
Lake Volume =
NH*-N
390
560
170
450
1570
2.5 X 106
NO~-N Org-N
3 (kg/yr)
440 260
480 1100
4140
60_0 350_0
5660 4860
3
m
DRP
25
21
30
570
646
t-P Vol. of3
waterCm )
32 IX '106
110
77 1.4 X 106
980 1 X 10 6
1199
* After Kluesener, 1972
but it is not believed that this is a significant source
(Kluesener, 1972).
The springflow contributes approximately 60 percent of the
inorganic nitrogen (i.e., NH^-N and NO~-N) influent to the
lake. All other sources contribute approximately equal
amounts of inorganic nitrogen. The urban runoff and spring-
flow each contribute about 35 percent of the total nitrogen.
Precipitation and dry fallout contribute about 10 percent
and 20 percent respectively, to the total nitrogen loading.
Thus, about 65 percent of the nitrogen budget of Lake Wingra
comes from 'natural' sources. The resultant lake nitrogen
concentration is thus more independent of storms than are
the phosphorus concentrations, since springflow and ground-
water provide significant nitrogen inputs to the lake between
storms (Kluesener, 1972).
364
-------
The volume of water contributed by rainfall, urban runoff
and springflow is approximately 3. "4 X 10 m /yr. The aver-
age nitrogen and phosphorus concentrations of this input
*.
are approximately 3.0 mg N/l and 0.3 mg P/l, respectively.
This is about four times the average concentration of phos-
phorus and three times the average concentration of nitrogen
(see Figures M- and 5) normally found in Lake Wingra (0.07 mg
total P/l and 1.1 mg total N/l, respectively). If it is as-
sumed that Lake Wingra reacts like a large completely mixed
body of water, as the data indicate , then nitrogen and phos-
phorus are being accumulated in the lake sediments or are
being released to the atmosphere (Kluesner, 1972).
DISCUSSION
A summary of the available nutrient loading data and im-
portant physical features of Lake Wingra is presented in
Table 11.
Huff e_t a].. (1973) attempted to simulate urban runoff,
nutrient loading and biotic response in Lake Wingra based
on a Hydrologic Transport Model (HTM). The nutrients con-
sidered in their open lake model were dissolved inorganic
phosphorus and dissolved inorganic nitrogen. They con-
sidered urban runoff, springflow, groundwater seepage,
rainfall, dry fallout and internal sediment nutrient re-
generation as nutrient sources.
Huff et a].. (1973) assumed the available phosphorus form
was dissolved inorganic phosphorus, and that this was a con-
stant percentage of the total phosphorus entering the lake.
However, Cowen (1973), studying the Madison area urban
drainage, has shown that approximately 30 percent of the
phosphorus in the particulate organic and inorganic forms
will become available for algal growth in natural water sys-
tems. Therefore, the Huff e_t al. (1973) estimates of the
365
-------
Table 11. SUMMARY OF AVAILABLE NUTRIENT LOADING DATA
AND PHYSICAL CHARACTERISTICS*
I. Nutrient Loadings
Total Phosphorus (t-P) 1199 kg/yr 0.88 g/m /yr
Dissolved Reactive Phosphorus (DRP) 646 kg/yr
Total Nitrogen (NH*-N, NO~-N & 12090 kg/yr 8.83 g/m2/yr
+ Org-N)
Inorganic Nitrogen (NH^-N S NO~-N) 7230 kg/yr
II. Biomass S Productivity
2
Phytoplankton Biomass, Annual Average 16 g/m
Phytoplankton Biomass, Growing Season 2
Average 25 g/m
Phytoplankton Primary Productivity
Annual Average (870 g C/m2/yr) 2.4 g C/m2/day
Phytoplankton Primary Productivity,
Growing Season Average 4.6 g C/m2/day
III. Physical Characteristics of Lake Wingra
Maximum Depth 6.10 m
Mean Depth 2.42 m 6 2
Surface Area, excluding lagoons S ponds 1.37 X 10gnu
Total Volume, excluding lagoons S ponds 2.50 X lOg^U
Annual Input 5.70 X 10 m
Hydraulic Residence Time 0.44 yr
Mean Depth/Hydraulic Residence Time 5.5 m/yr
Mean Secchi Depth 1.3 m
IV. Chemical Characteristics of Lake Wingra
Mean Alkalinity 153 mg/1 as CaCo-
Mean Calcium Concentration 34 mg/1
Mean Conductivity Not Determined
Mean Annual DO 1 m - 7.7 mg/1
3 m - 6.6 mg/1
pH Min.-7.7
Max.-9.4
•'After Huff et al., 1973 and Kluesener, 1972
366
-------
available phosphorus input to Lake Wingra are expected to
be low due to the fact that Kluesener (1972) found that a
substantial part of the phosphorus entering the lake is not
in the immediately available form. Further, it would be
expected that the marshes through which much of the urban
drainage enters the lake would significantly alter the
transport rate of available phosphorus to the lake, making
it essentially impossible, with the information available
today, to develop meaningful models which relate nutrient
transport in the urban areas of the Lake Wingra watershed
to algae and macrophyte growth in the lake.
The Vollenweider loading curve (Vollenweider, 1975; Vollen-
weider and Dillon, 197M-) values, based on data in Table 1L,
2
are 0.88 g/m /yr for phosphorus loading and 5.5 m/yr for the
mean depth/hydraulic residence time. When these values are
plotted according to Vollenweider (1975), Lake Wingra falls
in a category typical of lakes, with similar phosphorus
loadings and morphometric and hydrological characteristics,
which are considered eutrophic (Figure 9 ). The current
phosphorus loading is about four times its "permissible"
loading rate for its mean depth and hydraulic residence time
characteristics.
The trophic status is in agreement with the physical, chemical
and biological characteristics of the lake. Lake Wingra is
a shallow lake with shallow sloping shoreline, in which the
thermocline is absent. The hypolimnion volume is low or
absent, and it has low transparency. The entire water column
can be affected by wind-generated mixing. This situation
tends to promote increased nutrient cycling and therefore
a higher degree of eutrophication than for deeper lakes with
similar nutrient loads. Blue-green algae are usually the
dominant forms during the summer months. The fish present in
Lake Wingra are abundant in number, but mostly trash species
367
-------
a>
a
x:
c
0
•§
a>
o»
c
^j
*^j
h.
a>
•o
"o
J 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
I UJ
iu m
^ to
to co
to = O
UJ 2 —
o a: X
X Ul Q*
UJ 0. g
\ \ s
\ \ fe
\ \ 2
: \ \ o
: \ \
\ \
\ \
\ \
\ \
r \ \
: \ \
: © \ \
P \ \
1 \ \
u \ \
1 \ \
r y 3 \ \
: £ \ \
O y v
: £ \ \
UJ ^ v
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 ll 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 III 1 1 1 1 1 1
2-5
-
~
-
—
—
_
-
.
-
.
™
-
—
-
.
•
I
-
-
o
o
o
"•—
o
o
-
.^
0
d
3
h
IN
)9NIQVO"I SndOHdSOHd
368
-------
such as carp (Neess et al., 1957, cited in Hasler, 1963;
Huff et al., 1973).
IMPROVEMENT OF WATER QUALITY IN LAKE WINGRA
The overall water quality of Lake Wingra could be improved
somewhat with the cooperation of the residents of the portion
of the southwest corner of Madison, Wisconsin, which lies
within the Lake Wingra drainage basin. The primary water
quality problem in Lake Wingra and the other Madison lakes
is an excessive amount of alga and waterweeds (particularly
Myrillophyllum in Lake Wingra) caused by excessive inputs of
aquatic plant nutrients such as nitrogen and phosphorus com-
pounds. Studies by Walton and Lee (1972) and Fitzgerald and
Lee (1971) have shown the key factor governing the excessive
algal and waterweed growth in Lake Wingra is the concentra-
tion of phosphorus in the water.
As stated earlier, approximately one-third of the total
drainage to Lake Wingra comes from the University of Wisconsin
Arboretum, while the remaining two-thirds is urban runoff
from southwest Madison. More significantly, the urban runoff
delivers approximately 80 percent of the total phosphorus
and 90 percent of the soluble orthophosphate (see Table 10)
to Lake Wingra. Consequently, the amounts of nutrients
entering Lake Wingra by way of urban runoff could be sub-
stantially reduced by reduction of the phosphorus content of
the urban runoff. To achieve this will require that each
individual living in the Lake Wingra drainage basin conduct
his activities in such a manner as to reduce, and wherever
possible, eliminate the transport of phosphorus to Lake
Wingra. Particular attention should be given to improving
the efficiency and frequency of street cleaning in the urban
parts of the Lake Wingra watershed. Lee (1972) has dis-
cussed in detail various methods that can be used by the
369
-------
residents of Madison to improve the water quality of Lake
Wingra and the other Madison lakes. Elimination of the
phosphorus input from urban runoff would lower the annual
2
phosphorus loading to 0.23 g/m /yr. This reduced loading
would place Lake Wingra in the oligotrophic trophic cate-
gory, according to the Vollenweider criteria. Realistically,
of course, this will not be achieved. However, with even
a moderate reduction of phosphorus input, Lake Wingra could
likely become a less productive body of water and achieve
a significant reduction in the frequency and severity of
excessive algal blooms and macrophyte growth.
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
Support for research which served as a basis for this report
was derived from a variety of federal agencies, especially
the US EPA and the US IBP program. In addition, support
was given this investigation by The University of Wisconsin-
Madison, especially the Departments of Botany,Civil and
Environmental Engineering and Zoology. Special recognition
is given J. Magnusan of the University's Laboratory of Lim-
nology for his assistance in providing information on Lake
Wingra fisheries.
REFERENCES
Bannerman, R.T. Interstitial Inorganic Phosphorus in Lake
Wingra Sediments. MS Thesis, University of Wisconsin,
Madison, 1973. 120 p.
Baumann, P.C., J.F. Kitchell, J.J. Magnuson, and T.B. Kayes.
Lake Wingra, 1837-1973: A Case History of Human Impact.
Trans. Wise. Acad. Sci. Arts Lett. 6_2:57-94, 1974.
Birge, E.A. List of Crustacea Cladocera from Madison,
Wisconsin. Trans. Wise. Acad. Sci. Arts Lett. _8: 379-398,
1891.
Bortleson, G. The Chemical Investigation of Recent Sediments
from Wisconsin. Ph.D. Thesis, University of Wisconsin-
Madison, 1970. 278 p.
370
-------
Clesceri, N.L. The Madison Lakes Before and After Diversion.
MS Thesis, University of Wisconsin-Madison, 1961. 30 p.
Cline, D.R. Geology and Groundwater Resources of Dane County,
Wisconsin, USGS Water-Supply Paper 1779-U. 1965. 64 p.
Cowen, W.F. Available Phosphorus in Urban Runoff and Lake
Ontario Tributary Waters. Ph.D. Thesis, University of
Wisconsin-Madison, 1973.
Domogalla, B.P. and E.B. Fred. Ammonia and Nitrate Studies of
Lakes Near Madison, Wisconsin. J. Am. Soc. Agron. 18;
897-911, 1926.
Fitzgerald, G.P. and G.F. Lee. Use of Tests for Limiting or
Surplus Nutrients to Evaluate Sources of Nitrogen and
Phosphorus for Algae and Aquatic Weeds. Report of the
Water Chemistry Program, University of Wisconsin-Madison,
July 1, 1971. 34 p.
Frey, D.G. Wisconsin: The Birge-Juday Era. In: Limnology
in North America. Frey, D.G. (ed.). Madison, Wisconsin,
University of Wisconsin Press. 1963. p.3-54.
Huff, D.D., J.F. Koonce, W.R. Ivarson, P.R. Weiler, E.H. Dett-
man, and R.F. Harris. Simulation of Urban Runoff, Nutrient
Loading and Biotic Response of a Shallow Eutrophic Lake.
In: Mode]ing the Eutrophication Process, Workshop
Proceedings, ,"Nov. , 1973. Middlebrooks , E . J . , D.H. Falken-
borg, and T.E. Maloney (eds.). Utah State University, 1973,
211 p.
Kluesener, J.W. Nutrient Transport and Transformations in
Lake Wingra, Wisconsin. Ph.D. Thesis, University of
Wisconsin-Madison, 1972. 242 p.
Kluesener, J.W. and G.F. Lee. Nutrient Loading from a Separate
Storm Sewer in Madison, Wisconsin. J. Wat. Pollut. Control
Fed. 4j>_: 920-936, 1974.
Lee, G.F. Ways in Which a Resident of the Madison Lakes'
Watershed May Help to Improve Water Quality in the
Madison Lakes. Report of the Water Chemistry Program,
University of Wisconsin-Madison. 1972. 10 p.
Lee, G.F. and J.W. Kluesener. Nutrient Sources for Lake
Wingra, Madison, Wisconsin. Report of the Water Chemistry
Program, University of Wisconsin-Madison. 1971. 4 p.
Li, W.C., D.E. Armstrong, J.D.H. Williams, R.F. Harris and
J.K. Syers. Rate and Extent of Inorganic Phosphate
Exchange in Lake Sediments. Soil Sci.Soc. Amer. Proc.
^£.-279-285, 1972.
Murray, R.C. Recent Sediments of Three Wisconsin Lakes.
Bulletin of the Geological Society of America. 67 : 883-
910, 1956. ~
-------
Neess, J., W.T. Helm, and C.W. Theinen. Carp Census of Lake
Wingra. Cited in Kluesener, J.W. Nutrient Transport
and Transformations in Lake Wingra, Wisconsin. Ph.D.
Thesis, University of Wisconsin-Madison, p. 5, 1972.
Neess, J.C., W.T. Helm, and C.W. Theinen (1957). Some Vital
Statistics in a Heavily Exploited Population of Carps.
Cited in Hasler, A.D. Wisconsin, 1940-1961. In:
Limnology in North America. Frey, D.G. (ed.). Madison,
Wisconsin, University of Wisconsin Press, 1963.p.71-72.
Noland, W.E. (1950) The Hydrography, Fish and Turtle Polulation
of Lake Wingra. Cited in Frey, D.G. Wisconsin: The
Birge-Juday Era. In: Limnology in North America. .Frey,
D.G. (ed.). Madison, Wisconsin, University of Wisconsin
Press. 1963. p.7.
Sonzogni, W.C. Effect of Nutrient Input Reduction on the
Eutrophication of the Madison Lakes. Ph.D. Thesis,
University of Wisconsin-Madison, 1974. 412 p.
Tressler, W.L. and B.P. Domogalla. Limnological Studies of
Lake Wingra. Trans. Wise. Acad. Sci. Arts Lett. 26:331-
351, 1931.
Twenhofel, W.H. The Physical and Chemical Characteristics of
the Sediments of Lake Mendota, A Fresh-Water Lake of
Wisconsin. Jour. Sed. Pet. 3_: 68-76, 1933.
Vollenweider, R.A. (1973) Input-Output Models. Schweiz. Z.
Hydrol. In'Press,
Vollenweider, R.A. and P.J. Dillon. The Application of the
Phosphorus Loading Concept to Eutrophication Research.
Environmental Secretariat, National Research Council of
Canada, NRC Associate Committee on Scientific Criteria
for Environmental Quality. Ottawa, Ontario, Canada.
Publication Number NRCC 13690. 1974. 42 p.
Walton, C.P. and G.F. Lee. A Biological Evaluation of the
Molybdenum Blue Method for Orthophosphate Analysis.
Verh. Internat. Verein. Limnol. 18_: 676-684, 1972.
Williams, J.D.H., J.K. Syers, R.F. Harris, and D.E. Armstrong.
Adsorption and Desorption of Inorganic Phosphorus by
Lake Sediments in a 0.1 M NaCl System. Environ. Sci.
Tech. 4_:517-519, 1970.
Williams, J.D.H., J.K. Syers, S.S. Shukla, R.F. Harris, and
D.E. Armstrong. Levels of Native Inorganic and Total
Phosphorus in Lake Sediments as Related to Other
Sediment Parameters. Environ. Sci. Tech. 5:1113-1120,
1971.
372
-------
REPORT ON NUTRIENT LOAD - EUTROPHICATION RESPONSE
OF SELECTED SOUTH-CENTRAL WISCONSIN IMPOUNDMENTS
Marvin D. Piwoni and G. Fred Lee
Institute for Environmental Sciences
University of Texas at Dallas
Richardson, Texas
INTRODUCTION
To meet an increasing demand for lakeside property in Wisconsin, private
developers constructed a number of recreational impoundments during the 1960's
and early 1970's. In addition, state and local governmental agencies devel-
oped impoundments to provide water recreation for the public. This report
assesses the relative water quality in ten impoundments in central and south-
ern Wisconsin through the development of a trophic state index. The nutrient
loadings to each of the impoundments are estimated and a comparison made
between estimated nutrient load and trophic status for these impoundments.
This is accomplished by applying a phosphorus loading relationship developed
by Vollenweider (1973).
IMPOUNDMENTS STUDIED
Rickert and Spieker (1971) have defined real estate lakes as bodies of
water created in an urban environment for the enhancement of real estate
value. Wisconsin has experienced a large number of impoundments of this
type. This study includes lakes created to facilitate high density lake
front development. It also includes public recreation lakes which repre-
sent the other broad classification of impoundments investigated in this
study. These are lakes created for various recreational uses of the public
and are free of significant urban development around the lake. The impound-
ments investigated in this study can be divided into these two classifica-
tions as shown in Table 1.
373
-------
Table 1. GENERAL CLASSIFICATION OF IMPOUNDMENTS
IN THIS STUDY
Real Estate Lakes Public Recreation Lakes
Lake Redstone Blackhawk Lake
Lake Virginia Stewart Lake
Dutch Hollow Lake Cox Hollow Lake
Lake Camelot North Twin Valley Lake
Lake Camelot South
Lake Sherwood
GEOGRAPHIC AND HYDROLOGIC DESCRIPTION
The impoundments described in this report are all located in
central and southern Wisconsin (see Figure 1). The Camelot-
Sherwood complex is located in central Wisconsin about ten
miles south of Wisconsin Rapids. These three impoundments
are located on Spring Branch and Fourteen-Mile Creeks which
drain marshy areas of the central sand plains. Lakes Red-
stone, Virginia and Dutch Hollow, also located in the central
part of the state, are in Sauk County near Reedsburg. Lakes
Redstone and Dutch Hollow were formed in dammed valleys of
Big and Dutch Hollow Creeks, respectively. Lake Virginia is
a seepage lake, relying predominantly on groundwater to main-
tain the water level.
Three of the impoundments are located in Iowa County in the
southwestern part of the state. Blackhawk Lake is located
north of the town of Cobb. Two dams on adjacent valleys re-
sulted in a horseshoe-shaped lake. Two inlet streams (total
average flow is about 4.4 cfs) provide water to the lake.
Cox Hollow and Twin Valley Lakes, in Governor Dodge State Park
north of Dodgeville, are interconnected by a stream
374
-------
Figure I
Impoundment Locations in Central and Southern Wisconsin
N
25 MILES
\
WISCONSIN
RAPIDS.
PETENWELL
FLOWAGE
WISCONSIN
7 8 • MADISON
R>DGEV,U."MTHOREB
COBB c
KEY;
I.CAMELOT-SHERWOOD COMPLEX
2. DUTCH HOLLOW LAKE
3.LAKE REDSTONE
4. LAKE VIRGINIA
[MILWAUKEE
5.BLACKHAWK LAKE
6.COX HOLLOW LAKE
7TWIN VALLEY LAKE
8.STEWART LAKE
375
-------
approximately one mile long. Effluent waters from Cox Hollow
Lake flow into Twin Valley Lake. Cox Hollow Lake was formed
by placing an earthen dike at the junction of two valleys,
creating a horseshoe-shaped lake. The impoundment is equipped
with several artificial circulation devices to maintain dis-
solved oxygen in the hypolimnion during periods of stratifi-
cation. Twin Valley Lake receives about one-half of its
normal water flow from Cox Hollow Lake. Three other small
streams contribute to the 4 cfs average inflow. The dam
structure of the impoundment is designed for withdrawal of
bottom waters from the impoundment.
Stewart Lake is located in southwestern Dane County near Mt.
Horeb. The lake is fed by a small inlet stream and several
artesian springs.
The surface area, mean depth and hydraulic residence times
of the impoundments are summarized in Table 2. All the impound-
ments are quite shallow, with surface areas ranging from
25,000 to 2.8 million square meters. Hydraulic residence
times range from about one month to nearly three years.
CLIMATE
All of these impoundments are influenced by similar climato-
logical conditions. Annual average temperatures range from
40 to 50°F. In January, average temperatures are 15-20°F,
while in July the average temperature is about 70-75°F. An
ice cover forms on the impoundments in early to mid-December
and generally persists into early April.
Annual precipitation averages near 30 inches with much of the
precipitation falling from April through September. Average
annual snowfall ranges from 35-50 inches, with the larger
accumulations occurring further north in the state. Based on
studies of other lakes in this region of the state (Cline,
1965), the evapotranspiration is probably about equal to the
precipitation.
376
-------
Table 2. HYDROLOGICAL CHARACTERISTICS
OF THE IMPOUNDMENTS*
Surface
9Area5[;
Impoundment
Camelot-
Sherwood
Redstone
Dutch Hollow
Virginia
Blackhawk
Cox Hollow
Twin Valley
Stewart
m X
28
25
8
1
8
3
6
0
10
.3
. 3
.5
. 8
.9
.9
.1
.25
Mean
2
4
6
1
4
3
3
1
Depth, m
.9
.3
.7
.9
.8
.8
.9
Hydraulic
Residence
Years
0.09 - 0.
0.7 - 1
1.8
0.6 - 1.
0.5
0.5 - 0.
0.4 - 0.
0.08
Times ,
14
9
7
5
* Information in this table was obtained from the lake devel-
opers or from Wisconsin DNR files (1972-73) and previously
appeared in Piwoni and Lee (1974). Certain mean depth and
hydraulic residence time values have been subsequently re-
vised. All data are for projected normal pool elevations.
GEOLOGY
The Camelot-Sherwood basin is set into an area of unconsoli-
dated morainal deposits composed of glacial till and gravel
and sand outwash (Weeks and Strangland, 1971). These deposits
are underlain by Cambrian sandstone over Precambrian crystal-
line rock. The unconsolidated deposits are the major source
of water to the region.
Similar geology likely extends to the Reedsburg area (Lakes
Virginia, Redstone and Dutch Hollow), although no specific
information is available.
377
-------
The Twin Valley-Cox Hollow basin contains a number of water-
bearing geologic formations (Klingelhoets, 1962). These in-
clude Galena dolomite, Platteville limestone and St. Peter
sandstone, all yielding small amounts of high mineral content
water. Soils in the region are composed of silty loam and
loamy alluvial materials with high organic content. Much of
the area surrounding the impoundments is quite steep and
rocky.
The geology of the Blackhawk Lake watershed is probably quite
similar to Cox Hollow and Twin Valley watersheds. The water-
shed is located in the driftless region of the state and
consists of narrow ridges with steep, narrow V-shaped valleys
(Bredemus, 1970). The soil regime is composed of silty loam
and stony undeveloped soils.
The Stewart Lake watershed consists of deposits of Trenton and
Galena limestones and St. Peter sandstone (WDNR, 1972-73).
The soils in the region are predominantly silty loam and sandy
loam with some stony land.
WATERSHED CHARACTERISTICS
All of the impoundments are in rural, predominantly agricul-
tural watersheds (except for Stewart Lake, which is located
below a small city and receives much of the runoff from the
city streets). The real estate lakes will likely undergo
changes in nutrient loadings from the watershed as develop-
ment of waterfront homes (with septic tank systems) proceeds.
Table 3 presents the areas of the watershed of each impound-
ment. The range of watershed size is from 510 acres for
Stewart Lake to over 22,000 acres for the Camelot-Sherwood
Complex.
378
-------
Table 3. AREA OF IMPOUNDMENT WATERSHEDS*
Impoundment
Camelot- Sherwood
Redstone
Dutch Hollow
Virginia
Blackhawk
Cox Hollow
Twin Valley
Stewart
Acres
22,400
18,940
3,100
1,600
8,960
3,970
7,680
510
Hectares
9,060
7,660
1,250
650
3,630
1,610
3,110
210
* Information in this table was compiled from lake developer
data, data from the Wisconsin DNR files (1972-73) and from
USGS topographic maps. This information is based on
Piwoni and Lee (1974).
BIOLOGICAL DESCRIPTION
FISHERIES
Limited information was available on the fisheries of several
of the impoundments. Attempts have been made to manage the
fisheries in nearly all of the impoundments. Consequently,
stocking of various game fishes has taken place over the
years. However, the fisheries in nearly all of the impound-
ments are predominantly composed of panfish such as the blue-
gill (Lepomis macrochirus) and sunfish (Lepomis spp.),plus a
number of rough bottom feeding fish. Fishing time,and con-
sequently fish yields , has generally dropped in recent years,
presumably because of an overabundance of small panfish
varieties instead of more favored gamefish.
Lake Redstone has been stocked several times with walleye
(Stizostedion vitreum) to supplement existing fish populations
(Smith, 1973). The lake also contains apparently declining
379
-------
populations of largemouth bass (Micropterus salmoides) and
northern pike (Esox lucius). Walleye and panfish appeared to
be stunted in growth probably due to reduced living space
indirectly caused by reduced DO levels in the hypolimnion
during winter and summer.
Reports by Dunst (1969) and Wirth et al. (1970) indicate
that similar fish species inhabit Cox Hollow and Twin Valley
Lakes. Largemouth bass and northern pike were stocked in
Cox Hollow Lake in 1958 (Dunst, 1969).> but populations gener-
ally decreased after 1962. Records on these two fishes in
Twin Valley Lake (Wirth ejt al. , 1970) indicated both species
suffered from a 60-70 percent mortality rate. Smaller sized
bluegills were beginning to dominate the fish populations.
feiibow trout have been stocked in Stewart Lake and seem to
grow well although reproduction information was not available.
Annual opening day trout fishing is quite heavy on this
impoundment (with reportedly good results)
AQUATIC PLANTS
Very little information was available on specific macrophyte
populations in these impoundments. All of the impoundments
suffered from excessive macrophyte growth in littoral areas.
Impoundments with steep banks, such as Redstone, Blackhawk,
and Twin Valley, did not have the problems prevalent in
impoundments with large littoral regions such as the Camelot-
Sherwood complex. The latter was treated annually with her-
bicide to control aquatic weeds.
Dunst (1969) reported that Ceratophyllum demersum had become
the dominant macrophyte in Cox Hollow Lake. That plant, as
well as Myriophyllum, Potamogeton and Limna spp. , was observed
by the authors in the Camelot-Sherwood complex. Stewart Lake
supported a variety of aquatic vegetation in the shallow
waters near the point of inflow of the creek,including
380
-------
cattails, water lilies, wild rice and sedges. Macrophyte
problems were not critical in any of the other impoundments
sampled during a two year period from June, 1971 to April,
1973 (Piwoni and Lee, 1974).
Blue-green algae obtained dominance in all of the impound-
ments at least on two occasions during the summers of 1971
and 1972 (Piwoni and Lee, 1974). Anacystis spp. attained
dominance at least once in all the impoundments except Lake
Virginia. Aphanizomenon, C_oe la strum and Anabaena spp. were
other predominant blue-greens. In Lake Virginia, Scenedesmus
was the dominant algal genus on several sampling dates. Dur-
ing spring and fall, algal populations in the impoundments were
dominated by diatoms, such as Fragilaria and Asterionella,
and flagellates, such as Trachelamonas and Ch1amydomonas.
The amount of algae is reflected in chlorophyll a concentra-
tions presented later in this paper.
TROPHIC INDEX PARAMETERS AND ANALYSIS METHODS
To assess the water quality of the impoundments, a trophic
state index (TSI) was developed. The approach employed is
similar to that used by Lueschow et_ al. (1970) in their evalu-
ation of Wisconsin lakes. The index parameters were chosen
because it was felt that they would present a relative indi-
cation of water quality in the impoundments. While the over-
all approach is approximately the same, there are important
differences between the formulation and use of the different
parameters in this evaluation and in the trophic state index
used by Lueschow et al. (1970) in their studies.
The trophic state index parameters used in this study are pre-
sented in Table 4. Secchi depth measurements were used as a
measure of turbidity and light penetration (Ruttner, 1965).
Chlorophyll a., an estimate of the phytoplankton biomass, was
determined using the method described by Strickland and Parsons
(1965). The percentage of the lake volume containing less than
381
-------
Table 4. TROPHIC STATE INDEX PARAMETERS
1. Secchi Depth - Mean of all values obtained.
2. Chlorophyll a - Average concentration in first
2 meters of water column dur-
ing study period.
3. DO Depletion - Percent of lake volume with
less than 0.5 mg-DO/1; May to
October, inclusive.
4. Orthophosphate - winter - Average in-lake concentration
during winter under ice.
5. Orthophosphate - summer - Average epilimnion concentra-
tion; May to October, inclusive.
6. Total phosphorus - - Average in-lake concentration
winter during winter under ice.
7. Total phosphorus - - Average epilimnion concentra-
summer tion; May to October, inclusive.
8. Organic Nitrogen - Average concentration in first
2 meters of water column during
study period.
0.5 mg/1 of dissolved oxygen gave an indication of the aquatic
plant material that accumulated in the hypolimnion and exerted
an oxygen demand. DO was determined using a YSI Model 54 Dis-
solved Oxygen Meter. All phosphorus determinations were made
using the ascorbic acid method described in Standard Methods,
13th edition (APHA et_ al., 1971). Total phosphorus determina-
tions were made on unfiltered, autoclaved samples which were
treated with persulfate. Ammonium and Kjeldahl-nitrogen analy-
ses were automated using a Technicon AutoAnalyzer and the
phenate method as described in Standard Methods (APHA et_ al.,
1971). Organic-N was calculated as Kjeldahl-N minus NH -N.
All nitrogen and phosphorus values are reported as mg-N/1 and
mg-P/1. The atomic ratio of inorganic-N to soluble ortho-P
was in excess of 16 to 1 in all the impoundments except
Lake Virginia and, therefore, nitrogen apparently was not
382
-------
limiting algal growth. Consequently, inorganic-N was not
included as a trophic state index parameter since the algal
growth in these impoundments was probably not dependent on
the inorganic-N concentration.
Samples used for analysis were collected over a two-year
period at approximately six week intervals. Samples were
collected at either one or two meter intervals in the deepest
part of the impoundments. Volumn-weighted mean lake concen-
trations of the parameters in Table 45 excluding Secchi depth
and DO depletion, were calculated for each sampling date.
The mean values for the index parameters for each of the im-
poundments were then determined. These values are presented
in Table 5, along with the trophic ranking received by the
impoundments for each parameter. This ranking was based on a
relative scale in which each impoundment was assigned an integer
value from 1 to 10 dependent on the relative magnitude of each
of its water quality-TSI parameters. For example, Blackhawk
Lake had the highest average Secchi depth. It was ranked
number 1 for this parameter. Dutch Hollow Lake had the lowest
average Secchi depth and was ranked number 10. The sum of
these individual parameter rankings yielded an overall trophic
state index value for each lake. Inorganic-N was not used to
compute this sum. These values provided the basis for the
water quality ranking of the impoundments given in Table 6.
The complete data obtained in this investigation have been
reported by Piwoni and Lee (1974).
Lakes Camelot North and South and Sherwood received the high-
est water quality rankings (see Table 6). These lakes were
arbitrarily designated as moderately eutrophic based on the
TSI value and general water quality characteristics. The
reasons for the relatively high water quality in these lakes
is probably because of the low in-lake phosphorus levels and
the highly-colored nature of the water. The latter can limit
algal growth by limiting light penetration (Lee, 1972).
383
-------
P-, H
C_j | ^s.
V H PL,
i * '
306
CO EH— '
x-s
Oi H
j_i 1 *""•**
d> i — | fX
4-> id i
C 4-> bO
•H O 6
S EH — '
CX-N
O Q) H
•rl bQ**s
COS
IT) fc 1
b04-> M
CO fc'H 6
W OS —
W
W H
S £H """s
^ US
fv^ g i
< E S M
P-i 3 H 6
CO EH — '
X
W ^
P H
f^ £-1 *"N«-
H 0) S
+-> 1
W GSM
H -HME
I-H (X, H
p~] c_, i \
P-. Q) o PH
0 g -C 1
&, 6 -P M
H 3 k E
CO O —
PM
O s~*
p t { — l
S fn 1 ^
O 0) O PL,
H -P ,C 1
H C -P M
< -H PH g
H
S '"^
£*H CJP
W 1 ~~^
H 0)
W H C
P ft O
O 0) -H
Q P 4->
LO i (d!'^
O H
0} £H i — 1 ^^
rH O rH M
Id ,C ,C<3
EH O ft
x-s
W
•rl CH
rJ-H .I"! (U
O 4-> 4-1
O ft 0)
0) 0 6
CO Q — '
0)
^
id
^
x^
CO
\^
H
rH
.
O
^~,
H-
s^
CO
O
•
o
x^
;J-
N^X
CM
CO
•
O
x-s
.3-
\~s
rH
CO
•
o
x-s.
LO
s-x
0
CO
.
o
x-x
CM
\^r
CO
o
o
•
o
x-\
^J-
^x
CO
o
o
•
o
X-*
o
, — t
N^^
CM
•
CO
CM
s-^
LO
^^
CO
CM
rH
x-v
H-
^x
CO
•
rH
0)
Cj
O
4-1
CO
t>
0)
c^
o
rH
v_x
LO
, — |
,
O
x^.
i-H
\-s
CM
CD
•
O
x-v
O
H
\^
H
CO
•
H
x^
rH
*~x
CO
rH
•
O
x^
rH
v^
CM
CM
.
O
X— V
0
H
^r
LO
CM
0
•
O
x-\
, — 1
*^
Jj-
0
0
.
CD
x-^
LO
s^y
CO
•
LO
X-x
CD
^-/
CD
CD
CM
<~\
en
\_x
CM
.
H
id
•H
C
bO
C_j
•H
>
x^
en
v^x
CM
, — (
•
O
x-^
O
H
^^
o
^7
•
O
X-N
CD
*^s
[ —
CD
•
0
x^
CM
^^
CM
CM
•
O
x-v
J-
^x
, — (
CD
•
CD
x-^
c-^
^^
CO
rH
CD
•
O
x-~*
CO
^x
rH
CM
CD
•
CD
x-^
p^
v^
0
•
CO
0
rH
^x
CD
CO
CO
x^
O
H
—X
CO
.
o
5
,C O
O rH
4-- rH
3 O
P iT"!
^^
rH
\^
j-
o
,
o
X-N
H
^x-
CM
O
•
o
X-N
CM
^x
CD
CD
•
O
X-,
CD
— '
co
j-
•
0
x^
CM
^x-
en
_-^-
.
o
x-s
H
s_x
LO
0
O
•
O
X-N
CM
v_x
[ —
o
o
•
o
x-^
rH
LO
•
O
^
rH
\^s
CO
LO
/-^
CM
S.X
CO
.
CM
4->
0
rH .El
Q) 4J
g C_(
id o
o iz;
^^
H
j^-
o
.
o
x^
LO
v^
^J-
o
•
0
x-\
H
LO
CO
•
o
,-s
CD
X.X
o
CO
•
0
x~\
en
s_x
rH
.
H
x^
CD
v_x
0
H
0
•
o
x-s.
LO
S.X
O
H
0
•
CD
X^v
^J-
s_x
CO
•
^j-
x-s
H
v_x
CO
LO
x-s
CO
s-»
CO
H
4-1
O
rH ,Cl
0) 4->
6 3
id o
O CO
fr^
rH
X.X
^J-
CD
,
O
x^
H
^^
CM
0
•
O
x-s.
CM
v_x
CD
CD
•
O
x-^
CD
s^
CO
J-
•
O
S-*
CO
v-x
CM
CO
.
H
x-s
CM
s_x
CO
0
0
•
o
x^
CM
S_x
[-^
0
0
•
CD
x-s
CO
s_x
CM
•
CO
^
CO
V.X
CM
jj
x^
H-
s_x
CO
,
H
•o
O
0
^J
1)
t~l
CO
^^
J-
s^x
LO
O
.
O
r~.
en
s^
CM
H
•
o
x^
CD
•^s
CD
CN
•
rH
,^
CO
s^
J-
LO
•
O
x^
I--
s^»
CM
O
•
H
x-s
CO
s_x
LO
H
0
•
o
X^j
O
H
..*.
-j-
0
CD
x-^
CO
S-*
CO
•
f-^
x^
CO
' — '
CO
3-'
H
x-s
rH
v_x
CD
,
CO
*§
fd
_c^
rV_
o
id
rH
ra
^^
j^_
s^
CO
o
•
o
x^.
LO
V— '
J-
o
•
o
x-s
LO
v^
CO
en
•
0
o
rH
s*'
CO
CO
•
0
x-s
0
H
v_x
CD
CM
•
CM
x^
CM
s_x-
CO
o
0
•
o
x-s
CO
s^
H
H
0
•
o
x-s
CO
s»x
CD
•
CO
x-s
J-
s_x
CO
CM
rH
x-s.
co
v_x
J-
,
rH
4-1
f-l
id
3
CD
[ j
co
^^
LO
s_x
CD
O
.
O
x-s
CO
\^s
0
H
•
o
x-s
CO
s_x
CO
rH
•
rH
x-s
LO
s^
CO
CO
•
O
/•^
CO
\_x-
CO
CO
•
o
x-s
CO
s^
LO
H
o
•
o
X^v
en
s^
CD
CO
O
•
o
x-s.
CM
s^
0
•
CM
x-s.
CO
S_x
LO
co
CM
x-s
CO
v_x
LO
•
rH
^
O
rH
X rH
O 0
O fTt
^^
LO
s»x
CD
O
,
0
x-s
r-
v-x
[^
O
•
o
x-s
r-
CD
0
•
H
x-s
CO
v-x
CO
CM
•
O
x-s
CO
s_x
rH
LO
•
O
x-s
LO
S.X
CD
O
O
•
O
x-^
rs
s_x
CD
H
O
•
O
x-s
CD
v_x
CM
•
CD
x-s.
[•^
s-x
o
en
H
x-s
CD
s_x
in
•
rH
*>t
0)
C H
•H H
& id
EH >
0)
4-J
id
S
4-1
W
0)
bfl
•rl
f-J
0)
^!
EH
ti
p;
•H
v
C
id
^,
0
•H
^
ft
O
4-1
(U
^_j
id
o
•H
id
c;
•H
CO
a)
H.
rH
id
>
C_j
(U
^J .
(I) c.
6 oj
CD ^3
£-* ^
id §
ft a
c_| 4-*"
a) co
4-i
P -H
id a)
ft 0
0)
f4 rt
•rl
CO 4J
Q) -rl
3 H
rH Id
id 3
> CT1
•K
384
-------
Table 6. WATER QUALITY RANKING OF IMPOUNDMENTS
BASED ON TROPHIC STATE INDEX
Relative Degree
of Eutrophication
Moderate
High
Rank
1
2
3
4
5
6(tie)
6
8
9
10
Lake
Camelot North
Sherwood
Camelot South
Redstone
Stewart
Blackhawk
Twin Valley
Cox Hollow
Virginia
Dutch Hollow
TSI*
11
18
26
41
45
53
53
54
55
67
* Trophic State Index Value. This value is the sum of the
individual parameter relative rankings in Table 5.
Lakes Redstone through Virginia have similar water quality
problems and TSI values. Dutch Hollow Lake, which had severe
algal and turbidity problems throughout most of the study, was
designated as highly eutrophic.
Algal and macrophyte growth produces some aesthetic problems
in all these impoundments and can hamper establishment of game
fisheries. Most of the impoundments, which have occasional
excessive algal blooms and macrophyte growth provide water-
related recreational activities for large numbers of people
and, therefore, are important recreational assets to the
area.
Water quality in most of these impoundments should be quite
stable, except perhaps in the newest lakes, Blackhawk and
Dutch Hollow, where water quality is likely to improve with
385
-------
time (Frey, 1963). In the real estate lakes, which will ex-
perience continued development over the next 20-50 years
(Carlson, 1971), it is possible that some deterioration of
water quality could result as nutrients from septic tank
effluents enter the lake. The significance of this potential
source of nutrients would have to be evaluated in light of
the total nutrient loadings to the lakes and the amount of
phosphorus that enters the lakes from this source.
NUTRIENT LOADINGS
Nutrient loadings for all the impoundments were estimated from
land use in the watershed using the values Sonzogni and Lee
(1974) developed for the Lake Mendota (Wisconsin) watershed.
These values are presented in Table 7. The only variation in
the table values applied in the study was for total-P from
rural runoff. The range of 0.34 to 0.45 kg/ha/yr was used
because these values correlated most closely with a nutrient
input study on Cox Hollow Lake performed by Dunst et al. (1972).
Information on lake and watershed characteristics was obtained
from the Wisconsin Department of Natural Resources and lake
development personnel. The loadings, calculated as kg/year
2
and g/m of surface area, are presented for each impoundment
in Table 8. Ranges reflect the range used for contribution of
P from rural lands. Available information on the watershed re-
quired grouping Lake Camelot North and South and Sherwood.
Groundwater was not included in the estimates of nutrient load-
ings because of the difficulties of evaluating the relative
importance of this potential nutrient source. Groundwater
would be expected to supply considerable amounts of nitrogen,
and possibly some phosphorus, particularly in sandy soil regions
The omission of the groundwater component is thought to be of
minor importance based on studies conducted by Lee (1972).
Vollenweider (1973) had developed a logarithmic plot relating
phosphorus loading to mean depth/hydraulic residence time.
This graph also contains straight-line definitions of "per-
missible" and "excessive" phosphorus loading limits relative
386
-------
Table 7. AMOUNTS OF NITROGEN AND PHOSPHORUS DERIVED
FROM VARIOUS TYPES OF LAND USE
DANE COUNTY, WISCONSIN*
Amounts Contributed
(kg/hectare/yr)
Activity
Base Flow
Woodland
Rural Runoff
Inorganic -N
1.2
0
3.1
Organic-N Soluble 0-P Total-
0.11 0.11
0 00
P
2.0 0.34 0.67**
0.22***
Urban Runoff 1.1
Manured lands
100 cows/sq.mi.
15 tons manure/year
Precipitation 6.0
Dry Fallout 7 . 5
Domestic Waste-
waters 2.7
Septic Tanks var.
Groundwater var.
Drained marshes
3.9
3.4
1.9
0.67
0.18
0.11
8.1
(kg/capita/yr)
0.9 1.4
var.
var.
var.
var.
1.1
1.1
0.22
0.78
2.0
var.
var.
101 kg/hectare
45 kg/hectare
* After Sonzogni and Lee (1974)
** Wisconsin
*** Other Areas
387
-------
Table 8. NUTRIENT LOADINGS TO THE IMPOUNDMENTS5'5
Nitrogen
Impoundment
Redstone
Dutch Hollow
Virginia
Camelot -Sherwood
Blackhawk
Stewart
Cox Hollow
Twin Valley
kg
45
8
3
97
20
1
7
10
/year
,400
,800
,300
,600
,900
,850
,410
,500
Loading
Phosphorus
Loading
g/m^ kg/year
18
10
18
34
23
73
19
17
.1
.4
.3
.6
.4
.6
.1
.4
3630-42
810-
210-
30
870
2
6660-75
1.900-2
120-
630-
1090-1
0
2
70
80
70
00
810
250
1
0
1
2
2
4
1
1
g/m
.44-1
.95
.15
.35
-1
-1
-2
.11-2
.82
.62
.74
-8
-2
-2
2
.68
.02
.48
.68
.32
.05
.08
.05
" Date are revised from earlier values presented by Piwoni and
Lee (1974). Loadings are presented as total kg/year and as
grams per square meter of lake surface area.
to depth-flushing characteristics of the lake. The necessary
calculations were made to determine values of mean depth/hy-
draulic residence times for each of the study impoundments.
2
Annual total phosphorus loadings, in g/m , were then plotted
against the mean depth/hydraulic residence time values , in
m/yr, on a reproduction of the Vollenweider plot (Vollenweider,
1973) (Figure 2).
All of the impoundments fell into the region of the graph
defined by Vollenweider (1973) to be eutrophic. The degree
of eutrophication was interpreted as the "distance" a specific
lake was above the "permissible" loading level for a lake with
the same mean depth/hydraulic residence time value. Table 9
presents the estimated phosphorus loading and the "permissible"
loading level, as defined by Vollenweider (1973), for each of
388
-------
(VJ
9)
its on Vollenweider
>ading Plot.
c o
•o >
C3
^
-3 k.
0 °
^^L ^^™
*™ CL
E >
— o
£
£ Q.
tn
c
o
u
^
\\ !
N \ ££
\ \ z$>~ $^r
\ \ -^°x ~
\ \ QC>QO03(/)Of-
\\ ^ i
, , ..... \ °° OK o
\ \ al
\ \ a ««
\ 2 o>
\ \ 6 c
— 00 "TT > \ \ '*- 1^ —
t4n L_ \ \ OT ^
T-T *~ \ \ *» °
oTV \ --
•r \ \ ^2
H0 \ \ oo
v \ fe Q-
\ \ o M
T \ \ c o
^1 \ N ft
\\ *> C ~~
\ S2
\ \ H
\ \ ||
i i
Q C
^
o
0
UJ
o
z
UJ
Q
to
UJ
O
cr
Q
CL
UJ
Q
UJ
00
/2aj/d6 '9NIQV01
389
-------
CO
PH
M
h^|
CO
J2;
o
H
EH
<£,
,_3
W
PS
CD
]5
M
P
-
• .......
LO LOC~^COt>-COCDOO
H H
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
O rHLOcOr-rr^CDCxI
• .......
j- LOLOLOcDLOcnoo
Tj
bO SH
d >>
•H ^
T^CM
rd 6
O ^
tJ bO
OO CN CD OO HT
LO CO CM CM rH
. . . .
O CD O 0 O
00 CM O
r-\ CO LO
1 1 1 • 1 • 1
o o o
0 00 rH Zt- 00
H- CM CM CM O
. . . . .
O O O CD O
W)
d
•HCJ
T3 ^
rd >i
O ^
JCM
£3
H ^
rd bfj
-P
0
H
CO CNILOCOCMOOLOCO
CD OOCOCOOOrl-
. .......
CM rHCMHCMCMOOrH
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
LO LOHrJrCOCMCMLO
CO Cnr^J-rHCDOOrH
. .......
CM OrHrHCNJrH^rH
,£3
bO
d
M -H
CO ,X
EH p;
rd
PS
CO 0)
1 O CD Jr CD OO LO CD
H rH
T3 -P
O t) ^
O ~ d
3 0
r< S -H
CU O -P >i
rd H rrj (U 3
0)
rX
rd
J
C/l X rH > H ,X O
ICUOCUrHCUSH rd
•PrHKrH rd d rdrH-P-H
Oft CU>O^O!nd
HE.C; -pXKrd-H
CUOOrHdCOO gbfl
gO-PO-H'drd X 0) fc
rd DOSCUHO-P-H
O QC4rHpSpqCJOO>
fd ,
^
d
rd
PS
CO
1 0
H .3-LOCOr>-OOCDrH
390
.
Q)
bO
d
rd
£-1
O
•H
•P
rd
f_|
W)
d
•H
T3
rrj
0
rH
CO
3
f_!
O
ft
CO
O
f,
ft
CU
-p
MH
0
-P
d
•H
0
ft
T3
•H
£H
(U
-P
d
o
TD
CU
CO
trj
r|
^
d
id
PS
rrj
.
CD
CU
rH
£)
It)
EH
6
o
C_4
4H
txO
d
•H
y
d
rd
r4
M
CO
EH
A
.
^rj
CU
CO
C_(
Q)
-P
rrj
S
CU
r;
-P
d
•H
0)
CO
;3
rrj
d
rd
rH
e
O
f_i
MH
Tj
CU
-p
6
•H
-P
co
H
O
O
•H
rH
H3
rd
£H
TJ
^
-p
rd
.c;
-p
rd
•P
•H
CO
0)
^
rd
rH
c_,
O
4_i
^^
CO
t-^
CD
H
£_j
CU
•H
CU
f
d
CU
rH
rH
O
>
O
•p
bO
c;
•H
T3
C_|
O
O
O
rd
co
CU
3
H
rd
>
bO
d
•H
T3
rd
0
Tj
•
CU
e
•H
-P
CU
O
d
CU
13
•H
CO
CU
C_!
•
bfl
d
•rH
rH
H
•H
4n
CO
rd
3:
CU
^
H
CU
r;
-p
CU
•rH
ft
'g
T3
0)
-P
O
CU
[— I
rH
O
O
rd
-P
rd
t3
d
O
t)
CU
10
rd
CO
rd
•3-
3
0
rH
rH
0
K
,d
o
-p
Q
f_,
o
cp
cu
rH
id
>
H
CO
EH
0)
-------
of the impoundments. It also gives the ratio of estimated
loading to "permissible" phosphorus loading. This ratio
should be an indication of the degree of eutrophication of
each impoundment. The impoundments were arranged in Table 9
in order of ascending mid-range ratio values, i.e., in decreas-
ing lake water quality based on this loading ratio.
Dutch Hollow Lake was filling throughout the study period;
this is reflected in the ranking in Tables 6 and 9 and indi-
cates the lake water quality would improve when the lake was
filled. Blackhawk was also filling throughout the first eight
months of the study; however, normal pool elevation was used
in all calculations presented here.
Comparison of the water quality ranking in Table 6 with that
in Table 9 shows reasonably good correlation particularly at
the ends of the ranking scale. Several of the impoundments
have exchanged positions in the order in Table 9 , but these
lakes generally have overlapping phosphorus loading ratio
ranges. Part of the problem for a lack of correlation between
estimated total phosphorus loads and the overall water quality
characteristics may be due to a number of factors. One of
these is that in some instances a substantial part of the total
phosphorus, such as the particulate forms, entering the im-
poundment may not become available to aquatic plants in the
impoundment. Studies by Cowen (1973) show that only about
30 percent of the particulate phosphorus in both urban and
rural drainage will likely become available for algal growth
in lakes.
It appears that either approach to assessing relative water
quality in lakes and impoundments is viable, and together they
may provide an approach to lake water quality assessment and
management.
A number of hydrologic and water quality parameters for each
lake are summarized in Tables A-l to A-8 in the Appendix.
391
-------
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
Most of the information in this report was taken from Piwoni
and Lee (1974) Report to the Wisconsin Department of Natural
Resources. That report was assembled as part of a Master's
thesis study at the University of Wisconsin-Madison. Copies
of the report may be obtained by writing the authors. Pre-
sentation of much of the background information on these im-
poundments would not have been possible without the assist-
ance of the Wisconsin Department of Natural Resources per-
sonnel, especially T. Wirth and R. Dunst, and several of the
lake developers. Special thanks also go to J. Stroud for
his assistance throughout the project.
REFERENCES
American Public Health Association, American Water Works
Association, Water Pollution Control Federation.
Standard Methods for the Examination of Water and
Wastewater, 13th ed., New York, APHA, 1971. 874 p.
Bredemus, R.N. Fish Habitat Development Project Proposal
for Blackhawk Lake. Wise. Dept. Natural Res. Report,
Madison, Wise., June 5, 1970.
Carlson, K. Personal Communication to G.F. Lee. Building
Development Report, Madison, Wise. 1971.
Cline , D.R. Geology and Groundwater Resources of Dane
County, Wise. USGS Water-Supply Paper 1779-U.
1965. 64 p.
Cowen, W.F., K. Sirisinha and G.F. Lee. Nitrogen Availability
in Lake Ontario Tributary Waters During IFYGL, Pres. 17th
Conference Great Lakes Research, 1974.
Dunst, R.C. Cox Hollow Lake, The First Eight Years of Im-
poundment. Wise. Dept. Natural Res. Research Project
47. Madison, Wisconsin. 1969. 19 p.
Dunst, R.C., T.L. Wirth and P.D. Uttormark. Cox Hollow Lake
Nutrient Supply and Retention, Wise. Dept. Natural Res.
Madison, Wisconsin, 1972.
Frey, D.G. (ed.). Limnology in North America. Madison, Wise.
University of Wise. Press, 1963. p. 575-593.
Klingelhoets, A.J. Soil Survey of Iowa County, Wisconsin.
Soil Conservation Ser. 1958, No. 22, 1962. 100 p.
392
-------
Lee, G. F. Expected Water Quality in the N.E. Isaacson
and Associates Proposed Impoundment on Fourteen Mile
Creek-Adams County, Wisconsin. Report to N. E.
Isaacson and Associates. 1972.
Lueschow, L. A., J. M. Helm, D. R. Winter, and G. W. Karl.
Trophic Nature of Selected Wisconsin Lakes. Trans.
Wise. Acad. Sciences, Arts and Letters. 58: 247-264,
1970.
Piwoni, M. D. and G. F. Lee. A Limnological Survey of
Selected Impoundments in Central and Southern Wis-
consin. Report to Wise. Dept. Natural Res. May 1974.
Rickert, D. A. and A. M. Spieker. Real-Estate Lakes. USGS
Circ. 601-G. Washington, D. C. 1971. 19 p.
Ruttner, F. Fundamentals of Limnology. Toronto, University
of Toronto Press, 1965. p. 14-15.
Smith, T. Lake Inventory, Lake Redstone, Sauk County.
Report to C. Enerson, Wise. Dept. Natural Res., Dodge-
ville, Wise. 1973.
Sonzogni, W. C. and G. F. Lee. Nutrient Sources for Lake
Mendota — 1972. Trans. Wise. Acad. Sciences, Arts
and Letters. ^2: 133-164, 1974.
Strickland, J. D. H. and T. R. Parsons. A Manual of Sea
Water Analysis, 2nd Ed. Ottawa, Fisheries Research
Board of Canada. 1965. p. 1B5-192.
Vollenweider, R. A. (1973). Input-Output Models. Schweig.
Z. Hydrol. In Press.
Weeks, E. P. and H. G. Strangland. Effects of Irrigation
on Streamflow in the Central Sand Plain of Wisconsin.
USGS Open File Report, Madison, Wise. 1971. p. 18-29.
Wirth, T. L., R. C. Dunst, P. D. Uttomark, and W. Hilsen-
hoff. Manipulation of Reservoir Waters for Improved
Quality and Fish Population Response. Wise. Dept.
Natural Res. Research Rpt. 62, Madison, Wise. 1970.
23 p.
Wisconsin Department of Natural Resources (WDNR) Files,
Madison, Wise., 1972-73 . Much of this material was
undated and in loose form. Material was obtained
through the courtesy of T. Wirth and R. Dunst.
393
-------
TABLE A-l DATA SUMMARY FOR NORTH AMERICAN PROJECT
LAKE REDSTONE (WISCONSIN)
Trophic State
Lake Type
Drainage Area
Lake Surface Area
Mean Depth
Retention Time
Mean Alkalinity
Mean Conductivity
Mean Secchi Disk
Mean Dissolved Phosphorus
Mean Total Phosphorus
Mean Inorganic Nitrogen
Mean Chlorophyll a
Annual Productivity
Phosphorus Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
Nitrogen Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
Eutrophic
Impoundment
7
7.67 x 10 square meters
2.52 x 10 square meters
4.3 meters
0.7-1 years
125 mg/1 as CaC03
260 umhos/cm @ 25°C
1.6 meters
0.008a'b mg/1 as P
0.03a O.llb mg/1 as P
0.80a 0.31b mg/1 as N
12.8° pg/l
0 kg/year
3630 - 4230 kg/year ,
1.44 - 1.68 gr/meter /year
0 kg/year
45,400 kg/yea^1
18.1 gr/meter /yr
Average winter
b, . , .
Average sunder epilimnion
/-^
In first two neters of water column
--Not determined
394
-------
TABLE A-2 DATA SUMMARY FOR NORTH AMERICAN PROJECT
DUTCH HOLLOW LAKE (WISCONSIN)
Trophic State
Lake Type
Drainage Area
Lake Surface Area
Mean Depth
Retention Time
Mean Alkalinity
Mean Conductivity
Mean Secchi Disk
Mean Dissolved Phosphorus
Mean Total Phosphorus
Mean Inorganic Nitrogen
Mean Chlorophyll a
Annual Productivity
Phosphorus Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
Nitrogen Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
- Eutrophic
- Impoundment
7
- 1.25 x 10 square meters
- 8.50 x 10 square meters
- 3 mCstudy level)- 6 mCwhen
, D filled)
- 1.8 years
- 133 mg/1 as CaC03
- 25? pmhos/cm @ 25°C
- 0.8 jneters
- 0.021a 0.013b mg/1 as P
- 0.40a 0.12b mg/1 as P
- 0.61a 0.22b mg/1 as N
- 33.9° pg/1
0 kg/year
810 - 870 Kg/year
0.95 - 1.01 gr/meter /year
0 kg/year
8,800 kg/year2
10.4 gr/meter /year
Average winter
Average summer epilimnion
In first two meters of water column
--Not determined
395
-------
TABLE A-3 DATA SUMMARY FOR NORTH AMERICAN PROJECT
LAKE VIRGINIA (WISCONSIN)
Trophic State
Lake Type
Drainage Area
Lake Surface Area
Mean Depth
Retention Time
Mean Alkalinity
Mean Conductivity
Mean Secchi Disk
Mean Dissolved Phosphorus
Mean Total Phosphorus
Mean Inorganic Nitrogen
Mean Chlorophyll a
Annual Productivity
Phosphorus Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
Nitrogen Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
- Eutrophic
- Impoundment
- 6.48 x 10 square meters
- 1.82 x 10 square meters
- 1.7 meters
- 0.9 - 2.8 years
- 64 mg/1 as CaCOQ
J
- 230 umhos/cm at 25 C
- 1.2 meters
- 0.004a 0.025b mg/1 as P
- 0.02a 0.15b mg/1 as P
- 0.22° 0.18U mg/1 as N
- 29.0C yg/1
0 kg/year
210 - 270 kg/year 2
1.15 - 1.U8 gr/meter /year
0 kg/year
3,300 kg/year2
18.3 gr/meter /year
Average winter
b. ., .
Average summer epilimnion
cln first two meters of water column
--Not determined
396
-------
TABLE A-4 DATA SUMMARY FOR NORTH AMERICAN PROJECT
CAMELOT-SHERWOOD COMPLEX (WISCONSIN)
Trophic State
Lake Type
Drainage Area
Lake Surface Area
Mean Depth
Retention Time
Mean Alkalinity
Mean Conductivity
Mean Secchi Disk
Mean Dissolved Phosphorus
Mean Total Phosphorus
Mean Inorganic Nitrogen
Mean Chlorophyll a_
Annual Productivity
Phosphorus Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
Nitrogen Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
- Mesotrophic - Eutrophic
- Impoundment
7
- 9.06 x 10 square meters
- 2.83 x 10 square meters
~ 2.9 meters
- 0.09 - 0.14 years
-125 mg/1 as CaCOg
- 311 ym^ios/cm at 25 C
- 2.0 meters
- 0.008a 0.008b mg/1 as P
- 0.03a 0.04b mg/1 as P
- 1.07a 0.59b mg/1 as N
- 6.3C Ug/1
0 kg/year
6660 - 7580 kg/year
2.35 - 2.68 gr/meter /year
0 kg/year
97 ,600 kg/year
34.6 gr/meter2/year
Average winter
Average surfer epilimnion
°In first two meters of water column
--Not determined
397
-------
TABLE A-5 DATA SUMMARY FOR NORTH AMERICAN PROJEC
LAKE BLACKHAWK (WISCONSIN)
Trophic State
Lake Type
Drainage Area
Lake Surface Area
Mean Depth
Retention Time
Mean Alkalinity
Mean Conductivity
Mean Secchi Disk
Mean Dissolved Phosphorus
Mean Total Phosphorus
Mean Inorganic Nitrogen
Mean Chlorophyll a_
Annual Productivity
Phosphorus Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
Nitrogen Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
- Eutrophic
- Impoundment
- 3.63 x 10 square meters
- 8.90 x 10 square meters
- 4.9 meters
- 0.5 years
- 227 mg/1 as CaC03
umhos/cm at 25°C
- 3.6 meters
- 0.044° 0.015b mg/1 as P
- 0.12a 0.05b mg/1 as P
- 1.02a 0.54b mg/1 as N
- 14.6° pg/l
0 kg/year
1900 - 2070 kg/year 2
2.13 - 2.32 gr/meter /year
0 kg/year
20,900 kg/year
23.4 gr/meter^/year
Average winter
Average summer epilimnion
Q
In first two meters of water column
--Not determined
398
-------
TABLE A-6 DATA SUMMARY FOR NORTH AMERICAN PROJECT
LAKE STEWART (WISCONSIN)
Trophic State
Lake Type
Drainage Area
Lake Surface Area
Mean Depth
Retention Time
Mean Alkalinity
Mean Conductivity
Mean Secchi Disk
Mean Dissolved Phosphorus
Mean Total Phosphorus
Mean Inorganic Nitrogen
Mean Chlorophyll a_
Annual Productivity
Phosphorus Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
Nitrogen Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
- Eutrophic
- Impoundment
- 2.07 x 10 square meters
4
- 2.51 x 10 square meters
- 1.9 meters
- 0.08 years
- 213 mg/1 as CaCOg
- 540 Umhos/cm @ 25°C
- 1.4 meters
- 0.0113 0.008b mg/1 as P
- 0.04a 0.08b mg/1 as P
- 2.26a 0.86b mg/1 as N
- 12.3° ug/1
0 kg/year
121 - 202 kg/year 2
4.82 - 8.05 gr/meter /year
0 kg/year
1,850 kg/year2
73.6 gr/meter /year
Average winter
Average suruner epilimnion
Q
In first two meters of water column
--Not determined
399
-------
TABLE A-7 DATA SUMMARY FOR NORTH AMERICAN PROJECT
COX HOLLOW LAKE (WISCONSIN)
Trophic State
Lake Type
Drainage Area
Lake Surface Area
Mean Depth
Retention Time
Mean Alkalinity
Mean Conductivity
Mean Secchi Disk
Mean Dissolved Phosphorus
Mean Total Phosphorus
Mean Inorganic Nitrogen
Mean Chlorophyll a
Annual Productivity
Phosphorus Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
Nitrogen Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
- Eutrophic
- Impoundment
7
- 1.61 x 10 square meters
- 3.88 x 10 square meters
- 3.8 meters
- 0.5 - 0.7 years
- 205 mg/1 as CaCO
- 440 umhos/cm @ 25°C
- 1.5 meters
- 0.036a 0.015b mg/1 as P
- 0.10a 0.06b mg/1 as P
- 0.83a 0.36b mg/1 as N
- 26.5C pg/1
0 kg/year
630 - 810 kg/year 2
1.62 - 2.08 gr/meter /year
0 kg/year
7,410 kg/year2
19.1 gr/meter /year
Average winter
Average surfer epilimnion
CIn first two meters of water column
--Not determined
400
-------
TABLE A-8 DATA SUMMARY FOR NORTH AMERICAN PROJECT
TWIN VALLEY LAKE (WISCONSIN)
Trophic State
Lake Type
Drainage Area
Lake Surface Area
Mean Depth
Retention Time
Mean Alkalinity
Mean Conductivity
Mean Secchi Disk
Mean Dissolved Phosphorus
Mean Total Phosphorus
Mean Inorganic Nitrogen
Mean Chlorophyll a.
Annual Productivity
Phosphorus Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
Nitrogen Loading
Point source
Non-point source
Surface area loading
- Eutrophic
- Impoundment
7
- 3.11 x 10 square meters*
- 6.07 x 10 square meters
- 3.8 meters
- 0.4 - 0.5 years
- 175 mg/1 as CaCOg
- 370 ymhos/cm @ 25°C
- 1.5 meters
- 0.019a 0.009b mg/1 as P
- 0.07a 0.06b mg/1 as P
- 0.51a 0.23b mg/1 as N
- 19.0° yg/1
0 kg/year
1090 - 1250 kg/year 2
1.7U - 2.05 gr/meter /year
0 kg/year
10,500 kg/year
17. U gr/meter2/year
* About 1/2 of drainage area is controlled by an upstream
impoundment.
aAverage winter
Average summer epilimnion
cln first two meters of water column
—Not determined
401
-------
SECTION VIII - MULTIPLE-STATE LAKES AND SPECIAL TOPICS
LIMNOLOGICAL CHARACTERISTICS OF THE POTOMAC ESTUARY
N. A. Jaworski
Corvallis Environmental Research Laboratory
U.S. Environmental Protection Agency
Corvallis, Oregon
INTRODUCTION
Increasingly, over the past few centuries, the water of the
Potomac Estuary has been degraded, primarily by the domestic
wastewater discharged from the Washington, D.C. metropolitan
area. High coliform counts, low dissolved oxygen levels, and
nuisance algal growths typify water quality management problems
in the Potomac Estuary.
Since the early 1900's, numerous water quality studies have
been conducted on the Potomac River Basin including the Estuary.
Initial studies primarily emphasized bacterial quality and dis-
solved oxygen problems. Beginning in the late 1960's, studies
were expanded to include the problem of eutrophication. A report
on the "Water Resources/Water Supply" by Jaworski, et al. (1971)
culminated over six years of intensive investigation of the Upper
Potomac Estuary.
The Potomac Estuary was included in the North American
Project, a eutrophication study by the Organization of Economic
Cooperation and Development (OECD). This report summarizes
history and recent data relative to the goals of the North Amer-
ican Project of OECD.
402
-------
DESCRIPTION OF THE POTOMAC RIVER BASIN
The Potomac River Basin, including the Estuary, comprises the
second largest watershed in the Middle Atlantic States, with a
2
drainage area of approximately 38,000 square kilometers (km ).
From its headwaters on the eastern slope of the Appalachian
Mountains, the Potomac flows first northeasterly and then gen-
erally southeasterly some 644 km, flowing past the nation's
capital. The Potomac is tidal from Washington, D. C. to its
confluence with the Chesapeake Bay, a distance of 183 km (Figure 1)
Of the 3.3 million people living in the basin, about 2.8 million
live in the Washington, D. C. metropolitan area. The upper basin
is largely rural with scattered small cities populated by 10,000
to 20,000. Land use in the entire Potomac Basin is estimated to
be 5 percent urban, 55 percent forest, and 40 percent agriculture,
including pasture lands.
Climate Study Area
The Potomac River Tidal System lies in a sort of climatic cross-
roads. Cold air masses invade from Canada and the Arctic, while
the Appalachian Mountains provide some protection from the cold.
Hurricanes moving north along the Atlantic Seaboard generally pass
over the lower tidal system about once every five years. Coastal
"northeastern" storms often bring strong winds accompanied by heavy
rain or snow from that direction, most frequently in winter and
early spring.
Annual precipitation ranges from 89 to 114 centimeters (cm), in-
cluding about 61 cm of snow. Table 1 shows that precipitation is
fairly well distributed throughout the year.
403
-------
CHA.N
, D.C.
-WOODROW WILSON .._„.__ „„ -. .
BRIDGE UPPER REACH
MIDDLE REACH
POINT
LOOKOUT
CHESAPEAKE
BAY
Figure 1. Potomac Estuary.
404
-------
Winters In the Potomac River Basin are moderately cold and the
summers warm, indicated by the mean monthly temperatures also
in Table 1. Daytime temperatures of more than 35 C. are not
unusual in summer. The frost-free season averages about 150 days.
Description of Potomac Estuary
For discussion and investigative purposes, the tidal portion of
the Potomac River was divided into three reaches shown in Figure 1
and described below:
Volume
3 7
Reach Description River Kilometer (m x 10 )
Upper From Chain Bridge to 183 to 135 26.4
Indian Head
Middle From Indian Head to 135 to 75.0 102.5
Rt. 301 Bridge
Lower From Rt. 301 Bridge to 75.0 to 00.0 496.5
Chesapeake Bay
The upper reach, although tidal, contains fresh water. The middle
reach normally is the transition zone from fresh to brackish water.
In the lower reach, chloride concentrations near the Chesapeake Bay
range from about 9,000 to 15,000 mg/1.
The tidal portion, about 60 meters in width at its head and at
Washington, broadens to nearly 10 km at its mouth. A shipping
channel with a minimum depth of 7.5 meters is maintained upstream
to Washington, Except for this channel and a few short reaches
where depths reach up to 30 meters, the tidal portion is relatively
shallow, averaging about 5.5 meters in depth.
The mean tidal range is about 0.9 meter in the upper portion near
Washington and about 0.5 meter near Chesapeake Bay. The tidal lag
time between Washington and Chesapeake Bay is about 6,5 hours. The
405
-------
latitude and longitude of the centroid of the Potomac Estuary are
38° 22' 150" and 77° 00' 300", respectively. The altitude is at
the level of the Atlantic Ocean.
TABLE 1
MEAN MONTHLY TEMPERATURE AND PRECIPITATION
FOR
WASHINGTON, D. C., NATIONAL AIRPORT
1933 - 1972
Month
January
February
March
April
May
June
July
August
September
October
November
December
Monthly Temperature (°C)
2.1
3.1
7.4
13.4
18.8
23.4
25.7
24.8
21.2
15.2
8.9
3.3
Monthly Precipitation (cm)
6.55
6.83
8.36
7.34
9.88
9.22
10.52
12.12
7.80
7.24
7.90
7.72
WATER RESOURCE USES OF THE POTOMAC ESTUARY
Municipal Water Supply Use
The municipal water supply of the Washington metropolitan area
comes from five major sources, primarily the Potomac River above
Washington, D. C. During 1969-1970, the five sources provided
/- n
1.4 x 10 • m /day. Currently, no municipal water is drawn from
the freshwater portion of the Potomac Estuary; however, an emergency
estuary intake was considered during the drought in the summer of 1969.
406
-------
Industrial Use
In the Washington metropolitan area, an insignificant amount of
water is used for manufacturing, primarily as cooling water in
stream electric plants.
Currently six major consumers in the Potomac River tidal system
r «3
use 10.4 x 10 m /day of cooling water. A seventh user has
been proposed.
Recreation and Boating
Aside from enhancing the suburban environment, the water and land
resources of the Potomac Estuary and its tributaries improve the
aesthetics of the capital. From Washington with its many tourists
to the remote park at Point Lookout near Chesapeake Bay, the
Potomac's resources are widely used. These include freshwater and
tidal sport fishing, boating, hunting, swimming, camping, and picnicking.
Commercial Fisheries
The Potomac Estuary supports a substantial commercial fishery.
Approximately 160 fish species live in the Potomac Estuary ecosystem.
The most significant economically are the anadromous and the semi-
anadromous species such as striped bass, shad, white and yellow
perch, winter flounder, and herring.
Another group of commercially important fish species spawn and winter
outside of Chesapeake Bay in the Atlantic Ocean, using the Potomac
for a nursery area and feeding ground. This group includes the
menhaden, croaker, silver perch, sea trout, and drum.
The lower reaches of the Potomac Estuary are considered prime shellfish
waters. There oysters and soft clams are indigenous, occurring in
the same general areas. Only in recent years, however, have they been
harvested commercially, and the demand far exceeds the resource.
407
-------
The lower Potomac affords a favorable habitat for blue crabs. As
juveniles, the young crabs feed and grow in the Estuary before
completing their life cycle at the mouth of Chesapeake Bay.
WASTEWATER LOADINGS AND TRENDS
3
Approximately 1.4 million m" /day of municipal wastewater are dis-
charged into the upper reach of the Potomac River tidal system.
Currently, 18 waste treatment facilities serve approximately 2.8
million people in the Washington metropolitan area.
That current discharge is a nine-fold increase over the 0.16 million
m /day in 1913. Similarly, total nitrogen and phosphorus loads
have increased about 10-fold and 22-fold, respectively (see Table 2),
TABLE 2
WASTEWATER LOADING TRENDS
(AFTER TREATMENT)
Year
1913
1932
1944
1954
1960
1970
Waste Flow
(m /day)
160,000
283,000
632,000
738,000
840,000
1,400,000
5-day BOD
(kg/day)
26,300
46,700
63,900
90,600
49,800
63,900
Total Nitro-
gen (kg/day)
2,900
5,200
10,400
14,400
16,800
27,200
Total Phos-
phorus (kg/day)
500
1,000
2,000
2,500
4,500
10,900
MORPHOMETRY AND HYDROLOGY
Morphometry
The basic morphometric data for the three reaches of the Potomac
Estuarv are tabulated:
408
-------
Middle
Lower
Length (km)
Avg. depth (m)
Avg. width (m)
9 f\
Surface area (m x 10 )
Volume (m3 x 10?)
48
4.8
1100
57.4
26.4
60
5.1
3625
211.6
102.5
75
7.2
9740
695.2
496.5
Because of tidal action and low salinity, the upper reach is unstratified,
Stratification begins in the middle reach during summer conditions. In
the lower reach, stratification occurs mostly during summer conditions.
Hydrology
The upr>er Potomac River Basin is the major source of freshwater inflow
into the Estuary. From 1930-1968, the average flow at Great Falls
3
was 305 m /sec before diversions for municipal water supply.
The mean monthly flows of the Potomac at Great Falls are tabulated
below for the reference period of 1931-1960.
Mean Monthly Flow
(nr/sec)
January
February
March
April
May
June
215
245
395
360
245
170
Mean Monthly Flow
(m /sec)
July
August
September
October
November
December
100
75
55
55
85
110
Each year the Potomac River delivers about 2,300 million kilograms
of sand, silt, clay, and organic debris to the tidal system. Most
of this usually occurs during February or March with maximum monthly
loads ranging from 50 to 90 percent of the total annual load.
409
-------
Tides dominate the currents in the Estuary. Typical maximum tidal
velocities for the three reaches are:
Reach Velocity (cm/sec)
Upper 25
Middle 28
Lower 18
The hydraulic detention time for any given reach of the tidal system
depends on the rate of fresh water inflow. The water renewal time for
the three reaches are given for the 5, 50, and 95% flow conditions:
Flow Percent of time Hydraulic Detention Time (years)
(m /sec) flow exceeded Upper Middle Lower Total
40 95% 0.21 0.81 3.95 4.07
185 50% 0.045 0.175 0.854 1.07
1150 5% 0.0073 0.028 0.137 0.17
The above tabulation indicates that the upper reach has relatively
short detention times, while the lower reach has times similar to lakes,
LIMNOLOGICAL CHARACTERIZATION
Physical
Even though it is 189 kilometers long, the Potomac Estuary maintains
a rather homogeneous temperature. While some stratification occurs
in the lower reach, tidal action appears to keep the system fairly
well mixed.
The mean monthly water temperatures in the upper Estuary recorded
for 22 years are:
410
-------
Month °C Month
January
February
March
April
May
June
2.5
3.3
7.8
14.0
20.4
25.9
July
August
September
October
November
December
28.1
27.8
24.7
18.4
11.5
4.8
The light penetration measured by the Secchi disk varies considerably
in the Potomac Estuary:
Reach Ranges of Secchi Disk (meters)
Upper 0.4 to 0.8
Middle 0.5 to 1.3
Lower 1.0 to 2,3
The turbid upper reach has a rather low transparency due to particulate
natter originating in the upper river basin. Suspended solids in
wastewater discharges also hinder light penetration. During the summer
months, ttronounced algal growths in the lower part of the upper reach
sometimes limit Secchi disk depths to less than 0.15 meter.
The conductivity in the Potomac Estuary is related to the salinity
concentration. The average ranges of conductivity and salinity for the
three reaches of the Estuary are:
Conductivity Salinity
Reach ymhos at 25°C 0/00
Upper 200 to 500 0.06 to 0.16
Middle 600 to 17000 0.22 to 9.00
Lower 17000 to 26000 9.00 to 15.00
411
-------
In the lower reach, significant stratification is due to a two-
layer flow of water --- that is, an upper layer with a net seaward
movement and a lower layer with a net upstream movement. The sea-
ward flow of fresh water results in less salinity in the lower
layer than in the upper layer of water.
Chemical
The Potomac River tidal system appears well buffered chemically.
Average ranges for pH and alkalinity are:
pH Total Alka-
Reach (Units) linity (mg/1)
Upper 7.0 to 8.0 70 to 110
Middle 7.5 to 8.2 60 to 85
Lower 7.5 to 8.0 65 to 85
The well buffered inflows from the upper Potomac River Basin and
wastewater discharges maintain the Estuary in narrow ranges of pH
and alkalinity. Tidal action keeps the system fairly well mixed.
Dissolved oxygen concentrations in the upper Potomac Estuary have been
routinely monitored since 1935. In the Upper Estuary near the waste-
water outfalls, those concentrations have followed a continuous
downward trend since 1938, slightly enhanced in 1960. Measurements
for the point of least concentration in the Upper Estuary illustrate
this downward trend:
Min. Consecutive Min. Single Value
28 Day Average During Period
(mg/1)
1940 4.0 3.0
1948 3.5 2.5
1Q50 3.0 2.3
1955 2.5 1.0
1960 3.5 2.5
1965 3.0 2.0
1970 2.5 2.0
412
-------
These low concentrations occurred mainly during the warm temperature
months in a zone extending about 10 kilometers from the wastewater
outfalls.
In the middle reach of the Estuary, dissolved oxygen decreased
significantly only during periods of massive algal blooms. Tidal
action kept this region well mixed.
In the lower Estuary, low dissolved oxygen levels are common in
the summer months. Concentrations less than 2.0 mg/1 occur in the
deeper reaches because high biological turnover with thermal and
salinity stratification restricts reaeration.
To date, trace elements in the water of the Potomac Estuary have not
been comprehensively analyzed. A recent study by Jaworski, et al. (1971)
on heavy metals in the Estuary sediments has caused concern about the
accumulation of metals and resulting water quality problems. The
study included analyses for lead, cobalt, chromium, cadmium, copper,
nickel, zinc, silver, barium, aluminum, iron, and lithium.
The concentration of nutrients along the Estuary varies as a function
of wastewater loading, temperature, freshwater inflow from the upper
basin, biological activity, and salinity. Jaworski, et al. (1971, 1972)
have reported the annual distribution of the various nutrient con-
centrations. Table 3 summarizes the summer levels for six key stations
along the Estuary.
In the vicinity of the Woodrow Wilson Bridge, the increase in total
and inorganic phosphorus, N0~ 4- NCL, ammonia, and total Kjeldahl
£3 .j
nitrogen can be attributed to the 1.40 million m /day of wastewater
discharged from the Washington metropolitan area. Between Woodrow Wilson
Bridge and Indian Head, ammonia nitrogen rapidly disappears as nitrifying
413
-------
^
o
M
H
EH CO cd
;z; !z 3
W O 4-1
U M tfl
£5 EH W
CO O M
U Q 0
W S3 cd
i-J h O 6
PQ O U O
<} 4-1
H W & 0
O W P-i
6
,_J V™ X
CO C
O CO x-\
O --.
+ S-i 00
CM 4-1 E
O -H — '
53 53
W
0 3
*rH J-l /^N
C O rH
cd f~i ~^
00 CO. 00
S-J 0) 0
00"-^
M ft-,
W
3
rH S-l ^s
Cd O rH
4-1 , f^i ^^^
O CL, OC
H tn g
O ^
Ps
e
o
4-1 0)
•XJ 60
C tn T3
cd M -H
OJ rt
fl 4J PQ
o a)
•H g c
•U O %rl
Cd i — 1 Cd
4-i -H _n
co W o
ON
•
o
1
in
•
o
0
m
c
I
o
r-l
0
0
•
<-l
1
CO
•
0
0
rH
•
o
1
CM
C
o
0
CM
•
C
1
OO
o
o
01
OJO
•H
j-j
pq
C '^
•rf 0
cd •
rC 0
U ^
0)
60
Ti
*ri
M
PQ
C
O
cn
r-|
•r-l
£S
•
?2
O
•
CO
1
in
•
rH
O
O
CM
1
o
O
rH
CS1
•
^ •
V-l *vf
cd oo
S* ^~*
^o
.
O
1
CM
•
O
O
CM
O
1
m
o
o
CM
•
O
I
rH
•
O
O
rH
•
O
1
CO
c
0
c
CM
•
C
1
m
0
o
0)
oc
"O
*iH s~*\
J-i ^^
PQ •
^3"
rH 0
O rH
CO ^~-
^j-
•
O
1
CM
•
O
0
rH
O
1
in
o
o
rH
•
0
1
o
•
0
-d-
o
•
0
1
rH
0
o
o
vO
o
•
c
I
fO
c
c
3
O
0
0
0
4-1 •
C m
•rl 00
0 rH
PU "--
414
-------
bacteria oxidize NH to NO + NO . NO + NO. nitrogen drops
sharply between Indian Head and Maryland Point, taken up by the
pronounced algal growths in this area.
Biological
The previously described differences in salinity, as well as
nutrient enrichment by wastewater discharges, markedly affect
the ecology of the Estuary. Under summer and fall conditions,
large populations of blue-green algae, mainly Anacystis sp.,
prevail in the freshwater portion of the Estuary. Large standing
crops of this alga occur, especially during periods of low flow,
forming green mats of cells.
In the saline portion of the Potomac Estuary, the algal popu-
lations are not as dense as in the freshwater portion. At times
large populations of marine phytoplankton occur, primarily
Gymnodinium sp. and Arophidinium ap_., producing massive growths
known as "red tides."
Increased nutrient loadings from wastewater since 1913 have
impressively affected the dominant plant forms in the upper Estuary,
as documented by Jaworski et al. (1972) and shown in Figure 2. Of
several nutrients and other growth factors implicated as stimulating
this, nitrogen and phosphorus probably are the most manageable.
Plant succession in the upper Potomac Estuary can be inferred from
several studies. Gumming (1916) surveyed the Estuary in 1913-1914
and noted the absence of plant life near thenajor wastewater outfalls.
He observed normal amounts of rooted aquatic plants on the flats or
shoal areas below the urban area, but no nuisance levels of rooted
aquatic plants or phytoplankton.
415
-------
D SD NoeavD
0
0
Q
o
o
1
0
8
o"
co
1
o
o
o
o"
1
o
o
q
o
^f
1
0
0
o
o"
1
c
!•
*H*s
oo *» ° 3 O
1§3*§
Q- m
^ z
u
Q 3 £
!5 3 ^
|3^
m
Z)
I z
Ld O
O
cr
UJ
I
a: to
O , IAJ
III
1
o
o
o
iO
(\J
1
0
o
o
o
C\J
1
0
o
o
iO
1
o
o
0
o"
1
o
0
o
IT)
(ADp/6>t)
N39OH1IN 1V1O1
O
(O
CT>
o
m
CD
o
•*
CD
o
n
O)
o
cu
O)
o
a>
1
o
o
0
o
1
o
o
o
CD
1
0
o
o
(O
0
o
o
•t
1
o
0
o
(NJ
C
o
0)
M-l
cfl
O
•H
60
O
i-l
O
o
0)
cn
-a
a)
4-J
a
Q)
C
a)
d
S-i
0)
OJ
•u
en
t-t
3
t>0
•H
(Xop/6>()
d SD SfiaOHdSOHd 1V1O1
416
-------
In the 1920's, water chestnut (Trapa natans) infested the waters
of Chesapeake Bay and the Potomac Estuary. This weed was controlled
by mechanical removal.
In September and October, 1952, Bartsch (1954) surveyed the reaches
near the metropolitan area and found that vegetation was virtually
nonexistent in the area. He reported no dense phytoplankton blooms
although the study did not include the downstream areas where the
blooms subsequently occurred.
In 1958, a rooted aquatic plant, water milfoil (Myriophy-llum
spicatum), developed in the Potomac Estuary and created nuisance
conditions. These increased to major proportions by 1963, especially
in the embayments downstream from Indian Head (Elser, 1965). These
dense strands of rooted aquatic plants disappeared rapidly in 1965
and 1966, presumably due to a natural virus (Bailey, et al., 1968).
In August and September, 1959, Scotts and Longwell (1962) surveyed
the upper Estuary. They observed high levels of the nuisance blue-
green alga, Anacystis sp., in the Potomac Estuary near Washington.
Subsequent and continuing observations have confirmed persistent
summer blooms of this alga in nuisance concentrations greater than
50 ug/1, occurring from the metropolitan area downstream at least
as far as Maryland Point. Chlorophyll a_ determinations in the upper,
middle, and lower reaches of the Potomac Estuary are presented for
six key stations:
417
-------
Station and Kilometers Average Yearly
from Chain Bridge Range of chlorophyll (ug/1)
Chain Bridge
(0.0) 20 - 50
W. Wilson Bridge
(19.5) 30 - 60
Indian Head
(49.3') 30 - 150
Maryland Point
(84.3) 30 - 100
301 Bridge
(104.7) 10 - 30
Point Lookout
(185.0) 10 - 20
Diatom blooms have been observed in the late winter and spring. The
occurrence and persistence of these blooms appear greatly influenced
by the spring runoff in the Potomac River Basin.
Nutrient Budgets
Runoff from the upper basin greatly influences the nutrient budgets
of the Estuary reaches. Table 4 shows that the loading for carbon,
nitrogen and phosphorus is a function of the discharge flow from the
upper basin. Considering only upper basin runoff and wastewater
discharges to the Estuary leads to the conclusion that the nutrients
to be controlled by wastewater treatment are (1) phosphorus, nitrogen,
and (3) carbon.
While the percentages of controllable ohosphorus and nitrogen decrease
at higher flows, these conditions usually occur during the months of
February, March, and April when temperatures and algal crops are lowest.
Since nuisance algal conditions occur primarily in the upper, freshwater
portion of the Estuary, the higher flow effects are considerably less
418
-------
TABLE 4
SUMMARY OF MAJOR NUTRIENT SOURCES
Upper Reach of the Potomac Estuary
Low-flow Conditions
(95 % of time exceeded)
(Potomac River
Upper
Basin
Runoff*
(kg/day)
Carbon 77,100
Nitrogen 3,000
Phosphorus 450
Discharge at
Percent
of
Total
52
10
4
Washington, D. C.
Estuarine
Wastewater
Discharges
(kg/day)
72,600
27,200
10,900
3
= 40 meters
Percent
of
Total
48
90
96
/sec)
Total
(kg/day)
148,700
30,200
11,350
Median-flow Conditions
(Potomac River
Carbon 159,000
Nitrogen 18,100
Phosphorus 2,400
(50 %
Discharge at
68
40
18
of time exceeded)
Washington, D. C.
72,600
27,200
10,900
= 185 meters
32
60
82
/sec)
231,600
45,300
13,300
High-flow Conditions
(5 % of time exceeded)
(Potomac River
Carbon 6«0,00n
Nitrogen 185,000
Phosphorus 10,000
Discharge at
90
87
47
Washington, D. C.
72,600
27,200
10,900
3
= 1150 meters /sec)
10
13
53
752,600
212,200
20,900
*IIpper basin runoff includes both land runoff and wastewater discharges in upper
basin. The contribution of ground water and direct precipitation were estimated
to be insignificant.
419
-------
during July, August, and September when the blooms are most
prolific.
Current nutrient loading rates for the upper Estuary, the upper
and middle Estuary combined, and the upper, middle and lower
Estuary combined are:
2
Nutrient Loadings (grams/meter surface area/year) at median flows
Nutrient Upper Upper & Middle Upper, Middle, & Lower
Phosphorus 89.6 17.4 5.0
Nitrogen 288.0 55.6 16.9
Using the revised Vollenweider (in press) loading approach for lakes,
Figure 3 shows the current rate for the three groupings of the Estuary.
Figure 3 also shows the loading rate resulting from a protected degree
of phosphorus control and for the year 1913 as developed in the study
by Jaworski, et al. (1971).
Figure 3 demonstrates that providing a high degree of phosphorus
removal will cause the loading levels for 1he three combined segments
to approach the conditions of 1913. Moreover, another ready con-
clusion is that the permissible and excessive loadings to the Estuary
would be considerably larger than for lakes. Nevertheless, the
general overall relationship appears to hold true; that is, the
critical phosphorus loading is a function of mean depth/mean hydraulic
residence time.
When comparing the chlorophyll data of the Estuary to those of the
OECD lakes, the Estuary appears less affected bv high concentrations
of chlorophyll. In part this may be due to the greater mixing of
the Estuary, compared to lakes.
420
-------
1000
100
OJ
o
<
o
or
o
i
Q_
cn
o
X
Q_
10
0-
o-oi
ft:
S
ft:
O
Uj
- "EUTROPHIC"
-------
DISCUSSION
The eutrophication problems in the Potomac Estuary are more pro-
nounced than those of other North Atlantic Coast estuaries. While
the James and Delaware Estuaries are experiencing some eutrophication
problems, the more severe conditions in the Potomac can be classified
as hyper-eutrophic.
Analysis of the Potomac Estuary is complicated by two variables:
(1) salinity, and (2) light-limiting conditions. Frequently high
sediment loads from the upper drainage basin and suspended matter
in wastewater discharges make the upper portion turbid. This
light-limiting condition restricts algal growth in the upper portion
of the upper reach. In the middle and lower reaches, light penetration
increases; however, salinity also increases, resulting in a transition
from fresh-water to marine-water organisms.
Determining appropriate alternatives for water quality management,
including the eutrophication problem, of the Potomac Estuary requires
the ability to predict the effect of removing essential nutrients.
Numerous investigations, most dealing with lake eutrophication, have
attempted various approaches to relate trophic state and nutrient input.
An approach to defining a relationship between the ecology of the
Estuary and nutrient input can be delineated from the historical
data in Figure 2 and Tables 2 and 4. The Estuary responded dramatically
to the large increase of nutrients mainly from the wastewater dis-
charges in the Washington, D. C. area. The nutrient increase initially
resulted in rooted aquatic weeds with nuisance blue-green algal growths
overtaking the weeds when nutrients increased more. Figure 2 shows
that phosphorus and nitrogen loadings should be about equal to the
1913-1920 conditions about 600 kg/day of phosphorus and 3000 kg/day
of nitrogen from wastewater discharges that resulted in no major
plant nuisances.
422
-------
Mathematica1 modeling has been another approach to relate trophic
state to nutrient input. Studies summarized by Jaworski (1975) have
shown that the upper and middle reach of the Estuary become nitrogen
limited in the summer months. Recent model studies by Clark (personal
communication) project that instituting a high degree of phosphorus
removal at the wastewater treatment facilities in the Washington, D. C.
area will make the Estuary either phosphorus or nitrogen limited. The
degree to which either nutrient becomes limiting depends on factors
such as runoff and distance along the Estuary. Jaworski et al. (1970)
used mathematical models with a 25 yg/1 chlorophyll target to estimate
wastewater nutrient loadings of 1000 kg/day of phosphorus and 3100
kg/day of nitrogen into upper zones of the Estuary.
A third appraoch, the loading concept developed by Vollenweider,
relates nutrient loading to mean depth/mean hydraulic residence time.
This has been developed mainly for phosphorus and lakes. As previously
indicated, this method appears applicable to theEstuary but with higher
2
excessive and permissible loadings. Using an 18 g/m /yr loading rate from
Figure 3, the loading for the Upper Estuary would be about 500 kg/day
from wastewater effluents after subtracting the non-point source
contribution.
The three approaches yield about the same values for phosphorus and
nitrogen loadings. However, the Vollenweider loading concept needs
further verification with other estuaries before definitive relationships
can be formulated.
423
-------
SUMMARY
High oxygen-consuming and nutrient loadings, mainly from domestic
wastewater discharges, have degraded the water quality of the
Potomac Estuary. This high nutrient input has resulted in severe
eutrophication problems in the Estuary.
In this report the concept of critical phosphorus loading as a
function of mean depth/mean hydraulic residence time is applied
to the Potomac Estuary. When compared to lakes, the Potomac Estuary
apparently has a much higher capacity for assimilating nutrients.
Furthermore, the Estuary apparently can tolerate high trophic states
because it is & well-mixed system.
The critical phosphorus loadings compare favorably to estimates
derived from historical data and mathematical modeling efforts.
However, more research is needed to determine the validity of using
loading concepts on estuaries.
424
-------
REFERENCES
Bagley, S., H. Rabin, and C. H. Southwick. 1968. "Recent
Decline in the Distribution and Abundance of Eurasian
Water Milfoil in Chesapeake Bay." Chesapeake Science,
Vol. 9, No. 3.
Bartsch, A. F. 1954. "Bottom and Plankton Conditions in
the Potomac River in the Washington Metropolitan Area."
Appendix A, A Report on Water Pollution in the Washington,
D. C. Area. Interstate Commission on the Potomac River
Basin. Washington, D. C.
Clark, Leo. Personal Communication. Annapolis Field Station,
Environmental Protection Agency, Annapolis, Maryland.
Gumming, H. S. 1916. "Investigation of the Pollution and
Sanitary Conditions of the Potomac Watershed," Appendix
to Hygiene Laboratory Bulletin 104. U.S. Public Health
Service, Washington, D. C.
Elser, H. J. 1965. "Status of Aquatic Weed Problems in
Tidewater Maryland, Spring 1965." Maryland Denartment
of Chesapeake Bay Affairs, Annapolis. 8 pt>, mimeo.
Jaworski, N. A. 1975. "Use of Systems Analysis in Water
Quality Management of the Potomac Estuary." Presented
at seminar on System Analysis in Water Quality Management,
Budapest, Hungary, Feb. 2-8.
Jaworski, N. A., L. J. Clark, and K. D. Feigner. 1971. "A
Water Resources-Water Supply Study of the Potomac Estuary."
Technical Report 35. Chesapeake Technical Support Lab,
Middle Atlantic Region, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
Annapolis, Maryland.
Jaworski, N. A., D. W. Lear, and 0. Villa. 1972. "Nutrient
Management in the Potomac Estuary." In: Special Symposia,
Vol. 1. American Society of Limnology and Oceanography, Inc.,
Milwaukee, Wisconsin.
Scotts, V. D. and J. R. Longwell. 1962. "Potomac River Biological
Investigation 1959." Suoplement to Technical Appendix,
Part VII of the Report on the Potomac River Basin Studies.
U.S. Department of Health, Education, and Welfare, Washington, D. C,
Vollenweider, Richard A. (In press) "Input-Output Models."
Schweiz Z. Hydrol.
425
-------
THE JOHN H. KERR RESERVOIR -
VIRGINIA - NORTH CAROLINA
Charles M. Weiss and Julie H. Moore
Department of Environmental Sciences and Engineering
School of Public Health
University of North Carolina at Chapel Hill
INTRODUCTION
The 2,785 foot long concrete dam that impounds John H. Kerr Reservoir is
located in Mecklenburg County, Virginia, on the Roanoke River, about 178.7
river miles above the mouth in the Albermarle Sound, 20.3 miles downstream from
Clarksville, Virginia; 18 miles upstream from the Virginia-North Carolina State
Line and 80 air miles from Richmond, Virginia. Formed by closure of the dam
in 1952, the impoundment is a multipurpose project and was built for reduction
of flood damage in Lower Roanoke River, for generation of hydroelectric power
and for low water control for pollution abatement and conservation of fish
and wildlife.
GEOGRAPHIC DESCRIPTION
John H. Kerr Reservoir
Latitude - 36° 35' 56"; Longitude - 78° 18' 06"
Altitude - 300 feet MSL (maximum power tool)
Catchment area - Total of sub-basins and lake 7,800 sq. miles
General Climatic Data
The Climate in the Roanoke River Basin is temperate characterized by warm
summers and rigorous but generally not severe winters. Light snow and subzero
temperatures occur annually in the western portion of the basin and occasion-
ally over the entire basin. The average annual temperature for the basin is
about 14.4°C (58°F) and average monthly temperatures vary between 3.3°C (38°F)
and 25°C (77°F), (See Table 1 on following page for detailed monthly temperatures)
The average annual precipitation over the entire basin is about 43 inches
with annual extremes of 27 and 56 inches and is well distributed throughout the
year. Precipitation varies from 50 inches near the mouth of the Roanoke River,
426
-------
decreases with distance inland to 42 inches at about the center of the basin,
and then increases with elevation to approximately 54 inches at the headwaters
of the Dan River. In the vicinity of the John H. Kerr Reservoir the average
annual precipitation is about 43 inches. In the area at the headwaters of the
Roanoke River which lies between two mountain ranges (Allegheny and Blue Ridge
Mountains), the average annual precipitation is 38 inches. The average annual
snowfall is about 13 inches and does not accumulate sufficiently to have a
noticeable effect on flood flows.
Prevailing winds over the basin blow from the west to northwest in the
mountains and westerly elsewhere. The average annual wind velocity is 7 to 11
miles per hour. Wind velocities reach and exceed 80 miles per hour during
various types of storms. Most of the annual wind damage occurs during intense
thunderstorms.
The evaporation rate in the basin averages 37 inches from April to September,
which is 80 to 85 percent of the annual evaporation rate based on records for the
years 1954 to 1958 at Philpott and Kerr Reservoirs.
Table 1
Average Maximum, Average Minimum and
Normal Monthly Air Temperatures*
John H. Kerr Dam
Average Maximum Average Minimum Normal
Month
January
February
March
April
May
June
July
August
September
October
November
December
°C
9.6
11.3
15.7
21.2
26.3
30.1
31.6
30.7
27.7
22.2
16.8
9.5
°F
49.3
52.3
60.3
70.2
79.3
86.2
88.9
87.2
81.9
72.0
60.8
49.1
°C
-2.6
-1.8
1.9
6.8
12.4
17.1
19.3
18.6
14.9
7.7
1.8
-2.0
°F
27.3
28.7
35.5
44.3
54.3
62.7
66.7
65.4
58.9
45.8
35.2
28.3
°C
3.5
4.7
8.8
14.1
19.3
23.6
25.4
24.6
21.3
15.0
8.9
39.4
°F
38.3
40.5
47.9
57.3
66.8
74.5
77.8
76.3
70.3
59.0
48.1
39.1
Annual 21.0 69.8 7.8 46.1 14.4 58.0
^Reservoir Regulation Manual, Roanoke River Basin, North Carolina-Virginia. U.S.
Army Engineer District, Wilmington, Corps of Engineers, Wilmington, N.C. October
1965.
-------
General Geological Characteristics
In general the Piedmont Province, in which Kerr Reservoir is located, is
a maturely dissected upland underlain by a vast complex of igneous, metamorphic
and sedimentary rocks which are exposed in broad, northeast trending belts.
Deformation and intrusion of igneous material have altered preexisting igneous
and sedimentary rocks into metamorphic rocks which include gneisses, schists
and quartzites. The older rocks have been intensely folded, displaced by faults,
and intruded by igneous rocks, predominantly granites. The complexity of the
structure and the obscuring soil mantle make interpretation difficult and the
age relationships of many of the older formations uncertain. One large body
and three smaller outliers of Triassic sedimentary rocks occur within the
Piedmont portion of the Roanoke River Basin. These rocks consist of younger,
unaltered sandstones and shales which were preserved from erosion in
down-faulted basins. Diabase and gabbro dikes have been injected into the
Triassic rocks as well as into some of the older igneous and metamorphic rocks
of the Piedmont Province. Minerals abundant enough to be of commercial value
include tungsten, granite, gneiss, stone, sand and grave.
Actual sediment accumulation (due to erosion) measurements from a 9-year
survey period 1950-1959 showed about one ton of sediment per acre per year (or
639 tons per square mile per year). This rate of sedimentation if extended to
the whole Roanoke River Basin in Virginia would give a total of about 4 million
tons of sediment per year.
Vegetation
Over 60% of the drainage area is forested predominantly by Virginia,
loblolly, and shortleaf pine, and mixed-pine hardwood stands; small areas of
pure hardwoods are scattered throughout the basin. Vegetation on the lake
margins and in the lake is severely limited due to the fluctuating water level
428
-------
and wave action on the shoreline.
Other Basin Characteristics
The population of Roanoke River Basin in 1970 was 772,000. Land use was
predominately rural-agricultural, approximately 60% wooded, 30% cropland and
pasture, less than 10% urban and industrial. Water use of the impoundment
includes flood control, hydroelectric power, low water control for pollution
abatement and for conservation of fish and wildlife, recreation (fishing,
swimming, boating, etc.). The reservoir waters are also under development as
a regional water supply for several North Carolina towns.
Sewage and Effluent Discharges
Communities upstream of Kerr Reservoir contribute waste water effluents
to the rivers and streams that flow into the basin. In nearly all instances
these are treated sewages. However, in some instances plant breakdowns will
release untreated wastes to the inflowing streams. A recent compilation of
industrial and domestic point source discharges in the drainage of the
Roanoke basin is summarized in Table 2. Monitoring of the Dan, Banister and
Roanoke River and Nutbush Creek illustrates the nitrogen and phosphorus
concentrations and load (kg/d) currently entering the Kerr Reservoir, Tables 3
and 4. The configuration of John H. Kerr Reservoir characterized by two
major arms each with substantially different morphometric and hydraulic
dimensions (see map and Tables 5 and 6) requires that nutrient loading rates
and characteristic productivity responses be examined independently for each.
In turn, since each arm receives its major nutrient input at the head end, each
arm has been subdivided into five linear compartments, the discharge from each
becoming the inflow to the next downstream segment.
429
-------
Table 2
John H. Kerr Reservoir
Point Source Discharges, Industrial and Municipal
In Reservoir Drainage Area*
County
Industrial
Domestic
Virginia
Montgomery
Roanoke
Bedford
Franklin
Patrick
Henry
Pittsylvania
Campbell
Charlotte
Halifax
Appomattox
Mecklenberg
Other minor discharges
North Carolina
Vance
Granville
Rockingham
No.
3
15
9
3
5
11
10
10
5
12
-
-
-
-
-
-
MGD
.410
2.757
.305
.023
.528
54.799
16.834
6.364
.385
4.492
-
-
-
-
-
-
BODq Ib/day
75
75
-
8
303
3,279
20,334
1,995
34
11,325
-
-
-
-
-
-
No.
5
6
18
4
5
6
11
12
11
18
1
15
92
1
1
4
MGD
.181
29.029
.968
.606
.091
2.939
10.173
.830
.187
1.770
.100
.837
1.088
1.500
3.800
5.450
BOD5 Ib/day
54
6,077
975
154
164
2,637
935
454
105
1,965
30
346
561
626
1,809
2,823
Total 83 86.897 37,428
199 48.799 19,715
*Data for Virginia assembled from tabulations prepared by Hayes, Seay,
Mattern and Mattern for the Roanoke River Basin Study and provided by the
Wilmington District, U.S. Army Corps of Engineers. North Carolina data from
The Division of Environmental Management, Department of Economic and Natural
Resources.
-------
•g
ffl
CO
CO CU
C rH
0 a
^ *H H
•iH *J CO
O U CO
> OJ
CD I*t i-H
£ C CO
o CD >
>n
c c
cu id
oo cu
o s
Pu
H
Z
[
CO
O
H
,|
O O
en
O
"f
8
K
1— 1
o
H
r3
1
CO
,
li
2
i
r
IS
1
rH
i-J
^
-K
*
•K
^ 00
CO C!
<4H -H
CJ rH
6
& ccj
O en
i-H
P*< <4-l
O
QJ
00 T3
nj o
CO }-i
< PU
in ^
%•«
'H P* -X
r-4 QJ
01 V >
X w -H
O w Crf
C -H
CO C C
O ^ Ctf
04 M Q
O ON O v£> CO
O rO i — CO CO
O rH O 00
00 r- 1 ~& CO O
O O O 0 O
O CN O rH rH
rH vD CN CN rH
O O O 0 O
O m oo O~\ CN
vO CO cO "-3" ' — i
co in
00 3 rJ 00 r-i CJ
SQJ rH CJ qj li f-t
c pa c > o
v-t O M '"-< "H
co -u QJ QJ co Drf en
i-l tO rH J= 1-1 C
a cu AJ a Q o o
3 4-1 4-1 O r-l
X: iH -H 3 ^ X nj
4J PQ J CQ 4-J 33 <
0 O
fN ^> ON
CN O O
0 O O
ON r--- r--.
O O 0
O O> CO
rH O O
O O 0
0*1 o >n
ro r-. rH
rH O CO
rH rH CN
r-. O ON
0 O 0
CO O CN
. tJ 01
CO C -H
eo ro 4-J
CO rH 4J
S-i CO -H
O M H-I
rH
rH
CO
O
o
CO
O
O
r-~.
CO
CO
rH
in
o
rH
^
CO
CN
-3-
rH
^D
CN
CO
rH
1
X
QJ
S OJ
SJ i-J
en ro
3 rH
3
sD
rH
ON
O
0
0
O
cO
•*
O
rH
^O
0
CN
rH
CO
1
ON
CO
1
•^
01
CU
o
CO
ON
CN
-a-
^.j.*
m
ro*
rsl
vD
CN
rH
O
CO
i-H
CO
VO
CO
in
*>
r~-
CN
^
ON
01
QJ
O
C/3
3
4-J
3
^
in
in
CO
o
rH
O
XT
rH
O
CO
in
0
CN
in
ro
i-H
^
ro
CN
CN
ro
00
^f
•K
0)
.C
u
CO
•H
Q
g
CO
O
J-4
QJ
J^i
. r.
m
p^.
ON
rH
-C
CJ
I
CN
r-.
O^
rH
^~i
rH
3
CO
0)
rH
rx
e
en
i— i
_f~i
4J
C
o
E
T-H
ro
O
4-1
CO
CN
-K
m
i —
rH
_<^
U
cO
1
rH
rH
-H
J-
cx
CO
0)
rH
rx
e
cO
en
!>i
rH
4J
O
6
CN
rH
1
rH
rH
r-l
cfl
•u
CO
0
2
in
rH
r-t
•H
r-l
1
rH
t-l
&
§
4J
CX
01
en
TO
E
O
U-t
(X,
c
(0
rH
OJ
-------
Table 4
John H. Kerr Reservoir
River and Stream Flows and Nutrient Loads Based on Monthly Samples
Roanoke River*
July 1972-March 1973
April 1973-March 1974
April 1974-March 1975
Banister River*
July 1972-March 1973
April 1973-March 1974
April 1974-March 1975
Dan River*
July 1972-March 1973
April 1973-March 1974
April 1974-March 1975
North Drainage - April 1974-March 1975
Bluestone Creek
Little Bluestone Creek
Butcher Creek
South Drainage - April 1974-March 1975
Hyco River
Aarons Creek
Grassy Creek
Island Creek
Little Island Creek
Nutbush Arm
Flat Creek - April 1974-March 1975
Nutbush Creek
July 1972-March 1973
April 1973-March 1974
April 1974-March 1975
Kerr Dam*
Sept. 1973-March 1974
April 1974-March 1975
April 1974-March 1975
No. of Average
Samples c .f,s.
Total-N Total-P
Kg/d Kg/d N/P
8
11
12
8
11
12
8
11
12
12
12
12
12
12
12
12
12
12
8
11
12
6
12
3,488
3,707
2,725
562
546
615
2,769
2,934
2,803
47
19
25
309
48
64
33
21
14
10.9
8.3
6.4
7,425
9,219
4,380
5,495
3,248
659
833
880
3,977
6,306
5,770
41
24
31
422
68
75
32
25
14
266
282
150
11,509
11,032
608
524
574
51
64
73
765
1,174
970
4.1
6.4
4.3
49
3.4
5.7
2.9
2.2
1.3
81
87
61
553
1,033
7.2
10.5
5.6
12.9
13.0
12.1
5.2
5.4
5.9
10.0
3.8
7.2
8.6
20.0
13.2
11.0
11.4
10.8
3.3
3.2
2.5
20.8
10.6
365 8,859
*Gaged flows, others calculated from weighted drainage area.
432
-------
433
-------
Table 5
John H. Kerr Reservoir
Distance of Sampling Stations or Reference Buoys From
John H. Kerr Dam
Roanoke Arm
Dam
2
4
8
14
58-15*
20*
24*
Nutbush Arm
Buoy A
C (103)
E
H (108)
K (111)
L
N (114)
P (116)
218 (From Buoy P)
1308
118
119
Miles
0
1.5
4.5
8.5
13.2
19.5
20
24
2.7
4.7
5.4
7.9
10.7
11.5
12.6
13.4
0.6
14.0
14.6
15.0
Km
0
2.4
7.3
13.7
21.3
31.3
32.2
38.6
4.3
7.5
8.7
12.7
17.3
18.5
20.3
21.5
0.9
22.4
23.3
24.0
*Distance scaled from 1,250,000 USGS quadrangle "Greensboro, N. C."
Other distances scaled from USGS 1/24,000 quadrangles, "John H. Kerr Dam" and
"Middleburg, N. C."
434
-------
MORPHOMETRIC AND HYDROLOGIC CHARACTERISTICS
Table 6
John H. Kerr Reservoir
Morphemetrie and Hydrologic Characteristics
Reservoir Surface
At maximum flood-control pool (elev. 320)
At maximum power pool (elev. 300)
At minimum power pool (elev. 268)
Original river area (below elev. 320)
River elevation at dam elev. 200
Length at elevation 320
Roanoke River
Dan River above junction
Nutbush Arm above Buoy A
Length of Shoreline at elevation 300
Maximum width at elevation 300
Volume
Flood storage elev. 320 to elev. 300
Volume at elevation 300
Power draw down (elev. 300 to elev. 268)
Mean Depth
Roanoke Arm, Dam to Buoy 24
Nutbush Arm, Buoy A to 1308 bridge
Acres
83,200
48,900
19,700
4,280
Miles
56
34
14
800
2
Acre-Ft.
1,278,000
1,472,300
1,029,100
Feet
33.7
29.7
Ratio of Epilimnion to Hypolimnion - Transition depth 50
Hectares
33.670
19,789
7,972
1,732
Kilometers
90
55
22
1,287
3.2
Meter3 X 103
1,576,400
1,816,067
1,269,384
Meters
10.3
9.1
15.2
Acres - 48,900/11,000 hectares - 20,231/4,452
Acre-Ft. - 1,472,300/186,800 meters3 X 103 - 1,816,067/230,416
Stratification
Seasonal heating generally produces a thermal gradient of more than
2°C, in depths of 70-80 ft. (21.3-24.4 m) as early as mid-March. The upper
15 feet (4.6 m) may still be well mixed at this time. By mid-May the temperature
differential between the surface and the deeper portions of the reservoir has
increased to 5°C with the transition depth between 20 and 25 ft. (6.1-7.6 m).
In the upper arms of the reservoir the transition depth shallows to a depth of
10 to 15 ft. (3.0-4.6 m). In spite of hydro-power withdrawals stratification
persists with a 10°C differential, top to bottom, evident in August and the
435
-------
transition depth persisting between 40 to 50 ft. (12.2-15.2 m). Seasonal
cooling produces the fall overturn late in November and the reservoir is
generally well mixed by early December. Water temperatures lower than 4°C are
seldom found during the short winter period of December through February.
Lake Sediments
Bottom sediment samples from locations along the axes of the Roanoke and
Nutbush Arms of John H. Kerr Reservoir as well as in several of the lateral arms
that were also sampled for benthic organisms, were characterized according to
particle size dimension. These defined the sand, silt and clay content. In
addition the carbon content of these sediments was also determined by
dichromate oxidation, Tables 7 and 8. As might be expected the sand content of
the bottom sediments was much higher at the upper end of the Roanoke Arm
changing to a higher proportion of clay in the deeper portion of the impoundment.
Along the Nutbush Arm the silt content was generally greater than sand, which
was primarily limited to sublittoral locations. The carbon content of the
Nutbush Arm was also greater at its upper end where a substantial pollution
load enters. Even at the farthest downstream station, 103, the carbon content
of the sediment was still slightly higher than the average carbon content of
the main impoundment.
Seasonal Variation of Precipitation
The rainfall pattern of this area is characterized by regional
precipitation originating in air masses flowing from the Gulf of Mexico. This
is generally true of the winter and spring rains which give way to localized
thunderstorms from May to September. Except for the random intrusion of sub-
tropical hurricanes, the fall months, particularly October and November, are
the driest although midsummer droughts are quite common. The monthly
436
-------
Table 7
John H. Kerr Reservoir
Particle Size Characteristics of Bottom Sediments
Particle Size Range, mm.
Stations
Roanoke Arm
24
20
14
Sand
1-0.625
Percent, By Weight, Total Sample
17.8
21.7
0.0
0.0
0.0
Silt
0.0039-0.0625
31.3
26.9
8.3
24.0
11.8
Clay
0.0039
51.2
53.0
91.7
76.0
88.2
Butcher Creek
214
0.0
34.4
65.6
Eastland Creek
211
0.0
30.2
69.8
Nutbush Arm
119
118
118E
1308
1308E
116
114
114E
111
111W
108
103
103W
Flat Creek
219
219S
218
218 S
0.0
0.0
62.2
20.3
35.0
7.7
6.0
38.1
0.0
73.6
0.0
0.0
62.2
13.9
34.9
0
37.2
84.5
74.6
21.5
13.2
40.3
35.6
27.0
41.9
24.4
17.8
22.0
16.0
25.7
28.9
34.7
38.4
40.3
15.5
25.4
17.3
65.9
,6
.6
24.7
56.7
67.0
20.0
75,
8.
78.0
84.0
12.1
57.2
30.5
61.6
22.5
Letter designated stations are sub-littoral locations, others center channel
locations.
' 437
-------
Table 8
John H. Kerr Reservoir
Percent Carbon Content Bottom Sediments
Date Sampled Aug. 1973
Station
Roanoke Arm
24
20
14
Nov.
Feb. 1974
Average
Butcher Creek
214
Eastland Creek
211
Nutbush Arm
119
118
118E
1308
1308E
116
114
114E
111
111W
108
103
103W
Flat Creek
219
219S
218
218 S
2.03
1.71
1.57
0.51
2.31
0.60
2.10
1.66
1.63
2.13
2.48
2.03
1.78
2.22
2.23
2.23
1.89
4.03
3.33
0.94
2.46
-
-
2.30
0.79
-
0.48
-
-
0.52
3.97
3.38
1.04
2.35
1.15
2.67
2.31
0.60
2.27
0.20
-
-
0.30
3.83
3.38
0.71
2.23
1.14
2.90
2.56
0.71
2.27
0.65
2.30
2.20
0.67
1,20
0.46
1.97
0.59
1.75
1.88
2.17
2.32
2.13
2.13
2.00
1.90
0.73
2.40
0.65
2.12
1.94
1.98
2.27
2.10
2.12
1.82
3.95
3.35
0.33
1.90
0.95
3.00
2.60
0.70
2.30
0.90
2.50
2.51
0.53
3.95
3.36
0.76
2.24
1.08
2.85
2.36
0.70
2.28
0.56
2.40
2.36
0.51
1.58
0.57
2.20
0.61
Percentages carbon determined by dichromate oxidation.
For conversion to "organic matter" multiply by a factor of 1.33.
Letter designated stations are sub-littoral locations, others center channel
locations. ,00
4 JO
-------
precipitation record for Henderson, N. C., at the head of the Nutbush Arm of
John H. Kerr Reservoir, is presented in Table 9.
Water Renewal Time
The water renewal or retention time of an impoundment operated both for
hydropower and flood control needs to be considered over a range of discharges.
For both arms of John H. Kerr Reservoir water retention has been calculated
over a range of discharges based on annual averages, Table 10. The difference
in retention time of the two arms is generally by a factor of 30.
LIMNOLOGICAL CHARACTERISTICS
Physical and Chemical
Year round collection of limnological data from John H. Kerr Reservoir
early established a lengthy stratification period, April-November inclusive,
and a limited period in which the body of water was in a mixed condition,
December-March inclusive. Water temperatures in the reservoir during the
current period of observation never fell to 4°C and thus stratification in the
spring generally proceeded rapidly. In the following data tables, the
presentations when feasible are organized into the two yearly periods of April-
November and December-March. Samples collected after November 25, in some
instances, were considered as part of the winter period. Data from vertical
profiles are averaged as epilimnetic or hypolimnetic with the transition depth
indicated for each station. Physical characteristics are presented in Tables
11 and 12 and chemical characteristics in Tables 13, 14 and 15.
Biological-Phytoplankton
As with the physical and chemical parameters the phytoplankton have been grouped
into April-November and December-March data sets. For this report the quanti-
tative phytoplankton presentation is limited to cell no. per milliliter.
439
-------
Table 9
John H. Kerr Reservoir
Seasonal Variation of Monthly Precipitation*
Total Annual Rainfall - Inches
1972
49.07
51.53
52.25
50.30
Monthly
Precip. - inches
6.37
4.38
3.70
4.03
1.34
5.89
3.37
.99
10.03
7.76
1.26
1.19
4.02
6.22
2.97
1973 1974
38.30 49.24
45.41 43.62
45.61 43.43
49.91 47.96
Departure
From Average
3.22
1.11
.34
.31
-1.75
2.27
-.79
-4.57
5.37
4.16
-1.36
-1.94
.77
2.95
-.39
Long Term
Average
41.83
41.91
-
40.04
Virginia Stations
Halifax
Clarksville
John H., Kerr Dam
North Carolina Station
Henderson
Henderson
December 1973
January 1974
February
March
April
May
June
July
August
September
October
November
December
January 1975
February
*Data from National Climate Center, Asheville, N. C.
440
-------
Table 10
John H. Kerr Reservoir
Water Renewal Time (Retention Time)-Days
Regulated Discharge - Hydropower and Flood Control
Average Roanoke Arm
Flow Rates - c.f.s. 1.054,719 Acre-Ft. (elev. 300)
7,500 71
8,000 67
8,500 63
9,000 59
9,500 56
10,000 53
Nutbush Arm
363,400 Acre-Ft. (elev. 300)
90 2,036
95 1,929
100 1,832
105 1,745
110 1,666
115 1,593
120 1,527
441
-------
!
^"j
rH
01
rH
re
H
CO
rJ
3
O
35
4J
JT
00
•H
rJ
r>.
re
ca
c
o
•H
4J
re
•H
•d
re
OS
ij
re
H
o
w
VJ
0
o
o
fv
X
4J
CO -H
rl O T3
o u ,n
> CO rl
rl -H 3
CU rl EH
CO CU
CD 4-1 "
Bl O -C
re u
rl rl CX
ri re o>
<1) J3 D
tai CJ
•rl
• rH -C
33 re a
CJ CJ
C -H 0)
rC CO Cn
o >,
CL^ C
o
•H
re
ri
4-i
CU
c
CU
pj
4-)
oo
rJ
r.
^
t_t
•H
4J
O
3
-d
C
0
CJ
01
3
i-H
CJ
M
rl
CU
e
cu
J>
o
1
rH
•H
M
a
I4H
0
4-1
a)
e
ob
0)
CO
rl
cc
1
4J
f
M
•H
>>
re
o
rl
O
rH
O
CJ
D
1
>.
•H
T)
,£)
3
EH
x" in
CCS •
S ~*J~
rH
• O
C
£ S
0)
CJ
re
14-4 CO CN 'O CO CM O
rl rH rH rH rH rH rH
3
C/3
•1
O O CN r^ r^ m
H rH OO 1 OO CTN rH
33] CM rH rH rH rH
• j in r~- oo co ^o co
'pj co o ~* ON r-I r-I
Wl rH rH rH
•H I
•C J3
CJ 4-1
O ex
cu cu
en Q
¥
4J -C
^ r; 4J
oo a
•H CU
r4 O
o
(X
il
w|
o
CX
p.
w
¥
0) •
00 •
re -H
rl CO
01 C .
> re o)
< rl Q
H
CM OO O CO rH CN CM \O in
CN in
o o
>,
rH
j:
4J
c
o
B
I
,c
XI
CJ
o
en
B
o
cn
QJ
i-H
a-
m
w
o
ex
CO
0)
rH
o.
re
CO
o
•H
4-1
0)
c
01
AS
S
re
o
at
O rH
-------
CN
rH
OJ
rH
o
cd
H
rl
•H
O
rl
0)
od
SH
01
t^
•
33
,C
O
r-j
0]
O
•H
4-t
01
•H
!H
Cli
4J
O
CO
cd
_C3
CJ
, — J
CO
o
01
^
tf;
Dj
^-^
01
3
O
33
4J
j:
00
•H
rJ
^
CO
O
s —
c
o
•H
4J
cd
•H
•o
CO
cd
rH
O
CO
IH
O
i-H
O
u
^
X
4J
•H
•a
•H
rl
3
fH
r.
,C
4_)
CX,
CD
O
•H
j:
CJ
01
CO
*
C3
o
•H
4H
CO
4J
01
C3
01
CM
4J
^ f?
00
•H
1
r.
X
a)
>
•rl
»
— j
rH
CJ
r*
O
CO
g
1
^_!
0)
g
01
o
0)
n
a)
rH
•H
O
j_i
PU
CO
O
•H
^
CD
MM
O
4J
01
e
a)
CO
•a
01
cd
00
•H
01
a)
n
e
o
PT|
0)
rH
a
e
CO
CO
rH
fj*
14-1
O
OJ
a)
3
cd
01
00
cd
w
^i
W
t
4J
W
*(-<
i-J
1^1
CO
a
j_j
o
iH
O
u
£3
h~ j
1
•H
T3
•H
43
^
H
•H
43
O
CJ
CO
4-)
,c
00
|_5
o
6
•0
C
0
o
.
r"l
CO
^
C
•H
S
0)
CJ
CO
rl
3
CO
.
O
CX,
F-^l
fC
•
*Q
w
a
i
4J
01
Q
a
i
_rj
4J
CX
O
gs°
rH
O
P-
P^
•
-H
CX
W
m
*
CM
i— 1
CO
CT\
in r-H CN CO O CT^
CO CM CN CN CO r-H
CO CTv h- 00
co co i i m r-
• CO CO CO
- c^ co co o> o
r^- r~~ ""rt r~-- co
LO >n n) ^ co
• •*><••
^ oo
COO^CNCOOl^CMCNrH
ooc^r-cor^cooo^o
rrt r^j r--J .-pj y^ T~J O I***. CO
-------
CO
rH
CU
n)
H
O
Reseri
\j
QJ
c
O
tions
a
^
ft,
CM
H
0
Q
1
CO
0
•H
cterist
i-t
n3
fi
U
luslve
c
tH
}-(
0)
-D
b
>
S
4_)
rH
•H
J-j
CX
ofile
p-l
^
u
VJ
J-l
>
<4-t
4J
C
Q)
'TJ
CU
JJ
M
•H
10
0)
O
6
o
^1
-
bO w I
ctf -H JS
J-i (0 -U
in i—i rH CO 00 CO
rH rH iH O
rH rH CN CO
iH
1
•a
n)
o
Q
444
-------
C/J
C
0
•H
0
CO
14
fe
A<
H
CO
M
•H 2
O
VJ O
a) Q
CO
CD .
Cd 33
O.
U 1
01
^ CO
o
• -H
CO
C -H
J= tJ
O 0)
CO
VJ
52
o
rH
cd
CJ
•rH
J=
>
•H
cn
H
M
|
£
0
0)
-Q
E
a)
u
a
CJJ
iH
M-(
O
X
.H
cc
u
Verti
o
u
c
CU
a
QJ
4-J
C
M
•H
W
CD
O
S
o
QJ
i-l
a
E
ra
rH
Oi CT\
O CT\ CO CO f")
Sf 1 CN CN CO
CN] CN CN CN
•
t-HC7viHCJ\C^Ji— ICNCNi— t
o
cm u
CO -H
h »
01 C
j> C8
T
r!
O.
0)
S
i-j
Q)
O
C
CO
o
P~- ' — T3I — -ft "UTD'^J'TJ^l'^JOr^
u~i L/~I cu^cm CDCUCUIUOQ), (i^
'
*H
-------
rH O CN O rH O
CM r-- I r- m co
CM in co co *
i o en rH co o CD -a-
• -
I 00 CO ^O 00
^OrorHr-coOOfooo
CO ON CO OO r~- F-- ^T> vO v£)
CO O CO CO I
bD
o o ^
> 5/3 cj
EC •
CO ,
C CJ
m ^j co CM o
. . I ...
CM CN CN CM CN
- cij 0)
< H Q
H
6
)-i
<
-------
Associated parameters, productivity, both Ps and Pmax, chlorophyll ji and Secchi
depth, (Phytoplankton sample depth) are presented in Table 16. Characterization
of the total phytoplankton community by class and percent of each class of the
total is presented in Table 17.
Algal Assay
Algal assays for limiting nutrients in each of the two arms of John H. Kerr
Reservoir over the total period of observation from March 1972 through May 1974
show a characteristic "downstream" decrease in growth potential as indicated by
the quantity of biomass grown in the reseeded control. This was evident in both
filtered and autoclaved samples. Of particular interest is the clearly
indicated shift from a higher frequency of nitrogen limited assays, at the
head of each arm of the reservoir, changing to more frequent phosphorus-limited
assays at the downstream end, Table 18. This would be related to the observed
decrease in concentration of PO^-P and Total-P at these same stations.
Biological-Zooplankton
The total zooplankton populations of the sampling points along both arms
have been defined by vertical net tows in the euphotic zone. Monthly totals
and the April-November averages are presented in Table 19. A genera list is
presented in Table 20.
Bottom Fauna
Dredge samples from the stations along the two major arms of the reservoir
as well as several side embayments were collected in four seasonal periods to
define the bottom fauna. The density of five major groups as found in the four
collections is presented in Table 21.
447
-------
X PH
o
'-i -a
OJ
Q
O O O O O O
OOOOOOiH-H-H
i-HOOlcScncOO-i-^-^O
^LnocNoa^r^^c^-
r^. r-> "^o LO o o
co CD <>J o r-- CN
00
6
td
CO O r" en en i
cc
a)
oc c
X
O
448
-------
c ,c
;=> cj
ON o
ON CN
rn
r-
ft
Q)
C/3
CO CN
rH •
O
I— ro
O
oo -3-
-j-
o
0
cfl
3 i-i CX
a 6
< a
rg O
O O
CO O
O O
4-J
ft
CU
IB
H
EC 0) O O
O V^
C i a)
£ ,-H PJ
O CO rH
>-I Ml S ^
iH —
< 0 '-'
o
o
rH OS
^D •
oo en
Ol r-i C^ rvJ r-I rHO MD r~( T-H^n
-j- • I-H LO * * * rH ' sr- CN-
CNO OJO COrO roO r-fO
ON
a
O
I
CO
0)
e
d) «»\
4-1 n
to i--
•H CTs
r> -H
0
c
•<-!
^
iro mm v£)c-j tno i—) r-i i-n-j-
-j- CN • • • m - vo •
1 O O O O O t-l CN
f P-
CO (!)
o
4-1
a
x
iA ^O ^t O I oo 00
• CNI r-i •
O O O
oo LD o r^.
tN O O
i O m CN O !
o
-------
B
O rH O O
O r-H O O O O
X O
U
O
•g
B -H
SJ
3
g:
cu o oo
rt co
e tu
3 oJ
0)
.0
B
e -H
3 r-l
0) -H
'E -H
•H C
EQ 0
O O -d- O
O O fi O
• O r>j ro rH CN
O CN rH ^H O O
m rH ^ Q O T-M
O o o rH m
O O ip t— nn Q
CT\ rH O O O CN
1
0)
X!
a
g .
B
±4
<
450
-------
0) 0)
oc o
I I I I I
I I I + + + I I I
• CT\ CO CN CO i-H
i r-. n o CN o i
O ^C O> ^C iH r^i TH
CN r-i c^
-------
Table 20
John H. Kerr Reservoir
Genera of Zooplankton
Net Tows rv 1973-1974
COPEPODS
Argulus sp.
Diaptomus spp.
Misc. Calanoid Adults + copepodids
Cyclopoid Adults + copepodids
Harpacticoid Adults
Nauplii
CLADOCERA
Alona sp.
Bosmina longirostris
Ceriodaphnia sp.
Daphnia sp.
Diaphanosoma sp.
Leptodora kindtii
Pleuroxus sp.
Unknown Cladocera, adults and immatures
ROTIFERA
PROTOZOA
Ascomorpha sp.
Asplanchna sp.
Brachionus sp.
Collotheca sp.
Conochiloides sp.
Conochilus sp.
Epiphanes sp. (?)
Filinia sp.
Gastropus sp.
Hexarthra sp.
Kellicottia bostoniensis
Keratella sp.
Lecane sp.
Monostyla sp.
Ploesoma sp.
Polyarthra sp
Proales sp.
Rotaria sp.
Synchaeta sp.
Testudinella sp. (?)
Trichocerca sp.
Unknown Flosculariidae
Unknown Rotifera
Actinosphaerium sp.
Arcella sp.
Difflugia sp.
Epistylis sp.
Paramecium sp.
Stentor sp.
Vorticella sp.
OTHERS
Chironomidae
452
-------
CM
6
~~"^
0
1
4-1
•H
co
cu
o
CO
e
en
•H
G
00
O
tj
•H
4J
C
cu
«
o
CO
cx
3
O
O
1~>
s
f
rH
CM
cu
rH
,0
H
CO
r-N.
ON
H
CO
CM
H
CM
j_i
cu
ja
cu
o
.
cu
J3
cx
w
o
cx
rH
(2
O O 0 O
O 0 O O
O
rC
r}
CO CM ^* ""^
*^" in o ^f
0 0 !--
CO vO CM
i-4
'
^
!c
CJ
vo -* co ^f
^o r^ co i— i
rH
M
•H
H
O
in oo CM o
rH rH
CO
ON
H
o"
CO
I
CN
to
3
01
3
•I O 0 0 O
J^l
p j
wT
o
|*t
v^
rH
nj
0 O 0 0
o
•fl
CO ON in O
rH O rH
o m oo oo rH
CM H CN
in ON CM in *•£>
O CM in r^ ^d*
CM m -* oo
rH CM O
rH
vO CM OO OO ON
00 CO O rH ^O
oo
O 0 O 0 O
co O co O O
ON o in r~ o
ON rH O t-~ ON
CO rH CO CO
in ^0 ^o o rH
vo oo **o ^r
CO *3"
in in in o ^~
**O ifl p^ ^rf
0
CM
rirf CU
cu cu
CU M S
(-1 O !-(
t-lrH KrH rCrHrHrH
CUCN tTJCM COrHrHrH
J3 rH 3
CJ 4J ^2
4-1 CO 4J
3 crj 3
pr| fjq ^
0 O
m co
O CO 00
rH rH
CM rH rH
CO VD
-------
a)
a
w
CM O O
CO
CM
CM
m
o o o o
cMOOOo
CM
mrHOm
o o o o
o
ft
o o o o o
TJ
(1)
c
o
o
CM
0)
rH
H
va-
i-v.
co
CM
•H
rl
ft
•rl
x:
u
60
•H
rH
O
ft
w
o
ft
r-
ON
in
CM
m
cd
C_>
M
•H
u
bC
•H
T)
CU
H
ft
S
cd
c/i
cd
Q
fi
O
•rl
4-1
Cfl
OO ON in O CO
m
4-1 CO
3 Cfl
PQ w
O 0
r-v vo
CO rH
CM m
CM co
CM va-
in ON
r-- CM
rH
0 0
CM O
CM
o in
co wo
cu cd
rfi O
ft 0
W rH
1
a) to
*£^ Vi
ft O
w ^
4J
•- -H
cd iH
"ri t(*i
>-. 3
B cn
o
ft CU
rH t-l
CO cfl
p-l
1 CO
0 VI
ft 0
rH
TO **
p-l &
• * w
co
3 U
i-l CU
O 4->
tQ cd
o ci
cd bO
U CO
1 CU
o
cfl CO
X rt
U O
•H
. r, 4J
cu cd
Cd 4-1
T3 CO
'e •-
O rH
c cu
o a
Vi &
•rl Id
CJ CJ
1
• n
t-t CU
•H -P
•£ C
O CU
0
cd" C
4-1 -H
cu
cd >•
O -H
0 C
60 -r)
•H rH
i-H cfl
O CO
1
bO 00
•H •rl
rH PC
0 *
454
-------
Fish
Although the John H. Kerr Reservoir is one of the more popular fishing
locations in the Virginia-North Carolina region, quantitative data on the
productivity of the fishery is somewhat limited or unavailable at this time.
The data of two limited creel censuses from North Carolina waters, primarily
Nutbush Arm are as follows:
1964-1965 Census; 385 contacts yielded a gross catch rate of 0.86 fish/hr. —
which 54% were "sunfishes" (other than crappy, bluegill and redbreast sunfish),
30% catfish, 10% crappy, 3% carp, 2% large mouth bass, 1% pickerel and 1% other
species.
1970-1971 Census; 413 contacts yielded a gross catch rate of 1.79 fish/hr. —
of which 68.6% were crappy, 15.4% bluegill, 11.3% catfish, 1.5% large mouth
bass, 1.3% "sunfishes," 0.6% pickerel, 0.5% carp, 0.4% rough fishes, 0.4%
striped bass.*
NUTRIENT BUDGETS
Nitrogen and Phosphorus
The nutrient budget presented in Table 22 is described for the period
April 1974-March 1975. Only data collected within this period has been used in
this budget. Values estimated include land runoff, non-gaged sources, and
the relatively weak concentrations for N and P in rainfall. The Kerr Dam
discharge used in this budget, 8859 c.f.s. is based on 365 daily samples
whereas the average of the 12 samples taken monthly is 9219 c.f.s. The
concentrations of N and P in these 12 samples were used to calculate the
discharge (kgs/yr.) using the flow of 8859 c.f.s. The validity of this
computation appears to be justified by the budgets computed for Cl~ and SO^ .
*Creel census data provided by the N. C. Wildlife Resources Commission.
455
-------
Table 22
John H. Kerr Reservoir
Nutrient Budget - Nitrogen and Phosphorus
April 1974 - March 1975
Average kgs/yr
Source of Flow Discharge c.f.s. Total-H Total-P
ROANOKE ARM
Principal Rivers
Roanoke 2,725
Banister 615
Dan 2,803 6,143 3,612,770 590,205
Three Streams - North Drainage 91 35,040 5,402
Five Streams - South Drainage 475 227,030 23,068
Point Sources Discharges, 7 Municipal
and Industrial to Kerr Reservoir or
to Flows Downstream of Sampling Points 2.7 85,733 23,411
Total 6,712
Discharge J. H. Kerr Dam 8,859
Average Discharge Nutbush Arm All Sources 115
Net Flow Roanoke Arm (8859-115) 8,744
Net Flow Non-Gaged Streams and
Other Flow - Roanoke Arm (8744-6712) 2,032 686,565 58,035
(T-N..378 mg/1, T-P - .032 mg/1,
averages of five non-polluted streams)
Rainfall, 43"/yr/30,866 acres 153
Evaporation^ -153
N and P Contribution by rain2'3'1*
N03; .62 mg/1; Total-P, 0.1 mg/1
43"/yr/30,866 acres 18,556 13,644
Total Roanoke Arm 4,665,694 713,765
NUTBUSH ARM
Flat Creek 14 5,110 474
Nutbush Creek 6.4 54,750 22,265
Flow Non-Gaged Sources 94.6 31,967 2,697
(115-20.4)
Rainfall 43"/yr/12,452 acres) 7,488 5,506
Total Nutbush Arm 99,315 30,942
Total J. H. Kerr Reservoir 4,765,009 744,707
Kerr Dam Discharge 4,026,680 377,045
% Retained 16 50
'Yonts and Giese, 1974
2Gambell and Fisher, 1966
3T-P determined on rainfall samples collected at Chapel Hill, N.C. 13 and 25
April 1972.
"*Uttormark and Chapln, 1974.
456
-------
Fe, Cl and S04~
Utilizing the same flow data used to compute the budget for nitrogen and
phosphorus, the pass through for Fe, total, dissolved and particulate and Cl
and S0^~ was'also calculated, Table 23. The expected large reduction of total
and particulate Fe was confirmed and to a somewhat lesser degree the dissolved
Fe. The close agreement of both Cl and S0^~ for net pass through endorses the
validity of the flow values used.
DISCUSSION
The limnological characteristics of a reservoir are basically defined by
the velocity change as the inflowing rivers and streams encounter the standing
water of the impoundment. In turn downstream flow through the impoundment and
average retention time becomes a function of the relative inflow volume and
rate of discharge. This down reservoir movement is also generally over an
increasing mean depth since the deepest point and in many instances the
maximum surface area of an impoundment is at or adjacent to the dam. The
dimensional parameters of mean depth (z), residence time (TW), flushing rate
(1/Tw), retention coefficient (R) and areal loading (qs) for each of the
segments of each arm of John H. Kerr Reservoir have been calculated and
arranged in Table 24. With these dimensions the associated phosphorus
fraction concentrations and loading (Lp, g/m /yr) are also presented. The
changing magnitude of all dimensions in downstream movement and the
considerable difference in flushing rate and loading between the two arms of
this reservoir provides an opportunity to test the validity of the Vollenweider
numbers against the observed trophic state of each compartment (Vollenweider
and Dillon, 1974). The relationships of areal loading (qs) versus phosphorus
loading is shown in Figure 1 and phosphorus loading and productivity as
determined by chlorophyll a^ production is examined in Figure 2. The differences
in behavior of the two arms of John H. Kerr Reservoir is clearly seen with the
457
-------
o
§
o ^o o
CT\ CN r-H
co O co -vt •
-H
•H
4J ^
CO cJ
> H
h cO
0)
C 1
o
CJ st
1 —
.U
CU rH
60 -H
•a u
3 CX
cr)
0
CU
Pw
01
ffl
rH
3
CJ
•H
4-1
CO
PH
j^l c^ fn o
>J in m oJ
-^
O
01
0)
•H
O
J_4
M ^ m r^J 1
^ ro CN ^D
^1
•^.1 ro ro LA co
td rH en r-
4)
tn
rH
4J
O
EH
i-i r— ^D -, r- co cN i
OC o
"^ J 2 ^
-5 o
i CO CN vO CO
-xl" 00 CO CM
•H
tt!
CU
1
CTJ
O
Pd
OJ
•H
OS
CD
+J
CO
•H
C
f3
M
ver
n 58-15 Roanoke Arm
•H O
03 -H
•U
C nj
rrj 4-1
Q Ul
Drainage
estone Creek*
a
& iH
0
tie Bluestone Creek
cher Creek*
•H 3
i-4 W
Drainage
o River
CJ
w re
a
o
in
ons Creek*
ssy Creek*
and Creek*
tie Island Creek
^ trj rH 4J
Cd M CO 'H
CN
LA
CN
rH
JH
rH
rH
cd
•H
rd
r\l
Runoff to Reservoir
-gaged sources
Total
am Discharge
d
}-> O
OJ Z
4-1
O
Q
l-i
L4
(D
W
cu
00
c
CO
jH
U
B^?
CO
0)
U
M
O
03
T3
0)
M)
td
60
C
O
C
QJ
3
a
rH
n)
o
o
4-1
•X3
OJ
en
3
a)
H
j->
CO vD
VO
•a CT\
0) rH
4->
CTJ *>
O )H
•H 0)
•O J3
f3 CO
•H -H
Pn
•H TJ
PI cd
O
•rl rH
4J rH
crj CU
r-J -g
£ §
(U O
OCM
pi
o
CJ
• CO
a) o
> rH
-5 X!
* rH
458
-------
0) 03 C
CO B-i <
-
O N
»H>|
O
O
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
£*
a
s
iH
[K
1-1
0)
£
JJ
O
CO
J2 C
« o
3 -H
.O 4J
u ni
3 4-1
V4D
- m m
0 O 0
»
O
3
CO
1
§
-i Vj
m
0 O
o o
rH 00
rH O
i— ( i— (
CO ^D
VJD r-
(^
o
r-H CO
co r^
0 0
CN CO
CN CN
rH H
c-o r-
00 CJ\
CNJ m
CO CN
co in
CN CN
>-> rH
X W
1 1
(J 33
^ X
O 0
\o
o
rH
1-1
OJ
4J
c
w
o
CN
0
^0
O
0
CO
0
rH
m
CO
1
rH
CO
o
rO
CN
rH
m
0
r— 1
i£>
cn
0
CN
i-H
<
1
w
t^
o
\O
rH
0)
>
rfl
CU
vJ
(3
0
•r(
cfl
4-1
cn
j2
u
CtJ
CU
4_)
CO
en
01
i— t
CU
6
rt
«i
0)
rH
•H
u-r
O
V4
a
rH
CO
U
•H
4-1
rl
CU
>
rH
ni
<4-(
O
01
0)
3
efl
>
0)
M
n)
M
CU
>-
cd
at
u
CU
CO
q
o
•H
4-1
O
cd
U
<4H
tn
3
M
O
J3
a
4-J
P
CU
6
M
OJ
tfl
£
O
CO
OJ
M--1
o
03
Oi
i->
n:
OJ
DC
rd
c
CO
LJ
'V
M-t
O
c
O
is.
zs
*£
§£
S M
L, Oi
a »
73 °
C «
"•a
§2
•3 03
rt u
0°
> ^
AJ ^
8 e
i. l-i
a n)
w ^
™ 0
Jg c
"I
m
c
Tt ^
c c
t« •"
» a"
S "-
s ^
J^,
U,H
* CN
f^CN
rH
§ 3
O
rH l~t
H «H
C
C ^
S ""
£ on
° a
459
-------
10
I
D_
ID
O
•z.
Q
O
O
I
Q.
)
O
Q_
1.0
24-20
O
20-14
O
Above
1308
8-4 O
O 14-8
O 4-2
Vollenweider(l975)
• 1308-L
/
/
/
U-H
• E-A
•
H-E
O.I
O ROANOKE ARM
• NUTBUSH ARM
John H.Kerr Reservoir
10
qs ( z/Twl
100
Figure 1. Areal Loading and annual phosphorus load. Dashed line, Vollenweider's
boundary condition, acceptable below, unacceptable above.
460
-------
o
in
o
o
CM
E
o.
ii 6uu D
461
o
u
o
1
td
o
t-i
O
J2
Pu
CO
O
CM
0)
M
00
-------
flushing rate as a major controlling variable in establishing both the net
available phosphorus as well as its rate of utilization. In a final analysis
the several independent variables that describe the conditions for algal growth
are compared to growth as determined by chlorophyll a. and productivity (Ps),
Table 25. Again the consistent high correlations of the Nutbush Arm as
compared to the low or non-correlations of the Roanoke Arm indicate a major
dependency of the system on flushing rate to establish growth limiting conditions.
A preliminary analysis of productivity at secondary levels, total
zooplankton numbers and associated algal cell density shows that in the
Roanoke Arm the correlation has a r value of -.340 whereas in the Nutbush the
r value is .871.
SUMMARY
The John H. Kerr Reservoir, a hydro-power flood control impoundment of
48,900 acres, receives a substantial nutrient load of nitrogen and phosphorus
from upstream municipal and industrial waste water discharges. Because of
the relative flow into the two major arms of the reservoir, that of the Roanoke
being about 80-90 times greater than the Nutbush the residence time of the two
arms varies by a factor of 30, 60 days versus 1,800 days. Nutrient budgets
for nitrogen and phosphorus indicate for the period April 1974 to March 1975
about 16% of the nitrogen was retained in the impoundment and 50% of the
phosphorus. Budgeting for Cl and S0^~, utilizing the same flow values,
accounted for essentially the entire load, -4% for Cl and +5% for S0^~.
Examination of P budget parameters and the response of the system of each
arm subdivided into five segments verifies with high correlations the validity
of areal loading and Total-P as predictive dimensions when retention time is
•high. At high flushing rates the correlation values are lower. Impoundments
with high phosphorus retention coefficients exhibit considerable capacity to
462
-------
Table 25
John H. Kerr Reservoir
Correlation Coefficients - Growth Controlling Variables
April-November Data
Dependent Variables
Chloropl
Independent
Variables
Loading Pg/m2/yr.
Total P - Total Profile
Total P - Epilitnnion
Total Soluble P - Epilimnion
Areal Loading
Flushing Rate
Secchi Depth
R - Roanoke Arm stations
N - Nutbush Arm stations
Chlorophyll
mg/m3
R
.836
.923
.608
.561
.817
.871
-.805
a
N
986
985
975
953
993
995
830
Primary Production
gC/m2/d
R
.757
.755
.419
-.060
.743
.602
-.077
N
.989
.991
.965
.951
.999
.995
.745
463
-------
remove phosphorus from downstream systems. Even with comparatively short
residence time, such as the Roanoke Arm, phosphorus removal by adsorption on
iron rich sediments may be of considerable magnitude.
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
The collection of data for this report involved both staff and graduate
students of the Department of Environmental Sciences and Engineering. The
following should be acknowledged for their specific contributions which in
several instances will be discussed in greater detail in the final report on
John H. Kerr Reservoir, currently in preparation:
Field Collections: Mark A. Mason, Tom M. Ronman, Robert P. Sniffen
Benthos: David Y. Conlin
Phytoplankton: Sheila L. Pfaender, Ronald T. Kneid
The cooperation of the Corps of Engineers, Wilmington District, throughout
this study and in providing the basic morphometric information on John H. Kerr
Reservoir is gratefully acknowledged.
A detailed critique of the hydraulic estimates by Dr. William J. Snodgrass,
McMaster University, Hamilton, Ontario, has provided an opportunity to further
refine the loading calculations, between the several drafts of this report.
REFERENCES
Gambell, A. W. and D. W. Fisher. Chemical Composition of Rainfall Eastern
North Carolina and Southeastern Virginia. Geological Survey Water-
Supply Paper 1535. 1966.
Uttormark,P. D. and J. D. Chapin. Estimating Nutrient Loadings of Lakes from
Non-Point Sources. Water Resources Center, University of Wisconsin,
Madison. Ecological Research Series, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency.
EPA-660/3-74-020. August 1974.
Vollenweider, R. A. and P. J. Dillon. The Application of the Phosphorus
Loading Concept to Eutrophication Research. National Research Council
Canada. Associate Committee on Scientific Criteria for Environmental
Quality. NRCC No. 13690. June 1974.
Yonts, W. L. and G. L. Giese. The Effect of Heated Water on the Temperature
and Evaporation of Hyco Lake, North Carolina, 1966-72. U.S. Geological
Survey, Water Resources Investigations 11-74. May 1974.
Vollenweider, R. A. EPA-OECD Spring Workshop, North American Project.
University of Minnesota, May 14-15, 1975.
464
-------
TROPHIC STATUS AND NUTRIENT LOADING FOR LAKE TAHOE
CALIFORNIA-NEVADA
Charles R. Goldman
Division of Environmental Studies
University of California
Davis, California
I. INTRODUCTION
Lake Tahoe, located in the Sierra Nevada on the California-Nevada border,
is a large, deep, ultra-oligotrophic lake which is usually monomictic. The
lake, formed in a graben fault, has steep sides, a flat bottom and very little
shallow water for its size (Fig. 1). Over 60 tributaries flow into the lake
which is drained by one major outflow.
Lake Tahoe is particularly renowned for the great transparency of its
water and the beauty of its deep blue color. It is surrounded by high mountains
that are covered with snow during several months of the year. These character-
istics make the lake basin an ideal place for year-round recreational activities
which attract thousands each year. During the last few decades, there has been
a dramatic increase in both the resident and tourist population at Tahoe re-
sulting in serious environmental disturbance. By 1962 sewage discharge, even
after treatment, was shown to greatly stimulate phytoplankton primary produc-
tivity in the nutrient poor Lake Tahoe water. The export of treated effluent
from the basin was started shortly thereafter, with completion of most of the
sewage diversion process by 1970.
As the population continues to increase in the Tahoe basin with a concom-
itant rise in construction activities (road building, housing developments),
serious damage to the watershed of the lake continues. The exposure of mineral
soil to erosion and the resultant leaching of nutrients is a factor in the
cultural eutrophication of the lake. Large plumes of sediments extending from
tributary streams into the lake and the appearance of luxuriant growths of
attached algae around the lake margin in the last ten years were the first
clearly visible signs of change in the lake (Goldman 1974).
During the last 16 years Lake Tahoe has been the subject of intensive lim-
nological research with emphasis on the lake's primary productivity, nutrient
limiting factors and the process of eutrophication. Since 1972 the research
program has expanded into a multidisciplinary research project (supported by
NSF-RANN Grant GI-22) with the principal objective being the identification
and measurement of the impacts (physical, chemical, biological, and social) of
commercial and recreational development of the Lake Tahoe basin. The Ward
Creek watershed has been chosen for intensive studies of nutrient flux and
sediment transport through the watershed and their impacts of lake water quality.
465
-------
Primary productivity has proven to be one of the most sensitive indicators
of eutrophication in Lake Tahoe (Goldman 1974, Goldman and Amezaga in press).
Its level has increased alarmingly over the last 15 years of research.
LAKE TAHOE
INCLINE CREEK
SAND POINT
TRUCKEE RIVER
SKUNK HARBOR
UPPER TRUCKEE RIVER
Figure 1. Bathymetric map of Lake Tahoe indicating the index station and
other locations. The contour interval is 50 m. The shaded area
indicates the littoral zone which extends to 100 m depth. A few
tributaries only are shown. (After Goldman 1974)
466
-------
II. GEOGRAPHIC DESCRIPTION OF WATER BODY
A. LATITUDE AND LONGITUDE
Lake Tahoe is situated in the Sierra Nevada mountains at latitude 39°
06' and longitude 120° 02' (centroid of water area).
B. ALTITUDE OF THE LAKE ABOVE SEA LEVEL
The natural level of the outlet from the lake is 1897 meters and the
lake surface level is regulated for the purpose of water storage. A
low dam located at the Truckee River outlet serves this purpose and
maintains the level between 1897 meters and 1899 meters.
C. CATCHMENT AREA
The total catchment area, including the area of surface water, extends
over 1310 square kilometers.
D. GENERAL CLIMATIC DATA
Lake Tahoe never freezes; only some harbors and marinas have periodic
ice coverage in the winter. Its large volume of water stores enough
summer heat to prevent Lake Tahoe from freezing in the winter.
Average monthly air temperatures for two locations on the shore of the
lake are shown in Table 1.
Table K Average Air Temperature Data in °C (McGauhey et a!. 1963)
January
February
March
April
May
June
July
August
September
October
November
December
Annual
At Tahoe City for
22 year period 1931-52
-3.2
-2.1
0.2
3.8
7.8
11.7
16.1
15.8
12.4
7.2
1.7
-1.2
5.8
At Glenbrook for
17 year period 1945-61
-0.6
0.2
2.2
5.6
9.2
14.1
18.8
18.8
15.2
9.4
4.4
0.8
7.2
467
-------
The climate is influenced primarily by marine air masses moving inland
from the Pacific Ocean. Continental influence occurs occasionally.
Predominant winds are from the west, southwest or northwest. Within the
basin the lake forms an extensive plain which tempers the strong gusty
winds usually associated with montane areas.
Evaporation is estimated to average about 90 cm per year.
Evapotranspiration is about 60 cm per year.
E. GENERAL GEOLOGICAL CHARACTERISTICS
The Lake Tahoe basin is bordered on its west side by the main crest of
the Sierra Nevada and by the Carson Range on the east. The lake basin
is the southernmost of a series of tectonic depressions that form a NNW-
trending graben complex extending northward to the area of Mt. Lassen.
Granitic rocks of the Sierra batholith comprise the bedrock of the entire
southern half of the basin and along the eastern side as far north as
Incline Creek. Extensive flows of principally andesitic volcanic rocks
of the Cenozoic age occur at the north end. Little or no granitic rock
crops out in the basin west of Crystal Bay with the exception of State-
line Point. Volcanic rocks are predominant on the west side as far
south as Blackwood Creek.
Approximately 70% of the runoff in the basin comes from granitic terrain,
25% from volcanic rocks and about 5% from metamorphic rocks (Court,
Goldman and Hyne 1972). Sparse protective vegetation in many areas and
erodible soils result in appreciable erosion during heavy rain and spring
snowmelt. Large sediment plumes extend into the lake during heavy runoff.
F. VEGETATION
The lake shores are forested with coniferous trees. Some meadows exist
in the tributary stream valleys with abundant stands of nitorgen fixing
alders in many places. Rock exposures and steep slopes near the rim of
the basin may be almost devoid of vegetation. Most of the forest is
second growth having been extensively lumbered in the late 1800's for
mining activity in Nevada. Because of the dry summers and cold winters
revegetation is a slow process. Some ski slopes have remained barren
for over a decade.
G. POPULATION
The Lake Tahoe region is a recreational area. Precise population esti-
mates are difficult to acquire and soon become obsolete. Various com-
ponents of total population are present (listed below). In view of the
dynamic nature of population in the Tahoe region, a peak seasonal popu-
lation number is commonly used as the population indicator.
The Tahoe Regional Planning Agency (TRPA) has derived a population es-
timate from census data and economic activity analysis. The total
estimate is 129,700 broken down into the following categories:
468
-------
Permanent residents
Seasonal residents
Second-home residents
Motel/hotel visitors
Camper visitors
26,100
10,000
32,000
32,400
6,700
Estimate day use visitors
Total
107,200
22.500
129,700
The total value of 129,700 represents the existing peak seasonal popu-
lation. (After preliminary draft of Lake Tahoe Study Section 114, PL
92i500, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, October 1973).
H. LAND USAGE
The Tahoe basin is used extensively for recreation (skiing, gaming,
tourism, watersports). Land ownership is:
1. 62% public land* (57% National Forest and 5% State Parks)
2. 38% private land (67% of lake shoreline)
The majority of the developments are second-home subdivisions. Legalized
gambling in Nevada has spawned several large casinos at the south and
north ends of the lake adjacent to the state line.
Considerable land is being acquired by governmental agencies.
I. USE OF WATER
Tahoe is operated as a fluctuating reservoir to provide water for down-
stream users. High water in spring causes shore line erosion and late
summer low water may leave some piers high and dry during unusually dry
years. There are 34,000 acre feet (42 x lO^m3) allocated for use in the
basin (also see B). Approximately 19,000 acre feet are actually being
used. Fishing, boating, and some skin diving are recreational uses of
the lake. With continued development a water shortage could develop.
J. SEWAGE AND EFFLUENT DISCHARGE
Sewage is collected by conventional sewage lines in most parts of the
basin and is given tertiary treatment at the south end of the lake (South
Tahoe Public Utility District plant) before being pumped out of the basin
for recreation and irrigation. Sewage at the north end of the lake has
been pumped into a cinder cone out of the Tahoe drainage after primary
treatment. This natural filter is now overloaded and the rate of in-
filtration into sewer lines may be great. A few septic tanks persist
but the majority of sewage effluent is exported. There is no significant
industrial effluent discharge, if any, in the basin.
III. MORPHOMETRIC AND HYDROLOGIC DESCRIPTION OF WATER BODY
A. SURFACE AREA OF WATER
o
Lake Tahoe surface area is 499 km. Its maximum length is 34.7 km, its
469
-------
maximum width is 19.2 km. It has an average length of 32.9 km and an
average width of 15.4 km. Lake Tahoe's shoreline measures about 113 km
(including bays and inlets).
B. VOLUME OF WATER
Lake Tahoe has a volume of 156 km3 of water. The top 1.86 meters of the
lake (elevation 1896.77 m to 1898.63 m), with a volume of about 0.9 km3
serves as a storage reservoir for the Truckee Carson Irrigation District
which operates it on behalf of the United States Government.
C. MAXIMUM AND AVERAGE DEPTH
Lake Tahoe has a maximum depth of 501 meters and an average depth of
313 meters.
D. EXCEPTIONAL DEPTHS AND SURFACE AREA RATIO OF DEEP TO SHALLOW WATERS
The lake basin has steep sides, a flat bottom and very little shallow
water for its size (Fig. 1). Several large mounds (about 50 meters
high) occur on the floor of Laka Tahoe.
The shallow littoral zone of Lake Tahoe extends to about 100 meters
(Goldman and Amezaga 1974). The surface area ratio of deep to shallow
water is 4.35.
E. RATIO OF EPI- OVER HYPOLIMNION
The epilimnion of Lake Tahoe extends down to about 15 meters and its hypo-
limnion is located below 25 meters. This gives Lake Tahoe a ratio of
epi- over hypolimnion of about 0.05 (7 km3/143 km3).
F. DURATION OF STRATIFICATION
Stratification lasts from 6 to 7 months beginning about May and lasting
until November. Complete mixing occurs in late winter if sufficiently
high winds and low temperatures persist.
G. NATURE OF LAKE SEDIMENTS
The areal distribution of volcanic constituents of sand and gravel frac-
tions reflects volcanic sources in the north and northwest parts of the
basin. Volcanic areas contribute montmorillonite to clay fractions
whereas vermiculite and chlcritic intergrades are characteristic
weathering products of granitic sources.
Two distinct types of sediment are present. Pollen-rich diatomaceous
ooze (organic ooze) is characterized by the following: (a) abundant
diatoms and pollen; (b) chloritic intergrades in the clay fraction; (c)
all samples from flat-lying, well stratified beds. The other sediment
type (non-organic) is typified by: (a) diatoms and pollen rare or ab-
sent; (b) vermiculite/mica/montmorillonite clay fraction; (c) not
present in "flat-lying" beds; (d) texturally more varied than organic
ooze.
470
-------
Non-organic samples represent exposed depositional products of the Tioga
glaciation, reflecting relatively rapid erosion and slumping into deeper
parts of the basin. The principal source of non-organic material was
the west side where volcanic rocks constitute about half of the area.
In contrast, organic ooze samples result from relatively passive post-
glacial fluvial erosion. The relative abundance of biogenic components
in organic ooze reflects low depositional rates and the clay fraction,
rich in chloritic intergrades, points to the dominance of granitic source
rocks in the present basin-wide source (Court, Goldman and Hyne 1972).
H. SEASONAL VARIATION OF MONTHLY PRECIPITATION
Table 2. Precipitation data in cm (McGauhey et al. 1963)
January
February
March
April
May
June
July
August
September
October
November
December
Annual
Precipitation increases dramatically with altitude in the basin. For
example, 100 cm of precipitation fell during the 1973 water year and
187 cm during 1974 at 2195 m altitude in Ward Valley.
I. INFLOW AND OUTFLOW OF WATER
The total average inflow of water: The total average outflow of water
from the lake:
from runoff water is about 0.382 km3 from evaporation is about 0.410 km3
from precipitation on lake 0.259 km3 from discharge 0.217 km3
from diversion 0.006 km3
Total inflow 0.641 km3 Total outflow 0.633 km3
Ground water movements in the basin are for the most part unknown.
471
At Tahoe City for
43 year period 1910-52
15.39
13.82
9.91
5.28
2.82
1.52
0.66
0.38
1.17
4.24
8.41
13.54
77.14
At Glenbrook
17 year period
7.57
6.22
7.16
3.84
3.89
1.02
0.94
0.74
1.22
2.44
5.23
6.25
44.45
for
1945-61
-------
J. WATER CURRENTS
Surface and mid-depth currents have been observed to be generally southerly.
Bottom currents were found to be generally southeasterly (McGauhey et al.
1963).
Periods of the surface seiches in Lake Tahoe have been determined to be
about 19 min. (uninodal seiche) or less (binodal and transverse). Water
level records have indicated fluctuations with periods of about 12 and
24 hours and amplitudes of a few millimeters. These fluctuations are
possibly surface reflections of internal seiches (McGauhey et al. 1963).
K. WATER RENEWAL TIME
Retention time for Lake Tahoe has been estimated to be about 700 years.
IV. LIMNOLOGICAL CHARACTERIZATION SUMMARY
* Indicates that data on the parameter are (or have been) collected
regularly and that the representative values given here have been
selected from data covering a period of at least one year.
** Indicates that data on the parameter are (or have been) collected
occasionally. However, the values given here are known to be quite
representative.
All concentration values given below, for range limits, are actual point
measurements in the water column, unless otherwise indicated. They are
not mean concentrations for the whole water column. When mean concen-
trations over a period of time are given, values have been calculated
over both depth and time.
A. PHYSICAL
* 1. Temperature range 4.57 - 20.35 °C (reversing thermometer)
Representative profiles of temperature in the euphotic zone are
shown in Fig.2
** 2. Conductivity range 86.9 - 104.3 pmho/cm 25°C mean = 92 ymhos
* 3. Light penetrates to great depths in Lake Tahoe
Secchi depth range 15.5 - 43.0 m mean for 5 years = 28.3 m
Some representative profiles of light transmission in Lake Tahoe
are shown on Fig. 2
Depth of 1% light
transmission range 59 - 105 m
Extinction coefficient
range 0.044 - 0.078
** 4. Color measurements have been taken on Lake Tahoe waters by Smith,
Tyler and Goldman (1973), by using a spectroradiometer to measure
absolute values of spectral irradiance and a transmissometer to
472
-------
«• S-
-p <1)
-C +->
CT><4-
ro
I
_£
>-
o
o
cc.
Q-
cc
(O i—
s-
OJ C
O.T-
E
a; ai
-»-> o
-P
•r- OJ
> -^
•i- to
-p _1
o
3 M-
-a o
o
s_ c
Q. O
S- ro
(O +->
E oo
S- X
O-
a) -s=
4- -P
O O N
-P 0)
OJ ^ C >> C
(/) x: ro
0> D. E
s- -o
Q.-O i—
(1JEO
Q; rO CD
CM
S_
473
-------
measure beam transmittance. They measured the spectral composition
of the radiant energy up- and down-welling from lake waters and
evaluated the color attributed to lake waters in terms of the C.I.E.
chromaticity coordinates, They reported the tristimulus values
and showed the plot of the tristimulus values on the C.I.E. chroma-
ticity diagram which gives the numerical specification of the colors.
-2 -1
* 5. Solar radiation range: 20-750 cal-cm -day Total =
150,863 cal•cm"2-year"1
(average of 4 years)
B. CHEMICAL
** 1. pH range 7.3 - 8.0
* 2. Dissolved oxygen range 6.85 - 11.57 mg/1
There is essentially no oxygen depletion in Lake Tahoe.
* 3. Total phosphorus range:
epilimnion (0-15 m) 0.7 - 20.4 yg/1 with mean = 2.8 yg/1
for growing season
euphotic zone (0-105 m) N-D - 25.0 yg/1 (N-D = non detectable)
whole lake (0-400 m) N-D - 25,0 pg/1 with mean = 3 yg/1
We have not been able to measure satisfactorily the fractions of
phosphorus which are present in very small amounts. The mean dis-
solved phosphorus value is less than 5 yg/1.
4. Total nitrogen
* NOo-N range:
epilimnion (0-15 m) N-D - 25 yg/1 with mean = 4.3 yg/1
for growing season
euphotic zone (0-105 m) N-D - 26 yg/1 with mean = 7 yg/1
(one year)
whole lake (0-400 m) N-D - 26 yg/1 with mean = 13 yg/1
(one year)
Other forms of nitrogen have not been measured on a regular schedule
in the past in Lake Tahoe. Based on some past measurements,
however, an average concentration has been estimated (McGauhey
et al. 1963). These values are:
Nitrate as N 8 yg/1 Nitrite as N 1 yg/1
Ammonia as N 2 yg/1 Organic nitrogen as N 50 pg/l
There is considerable variation in nitrate during the year with
depletion occurring in the euphotic zone.
** 5. Alkalinity range 40 - 45 mg/1 with mean = 43 mg/1
6**Ca++ range: 8.8 - 9.9 mg/1 **Mq+ range: 2.1 - 2.9 mg/1
**Na+ range: 5.8 - 7.0 mg/1 **K* range: 1.6 - 1.8 mg/1
**S04= range: 1.5 - 3.6 mg/1 **CT range: 1.7 - 2.1 mg/1
*Fe range: N-D-126 yg/1
** 7. Trace metals. Where levels were below detection, the analytical
474
-------
limit is indicated (e.g. Beryllium
per liter.
cO.3). Values are in micrograms
Aluminum
Beryl 1 i urn
Bismuth
Cadmi urn
Cobalt
16
<0.3
<0.3
<0.7
<0.6
Chromium
Copper
Gallium
Germanium
Manganese
<0.07
trace
<2.8
<0.3
2.6
Molybdenum
Nickel
Lead
Titanium
Vanadium
Zinc
0.51
<0.3
<0.06
<0.6
15
<14
C. BIOLOGICAL
1. Phytoplankton
Representative profiles of phytoplankton biomass and productivity
are shown in Fig. 2.
* a. chlorophyll a_ ranges (unit is mg/m^)
epilimnion (0-15 m) 9.06 - 0.31
euphotic zone (0-105 m) 0.03 - 1.25
mean =0.18 for growing
season
mean = 0.275 for year
round
whole lake (0-400 m) 0.01 - 1.49 3
Maximum average concentration for the euphotic zone = 0.59 mq/m .
Maximum average concentration for the whole lake = 0.39 mg/np.
* b. primary productivity (expressed as carbon)
annual productivity = 55 g m~2 year~^ (average of 6 years)
epilimnion (0-15 m) range 8.79 - 76.46 mg-day-1-m~2 (of
epilimnion)
average = 38 mg-day~'-m~2 for growing season
euphotic zone range 42 - 322 mg.m~2-day~1
average 150 mg-m~2.day~' (for 6 years)
Note on Fig. 2 that the euphotic zone extends well below the
depth at which 1% of surface light is transmitted.
c. Algal growth is limited primarily by nitrogen and iron. EDTA
or NTA additions can effectively stimulate primary productivity
through chelation. Phosphorus is stimulating only when addi-
tional nitrate is provided.
* d. There are over 160 species of phytoplankton in Lake Tahoe,
112 of which are diatoms. Only 10 are centric forms. One of
the dominant diatoms of the late 1960's Cyclotella bodanica has
been replaced by Cyclotella stelligera. Other dominant species
include Dinobrypn sertularia, Fragilaria crotonens i s and Melosira
crenulata. As few as three species often account for 80% of
the total phytoplankton biomass. A large number of very small
~3y forms are now abundant at about 90 m in summer. There tax-
onomic status is still uncertain.
of the euphotic
Phytoplankton fresh weight biomass = 8.3 g-m"
zone for an average day (average of 2 years).
The average number of cell concentration is about 100 cells per
milliliter.
475
-------
Duration of a "bloom" at Lake Tahoe is about 3 to 4 months. The
time of its occurrence is highly variable from one year to the
next, and it would not be considered a bloom by most observers.
* 2. Zooplankton
There is an average of about 1000 zooplankters per cubic meter
in Lake Tahoe. The community is composed of about 25 species of
crustaceans and 14 species of rotifers. It is dominated by the
rotifers Kel1icottia longispina, Ascomorpha and Chromogaster
and the copepods Epischura nevadensis and Diaptomus tyrrel1i. The
major pelagic cladocerans Daphnia and Bosmina that were found
often in Lake Tahoe have almost completely disappeared in recent
years, perhaps from predation by the introduced Mysis relicta
(Richards et al. in press).
3. Bottom Fauna
The most abundant benthic animals are sculpins and the California
crayfish Pacifastacus 1eniusculus. There are an estimated 56
million adult crayfish in the lake (Abrahamsson and Goldman 1970).
Aquatic oligochaets and an endemic stone fly are also abundant
in some areas of the lake.
4. Fish
The fish fauna is largely composed of exotic species. These in-
clude the lake trout, rainbow and brown trout as well as kokanee.
Sculpins, suckers, and dace make up the rest of the fauna.
5. Bacteria
Bacteria are the usual pseudomonad varieties which.are often
associated with detrital particles (see Paerl and Goldman 1972).
Measurements of primary productivity in Tahoe together with
measures of heterotrophy remain the most important and sensitive
indicators of eutrophication in the lake.
6. Bottom Flora
Aquatic mosses, attached diatoms and chara make up most of the
benthic flora which grows to a depth of 100 meters (Goldman and
Amezaga 1974).
7. Macrophytes
Some pond weeds are to be found in marinas and protected areas.
Higher aquatic plants are for the most part absent in the lake.
V. NUTRIENT BUDGETS
Computations of nutrient budgets were based on the following:
Source from land runoff:
1. Total monthly water discharge calculated from daily measurements
taken by the U.S. Geological Survey on nine major tributaries of Lake
Tahoe.
476
-------
2. The estimated yearly runoff of each of the other 54 creeks and
tributaries of Lake Tahoe (see Table 3-XV in McGauhey et al . 1963). The
total monthly water discharge was estimated for these 54 creeks from this
yearly runoff and the measured discharge of the nine major tributaries.
3. Chemistry data collected on nine major tributaries by four dif-
ferent organizations. The major data source was the Tahoe Research Group
of the University of California at Davis. Other groups were: The
California-Nevada Federal Joint Water Quality Investigation, Lake Tahoe
Area Council, Water Resources Information Series of the State of Nevada.
All chemistry concentration data were integrated monthly to get a mean
monthly concentration of nutrient per creek.
Creeks for which data for a specific month had not been collected were
assumed to have a concentration of nutrients equal to the average con-
centration of the other creeks that month.
For every creek the total amount of each nutrient that was discharged into
the lake was calculated for each month by multiplying the total flow data
by the mean concentration. All creeks total discharge of nutrient were
summed by month and all monthly values summed to obtain the total load
of nutrients entering Lake Tahoe in one year from land runoff. This
was done using 1969 data.
Precipitation
1. Average estimate total precipitation on the lake surface.
2. Measurements of average ammonium-nitrogen and nitrate-nitrogen
were made in the Lake Tahoe watershed (Coats, Leonard, Fujita and Goldman
in prep.) and various estimates have been made of total nitrogen content
of rain waters. Only traces of phosphorus are assumed to be present in
the precipitation.
Groundwater
According to the water balance ground water does not contribute any sig-
nificant amount of water to the lake.
Waste Discharge
Waste is being diverted out of the basin. Information on seepage is not
available, although exfiltration from sewer lines may be important. High
nitrate runoff is still occuring from a temporary land disposal site at
South Tahoe (Perkins et al . in press).
A. PHOSPHORUS
1 -21
Source kg -year" ' g-m -year"'
Land runoff 23,404 0.047
Precipitation trace —
Total 23,404 0.047
477
-------
B. NITROGEN (kg-year"1)
Land Runoff Precipitation*
N03-N 21,832 20,116
Organic N 104,645 no information
NH3-N 24,480 7,165 31,645
N02-N 2,731 no information
Total Nitrogen 153,688 104,000 257,288
? 1
Total nitrogen surface area loading = 0.5156 g-m -year .
*A recent estimate for (N03-N + NH^-N) in precipitation was obtained
using the water-year 1973-1974. The new value is 49,900 kg-year"'.
Preliminary results were obtained recently on measurements of organic
nitrogen. These,new results confirm that our preliminary value of
104,000 kg-year" is a very reasonable estimate of total nitrogen
loading from precipitation, although it was not obtained by direct
measurements.
VI. DISCUSSION
Lake Tahoe remains a classic example of a subalpine, ultraoligo-
trophic lake whose remarkable clarity gives record Secchi readings to
forty meters. Oxygen shows no measurable depletion, even at depths of
500 meters, and the dilute rain of organic matter into the abyssal zone
is almost completely mineralized before it reaches the sediment. The
lake, at present nitrogen levels, is rather insensitive to phosphorus
and can be considered a classic example of a nitrogen limited system.
It would appear to be highly sensitive to nitrogen loading and the in-
creased loading that has certainly accompanied the development of the
basin has caused an increase in primary productivity of about five per-
cent per year.
VII. SUMMARY
Because of its relatively small watershed and great volume Lake
Tahoe is at the extreme lower end of lakes classified on the basis of
loading. In all probability this also makes it one of the lakes most
sensitive to nutrient loading. Some confirmation of this is seen from
measures of primary productivity during the last 15 years (Fig. 3). The
rate of increase appears to have peaked out during the last two or three
years, perhaps in response to the extensive sewage diversion from the
lake. The loss of Daphnia and Bosminia as dominant zooplankters and
the increase of ultra plankton at the lower level of the euphotic zone
is of great interest.
478
-------
80,000-
70.000H
C\J
i
CP
E
60,0 OOH
50,000-^
40,000-j
30,000
1958 I960 1962 1964 1966 1968 1970 1972 1974 1976 1978 I960
Figure 3. Annual primary productivity at Lake Tahoe between 1959-60 and
1973. Preliminary results indicate that the 1974 value is
very close to the 1973 value for primary productivity.
479
-------
REFERENCES
Abrahamsson, S.A.A. and C.R. Goldman. 1970. The distribution, density
and production of the crayfish Pacifastacus leniusculus (Dana) in
Lake Tahoe, California-Nevada. Oikos 21:83-91.
Court, J.E., C.R. Goldman and N.J. Hyne. 1972. Surface sediments in
Lake Tahoe, California-Nevada. J. Sediment. Petrol. 42:359-377.
Goldman, C.R.
quality.
408 p.
1974. Eutrophication of Lake Tahoe emphasizing water
EPA-660-/3-74-034. U.S. Gov. Printing Office, Washington.
Goldman, C.R. and E. de Amezaga. 1974. Primary productivity of the
littoral zone of Lake Tahoe, California-Nevada. Proc. Symp. Limnol.
Shallow Waters, 15:49-62.
Goldman, C.R. and E. de Amezaga. (In press). Spatial and temporal changes
in the primary productivity of Lake Tahoe, California-Nevada be-
tween 1959 and 1971. Verh. Internat. Verein. Limnol. 19.
McGauhey, P.H., R. Eliassen, G. Rohlich, H.F. Ludwig and E.A. Pearson.
1963. Comprehensive study on protection of water resources of Lake
Tahoe basin through controlled waste disposal. Prepared for the
Lake Tahoe Area Council. Engineering-Scinece, Inc., Oakland,
California. 157 p.
Paerl, H.W. and C.R. Goldman. 1972. Stimulation of heterotrophic and
autotrophic activities of a planktonic microbial community by sil-
tation at Lake Tahoe, California. Mem. 1st. Ital. Idrobiol. 29
Suppl.:129-147.
Perkins, M.A., C.R. Goldman and R.L. Leonard. (In press). Residual
nutrient discharge in streamwaters influenced by sewage effluent
spraying. Ecology.
Richards, R.C., C.R. Goldman, T.C. Frantz and R. Wickwire. (In press).
Where have all the Daphnia gone? The decline of a major cladoceran
in Lake Tahoe, California-Nevada. Verh. Internat. Verein. Limnol. 19.
Smith, R.C., J.E. Tyler and C.R. Goldman.
color of Lake Tahoe and Crater Lake.
1973. Optical properties and
Limnol. Oceanogr. 18:189-199.
480
-------
REPORT ON NUTRIENT LOAD - EUTROPHICATION RESPONSE
FOR THE OPEN WATERS OF LAKE MICHIGAN
M.D. Piwoni, Walter Rast, Jr. and G. Fred Lee
Center for Environmental Studies
University of Texas at Dallas
Richardson, Texas
INTRODUCTION
Concern over the potential overfertilization of the waters of Lake Michigan
prompted the Water Pollution Control Administration (now the Environmental Pro-
tection Agency) and the states bordering on the lake to take action. They
adopted regulations in 1968 that sought to reduce the phosphorus input from
waste treatment plants by 80 percent by December 1972. In addition, the United
States and Canada have reached an agreement to reduce effluent phosphorus con-
centrations to 1.0 mg/1 for waters entering Lakes Ontario and Erie. It is con-
ceivable that this requirement might also eventually apply to Lake Michigan.
This paper discusses the effects on loading that the reduction in effluent phos-
phorus has produced. It also discusses the implications of this reduction on
water quality in the open waters of Lake Michigan.
PHOSPHORUS LOADING ESTIMATES
Lee (1974) compiled the phosphorus loadings to Lake Michigan in 1971 using
a report by the Phosphorus Technical Committee to the Lake Michigan Conference
(Zar, 1972). The total estimated loading of phosphorus from all sources was
18.1 million pounds per year (Table 1) . This is somewhat higher than the values
estimated by Bartsch (1968), by US EPA report (1971), and by the Region V Office
of the Environmental Protection Agency (Zar, 1972). However, these latter esti-
mates probably do not include storm sewer overflow or direct precipitation and
dry fallout contributions (see Table 1).
Lee (1974) also included predicted phosphorus loading to the lake for 1973
which incorporated the 80 percent reduction in phosphorus by waste treatment
facilities in the basin that was agreed to in the late 1960's by the states
bordering on Lake Michigan. This value, included in Table 2, assumes 13.2
million pounds of phosphorus yields 2.6 million pounds per year of phosphorus,
which leads to the 7.5 million pounds per year total loading of phosphorus
shown in Table 2. This predicted phosphorus loading of 7.5 million pounds per
year is expected to be reached by approximately 1976-77, assuming the projected
goal of 80 percent removal of phosphorus from domestic wastewaters is attained.
This would place Lake Michigan in an oligotrophic category (Figure 1) relative to
481
-------
Table 1. ESTIMATED PHOSPHORUS LOAD
TO LAKE MICHIGAN, 19711
Source Load
(Million Ibs/yr)
Direct wastewater 3.9
Indirect wastewater 9.3
Total wastewater 13.2
Erosion and other diffuse sources 3.0 (1 to 7)
Combined sewer overflow 0.8
Precipitation and dustfall on 1.1
surface of lake
Total diffuse source 1.9
Total 18.1
Bartsch 1968 Estimate 14.6
US EPA 1971 Estimate 14. 3
Zar 1971 Estimate 16.7
XAfter Lee (1974).
482
-------
Table 2. ESTIMATED PHOSPHORUS LOADING
TO LAKE MICHIGAN, 1974
Source Load
(Million Ibs/yr)
1 2
Wisconsin contribution '
3
Michigan contribution
i 4
Indiana*
Illinois5'"'5
Combined sewer overflow
Precipitation and dustfall
Total
Lee Estimate for 1973
4.5
4.7
0.6
0.7
0.8
1.1
12.4
7.5
(assumes 80 percent P removal from
domestic wastewaters)
IJC Goal for 19737 11.7
l32From Schraufnagel (1974) and Wisconsin DNR report (1973)
From McCracken (1974).
4 From Miller (1971).
5 From US EPA (1971).
c
From Lee (1974). Based on 80 percent removal.
7
From Great Lakes Water Quality Board (1973).
" Tributary input of phosphorus into Lake Michigan,
1970 data.
** Represents 1971 data.
483
-------
JMI I
-
I
—
-
_
-
•"
—
—
—
-
_
-
Mil 1
/
1 I 1
UJ
>
CO
CO
UJ
o
X
UJ
\
\
\
\
o
I
Q.
o
/y
LX.
1-
Z>
UJ
1 1 1
i X / in
1 1 i i i i
UJ
_J
CO
CO
to
5
cr
UJ
O-
\
\ \
\
*2\
>/
o
to
ii
J?
u>
z i>
<- 8
O to i=
— DC "
X uj 3
OH ^
—
0
^
-
—
-
(oXo)(o^oy
!^^X^^X ^
*
\
^"
v >
\
\
|,
_
6
o f\ \ \r
^ •NMI^-
*Xi)
k
\
\
'
1 1
\ 1 1
ill 1
10/^1 i i
-
~
—
—
-
"
—
"
o
o
o
o
o
1
__
-O
o
o
c
o
0)
o:
o»
a
2
o>
c
V
484
-------
Vollenweider's (1975) loading criteria (the effects of differ-
ent hydraulic residence times in assessing the trophic status
of Lake Michigan is discussed in a following section). Vollen-
weider (1975) has used this relationship (Figure 1) to indicate
the relative trophic status of a large number of lakes based
on phosphorus loadings and mean depth and hydraulic residence
time.
Table 2 also includes the best available estimates for phos-
phorus loadings to Lake Michigan as of January, 1974. The
pollution control agency of each of the states bordering on
Lake Michigan was contacted for updated information on nutrient
sources. These values are based on information provided by
each state. Values for Michigan and Wisconsin reflect improved
phosphorus removal by sewage treatment plants by the end of
1973. Current values for Indiana and Illinois were not avail-
able. The values for these states presented in Table 2 are
probably somewhat high.
If one assumes that the decrease in phosphorus loading from
1971 to 1973 was due entirely to improved sewage treatment
plant phosphate removal, then the 1973 estimates reflect a
43 percent reduction in this source of phosphorus, based on
Lee's (1974) estimates.
Without any phosphorus removal from domestic wastewaters or
a change from phosphorus to nonphosphorus-type detergents,
it would be expected that approximately 30 million pounds
of phosphorus per year would be entering the lake by the
year 2020 over what was expected to enter Lake Michigan in
1973. This would make the 2020 loading approximately 42.2
million pounds of phosphorus annually. This would place
Lake Michigan in a eutrophic or eutrophic-mesotrophic status,
depending on the hydraulic residence time used in calculation
of the 2/T term in the Vollenweider diagram, relative to its
U) to 5
phosphorus loading (Figure 1). However, since the wastewaters
will be treated for at least 80-90 percent phosphorus re-
485
-------
moval , only a 2.4 million pound increase per year (assuming 90
percent removal) in the phosphorus loading from the sewered
population is expected by the year 2020.
This will be countered by a combination of diversion of
sewage and elimination of combined sewer overflow (Table 3a)
with the result that the new change in phosphorus loading
to Lake Michigan between 1973 and 2020 is expected to be only
about 2.1 million pounds per year (Lee, 1974). This is a
total phosphorus loading to Lake Michigan of 9.6 million pounds
per year by the year 2020. This would leave Lake Michigan in
an oligotrophic status relative to the Vollenweider (1975)
plot (Figure 1), regardless of whether 30 or 100 years is
taken as the hydraulic residence time, even with the 2.1
million pound per year increase in phosphorus load.
The nitrogen loading to the lake was estimated by Bartsch (1968)
to be about 166 million pounds per year. It is not expected
that the nitrogen loadings would have changed much since 1968.
PROBLEMS IN ESTIMATING NUTRIENT LOADS
The estimates presented in Tables 1 and 2 are necessarily
based on a number of assumptions. Much of the wastewater data
is calculated using 3.6 pounds of phosphorus per person per
year. For direct wastewater sources (i.e., discharge directly
into the lake), this value is probably quite good, but for in-
direct sources (i.e., discharge to a tributary to the lake), it
is probably too high. No attempt was made to determine what
percentage of the phosphorus from indirect wastewater sources
is actually reaching the lake in an available form.
Diffuse source estimates were based on an average contribution
per square mile of watershed area, usually about 100 pounds of
phosphorus per square mile per year: These assumptions, although
the best available at this time, result in considerable uncer-
tainty in the loading estimates.
486
-------
Table 3a. EXPECTED CHANGES IN PHOSPHORUS LOADING
OF LAKE MICHIGAN, 1973-2020a
Factors Influencing
Future Phosphorus Load
Change in Load
(Million Ibs/yr)
Diversion of North Shore Sanitary
District
Eliminate Combined Sewer Overflow
Increase in Sewered Population
(90 percent phosphorus removal by
year 2020)
Increased Urban Area (conversion of
rural to urban land)
Rural Runoff Input Reduction
Urban Runoff Input Reduction
Improvement in Advanced Waste
Treatment
Net Change in Phosphorus Load
to Lake Michigan, 1973-2020
-0.1
-0.8
+ 2.4
+ 0.6
magnitude unknown
magnitude unknown
magnitude unknown
+ 2 .1
From Lee (1974)
487
-------
PROBLEMS IN ESTIMATING THE HYDRAULIC RESIDENCE TIME FOR LAKE
MICHIGAN
For the purposes of this discussion, and as it is used in the
Vollenweider phosphorus loading diagram (Figure 1), the hydrau-
lic residence time is defined as the water body volume/annual
inflow volume. Thus, it constitutes the water body's "filling
time." If the annual precipitation onto the water body surface
was approximately equal to its annual evaporation, the annual
outflow volume could be used in the same manner as the inflow
volume. There are advantages to both methods. The necessity
of having to account for precipitation and evaporation in
calculation of the hydraulic residence time is avoided if the
inflow volume is used. However, the inflow to a water body
is frequently through numerous tributary inputs , as well as
from runoff directly into the water body and precipitation
directly onto the water body surface. It is usually difficult
to measure accurately all such inflows to a water body. By con-
trast, the outflow for most water bodies is usually through a
single outlet, allowing it to be more easily measured. The out-
let is often gaged and, therefore, the computed total outflow
is usually more accurate than the total inflow. Since several
methods were possible, it was decided early in the US OECD study
that the hydraulic residence time of the US OECD water bodies
would be determined on the basis of their annual inflow volumes
(Jaworski, 1974).
For Lake Michigan, an examination of the literature indicates
there is considerable confusion concerning its hydraulic resi-
dence time. Most investigators used the outflow or discharge
volume rather than the inflow volume to calculate Lake Michigan's
hydraulic residence time. Because precipitation is approximately
equal to evaporation, calculation of the hydraulic residence time
using the outflow volume will give a reasonable estimate of its
magnitude. A summary of the reported hydraulic residence times
for Lake Michigan is presented in Table 3b. In some cases, the
hydraulic residence time was stated by the investigators, while
488
-------
Table 3b. SUMMARY OF HYDRAULIC RESIDENCE TIMES
REPORTED FOR LAKE MICHIGAN
Hydraulic Residence
Time (yr) Source of Information
99. 4 Beeton and Chandler (1963)
30.8 Rainey (1967)
31.2 Patalas (1972)
Vollenweider and Dillon (1974)
31.2 a) Table 1
100 b) Figure 2
94-113 Vollenweider (1975, 1976, 1977a)
30 Watson (1976)
105 International Joint Commission
(1976)
30 Sonzogni et_ al. (1976)
100 Schelske (1977)
100 Bennett (1977)
489
-------
in other cases it was calculated by these reviewers based on the
data presented by the indicated sources. Examination of Table 3b
indicates that, with one exception, the hydraulic residence time
estimates for Lake Michigan aggregate around the two values of
30 and 100 years, depending on the source of the data. There
are several reasons for this three-fold difference in the hy-
draulic residence time estimates. One reason is that previous
investigators have not adequately defined their terms. They did
not clearly indicate whether annual inflow or outflow volumes
were used in their calculations. However, this factor alone is
not sufficient to account for the large differences in the re-
ported hydraulic residence times for Lake Michigan.
Recently, Quinn (1977) has conducted a study of the annual and
seasonal flow variations through the Straits of Mackinac from
Lake Michigan to Lake Huron. While Lakes Michigan and Huron
have historicallv been treated as a single body of water in
hydraulic and hydrologic studies, Quinn has indicated that the
actual water mass transport between these two lakes has generally
been ignored. Consequently, Quinn developed a water mass con-
tinuity technique which he applied to Lake Michigan for the
1950-1966 period to determine average annual and monthly flows
through the Straits of Mackinac. His model indicated a 500+
percent variation between maximum and minimum annual flows
through the straits during the 17-year period. He also compared
his predicted flows with the results of a direct current mea-
surement of flow through the straits for a 100-day period in
1973 and found the results agreed within 2 percent. Using his
technique, the annual variations and seasonal cycle of the flow
through the straits were quantified. Based on his study, Quinn
has determined that calculation of two different hydraulic re-
sidence times is possible for Lake Michigan. If the annual
mean flow, with no regard for seasonal variations, is used in
the computation of the hydraulic residence time, Quinn obtains
a value of 137 years. However, Quinn also found that there is
a deep return flow of water into Lake Michigan through the
straits during stratification. If this return flow is considered
490
-------
in the computations as part of the annual inflow water volume,
a hydraulic residence time of 69 years is obtained. This value
of 69 years falls approximately in the middle of the 30-100
year range reported in Table 3b.
There is mixing of this "backflow water" with the water at the
upper end of Lake Michigan, although the extent of this mixing
is not known. It is likely that the backflow has limited effect
on the waters of lower Lake Michigan, but it influences the dis-
charge through the Straits of Mackinac into Lake Huron. Because
of the uncertainty concerning the correct value, both the 30 and
100-year hydraulic residence time values were used in calcula-
tion of the mean depth/hydraulic residence time term (i.e.,
Z/T ) in the Vollenweider phosphorus loading diagram (Figure 1).
A value between these two extremes is likely the correct hydrau-
lic residence time for Lake Michigan (e.g., Quinn's (1977) value
of 69 years). Consequently, 30-100 years can be used as a range
of the hydraulic residence times, depending on the actual out-
flow volume of Lake Michigan during a given year. The use of
100 years in the Z/T expression produces a value of 0.8U m/yr,
while 30 years produces a Z/T value of 2.8 m/yr. However, it
should be noted that while 30-100 years was used as a range for
the hydraulic residence time values in this report, based on the
work of Quinn (1977), a range of 70-100 years is likely a more
realistic estimate of the present hydraulic residence time for
Lake Michigan.
The effect of these two hydraulic residence time values (i.e.,
30 and 100 years) on the relative position of Lake Michigan on the
Vollenweider diagram can be seen in Figure 1. AT value of 100
years indicates Lake Michigan was in the mesotrophic zone of the
Vollenweider diagram, based on its 1971 phosphorus load, and is
approximately at the oligotrophic-mesotrophic boundary, based
on its 1974 phosphorus load. This characterization of Lake Mi-
chigan is reasonable for its nearshore water zones, but is not
indicative of the open water trophic conditions of the lake,
which are generally considered as oligotrophic. A T value of
491
-------
30 years indicates Lake Michigan plots at the oligotrophic-meso-
trophic boundary in 1971 and in the oligotrophic zone of the
Vollenweider diagram in 1974. This oligotrophic characteriza-
tion is accurate for Lake Michigan's open waters, but does not
describe its nearshore zones, which are in a relatively more
productive condition than its open waters. Thus, the effects
of the two T values make a difference in delineation of Lake
OJ
Michigan's predicted trophic condition, as indicated by its
position on the Vollenweider phosphorus loading diagram (Fig-
ure 1). The lower 1974 phosphorus load to Lake Michigan, re-
lative to its 1971 load, implies an improvement in its water
quality, as indicated by its more oligotrophic position on the
Vollenweider diagram (Figure 1). Such an improvement is likely
when Lake Michigan has reached a new equilibrium condition
relative to its reduced phosphorus loading (Sonzogni et al. ,
1976) .
NUTRIENT LOADS AND PRODUCTIVITY IN LAKE MICHIGAN
Schelske and Callendar (1970) surveyed the phytoplankton
productivity and the nutrient levels of Lakes Michigan and
Superior during the summer of 1969. Table 4 contrasts data
for nutrient and productivity parameters for the two lakes,
Productivity, as measured by carbon fixation, is about eight
times greater in Lake Michigan than in Lake Superior. Con-
versely, SiO~ concentrations are considerably lower in Lake
Michigan because of the larger diatom population. Schelske
and Callendar (1970) suggest that the large difference in Si02
concentrations between surface and bottom waters in Lake
Michigan also indicates a substantial diatom population,
NO_-N is higher in Superior and shows little concentration
+ =
change down the water column. NH -N and ortho-PO -P show no
apparent correlations but are included in Table 4 to facilitate
comparison. A summary of nutrient loadings and productivity
characteristics is presented in Table 5.
492
-------
CO
Pi
H
EH
W
*r^
H
EH
CJ
P
O
Pi
On
P
55
<£
EH
Iz;
W
H
Pi
EH
J3
55
•
HT
0)
rH
,Q
rd
EH
H
CD
CO
CD
H
"
-
•
0
OO
rH
^
.
CD
H
x-\
c-»
H
r-
+1
CD
H
rH
, — s
OO
rH
c-~
o
.
o
-H
CD
CM
.
O
^
CD
H
*^>
CT>
CM
.
H
+1
CD
O
.
00
c
rd
bO
•H
r|
O
•H
(D
C 0
f-i rd
0) UH
f^ C_|
•P d
^ CO
0
!z;
x-^
CM
H
CM
•
H
CM
H
0
.
CO
H
x-v
CM
rH
^-
CD
OO
+ 1
CD
H
CM
x — ^
CM
H
CD
H
•
O
+ 1
CD
CM
.
H
1
1
e
o
p>
p
0
pa
£
rd
bO
•H
r|
O
•H
C
£_|
C1J
fr|
P
3
O
CO
X-N
CO
rH
CD
•
O
LO
rH
CM
.
O
H
x-s
LO
rH
^
OO
H
+ 1
H
O
H
x-^
CO
H
r—
O
.
0
+ 1
LO
H
o
^
HT
rH
v —
CM
CO
.
CM
+ 1
LO
LO
•
CO
Q)
0
rd
C|_(
£_,
d
CO
x-s
CO
H
CD
•
rH
LO
H
CD
.
CO
CM
x-s
CM
rH
v^
CD
CM
+ 1
00
rH
CM
x-s
CM
H
CD
H/
.
O
+1
OO
CO
.
rH
1
1
e
0
p
p
o
PQ
x-s
CM
CM
LO
•
O
CM
CM
CM
•
J-
, V
CD
rH
^
H
CM
+ 1
CD
CO
CM
x-s
O
CM
H
H
•
O
+ 1
r-~
OO
•
rH
^
CD
H
• —
rH
H
.
O
+1
CT>
OO
•
O
0)
£n O
O rd
•H 4n
SH fc
0) d
PH CO
Hi
CO
493
x-s
H
CM
LO
•
rH
CM
CM
LO
.
CO
H
s~*
rH
CM
v-x
CD
rH
+1
CD
[-^
CM
s~^
CM
CM
J-
H
•
0
+1
H
O
.
CM
1
1
6
0
p
p
o
OQ
.
CO
0)
H
f\
e
W
'H
0
d) C_^
c~~ 0)
,C ^
o id
CO (^
p
0)
P H
4n EH
-------
Table 5. LAKE MICHIGAN SUMMARY OF PRODUCTIVITY
AND NUTRIENT LOADING CHARACTERISTICS
Loading values
1 2
Phosphorus (total) 0.1 g/m /yr
2 2
Nitrogen (total) 1.3 g/m /yr
Productivity3'4 3.4 mg-C/m3/hr
150 g-c/M2/yr
Yearly average
3 3
chlorophyll a '2.3 mg/m
Euphotic zone 8 meters
Mean depth 84 meters
Mean water residence time 30 - 100 years
From this report.
2After Bartsch (1968).
After Schelske and Callender (1970).
4After Vollenweider (1975).
494
-------
According to the Vollenweider (1975) phosphorus loading diagram,
the current phosphorus loading to Lake Michigan places it in the
oligotrophic zone of the diagram, below its "permissible" loading
line, regardless of whether the 30 or 100 year hydraulic residence
time value is used (Figure 1). Table 5 contains loading estimates
as well as the mean depth and hydraulic residence times used in
the Vollenweider diagram. This trophic classification is roughly
in agreement with the productivity status of the open waters of
this lake. Further reductions in the phosphorus loading to the
lake would tend to move Lake Michigan to a relatively more "oligo-
trophic" position on the Vollenweider diagram. Table 5 also con-
tains values for productivity, yearly average chlorophyll a, and
the depth of the euphotic zone in the open waters of Lake Michigan.
IMPACT OF NUTRIENT REDUCTION
ON WATER QUALITY IN LAKE MICHIGAN
Three more or less distinct regions of the lake must be con-
sidered in evaluating the potential impact that 80 to 90
percent phosphorus removal from domestic wastewater will have
on water quality in Lake Michigan. These are the open waters
of the lake (which are the primary focal point of the report),
the nearshore waters, and the areas of restricted circulation
such as river mouths, harbors, etc. Lee (1974) has discussed
the characteristics of each of these regions and the probable
impact which 80 to 90 percent phosphorus removal from domestic
wastewaters will have on water quality in each of these areas.
As pointed out by Lee (1974), there will likely be a small
improvement in water quality in the open waters of the lake
which should be manifested several years from now in the form
of reduced phytoplankton growth. The greatest improvement in
water quality will likely occur in the nearshore waters where
phosphorus is already or can be made the limiting factor con-
trolling planktonic and attached algal growth. As noted by
Lee (1974), in areas of restricted circulation such as southern
Green Bay, little or no improvement in water quality will
495
-------
likely occur from the 80 percent removal of phosphorus from
domestic wastewater sources, since it would be insufficient to
make phosphorus the limiting element controlling algal growth
in these areas.
From an overall point of view, the information available today
strongly supports the decision that was made in the late
1960's by the federal government and the states bordering on
Lake Michigan to provide for 80 percent removal of phosphorus
from domestic wastewater sources. Failure to take this step
would have resulted in a very significant deterioration of
water in Lake Michigan due to the increased urbanization of
the lake's watershed. Instead of the steady, slow decline in
water quality of the lake which would have resulted without
the removal of phosphorus from domestic wastewaters, water
quality in this lake should improve in the next 50 years due to
the decision that was made in the late 1960's bringing about
phosphorus removal from domestic wastewaters.
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
The primary source of information which served as the basis
for this paper is a report by the Phosphorus Technical Com-
mittee to the Lake Michigan Enforcement Conference, H. Zar,
Chairman. The information provided in this report was up-
dated through the assistance of F. Schraufnagel, State of
Wisconsin, and C. Fetterolf, State of Michigan, as well as
several individuals from the State of Illinois and the
International Joint Commission, Windsor, Ontario. The
assistance of these individuals is greatly appreciated.
496
-------
REFERENCES
Beeton, A.M. and D.C. Chandler. 1963. The St. Lawrence Great
Lakes. In: D.G. Frey (ed.), Limnology in North America,
University of Wisconsin Press , "Madison . p~pT]535-558"!
Bennett, H.W. 1977. Letter to G.K. Rodgers, Canada Centre
for Inland Waters, Burlington, Ontario, dated April 14, 1977.
Dillon, P.J. 1975. The Phosphorus Budget of Cameron Lake,
Ontario: the Importance of Flushing Rate to the Degree of
Eutrophy of Lakes. Limnol. Oceanogr. 2 Ch 2 8 - 3 9 .
Frey, D.G. Limnology in North America. University of Wisconsin
Press, Madison.734 pp.
International Joint Commission. 1976. Further Regulation of
the Great Lakes. International Joint Commission Report to
the Governments of Canada and the United States. 96 pp.
Jaworski, N.A. 1974. Personal Communication - US EPA, National
Environmental Research Center, Corvallis. October 8, 1974.
Patalas , K. 1972. Crustacean Plankton and the Eutrophication
of the St. Lawrence Great Lakes. J. Fish. Res. Bd. Can.
29 :1451-1462.
Quinn, F.K. 1977. Annual and Seasona] Variations Through the
Straits of Mackinac. Water Resources Research 13:137-144.
Rainey, R.H. 1967. Natural Displacement of Pollution From the
Great Lakes. Science 155:1242-1243'.
Schelske, C.L. 1977. Personal Communication - Great Lakes
Research Division, the University of Michigan, Ann Arbor,
Michigan. January 31, 1977.
Sonzogni, W.C., P.D. Uttormark and G.F. Lee. 1976. Phosphorus
Residence Time Model: Theory and Application. Water Research
10:429-435.
497
-------
Vollenweider, R.A. and P.J. Dillon. 1974. The Application of
the Phosphorus Loading Concept to Eutrophication Research.
National Research Council Canada Report No. 13690. 42 pp.
Vollenweider, R.A. 1968. Scientific Fundamentals of the
Eutrophication of Lakes and Flowing Waters, with Particular
Reference to Phosphorus and Nitrogen as Factors in Eutrophica-
tion. OECD Tech. Report DAS/CSI/68.27, Paris. 159 pp.
Vollenweider, R.A. 1975. Input-Output Models. Schweiz. Z.
Hydrologie . 3T_: 53-84.
Vollenweider, R.A. 1976. Advances in Defining Critical Loading
Levels for Phosphorus in Lake Eutrophication. Mem. 1st. Ital .
Idrobiol. 3j3:53-83.
Vollenweider, R.A. 1977a. Personal Communication - Canada Centre
for Inland Waters, Burlington, Ontario, January 13, 1977.
*
Vollenweider, R.A. 1977b. Personal Communication - Canada Centre
for Inland Waters, Burlington, Ontario, February 10, 1977.
Watson, A.P. 1976. Personal Communication - International Joint
Commission, Windsor, Ontario, December 13, 1976.
498
-------
TROPHIC STATUS AND NUTRIENT LOADING
FOR LAKE MICHIGAN
Claire L. Schelske
Great Lakes Research Division
University of Michigan
Ann Arbor, Michigan
INTRODUCTION
Lake Michigan is the world's sixth largest lake in terms of volume or
surface area (Hutchinson 1957). Limnologically it has not been studied
extensively. Studies on lakewide eutrophication, with the exception of
fisheries, are relatively recent (Beeton 1965; Ayers and Chandler 1967;
Beeton 1969). Limnological characteristics have been summarized and
compared with other Laurentian Great Lakes by Beeton and Chandler (1963)
and Schelske and Roth (1973). The lake serves many uses including munic-
ipal and industrial water supply, recreation, transportation, and com-
mercial and sport fishing (Beeton and Chandler 1963; Beeton 1969).
The purpose of this paper is to review the effects of nutrient loading
on biological communities and processes and to assess current and past
trophic conditions in Lake Michigan. In this paper, the classical
definition of oligotrophic and eutrophic will be used, i.e. that the
terms imply variation in nutrient content. Eutrophication therefore
results from nutrient enrichment or more specifically from increased
supplies of limiting nutrients.
The discussion of nutrient loads for Lake Michigan is the subject of a
separate paper by Piwoni, Rast and Lee in this volume.
Phytoplankton growth and primary production in Lake Michigan are limited
by supplies of phosphorus, an environmental characteristic common to
Lake Superior and Lake Huron as well. Evidence to support this state-
ment is available from numerous field and laboratory experiments
(Schelske and Stoermer 1972; Schelske et al. 1972; Schelske et al. 1974;
Schelske, Simmons and Feldt, In press). It has also been shown that
supplies of nitrogen have little if any effect on phytoplankton growth
499
-------
(Schelske et al. 1974). Other evidence for control of eutrophication by
inputs of phosphorus in the Laurentian Great Lakes is provided by data
that show concentrations of phosphorus increase as primary productivity
and chlorophyll a increase and Secchi disc transparency decreases
(Fig. 1). Concentrations of chlorophyll a from the open-lake stations
are lowest in Lake Superior, larger in Lake Huron, and largest in Lake
Michigan, with phosphorus having the same relationship among the three
lakes. These results clearly show that standing crops of algae (measured
by concentrations of chlorophyll a) are positively correlated with
concentration of phosphorus in the water. There also is nearly an order
of magnitude range in rates of primary productivity for Lake Superior,
the most oligotrophic of the lakes, and Lake Michigan.
Historical data on trends in levels of nutrients are not available, but
ample evidence exists that conservative elements have increased (Beeton
1965) . Whether changes in levels of conservative elements affect trophic
state is an unresolved question.
INSHORE-OFFSHORE DIFFERENCES
Investigations of Lake Michigan, particularly the southern half, have
revealed extreme differences in nutrients, phytoplankton productivity and
standing crop between the nearshore waters and the open parts of the lake
(Ladewski and Stoermer 1973; Stoermer 1972). Maximum chlorophyll a
concentrations and standing crops of phytoplankton in the spring were
15 mg/m-3 and 8,000 cells/ml in the nearshore waters, several times great-
er than the offshore waters. In the spring during the presence of the
thermal bar these differences may not be surprising since the nearshore
area may be 6-10°C warmer than the offshore region; but these differences
persist throughout the year so factors other than temperature are
important (Holland and Beeton 1972) . Nutrient input from rivers obvious-
ly contributes to the inshore-offshore differences, and this factor is
important to consider since the input is not distributed uniformly over
the lake.
500
-------
100
50
10
1.0
0.5
O.I
I
\
1
Chlorophyll a
Primary Productivity
Total P
Secchi Disc
Lake Erie
Western
Basin
Lake
Michigan
Lake
Huron
Lake
Superior
Figure 1. Chlorophyll a (mg/m^) , primary productivity
(mg C/m^/hr), total phosphorus (mg PO^-P/m^) and Secchi disc
transparency (m) in the Great Lakes. (From Schelske 1974.)
501
-------
No estimates of differences in nearshore nutrient loading have been made,
but the significance of unequal loadings is obvious from data on nutrient
input by various tributaries. Forty percent of the nutrient loading as
total soluble phosphorus occurs on about five percent of the shoreline or
from the input of the Muskegon, Grand, Kalamazoo, and St. Joseph rivers
along the southeastern part of the lake. Another 35 percent is contrib-
uted by the Fox and Menominee rivers flowing into Green Bay, leaving
only 25 percent of the loading for the remainder of the nearshore zone
(Schelske 1974).
It is obvious that the effects of nutrient loading to Green Bay are
manifested primarily in the bay and do not affect greatly the water
quality in the northern part of Lake Michigan. Evidence for this state-
ment is based primarily on the fact that the chemical and biological
characteristics in northern Green Bay are very similar to those found in
northern Lake Michigan (Schelske and Callender 1970). The nutrient
contribution from Green Bay to northern Lake Michigan is therefore
diffuse and represents only a relatively small, if any, source of nutri-
ent enrichment for the open-lake waters. If there is a difference in
nutrient composition, the loading factor might be significant due to the
relatively large volume of water flowing out of Green Bay into Lake
Michigan.
Due to the large difference in nutrient loading within the nearshore zone
and between the nearshore zone and the offshore zone, it will not be
possible to discuss the nearshore zone in this paper. The nearshore zone
is also much more variable biologically than the offshore zone. This
restriction is not too serious when one considers nutrient loading for
the system, since the nearshore zone divided arbitrarily at the 20-m
contour represents a small fraction of the lake (Table 1).
502
-------
Table 1. MORPHOMETRIC AND HYDROLOGIC CHARACTERISTICS OF LAKE MICHIGAN.
Nearshore
Depth (m) 0-20
Length (km)
Breadth (km)
2
Water surface (km ) 7,440
2
Land drainage basin (km )
2
Land and water (km )
Maximum depth (m) 20
Average depth (m) 10
3
Volume of water (km ) 74
3
Mean outflow (km /yr)
Offshore Lake
20-281 0-281
490
188
46,110 53,550a
117,840
170,390
281 281
97.5
4,796 4,870
49.1
Excluding Green Bay.
GENERAL MORPHOMETRY AND HYDROLOGY
Lake Michigan is deep, with a maximum depth of 281 m, and has two prin-
cipal basins, the northern and the southern. The long axis is 490 km in
a nearly north-south direction (Fig. 2). Morphometric and geological
characteristics have been described by Hough (1958) and geological
research has been reviewed by Sly and Thomas (1974). The drainage basin
is large, 170,390 km2 with the lake occupying one-third of the surface
area (Table 1). Because of the large proportion of lake surface to
drainage area, inputs of water and nutrients from precipitation directly
on the lake surface are significant. The other large input of water is
surface runoff from streams and rivers, although ground water inflow may
be an important consideration in local areas. Water is lost mainly
503
-------
Rapid R Wfutefish R.
Escanaba R.
GREEN BAY
Fox
Manitowoc R
Sheboygan R.
Milwaukee R
MILWAUKEE
Boardman R.
.UDINGTON
Pere Marquette R.
STRAITS
AREA
Muskegon R
RAND HAVEN
Kalamazoo R.
St. Joseph R.
Figure 2. Major tributaries of Lake Michigan. (From Schelske
1974.)
504
-------
through evaporation and the main outflow at the Straits of Mackinac
(Table 1). A small amount of water in relation to the outflow (3 km^/yr)
is used to supply water for the city of Chicago and is not returned
because waste water is diverted to the drainage system of the Mississippi
River through the Chicago Sanitary Canal.
PHYSICAL AND CHEMICAL CONDITIONS
Areas of all five Laurentian Great Lakes are extensive so meteorological
factors, particularly wind energy, can produce large-scale physical
changes resulting in seiches, upwelling, and surface and subsurface
currents. Two recent review papers provide excellent treatments of
physical processes of large lakes (Mortimer 1974; Boyce 1974), but few
studies have been made on how these physical processes influence chemical
or biological processes. Physical characteristics are determined by the
facts that the basins are closed and large enough so water transport is
affected by Coriolis force (rotation of the earth), wind is the princi-
pal source of mechanical energy, and the water is thermally stratified
in the summer (Boyce 1974).
Surface currents generally behave as expected due to the influence of
Coriolis force with movement in a counterclockwise direction, i.e.
currents moving south on the western shore and north on the eastern shore,
The mean surface currents indicate two and possibly three cells or areas
of counterclockwise circulation along the long axis of the lake (Millar
1952). Ayers et al. (1958) found this general pattern during periods of
the normal westerly winds in June but not in August when winds were more
easterly. It is well known that circulation patterns are transient and
can change within a day, given normal shifts in wind speed and direction.
The thermal structure and stratification differ from either first-class
or second-class temperate lakes, described by Hutchinson (1967) . Lake
Michigan is an atypical temperate lake in that it is not truly dimictic
but is probably monomictic. After thermal stratification breaks down in
505
-------
the fall, the lake does not stratify again until the next summer, mixing
at least periodically during storms all winter. Due to the long fetch
and mixing in the winter, the entire water mass cools to less than 4.0°C
with temperatures as low as 0.5°C being common in mid-lake during March
(Rousar 1973). Investigators have observed inverse thermal stratifica-
tion after the water has cooled below 4.0°C—the warmer water remains on
the bottom until the lake is mixed completely by a storm. Very unusual
winter cgnditions are needed for the lake to freeze completely for
extended periods of time, but ice formation is extensive in shallow
waters. Temperature ranges in the open lake are at least 0.5-22.9°C
(Rousar 1973).
In addition to being monomictic, Lake Michigan differs from shallower
temperate lakes in that spring warming produces a thermal bar in the
lake. This phenomenon has been well described previously for other large
lakes and for the Laurentian Great Lakes, by Rodgers (1965) for Lake
Ontario, by Huang (1972) for Lake Michigan, and generally by Mortimer
(1974) . Differential warming in the spring produces the thermal bar;
nearshore waters being shallower warm more rapidly than the deeper off-
shore waters. The thermal bar is the downwelling water at maximum
density (4.0°C) that develops between water nearshore that is warmer and
water offshore that is colder than 4.0°C. This sharp horizontal temper-
ature gradient restricts mixing of inshore waters with the open lake and
affects biological problems related to nutrient loading. Different and
greater numbers of phytoplankton were present on the shoreward side of
the thermal bar (Stoermer 1968).
Seasonal, physical and chemical data are available from Rousar (1973).
These data are summarized in Table 2 as they are the most extensive data
set available for open-water conditions during an entire year. These
data also appear to represent chemical conditions during 1970-1971
because results available from other investigators sampling at the same
time are comparable in magnitude.
506
-------
Table 2. PHYSICAL AND CHEMICAL DATA FOR LAKE MICHIGAN WATER COLLECTED
FROM A DEPTH OF 4 METERS. Nearshore values are Station 1 near
Milwaukee and offshore values are for Stations 3 and 4 between
Milwaukee, Wise, and Ludington, Mich. Data presented are averages
and ranges for an 18-month period in 1970-1971.
Data are from Rousar (1973).
Nearshore
Offshore
Temperature (C)
PH
Total alkalinity (meq/liter)
Specific conductance
(ymhos/cm @ 25 C)
N03-N (mg/liter)
Si02 (mg/liter)
Total P (pg/liter)
Soluble reactive P (pg/liter)
11.4 (0.1-20.8)
8.3 (7.9-8.8)
2.14 (2.06-2.25)
265 (257-278)
0.19 (0.10-0.29)
0.75 (0.2-1.6)
15.2 (8.2-32.9)
1.9 (ND-10.8)
11.4 (0.5-22.9)
8.3 (8.1-9.0)
2.12 (2.04-2.17)
259 (251-273)
0.19 (0.12-0.27)
0.85 (0.2-1.5)
8.1 (2.4-16.0)
1.1 (ND-4.0)
A distinct difference is obvious in the total phosphorus concentrations
between nearshore and offshore, but there is no difference in the
averages for the other parameters (Table 2). The lack of significant
differences is due partly to the technique of averaging, partly to the
parameters listed, and partly to the locations of the stations.
Distinct differences between offshore and inshore stations were obtained
for Secchi disc transparency during two years of intensive sampling
(Fig. 3). The transparency varies seasonally and, with the exception of
the minimum in September, was correlated inversely with cell counts and
chlorophyll concentrations (Ladewski and Stoermer 1973). September
transparency was reduced by upwelled light from "milky water," probably
suspensions of precipitated calcium carbonate.
507
-------
10
X
>-
a.
Ul
Q
\' I \/ •' ••X--H
Kr KY -• »-U
May July Sept Nov
1971
May July Sept Nov
1972
Figure 3. Secchi disc transparency averaged by depth range and month.
Key: Dotted line shows mean value for stations less than 10 m deep,
dashed line shows mean value for stations between 10 m and 40 m deep and
solid line shows mean value for stations deeper than 40 m. For each
cruise there are nominally 12 stations shallower than 10 m, 16 between
10 and 40 m deep and 13 deeper than 40 m. Error flags show the standard
error of the mean. (From Ladewski and Stoermer 1973.)
"Milky water" is associated with increases in pH of surface waters dur-
ing summer. Maximum open-water values for pH are now much greater in the
summer than 8.0-8.2 commonly cited in many papers, as pointed out
previously by Schelske and Roth (1973). This fact is confirmed by the
maximum pH of 9.0 recorded by Rousar (Table 2). Data for the conserva-
tive elements and representative values for a number 'of the trace
elements are given in Table 3.
508
-------
Table 3. LAKE MICHIGAN WATER CHEMISTRY FOR
CONSERVATIVE AND TRACE ELEMENTS.
Data on trace elements are from Rossmann (1973).
Element
Ca
Mg
Na
K
so4
Cl
Fe
Mn
Cu
Zn
Co
Ni
Mo
Ba
Concentration (mg/liter)
36
11
3.8
1.4
18
8.0
0.007
0.00084
0.0027
0.004
<0.001
0.0065
0.0018
0.026
MAJOR NUTRIENT CYCLES
Some data are available for the seasonal cycles of phosphorus, nitrogen
and silica in Lake Michigan—these elements and carbon are the major
nutrients for phytoplankton. Supplies o£ carbon are more than adequate
for phytoplankton growth.
Phosphorus concentrations in the lake are low, with total phosphorus
averaging 8.0 yg P/liter (Table 2). Allen (1973) reported averages of
less than 7.0 ug P for samples collected in 1965. Soluble reactive
phosphorus being frequently below 1.5 yg P/liter leads one to question
509
-------
the utility of this measurement, particularly on a routine basis
(Schelske and Callender 1970) . No clear seasonal cycle of either soluble
reactive or total phosphorus is evident from Rousar (1973) or Allen
(1973) but summer values for total phosphorus appear to be smaller than
at other times of the year.
Of the three forms of combined inorganic nitrogen, only nitrate is
quantitatively significant. Concentrations of ammonia and nitrite are
low being only a few percent of the nitrate concentrations. Nitrate
varies seasonally with a maximum in the winter of 0.27 mg N/liter
followed by a steady decline to 0.12 mg N/liter in August (Rousar 1973).
This decline is due to nitrogen utilization for phytoplankton growth.
The seasonal cycle for silica is similar to that for nitrate. A maximum
value of 1.4-1.5 mg Si02/liter occurred for the winter of 1970-1971
(Rousar 1973). Data from the Great Lakes Research Division, University
of Michigan, collected in the spring of 1971, agree well with these
values for the winter, and it seems reasonable therefore to conclude
that the maximum open-lake concentration was no greater than 1.5 mg/liter
(Stoermer 1972). The minimum value reported by Rousar of 0.2 mg/liter
occurred in August. Minimum values during the summer may not be accurate
due to technical problems associated with detecting concentrations lower
than 0.1 mg/liter, but it is clear from unpublished GLRD data that the
minimum is presently less than 0.1 mg/liter.
A more detailed discussion of the seasonal cycle of silica has been
derived from data collected in 1971 by the GLRD as part of a study of
algal quality in southern Lake Michigan (Stoermer 1972). For this
discussion, silica depletion is defined as concentrations equal to or
less than 0.2 mg/liter.
Silica depletion in 1971 had occurred in localized nearshore areas at the
time of our first collections (in late March and early April). Concen-
trations of 1.4 mg/liter were measured at mid-lake stations, indicating
little utilization by diatoms at this time, but were significantly less
than 1.4 mg/liter at distances as great as 6.4 km offshore.
510
-------
The zone of silica depletion increased in May and June and by June
extended to at least 6.4 km offshore. The mid-lake values ranged from
0.9 to 1.3 mg/liter in May and were generally less than 1.0 mg/liter in
June. Silica concentrations in June over much of the lake were less than
0.7 mg/liter, indicating that half the silica reserve in the euphotic
zone had been utilized by diatoms.
Silica was essentially depleted in the euphotic zone to a depth of 20 m
in July. In August and September concentrations remained low, generally
< 0.2 mg/liter over the study area.
Increases in silica in surface waters from the spring-summer lows were
not evident until the October cruise when concentrations ranged from 0.3
to 0.5 mg/liter. Concentrations did not increase greatly on the next
and last cruise at the end of October, as most values ranged from 0.3 to
0.6 mg/liter. Rousar did not find maximum values in the epilimnion until
January.
PHYTOPLANKTON
Based on the report of "more than 700 morphologically distinguishable
entities" in a study of plankton diatoms from Lake Michigan (Stoermer
and Yang 1969), one might conclude that the phytoplankton had been
studied extensively. Such a conclusion would be erroneous for a number
of reasons recognized by Stoermer and Yang. First, many of the data
analyzed were from nearshore regions that differ physically, chemically
and biologically from the open lake. Second, there is a lack of season-
al data. The only data collected seasonally are those obtained by
sampling municipal water intakes that are necessarily located close to
shore. Third, many of the data were obtained from vertical plankton
tows, so the absolute abundance of organisms in the water cannot be
estimated. Fourth, there are therefore few quantitative data on cell
counts or even on chlorophyll concentrations which might be used to
estimate the biomass of phytoplankton. Stoermer and Yang therefore
511
-------
studied the relative abundance of different organisms in available
collections. With this approach, it was possible to obtain a comparative
data set for samples collected from as early as the 1880's to 1967 and to
make a detailed analysis of 44 common species (Table 4). Because many of
the older samples were preserved as material for diatom identification or
in samples in which other types of algae were destroyed, it was not pos-
sible to work with the complete phytoplankton assemblage.
Historically, the plankton flora of Lake Michigan was dominated by
diatoms (Stoermer 1967; Ahlstrom 1936) as would be expected for a pris-
tine flora (Stoermer and Yang 1969) . It is obvious from other studies
of the Laurentian Great Lakes, particularly Lake Superior which is the
most oligotrophic, that diatoms are the dominant phytoplankton organisms
(Holland 1965; Schelske et al. 1972). It appears from limited studies
of populations in Lake Superior that the phytoplankton assemblage is the
typical Cyalote'ita plankton of oligotrophic lakes as characterized by
Hutchinson (1967). The available collections from Lake Michigan indi-
cate that the oligotrophic Cyolotella plankton is presently never as
dominant as it is in Lake Superior (Holland 1969) .
The species composition of phytoplankton in Lake Michigan changed
markedly in the past 100 years as the result of accelerated eutrophica-
tion and possibly from other forms of pollution. A change from 1930-
1931 to the 1960's was documented by Stoermer (1967). During this time
interval, the number of euplanktonic species that could be considered
indicators of eutrophication increased 70 percent. New species, such as
Stephanodiscus binderanus and Stephanodiscus hantzschii, characteristic
of eutrophic conditions became dominant (Stoermer and Yang 1970). In
addition, more recently the predicted shift (Schelske and Stoermer 1971)
of phytoplankton assemblages dominated by diatoms to those dominated by
blue-green algae has occurred in summer populations (Stoermer 1972).
Seasonally the spring pulse occurs as early as February and as late as
April at the Chicago water intakes, a nearshore location (W. F. Danforth,
111. Inst. Tech., personal communication), but based on chlorophyll it
512
-------
Table 4. DOMINANT DIATOMS IN LAKE MICHIGAN.
As taken from Stoermer and Yang (1970).
Amphipleura pellucida (Kiitz.)
Kutz.
Asterionella formosa Hass.
Cyolotella oomta (Ehr.) Kutz.
C. kuetzingiana Thwaites
C. meneghiniana var. plana
Fricke
C. michiganiana Skv.
C. ooellata Pant.
C. operculata (Agardh) Kutz.
C. pseudostelligera Bust.
Diatoma tenue var. elongation
Lyngb.
D. tenue var. pachycephala Grun.
Fragilaria capucina Desm.
F. ca.puci.na var. lanceolata Grun.
F. cccpucina var. mesolepta Rabh.
F. crotonens-is Kitton
F. intemed-ia Grun.
F. intermedia var. fallax (Grun.)
F. pinnata Ehr.
Melosira granulata (Ehr.) Ralfs
M. granulata var. angustissima
0. Mull.
M. islandica 0. Mull.
Af. italica subsp. siibartioa 0. Mull.
Nitzsehia bacata Bust.
N. dissipata (Kutz.) Grun.
N. recta Hantz.
Nitzschia sp. #2.
Rhizosolenia eriensis H. L. Smith
Stephanodiscus alpinus Hust.
S. binderanus (Kutz.) Krieger
S. hantzschii Grun.
S. minutus Grun.
S. niagarae Ehr.
S. subtilis (Van Goor) A. Cleve
S. tenuis Hust.
S. trans-Llvon-icus Pant.
Synedra delicatissima var.
angustissima Grun.
S. demerarae Grun.
S. filiforrrri-s Grun.
S. ostenfeldii (Krieger) A. Cleve
S. ulna var. chaseana Thomas.
5. ulna var. danica (Kutz.) V.H.
Tabellari-a fenestrata (Lyngb.)
Kutz.
T. fenestrata var. geniculata
A. Cleve
T. flocculosa (Roth) Kutz.
513
-------
does not occur until May or June in the offshore waters between Milwaukee
and Ludington (Rousar 1973). One would expect the pulse to be delayed
from south to north due to cooler air temperatures and from the shore to
open lake due to slower increases in offshore water temperature. These
effects are related to the length of the lake and the thermal bar. The
latter effect is evident in the data presented by Ladewski and Stoermer
(1973) and by Stoermer (1972). The summer minimum occurs in late August
and September followed by an autumnal pulse smaller than the spring
maximum. According to Rousar's data, chlorophyll a concentrations for
the open lake average 4.5 mg/m^ during the spring pulse, 3.0 mg/m^ for
the fall pulse and about 1.0 mg/nr during the summer minimum. Ladewski
and Stoermer (1973) found a spring maximum of 2.7 mg/m^, a fall maximum
of 1.8 rng/m^ and a summer minimum of 0.7 mg/nr* from data averaged for 13
offshore stations (Fig. 4). Allen (1973) reported a minimum of 0.5 mg/m^
and a maximum of 2.4 mg/m^.
In terms of species composition the spring pulse is dominated by diatoms
and the summer minimum by blue-greens (Stoermer 1972). Blue-greens in
surface samples in 1971 comprised a major fraction of the phytoplankton
counts from late August until late October when sampling was terminated
(Stoermer 1972); percentages of blue-greens exceeded 80% in many of the
samples. The dominant species was Anacystis ineevta.
The spring pulse from 1968-1972 at Chicago was dominated by S.
bindeTonus and S. hantzsahiij while the autumn maximum consisted mainly
of Astepionetla, Fragila^ia3 and TabeZtcon-a (Danforth, personal communi-
cation) . S. hantzschii and S. bindspanus were not common at the Chicago
filtration plants until 1956 and 1960, respectively— these species
apparently replaced Melosira islandioa indicating severe environmental
perturbation (Stoermer and Yang 1970), presumably nutrient enrichment.
Holland (1968, 1969) found that M. islandioa was dominant in the open
waters during May and June, but was replaced by other species of Metosiva
in more eutrophic areas; one of the species of Melosira, M. bindevana is
a synonym for S. binderanus. Fluctuations in the standing crops of
514
-------
12
CO
0>
E
O
u
>•
2
X
U
8
May July Sept
Nov
Figure 4. Chlorophyll concentration in 1971 averaged
by depth range and month. See Figure 3 for key.
(From Ladewski and Stoermer 1973.)
515
-------
common diatoms from May to October in northern Lake Michigan have been
studied by Holland (1969).
The relative abundance of Chlorophyta, Chrysophyta, and Cyanophyta in
the offshore plankton was studied by Stoermer (1967) . Each group
comprised only a minor part of the phytoplankton compared to the
Bacillariophyta. Some of the more abundant forms of green algae were
Botryooooous brawLi Kutz., Closterium aeLaulape West, Diotyosphaerium
pulohellum Wood, Sphaevooystis sdhroeteiri, Chodat, and several species of
Oooystis Nageli. The main genus of Chrysophyta was Dinobryon Ehr..
Five species were recorded, but the dominant one was D. divevgens Imhof.
Blue-greens were represented by Chvoooooaus lirmeticus Lemm., C. minutus
(Kutz.) Nageli, Coelosphaeriwn naege'i'ianum Unger, Gomphosphaeria
laeustris Chodat, and Oseillatom-a mougeotia Kutz.
Phytoplankton productivity is relatively low with summer values averaging
about 4.0 mg C/m^/hr (Schelske and Callender 1970). Annual rates of
carbon fixation for offshore waters ranged from 121-139 g C/m^ at three
offshore stations between Ludington and Milwaukee as compared to a
maximum value of 247 g C/m^ at a nearshore station near Milwaukee (Fee
1973). Phytoplankton productivity in the Great Lakes has been compared
by Vollenweider et al. (1974).
ZOOPLANKTON
Studies of zooplankton have concentrated mainly on the Crustacea
(Table 5) with very little being known about Protozoa or Rotifers
including their taxonomy (Gannon 1972a). There are no data on open-
water zooplankton prior to 1954 (Wells 1970) or for the winter months.
Zooplankton studies on the Great Lakes have been reviewed by Watson
(1974).
Wells (1970) found changes between 1954 and 1966 in both the size and
species composition of zooplankton populations. Size-selective preda-
516
-------
Table 5. ZOOPLANKTON CRUSTACEA OF LAKE MICHIGAN.
Common Gannon
Species (1972a)
Copepods
Diaptomus ashlandi Marsh
Diaptomus minutus Lilljeborg
Diaptomus oregonensis Lilljeborg
Diaptomus sicilis Forbes
Episehura laoustris Forbes
Eurytemora affinis (Poppe)
Limnooalanus maorurus Sars
Seneoella calanoides Juday
Cyclops biouspidatus thomasi Glaus
Cyclops vemalis Fischer
Eucyclops agilis (Koch)
Mesocyclops edax (Forbes)
Tropocyolops prasinus mexicanus Kiefer
Canthooamptus robertookeri M.S. Wilson
Cladocera
Bosmina longirostris (Muller)
Eubosmina coregoni Baird
Daphnia galeata-mendotae Birge
Daphnia longiremis Sars
Daphnia retpocuwa Forbes
Daphnia schtfdleri Sars
Ceriodaphnia lacustris Birge
Ceriodaphnia quadrangula (Muller)
Alona affinis (Ley dig)
Chydorus sphaericus (Muller)
Holopedium gibberum Zaddach
Leptodora kindtii (Focke)
Polyphemus pedioulus (L.)
Diaphanosoma leuehteribergianum Fischer
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Wells
(1970)
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
a
a
X
X
X
X
Roth and
Stewart
(1973)
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Ceriodaphnia species.
517
-------
tion by alewife was given as the most likely factor for the change.
The largest species, Leptodora kindtii Daphnia galeata-mendotae3 D.
vetroourva., Limnooalanus maerurus, Epischura laaustvis, Diaptomus
sieilis and Mesocyalops edax, declined in abundance with D. galeata-
mendotae and M. edax decreasing from abundant to extremely rare. At the
same time smaller species increased in abundance. Species such as M.
edax3 D. galeata-mendotae, Diaptomus oregonensis, Diaphanosoma
leuchtenbergianum and L. kindtii that decreased in Lake Michigan due to
selective predation are abundant in Green Bay. Gannon (1972b) concluded
that size-selective predation had a smaller effect on zooplankton
Crustacea in Green Bay than in open Lake Michigan because higher rates
of primary productivity support greater rates of zooplankton production
in Green Bay. If greater primary productivity is a causal factor it
would be related directly to eutrophication.
Eurytemora, a marine species, has invaded the lake— it was recorded by
Wells (1970) in 1966 but not in 1954 and by other workers (Table 5).
Seasonal distribution of the major groups appears quite simple. Copepods
are present throughout the year, but cladocerans are found only during
the summer. Gannon's data indicate that cladocerans do not appear until
thermal stratification is present and persist until the lake becomes
homothermous. Cyclops biauspidatus thomasi is the most abundant copepod
with Diaptomus ashlandi, Diaptomus minutus, Diaptomus oregonensis,
Diaptomus sieilis and Limnooalanus maaruvus being common but less
abundant. Cladocera are most abundant from June to September with the
maximum populations occurring in July and August when copepods are also
most abudant. In the summer the dominant species are the copepods, C.
bicuspidatus thomasi, Diaptomus ashlandi and the cladocerans, Bosmina
longirostris, Daphnia petrocurvaj and Daphnia galeata-mendotae. Bosmina
dominates the zooplankton in July and August. Later in the summer during
August and September Daphnia replaces Bosmina as the dominant cladoceran.
Quantitative data on zooplankton abundance are lacking, with only four
studies of major importance. Each of these studies was restricted to
518
-------
small areas of the lake or to few stations. In addition, the data are
not comparable as two different methods were used. Wells (1970) used
horizontal tows with a calibrated Clarke-Bumpus sampler and 0.366 mm
silk net; Gannon (1972a), Roth and Stewart (1973), and Stewart (1974)
used vertical tows with a 0.5-m diameter nylon net. Gannon used a
0.256-mm aperture and Roth and Stewart used a 0.158-mm aperture. All of
the data are reported as individuals/m. Gannon's station was 60 m deep
and Roth and Stewart's stations were 14 m for the nearshore station and
40 m for the offshore station. Gannon reported a maximum crop of 8300
individuals/m3 in August, whereas Roth and Stewart (1973) reported
maxima of 130,000 individuals/m^ in July at the offshore station and
280,000 individuals/m^ at the nearshore station in August. Roth and
Stewart considered that some of these differences may have been due to
more immature forms being collected by their smaller mesh net, but
concluded that the main factor was greater productivity in their study
area.
Roth and Stewart (1973) also noted differences between their offshore
and inshore station. The cladoceran bloom appeared to start earlier at
the nearshore station and contained a greater proportion of cladocerans
than the offshore station, presumably an effect attributable to earlier
warming at the inshore station. The large population of Bosmina
longirostris at the nearshore station was attributed in part to size-
selective feeding by abundant nearshore fish on zooplankton. Whether
the inshore station contained larger standing crops of zooplankton is a
question of data interpretation, since the offshore station was three
times deeper than the nearshore station. Maximum standing crops on an
areal basis therefore would have occurred at the offshore station,
because abundances at the nearshore station were seldom greater than a
factor of two larger than the offshore station. Actually the largest
standing crop of zooplankton, 360 mg dry weight/m^, occurred at the
offshore station in July; the largest standing crop at the nearshore
station was 280 mg dry weight/m^ in August. Biomass values were as low
as 30 mg dry weight/m3 in April.
519
-------
BENTHOS
Knowledge of the benthos is restricted mainly to the macroinvertebrates.
Numerically the fauna in the main lake is dominated by Amphipoda,
Oligochaeta, Sphaeriidae, and Chironomidae in that order (Robertson and
Alley 1966). Nearshore Gastropoda, Hirudinea, other Insecta and other
Crustacea may be numerous (Mozley 1974). In the main lake, Pontoporeia
affinis is the only species of Amphipoda. Cook and Johnson (1974) have
reviewed several aspects of studies on macrobenthos of the Great Lakes.
Powers and Alley (1967) investigated the depth distribution of benthos.
Maximum numbers occurred at 30 m, with large numbers being present at 40
and 50 m. At depths of 20 m and greater, Pontopore-ia was the dominant
organism, comprising more than 50 percent of the total counts. Propor-
tions of Pontoporeia increased with depth, with 75 percent of the total
being at depths greater than 80 m. At 30 m, the mean and standard
deviation of total counts/m^ was 15,000 + 6,700 and at 40 and 50 m it was
11,000 + 5,000. At 30, 40 and 50 m, the mean and standard deviation for
Pontoporeia was 8,600 + 3,700, 6,800 + 3,100 and 6,300 + 2,800. The mean
number of benthic organisms declined to less than 1,000 at depths greater
than 200 m. Average standing crops (dry weight) of macrobenthos ranged
from highs of 10 and 20 g/m^ at 30 and 10 m to approximately 0.3 g/m2 at
depths greater than 200 m.
At depths less than 30 m, the second most abundant group of organisms is
the Tubificidae (Mozley 1974). This group of oligochaetes, composed of a
number of species, is dominated by LimnodvUus hoffmeisteri, Potcmothi*ix
moldaviensis, Pelosoolex freyi, P. ferox and Tubifex tubifex. In
addition, the lumbriculid oligochaete Stylodrilus heringianus is abundant
at depths greater than 20 m (Hiltunen 1967).
Sphaerids are most abundant at 30 m and also occurred abundantly at
depths of 60 m and less. There are three species of SphaeTium, S.
nitidwn, S. stviati-num, and S. oomeum, and at least nine species of
(Robertson 1967). The deep water species, P. oonventus, is the
520
-------
most abundant Pisiditffn. In shallow water, P. ca.ser~ta.nwn, P. henslowanum
and P. lill-jebofgi are the most abundant species.
Chironomids form a relatively minor part of the benthos, with maximum
counts averaging 200/m2 at 40 and 50 m (Powers and Alley 1967) . This
group is complex from the taxonomic standpoint, so species identification
is either not attempted or is questionable in many studies. Certain
species have been considered pollution tolerant and others as pollution
intolerant, thereby types of chironomids have been used to assess
environmental quality (Brinkhurst, Hamilton and Herrington 1968; Mozley,
In prep.).
The benthic fauna in deep waters has been affected little by environmental
changes. Although abundances of Pontoporeia and oligochaetes were signifi-
cantly greater in 1964 than in 1931, Robertson and Alley (1966) stated "no
definite conclusions can be reached concerning long-term trends" due to
expected year-to-year variations in abundances. Severe changes in benthic
organisms have occurred in localized areas, harbors, bays, and river mouths,
but extensive changes over large areas have been observed only in southern
Green Bay (Howmiller and Beeton 1970). In southern Green Bay, drastic
changes have been documented, including the disappearance of mayfly nymphs
(Hexagenia), a change that also occurred in the western basin of Lake Erie
as the result of oxygen depletion (Britt 1955).
FISH
Much has been written about the fish fauna, partly reflecting the concern
over decreases in the abundance of species in the commercial fishery.
Wells and McLain (1973) summarized many of the papers dealing with the
history of fish and list 38 species (Table 6) as "all common fish of
Lake Michigan, past and present." A much longer list of species,
numbering 70 to 75, resulted from intensive sampling of species that "are
extremely rare or transients that normally inhabit streams, inland lakes
or protected bays" (Jude et al. 1975). Only 32 of these 70 species were
521
-------
Table 6. PAST AND PRESENT COMMON FISH OF LAKE MICHIGAN.
Sea lamprey3
Lake sturgeon
Alewifea
Lake whitefish
Blackfin cisco
Deepwater Cisco
Longjaw cisco
Shortjaw cisco
Bloater
Kiyi
Shortnose cisco
Lake herring
Round whitefish
Lake trout
Brook trout
Rainbow trout (steelhead)a
Brown trout a
Coho salmona
Chinook salmon3
Rainbow smelt3
Northern pike
Carpa
Emerald shiner
Spottail shiner
Longnose sucker
White sucker
Channel catfish
Bullheads
Trout-perch
Burbot
Ninespine stickleback
Smallmouth bass
Yellow perch
Walleye
Freshwater drum
Slimy sculpin
Spoonhead sculpin
Fourhorn sculpin
Petromyzon mar-inus
Aaipenser fulvescens
Alosa pseudoharengus
Coregonus oZupeaformis
Coregonus nigripinnis
Coregonus johannae
Coregonus alpenae
Coregonus zenifkicus
Coregonus hoyi-
Coregonus kiyi
Coregonus reighardi
Coregonus artedH
Prosopium cylindraceurn
Salvelinus namayaush
Salvelinus fontinalis
Salmo gairdneri,
Salmo trutta
Oncorhynahus kisutch
Oncorhynchus tshauytscha
Osmerus mordax
Esox luaius
Cyprinus carpio
Notropis atherinoides
Notropis hudsonius
Catostomus aatostomus
Catostomus aommersoni,
Ictalurus punctatus
letalurus spp.
Percops-is omi,scomaycus
Lota Iota
Pungitius pungitius
Micropterus dolomieui.
Peraa flavesaens
Stizostedion witreum witrewn
Aplodinotus grunniens
Cottus aognatus
Cottus r-Lcei,
Myoxocephalus quadri-aornis
a Species that have been introduced or invaded the lake.
522
-------
collected in both years of the two-year study of a nearshore area in the
southeastern part of the lake.
During the period of historical record, eight common species were either
introduced or gained access to the lake (Table 6). The rainbow trout or
steelhead, brown trout and carp have been present in Lake Michigan since
the turn of the century. A few chinook salmon were introduced between
1873 and 1880 but they did not become established. Extensive stocking of
coho salmon and chinook salmon began in 1966 and 1967. It was originally
thought that these species would not reproduce in the Great Lakes and,
although there is ample evidence that spawning runs have been established
in streams in Wisconsin and Michigan, it is still not certain if these
spawning runs would continue if stocking was discontinued. Another salmon
from the Pacific Ocean was introduced with the release of 2,000 masu
salmon (OncoThynohus masou) in 1920, and some 645,000 Atlantic salmon
(Salmo solar) were released in the lake between 1872 and 1932, but
neither became established. The pink salmon (Oncorhynchus gorbuseha) is
the only introduced salmon that has established self-sustaining popula-
tions. It was introduced in Thunder Bay, Lake Superior in 1956 and has
recently spread to Lakes Huron and Michigan.
Three of the species presently common in the lake are native to the
Atlantic Ocean. First records of the rainbow smelt in 1923, the sea
lamprey in 1936 and the alewife in 1949 represent relatively recent
introductions. The smelt in Lake Michigan originated from a planting in
Crystal Lake, Michigan in 1912 (Van Oosten 1937). The alewife and sea
lamprey probably entered the Great Lakes drainage via the Erie Canal
which linked the Mohawk-Hudson River system entering the Atlantic Ocean
with the Oneida-Oswego River system entering Lake Ontario (Smith 1970;
Aron and Smith 1971) . They became established in Lake Ontario and
subsequently circumvented the natural barrier at Niagara Falls and reached
the other Great Lakes via the Welland Canal.
Some of the introduced species have caused severe environmental problems
as well as (at least on the short term) environmental benefits. Most
523
-------
experts on the problems of the commercial fisheries of the Great Lakes
attribute some of the cause to the invasion by the sea lamprey. In Lake
Michigan, during its period of maximum abundance in the 1950's, the sea
lampreys destroyed from five to twelve million pounds of fish per year.
At this time the prey was largely deepwater ciscoes, as most of the lake
trout had disappeared (Smith 1968). Control measures for sea lamprey
have been successful. Adult fish are trapped in weirs on the spawning
streams,and the larvae are killed in the spawning streams with the
selective larvicide, 3-trifluoromethyl-4-nitrophenol.
With the decline in lake trout and other large predators, the population
explosion of alewives resulted, reaching a climax in 1967 with massive
dieoffs of alewives. Dead fish clogged municipal and industrial water
intakes and littered beaches, detracting from their desirability for
swimming and creating costly problems of removal. Coho salmon and
chinook salmon from the Pacific Ocean have been introduced since 1966 and
1967, partly to overcome the problem of over-population with alewives,
providing a predator to check population increases and large fish for a
sport fishery. Results were dramatic, the salmon flourished on the abundant
alewives and provided an excellent sport fishery. In Lake Michigan the
largest fish caught by angling have been a 13.7 kg coho, only .4 kg less
than the world's record, and a 19.6 kg chinook.
Although largely successful, stocking Pacific salmon has not been with-
out its environmental repercussions. When salmon mature they return to
spawn in the stream in which they were stocked. These spawning runs of
salmon have been extensive, creating a bonanza for fishermen in the
streams. They also provide large numbers of fish that can be removed by
unsportsmanlike means including snagging. Dead fish often litter the
streams as they die after spawning or are caught and discarded by fisher-
men who do not value fish in poor spawning condition.
Historically and continuing to the present time, the most common native
and introduced fish, especially the large predators, are species
characteristic of oligotrophic environments. This fact alone leads one
524
-------
to conclude that some of the characteristics of open Lake Michigan are
definitely oligotrophic. The original fish fauna included 10 species of
coregonids (Table 6) and one salmonid. Of these the lake whitefish, lake
herring and lake trout were taken in the largest quantities by the
fishery. Whitefish are recovering as a result of sea lamprey control,
and lake trout are being maintained through artificial stocking, but the
other species are no longer abundant. All of these species have been
sought actively by commercial fishermen and have been significant in the
commercial fishery.
Commercial fishing in Lake Michigan began at least as early as 1843
primarily for abundant nearshore populations of lake whitefish. "By 1860
certain grounds for this species were becoming depleted and by the 1870's
complaints about the scarcity of whitefish were common" (Wells and McLain
1973). Logging and dumping sawdust in streams were factors in the
decline. Other species were abundant in the fishery and then declined.
For example, catches of lake trout averaged eight million pounds in the
early 1900?s, declined to five million pounds in the 1930's and increased
to more than six million pounds in the early 1940's before declining
sharply in the late 1940's. By the mid-1950's, the lake trout was
believed to be extinct.
The total commercial production was greatest from 1893-1908 when the
average harvest was 41 million pounds yearly. Production dropped between
1908 and 1911, due primarily to a decrease in catches of lake herring,
and then fluctuated with catches ranging from 20 to 30 million pounds
until 1966 when catches of alewives became large. The peak year was 1967
when the total catch was 60 million pounds, of which 42 million pounds
were alewives.
Causes for changes in the fish fauna are not fully explained (Smith 1972).
Some of the factors have been modification of the drainage basin first by
logging and then by agriculture, influences of urbanization and industri-
alization, invasion of the sea lamprey, and undoubtedly the effects of
overfishlng for commercial species (Smith 1972).
525
-------
ASSESSMENT OF TROPHIC CHANGE
Basically either chemical or biological approaches can be used to deter-
mine changes in the trophic status of lakes. Detectable changes in the
biota should be those that result from nutrient enrichment of the system
or in the case of Lake Michigan from increased loading of phosphorus.
Of the biota only the phytoplankton can be used to determine changes in
trophic state of Lake Michigan. Qualitatively, the benthic community has
been affected little by nutrient enrichment, and quantitatively the
problems of large variances in sampling invoke the need for large differ-
ences to detect changes in standing crops (Mozley 1974). No zooplankton
data are available for long-term assessments of standing crop and there
is no direct evidence that changes can be used to assess trophic changes—
the latter aspect also is confused by size-selective predation by fish
and its resultant shifts in species composition. Many changes in the
abundance and species composition of fish have been documented, but these
"have been largely unexplained and have been a subject of uncertainty and
controversy" (Smith 1972). One of the reasons that changes in trophic
state have not been obvious is that the biological communities of the
open waters, with the exception of the phytoplankton, continue to be
those characteristic of oligotrophic environments.
Changes in the phytoplankton species composition have been documented,
and the cause for the change has been related to increased inputs of phos-
phorus. Changes in species composition have occurred that apparently
reflect nutrient enrichment. Changes in the diatom flora have been
documented in papers by Stoermer and Stoermer and Yang from data
collected in the early 1960's. Another shift in species composition has
occurred due to depletion of silica in the euphotic zone during the
summer—this shift is the replacement of diatoms by blue-green algae as
the phytoplankton dominant. These blue-greens, however, are not Anabaena
flos-aquae or Mieroeystis, the most common nuisance forms, and the
standing crops are not large due to the relatively low levels of phos-
phorus in the system.
526
-------
It is possible that much of this change is relatively recent, perhaps
the most serious changes have occurred in the last 20 years. Nuisance
species of Stephana discus, S. ln.antzsohii and S. binderanus, did not
appear in the phytoplankton at the Chicago water intake prior to 1956.
In the mid-1950's (Ayers et al. 1958) and in the early 1960's (Risley
and Fuller 1965), reported levels of silica during the summer that would
not limit diatom growth. But by 1969, levels over the entire lake basin
were no greater than 0.2 mg SiC>2/liter in the epilimnetic waters
(Schelske and Callender 1970). Further evidence for a relatively recent
effect caused by increased inputs of phosphorus comes from recent
mathematical modelling of phytoplankton growth in Lake Ontario (Thomann
et al. 1975). This model indicates that three detention times or 24
years are needed to reach a steady state. In Lake Michigan it would be
more appropriate to use three residence times for phosphorus or approx-
imately 18 years as the time needed to reach equilibrium. The model
suggests that effects of increased phosphorus loading will not be
manifested in the lake immediately and would have been delayed from the
first large increases in loading, probably in the 1940's.
If there is a significant delay between the time of phosphorus inputs
and the effects produced in the biological system, then one can accept
the hypothesis that major changes in the open-water phytoplankton have
occurred in the past 20 years. If this is true it may also be one of the
reasons why there has not been a measurable effect in the benthos and
other components of the biological system.
Assessing differences or changes in trophic state of oligotrophic waters
from biomass of phytoplankton or concentrations of chlorophyll a may not
be practical as relatively large differences or intensive sampling may be
required. It is not certain that a statistically significant increase of
0.5 mg/m^ in the spring maximum of chlorophyll a could be detected on a
lakewide basis as this would represent an increase of 20 percent. It
seems obvious more sensitive techniques are needed. One technique that
offers increased sensitivity is the use of environmental parameters that
integrate environmental processes. Hypolimnetic oxygen depletion has
527
-------
been used for this purpose in shallower lakes, but there is little change
in hypolimnetic oxygen concentrations in Lake Michigan. Schelske (1975)
proposed that silica and nitrate depletion in the euphotic zone during
summer stratification could be used to assess trophic state.
Chemical changes or utilization of nitrate and silica in the upper Great
Lakes are related to trophic state in the upper Great Lakes. Reserves of
these nutrients in surface waters (photic zone) are depleted by phyto-
plankton during summer stratification. Reserves, as indicated by
differences in concentrations between bottom and surface waters, are
related inversely to trophic state: Lake Superior, the most oligotrophic,
has the greatest reserves, and Lake Michigan, the most eutrophic, has the
smallest reserves (Fig. 5).
In conclusion, one would expect eutrophication of Lake Michigan to be a
function of increasing phosphorus concentrations. Unfortunately adequate
data are not available for consideration. The rate of silica depletion
may be the most sensitive means of assessing changes in trophic state
since the dominant phytoplankton are diatoms. Diatoms require silica
for growth, so as nutrient enrichment increases standing crops of diatoms
utilize silica in increasing amounts and rates. Even though silica is
depleted in the summer, rates or annual quantities of silica utilized by
diatoms can still be used to assess trophic state. Rates of depletion
would have to be calculated for the spring bloom period. Finally, if
eutrophication of Lake Michigan continues, the total amount of silica in
the lake would continue to decline. Conversely, if eutrophication is
reversed, the total amount of silica in the lake should remain constant
or increase.
Contribution No. 192 of the Great Lakes Research Division, The University
of Michigan.
528
-------
0.3
0.2
to
9 o.i
Surface
I Bottom
w/f
o>
-------
REFERENCES
Ahlstrom, E. L. The Deep Water Plankton of Lake Michigan, Exclusive of
the Crustacea. Trans. Amer. Microsc. Soc. 55_:286-299, 1936.
Allen, H. E. Seasonal Variation of Nitrogen, Phosphorus, and Chlorophyll
a_ in Lake Michigan and Green Bay, 1965. Bureau of Sport Fisheries
and Wildlife Tech. Paper 70. June 1973. 23 p.
Aron, W. 1. and S. H. Smith. Ship Canals and Aquatic Ecosystems.
Science 174^:13-20, 1971.
Ayers, J. C. and D. C. Chandler. Studies on the Environment and Eu-
trophication of Lake Michigan. Univ. Michigan, Great Lakes Res.
Div. Spec. Rep. 30, 1967. 415 p.
Ayers, J. C., D. C. Chandler, G. H. Lauff, C. F. Powers, and E. B.
Henson. Currents and Water Masses of Lake Michigan. Univ.
Michigan, Great Lakes Res. Div. Pub. 3, 1958. 169 p.
Beeton, A. M. Eutrophication in the St. Lawrence Great Lakes. Limnol.
Oceanogr. 10_: 240-254, 1965.
Beeton, A. M. Changes in the Environment and Biota of the Great Lakes.
In: Eutrophication: Causes, Consequences, Correctives. Washington,
Nat. Acad. Sci. , 1969. p. 150-187.
Beeton, A. M. and D. C. Chandler. The St. Lawrence Great Lakes. In:
Limnology in North America, Frey, D. G. (ed.). Madison, Univ.
Wisconsin Press, 1963. p. 535-558.
Boyce, F. M. Some Aspects of Great Lakes Physics of Importance to
Biological and Chemical Processes. J. Fish. Res. Board Can. 31:
689-730, 1974.
Brinkhurst, R. 0., A. L. Hamilton, and H. B. Herrington. Components of
the Bottom Fauna of the St. Lawrence Great Lakes. Univ. Toronto,
Great Lakes Institute PR 33, 1968. 50 p.
530
-------
Britt, N. W. Stratification in Western Lake Erie in Summer of 1953;
Effects on the Hexageni-a (Ephemeroptera) Population. Ecology 36:
239-244, 1955.
Cook, D. G. and M. G. Johnson. Benthic Macroinvertebrates of the St.
Lawrence Great Lakes. J. Fish. Res. Board Can. 31:763-782, 1974.
Fee, E. J. A Numerical Model for Determining Integral Primary Produc-
tion and its Application to Lake Michigan. J. Fish. Res. Board
Can. 30:1447-1468, 1973.
Gannon, J. E. A Contribution to the Ecology of Zooplankton Crustacea of
Lake Michigan and Green Bay. Ph.D. dissertation, Univ. Wisconsin,
1972a. 257 p.
Gannon, J. E. Effects of Eutrophication and Fish Predation and Recent
Changes in Zooplankton Crustacea Species Composition in Lake
Michigan. Trans. Amer. Microsc. Soc. 9.1:82-84, 1972b.
Hiltunen, J. K. Some Oligochaetes for Lake Michigan. Trans. Amer.
Microsc. Soc. 86_:433-454, 1967.
Holland, R. E. The Distribution and Abundance of Planktonic Diatoms in
Lake Superior. Proc. 8th Conf. Great Lakes Res., Univ. Michigan,
Great Lakes Res. Div. Pub. 13. p. 96-105, 1965.
Holland, R. E. Correlation of Melosira Species with Trophic Conditions
in Lake Michigan. Limnol. Oceanogr. 13^:555-557, 1968.
Holland, R. E. Seasonal Fluctuations of Lake Michigan Diatoms. Limnol.
Oceanogr. 14_:423-436, 1969.
Holland, R. E. and A. M. Beeton. Significance to Eutrophication of
Spatial Differences in Nutrients and Diatoms in Lake Michigan.
Limnol. Oceanogr. 17^88-96, 1972.
Hough, J. L. Geology of the Great Lakes. Urbana, Univ. Illinois Press,
1958. 313 p.
Howmiller, R. P. and A. M. Beeton. The Oligochaete Fauna of Green Bay,
Lake Michigan. Proc. 13th Conf. Great Lakes Res. p. 15-46, 1970.
Internat. Assoc. Great Lakes Res.
531
-------
Huang, J. C. K. The Thermal Bar. Geophysical Fluid Dynamics 3:1-25,
1972.
i
Hutchinson, G. E. A Treatise of Limnology. Vol. I. Geography, Physics,
and Chemistry. New York, John Wiley and Sons, 1957. 1015 p.
Hutchinson, G. E. A Treatise on Limnology. Vol. II. An Introduction
to Lake Biology and the Limnoplankton. New York, John Wiley and
Sons, 1967. 1115 p.
Jude, D. J., F. J. Tesar, J. A. Dorr HI, T. J. Miller, P. J. Rago, and
D. J. Stewart. Inshore Lake Michigan Fish Populations Near the
Donald C. Cook Nuclear Power Plant. Univ. Michigan, Great Lakes
Res. Div. Spec. Rep. 52, 1975. 267 p.
Ladewski, T. B. and E. F. Stoermer. Water Transparency in Southern
Lake Michigan in 1971 and 1972. Proc. 16th Conf. Great Lakes Res.
p. 791-807, 1973. Internat. Assoc. Great Lakes Res.
Millar, F. G. Surface Temperatures of the Great Lakes. J. Fish. Res.
Board Can. 9j 329-376, 1952.
Mortimer, C. H. Lake Hydrodynamics. Mitt. Internat. Verein. Limnol.
(Stuttgart) 22:124-197, 1974.
Mozley, S. C. Preoperational Distribution of Benthic Macroinvertebrates
in Lake Michigan Near the Cook Nuclear Power Plant. In: E. Seibel
and J. C. Ayers, The Biological, Chemical, and Physical Character
of Lake Michigan in the Vicinity of the Donald C. Cook Nuclear
Power Plant. Univ. Michigan, Great Lakes Res. Div. Spec. Rep. 51,
1974. p. 5-137.
Mozley, S. C. Zoobenthos of Lake Ontario—A Review of Recent Field Studies
In prep., U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Ecol. Res. Series.
Powers C. F. and W. P. Alley. Some Preliminary Observations on the
Depth Distribution of Macrobenthos in Lake Michigan. In: J. C.
Ayers and D. C. Chandler, Studies on the Environment and Eutrophi-
cation of Lake Michigan. Univ. Michigan, Great Lakes Res. Div.
Spec. Rep. 30, 1967. p. 112-125.
5.32.
-------
Risley, C., Jr. and F. D. Fuller. Chemical Characteristics of Lake
Michigan. Proc. 8th Conf. Great Lakes Res., Univ. Michigan, Great
Lakes Res. Div. Pub. 13. p. 168-174, 1965.
Robertson, A. A Note on the Sphaeriidae of Lake Michigan. In: J. C.
Ayers and D. C. Chandler, Studies on the Environment and Eutrophica-
tion of Lake Michigan. Univ. Michigan, Great Lakes Res. Div. Spec.
Rep. 30, 1967. p. 132-135.
Robertson, A. and W. P. Alley. A Comparative Study of Lake Michigan
Macrobenthos. Limnol. Oceanogr. 1^:576-583, 1966.
Rodgers, G. K. The Thermal Bar in the Laurentian Great Lakes. Proc. 8th
Conf. Great Lakes Res., Univ. Michigan, Great Lakes Res. Div. Pub.
13. p. 358-363, 1965.
Rossmann, R. Lake Michigan Ferromanganese Nodules. Ph.D. dissertation,
Univ. Michigan, 1973. 155 p.
Roth, J. C. and J. A. Stewart. Nearshore Zooplankton of Southeastern
Lake Michigan, 1972. Proc. 16th Conf. Great Lakes. Res. p. 132-
142, 1973. Internat. Assoc. Great Lakes Res.
Rousar, D. C. Seasonal and Spatial Changes in Primary Production and
Nutrients in Lake Michigan. Water, Air, and Soil Pollution 2^:497-
514, 1973.
Schelske, C. L. Nutrient Inputs and Their Relationship to Accelerated
Eutrophication in Lake Michigan. In: Biological Effects in the
Hydrobiological Cycle, Monke, E. J. (ed.). Proc. 3d Internat.
Symp. for Hydrology Professors, Purdue Univ., Dept. Agricultural
Eng., 1971. 1974. p. 59-81.
Schelske, C. L. Silica and Nitrate Depletion as Related to Rate of
Eutrophication in Lakes Michigan, Huron, and Superior. In:
Coupling of Land and Water Systems, Hasler, A. D. (ed.). New York,
Springer-Verlag New York Inc., 1975. p. 277-298.
Schelske, C. L. and E. Callender. Survey of Phytoplankton Productivity
and Nutrients in Lake Michigan and Lake Superior. Proc. 13th Conf.
Great Lakes Res. p. 93-105, 1970. Internat. Assoc. Great Lakes Res.
533
-------
Schelske, C. L., L. E. Feldt, M. A. Santiago, and E. F. Stoermer.
Nutrient Enrichment and its Effect on Phytoplankton Production and
Species Composition in Lake Superior. Proc. 15th Conf. Great Lakes
Res. p. 149-165, 1972. Internat. Assoc. Great Lakes Res.
Schelske, C. L. and J. C. Roth. Limnological Survey of Lakes Michigan,
Superior, Huron and Erie. Univ. Michigan, Great Lakes Res. Div.
Pub. 17, 1973. 108 p.
Schelske, C. L., E. D. Rothman, E. F. Stoermer, and M. A. Santiago.
Responses of Phosphorus Limited Lake Michigan Phytoplankton to
Factorial Enrichments with Nitrogen and Phosphorus. Limnol.
Oceanogr. 19_: 409-419, 1974.
Schelske, C. L., M. S. Simmons, and L. E. Feldt. Phytoplankton Responses
to Phosphorus and Silica Enrichments in Lake Michigan. In press,
Verh. Internat. Verein. Limnol.
Schelske, C. L. and E. F. Stoermer. Eutrophication, Silica Depletion
and Predicted Changes in Algal Quality in Lake Michigan. Science
l_73:423-424, 1971.
Schelske, C. L. and E. F. Stoermer. Phosphorus, Silica and Eutrophica-
tion of Lake Michigan. In: Nutrients and Eutrophication, A. Soc.
Limnol. Oceanogr., Spec. Symp. 1, Likens, G. E. (ed.), 1972.
p. 157-171.
Sly, P. G. and R. L. Thomas. Review of Geological Research as it Relates
to an Understanding of Great Lakes Limnology. J. Fish. Res. Board
Can. 31:795-825, 1974.
Smith, S. H. Species Succession and Fishery Exploitation in the Great
Lakes. J. Fish. Res. Board Can. 2_5_:667-693, 1968.
Smith, S. H. Species Interaction of the Alewife in the Great Lakes.
Trans. Amer. Fish. Soc. 9_9_: 754-765, 1970.
Smith, S. H. Destruction of the Ecosystem in the Great Lakes and
Possibilities for its Reconstruction. Univ. Wash. Pubs, in
Fisheries, New Series 5_: 41-46, 1972.
534
-------
Stewart, J. A. Lake Michigan Zooplankton Communities in the Area of
the Cook Nuclear Plant. In: E. Seibel and J. C. Ayers, The
Biological, Chemical, and Physical Character of Lake Michigan in
the Vicinity of the Donald C. Cook Nuclear Plant. Univ. Michigan,
Great Lakes Res. Div. Spec. Rep. 51, 1974. p. 211-311.
Stoermer, E. F. An Historical Comparison of Offshore Phytoplankton
Populations in Lake Michigan. In: J. C. Ayers and D. C. Chandler,
Studies on the Environment and Eutrophication of Lake Michigan.
Univ. Michigan, Great Lakes Res. Div. Spec. Rep. 30, 1967.
p. 47-77.
Stoermer, E. F. Nearshore Phytoplankton Populations in the Grand Haven,
Michigan, Vicinity during Thermal Bar Conditions. Proc. llth Conf.
Great Lakes Res. p. 137-150, 1968. Internat. Assoc. Great Lakes
Res.
Stoermer, E. F. Statement. In: Conf. Pollution of Lake Michigan and
its Tributary Basin,Illinois, Indiana, Michigan, and Wisconsin -
4th Session, Sept. 19-21, 1972, Chicago, 111. U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency. Vol. I. p. 217-254.
Stoermer, E. F. and J. J. Yang. Plankton Diatom Assemblages in Lake
Michigan. Univ. Michigan, Great Lakes Res. Div. Spec. Rep. 47,
1969. 268 p.
Stoermer, E. F. and J. J. Yang. Distribution and Relative Abundance of
Dominant Plankton Diatoms in Lake Michigan. Univ. Michigan, Great
Lakes Res. Div. Pub. 16, 1970. 64 p.
Thomann, R. V., D. M. DiToro, R. P. Winfield, and D. J. O'Connor.
Mathematical Modeling of Phytoplankton in Lake Ontario. 1. Model
Development and Verification. U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
Corvallis, Or. Publication Number EPA-660-/3-75-005. 1975. 177 p.
Van Oosten, J. The Dispersal of Smelt, Osmerus movdax (Mitchill), in the
Great Lakes Region. Trans. Amer. Fish. Soc. 66_:160-171, 1937.
535
-------
Vollenweider, R. A., M. Munawar, and P. Stadelmann. A Comparative Review
of Phytoplankton and Primary Production in the Laurentian Great
Lakes. J. Fish. Res. Board Can. 3^:739-762, 1974.
Watson, N. H. F. Zooplankton of the St. Lawrence Great Lakes - Species
Composition, Distribution, and Abundance. J. Fish. Res. Board Can.
31:783-794, 1974.
Wells, L. Effects of Alewife Predation on Zooplankton Populations in
Lake Michigan. Limnol. Oceanogr. 16_:556-565, 1970.
Wells, L. and A. L. McLain. Lake Michigan. Man's Effects on Native
Fish Stocks and Other Biota. Great Lakes Fish. Commission Tech.
Rep. 20. p. 1-55, 1973.
536
-------
•«:*-
Ar
^
'^
"•*^»
jrfss;
s&
&>
^
s?^
u
^:
"o-
^
/?
^/0>/;( ^c
''Op
C^^cc,;;;e
X/».co
c
-------